harry_potter_02
Introduction:
harry potter
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter or any of Jared Campbellâs songs.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Cause fate, itâs in my way
and I donât have the patience to put life on hold,
I think Iâm holding out for something more.
~Fate, Jared Campbell
Eleven-year-old Albus Severus Potter was standing in front of the window in the drawing room of his London house, Grimmauld Place. He had been standing perfectly still for the past two minutes, watching as a dot in the sky got larger and larger until it was recognizable as an owl.
The owl was close now and it looked like it was heading straight for Grimmauld Place. It was close enough for Albus to notice its ruffled brown feathers and the letters wrapped around its legs. Albus gulped and he rubbed his sweaty hands on his pants.
Watching for the morning post had become a routine for Albus over the past few days. As soon as he woke up, he would stand by the window waiting for the owl that he knew would arrive soon. The owl from Hogwarts School of Witchcraft and Wizardry that would bring him his acceptance letter. Albusâs older brother, James, had received his letter a year ago, in mid-July, and Albus was sure his would arrive at roughly the same time.
Albus wrenched open the window and the owl soared inside. It stuck out its leg and Albus quickly detached the letters. The owl gave a loud hoot and then soared out the window. Albus shut it as he rifled through the letters. One was addressed to James. But the other, the other was addressed to Albus.
Albus sat down on the couch and slowly turned the letter over in his hands. He swallowed hard and began to open it with shaking hands. He pulled it out of the envelop and read it.
Albus closed the letter, grinning to himself. It had finally arrived. Albus had been kind of anxious about it the entire summer. He knew it would arrive, but after days of no owls from Hogwarts, he had gotten a bit worried.
Albus stood up and ran to the stairs. He had to wake James up. James had been teasing Albus ever since he returned from Hogwarts, telling him he wouldnât get his letter. Albus knew James liked to joke, but it had gotten a bit irritating by the third week.
Jamesâs bedroom door was closed, but that didnât stop Albus. After all, James always barged into Albusâs room. Albus banged open the door and peered down at James, who was curled up on his bed. He looked rather innocent when he was sleeping, but if anyone could make trouble even while sleeping, it was James.
Albus glanced around the room, trying to think of a creative way to wake him up. He wished he had a wand and could spout water in Jamesâs face.
Albus decided to just go with the old standby of staring at James until he woke up. It usually worked. Albus peered down until he was only inches from James and waited.
All of a sudden, Jamesâs eyes shot open and he jumped back. He hit his head on the wall behind his bed and winced.
âWhat the hell, Al?â James shouted as he rubbed his head, âDo you realize what time it is?â
âNine in the morning,â Albus said, âSorry about your head.â
âItâs ok,â James muttered, âIâll get you back eventually. But why in the name of Merlin did you wake me up so early?â
Albus pulled his letter out of his envelop and proudly shoved it in Jamesâs face. James grabbed it and scanned it. He gave it back to Albus and grinned.
âSee, you got it,â James said.
âI know,â Albus said, âBut youâre the one who said I wouldnât.â
âI was only joking,â James shrugged, âItâs what brothers do. Now you get to do it with Lily.â
Albus shrugged. He sort of doubted Lily would believe him if he told her she wasnât going to Hogwarts. Sheâd been waiting impatiently for her Hogwarts letter since she was five or so. Now she was nine and she still had two years to go.
âOh, you got your book list, too,â Albus handed James the letter addressed to him.
âExcellent,â James grinned as he ripped it open, âMaybe Mum and Dad will get me a broom as an early birthday present. Then I can try out for Seeker this year and not have to use one of those school brooms.â
James was entering his second year and was determined to become Gryffindorâs new Seeker. He had been practicing all summer on one of their mumâs old brooms. Jamesâs birthday was in November and he had been giving their parents not so subtle hints about a new broom ever since he returned home from school.
âWell, Iâm going to go see if we can go to Diagon Alley today,â Albus said.
âThen I can get my broom,â James replied and laid back down.
Albus looked back at James as he left, and noticed that he already had his eyes closed.
Albus ran back downstairs and to the kitchen. Both of his parents were sitting at the table eating eggs and toast.
âIt came!â Albus said proudly as he set his letter down in between his parents.
âCongratulations, Al,â Harry grinned and ruffled Ablusâs hair, âTold you you just had to be patient.â
âThatâs wonderful, Albus,â Ginny got up and kissed the top of his head, âWe can go shopping today, if youâd like.â
âDefinitely,â Albus grinned, âJames wants to go, too. He wants his new broom.â
Ginny rolled her eyes as she put her plate in the sink. âWeâll see about that.â
âMummy!!!!â Lily came shrieking down the stairs.
Albus turned around and saw that she had a hair brush stuck in her hair and her eyes were welling up with tears.
âMummy!â Lily cried, âItâs stuck!â
Ginny sighed and picked up her wand. âLily, what were you doing?â
âI was just trying to make my hair curly like Rosieâs,â Lily pouted as Ginny started to extricate the brush from her hair.
âLily, what have I told you about wrapping your hair around your brush?â Ginny asked.
âNot to do it,â Lily muttered.
âExactly,â Ginny said, âAlbus got his Hogwartâs letter.â
âReally?â Lily shrieked and ran away from Ginny just as she got the brush free, âWhere is it? I want to see!â
Albus grabbed his letter off the table and held it in front of Lily. Lily stared wide eyed at it and tried to grab it away from Albus. Albus held it up above her head.
âI wanna hold it!â Lily shouted.
âNo,â Albus shook his head.
âMum!â Lily shouted, âHe wonât let me see it!â
âItâs his letter, Lils,â Harry replied.
Lily crossed her arms across her chest. âFine. I want to go to Hogwarts, too.â
âYouâre not old enough. You just have to be patient, Lily,â Ginny told her.
Harry snorted into his juice. âI seem to remember someone else who was impatient about going to Hogwarts.â
Ginny smacked Harry playfully on the head with that morningâs copy of the Prophet. âOh, shut it, Harry.â
Albus poured himself a bowl of cereal and sat down just as the fireplace lit up with green flames. It cleared a few seconds later and out stepped a boy in his late teens who had turquoise colored hair.
âTeddy!â Albus shouted and jumped up from the table, âI got my letter just now!â Albus handed Teddy his letter.
âBrilliant,â Teddy grinned and scanned Albusâs letter, âMerlin, I wish I still had another year there.â
âThatâs only because then you could put off deciding what you want to do with your life,â Ginny laughed.
âNo, so I could be there when Albus is there,â Teddy groaned, âBut I suppose youâre right, too.â
âOf course I am,â Ginny said.
âAnyway, I just stopped by to say hi on my way to work,â Teddy said as he grabbed a piece of toast off Harryâs plate.
âAnd to steal my food,â Harry muttered.
âThat, too,â Teddy grinned, âIâm working at the Diagon Alley store today, so will I see you lot there later?â
âYep,â Harry nodded, âWeâll be there. Iâm going to see if Ron and Hermione want to go as well. Rose probably got her letter today.â
âSounds good,â Teddy said as he stepped back into the fireplace and disappeared in green flames.
******
A few hours later (after James had woken up), the Potter family found themselves in Diagon Alley. The street was filled with returning Hogwarts students and their families.
Albus had been to Diagon Alley numerous times before, but there was something very exciting about going there to buy supplies for Hogwarts. He was getting to do everything James had done the previous year. Albus was especially excited about going to Olivanderâs and getting his wand.
They met Ron and Hermione Weasley, as well as their two kids, Rose and Hugo, in front of Gringottâs. Rose was a couple months younger than Albus, but would be turning eleven in August and would be going to Hogwarts as well. Hugo was Lilyâs age.
âWhere to first?â Harry asked.
âOlivanderâs!â Albus announced.
âFlourish and Blotts!â Rose said excitedly.
Albus stared at her like she had three heads. How could his cousin want to go to the book store before she got her wand?
âYouâre mental, Rose,â James laughed, âI say we go to Quality Quidditch Supplies!â
âEyelops!â Lily shouted.
âYouâre not even going to Hogwarts,â Albus pointed out.
âI donât care,â Lily huffed.
âWeasleyâs Wizard Wheezes,â Hugo suggested.
âThen itâs settled,â Harry grinned, âWeâre going to the Apothecary first.â
Everybody groaned, but followed Harry down the street anyway. Albus sighed to himself. That was always how his dad settled arguments. Heâd pick what nobody had suggested.
The trip to the Apothecary was quick. Nobody really wanted to linger in there. Albus didnât particularly enjoy the place. It had an odd smell to it and there were cauldrons full of things that looked like they were decaying.
After the Apothecary, they went to Madam Malkinâs, which was boring as well. Albus just didnât find buying robes very exciting. It seemed like his dad was doing the most boring shopping first.
Finally, after a long trip to Flourish and Blotts, Harry announced that Olivanderâs was next on the list. Albus and Rose ran ahead of the rest of the group and arrived a few minutes before anyone else.
âAh, Albus and Rose,â Olivander turned around and greeted them with a wispy voice.
âHello, Mr. Olivander. Weâre getting our wands today,â Albus grinned.
âI thought so,â Olivander smiled and walked slowly to the rows of wands that were behind him.
Olivander took measurements and then walked to the back of the shop. He returned with a few wands just as the rest of the Potter and Weasley families entered the shop. Olivander greeted them and then handed Albus and Rose each a wand.
Albus smiled as he held the wand in his hand. It was an unbelievable feeling; holding a wand that could be his. He waved it and the window behind him exploded.
James burst out in laughter as Albusâs face turned bright red. He set the wand on Olivanderâs desk and looked sheepishly at his family. Harry grinned and repaired Olivanderâs window with a wave of his own wand.
âPerhaps this one,â Olivander handed Albus another wand, âEleven and a quarter inches, Ash, phoenix feather.â
Albus took the wand and all of a sudden a warm feeling enveloped him. If he didnât know any better, heâd say the wand actually glowed in his hand for a split second. He could feel that it was the right one even before he waved it. He gave it a wave and gold sparks erupted from it.
âExcellent,â Olivander grinned.
A little while later, Rose had her wand as well and the group left the shop. Albus was carrying his wand with the utmost care and staring more at the box than what was in front of him.
The adults decided that it would be best to visit Eyelops last since both Albus and Rose were getting owls. They didnât want to have to carry the owls around all day.
James was asking to go to Quality Quidditch Supplies every five minutes or so, but Harry led the way into Weasleyâs Wizard Wheezes first.
âRon, Ginny!â George greeted them as they entered, âAnd Harry and Hermione! Youâve got everyone with you today.â
âHogwarts shopping,â Harry grinned, âAl and Rosie just got their wands.â
Albus proudly opened the box and showed his Uncle George his new wand. Rose did the same.
âBrilliant, both of you!â George said, âAnd now I shall get you both ready for Hogwarts in the prank departmentâŠ.â
Albus followed George into the depths of the shop. He was not at all surprised that his uncle was assisting him with pranks. George was the owner of Weasleysâ Wizard Wheezes and was legendary at Hogwarts as one of the most mischievous students ever to attend.
âNow, every student needs a Skiving Snackbox or two,â George said as he handed Albus and Rose each a colorful box, âAfter all, I canât imagine youâll want to sit through History of Magic very often.â
Albus grinned as he took the box of sweets to make one ill. He had heard many a story from his parents, aunts, uncles, cousins, and James about how boring Professor Binnsâ classes were.
âAnd then youâll need some dung bombs,â George said as he led them to a different display.
âLast time I checked, those were still forbidden at Hogwarts,â Hermione said sternly.
âOh, Iâm sure they are,â George winked, âBut so long as Filch doesnât find out it was these two who set them off, it doesnât matter.â
âGeorge Weasley!â Hermione scolded, âYou should be setting a better example for these two! No wonder Fred was in detention every week last year!â
Albus laughed as he took a pack of dung bombs off the shelf. His cousin Fred was Georgeâs son and just finished his third year at Hogwarts. Fred had taken after his father as far as pranking went.
âLighten up, Hermione,â Ron laughed, âLet them have their fun.â
âRonald!â Hermione shouted, âYouâre even worse!â
âHarry!â Teddy burst out of the back room and joined the group, âGetting Al all the pranking products heâll need this year?â
âSure am,â Harry grinned, âAlthough I donât think Hermione is too happy about it.â
âI am not buying this stuff for Rose,â Hermione stated.
After a few more minutes of arguing, Hermione gave up and both Albus and Rose had bagfuls of Weasleysâ products. James had replenished his stash as well and Albus had a feeling heâd use everything up within a month.
George closed the shop so he and Teddy could get something to eat and everyone went to the Leaky Cauldron for dinner. Albus mainly listened to the conversation but was very content. Going to Hogwarts was something he had been looking forward to for years and now it was finally happening.
James finally got to go to Quality Quidditch Supplies after dinner and got his early birthday present. Albus was slightly jealous about this, but knew that he couldnât have his own broom at Hogwarts anyway. He was determined to make it onto the Quidditch team eventually, though.
The last stop of the day was Eyelops Owl Emporium, which was a place Albus was almost as excited about as he had been about Olivanderâs. His parents had told him heâd be able to get an owl when he went to Hogwarts.
âI want an owl,â Lily whined as they entered the shop.
âIn two years,â Harry replied.
âThatâs so far away,â Lily groaned.
âI know,â Harry said as he picked her up, âBut itâll go by faster than you think.â
Albus began looking around at all the owls. He didnât really have any ideas about what kind of owl he wanted; he just thought heâd look around and see what owl liked him.
There were owls of all sizes and colors. White ones, black ones, and speckled ones. Small ones, large ones, and medium sized ones. Albus walked slowly through the shop and looked at each owl. His eyes rested on an owl with gleaming topaz eyes and dark brown feathers. The owl had a few flecks of white on its head and it was staring directly at Albus.
Albus walked over to the owl and gave the owl a pat on its head. The owl gave a soft hoot and Albus knew it was the one for him. The owl flew onto his shoulder and Albus walked back to his parents.
âIâve got my owl,â he grinned.
âWhatâs his name?â Harry asked.
âDunno,â Albus shrugged, âHavenât thought of one yet.â
âName him Salazar,â James smirked, âBecause youâll be in Slytherin.â
âWhat?â Albus stared at his brother, âIâm not going to be in Slytherin.â
âYou never know,â James said, âThereâs a 25 percent chance that you might.â
Albus was stunned. It was so obvious. There was a 25 percent chance that heâd be in Slytherin. After all, there were four houses. But the thought of being in Slytherin had never crossed his mind. He always thought heâd be in Gryffindor, where everyone in his whole family had been. It was possible for him to be in Slytherin, though. Or Ravenclaw or Hufflepuff. Neither of those would be that bad, but Albus wanted to be in Gryffindor.
âReady to go, Al?â Harry asked, âRose just found her owl.â
âOh, yeah,â Albus said quietly, âIâm ready. And Iâm naming my owl Godric.â
Albus followed his family out of the owl shop and to the Leaky Cauldron. In two months, heâd be at Hogwarts. The place where his parents went and most of the rest of his family. The place he had been impatiently waiting to go to for years. He couldnât think of a time in his life where he had been more excited. All he hoped was that he would wind up in Gryffindor and maybe, just maybe, he would be able to make a name for himself.
But he knows that itâs going to be all right
Cause the love that heâs got will keep him warm through the night
Life is good, life is good
~LIfe Is Good, Jared Campbell
Eleven-year-old Matthew Conan Eckerton was sitting below a large oak tree in his backyard. His eyes were closed and he was resting his head against its rough trunk. The sun was beating down on him through the branches above. For the past hour, the only sound had been the occasional bird chirping or cow mooing. Then a loud revving broke the silence.
Matt slowly opened his eyes and squinted in the bright sunlight. He glanced around to try and find out where the noise was coming from. In the distance, he saw the farmer riding his tractor through the fields that surrounded Mattâs house.
Matt lived in the country, far from any towns. His house was on an acre of property that was surrounded by farmland on three sides and a forest on the other. The nearby farmer owned all of the surrounding farmland and was regularly seen plowing or performing other tasks. The farmerâs house was quite far away, although Matt could see it from where he was sitting. Other than the farmer, Matt had no other neighbors.
Mattâs parents, Walter and Julie, wanted it that way. Matt was not an ordinary eleven-year-old boy, even by wizarding standards. At the age of five, he was bitten by a werewolf and became one himself. For the past five and a half years, over half his life, he had been enduring painful transformations every month that left him exhausted and sick. As if he could be anymore unusual, the Wolfsbane Potion which normally enabled a werewolf to keep his mind during full moons, did not work for Matt.
That particular day happened to be the day of the full moon. In only a few short hours, Matt would be locked in a room in the basement and go through the painful transformation into the wolf.
As the full moon was only a short while away, Matt was already feeling the effects of it. A few days beforehand, he would tire quickly and get a lot of headaches. He also lost his appetite. At the moment, he had a splitting headache which was not helped by the tractor, but felt too exhausted to move. He closed his eyes and tried to ignore the pounding in his head and the tractorâs roaring.
âMatt, are you out here?â someone shouted.
Matt opened his eyes again and saw his sister, Amy, walking towards him. âIâm over by the tree!â he shouted.
Amy ran the rest of the distance and sat down next to him. Her blond hair was thrown up into a messy ponytail and flying everywhere as she walked.
âThank Merlin,â Amy sighed, âI couldnât find you anywhere. You know Mum doesnât like it when you go outside the day of the full moon.â
Matt groaned inwardly. His mother was extremely overprotective, in his opinion. He understood she had her reasons and after what had happened in the past, he couldnât really blame her. But he wasnât a baby anymore and he didnât think going outside was going to hurt. He liked going outside before full moons since heâd be cooped up inside for a few days afterwards.
âIs she back yet?â Matt asked. His mother had gone to Diagon Alley to pick up some groceries a little while ago, leaving Amy to âbabysitâ him. Matt thought this was ridiculous since he was eleven and certainly did not need a babysitter, but didnât argue with her. Plus, Amy was home anyway.
âNo,â Amy replied, âBut I had to find you because this just came by owl.â
Amy grinned as she handed Matt a letter. Matt took it and turned it over. His breath caught in his chest as he saw the Hogwarts crest stamped on it. It was his Hogwarts letter.
Ever since Amy had begun her magical education, when Matt was four, he had been excited about going himself. Even after he had been bitten by a werewolf, he thought heâd get to go. His parents had never said otherwise. Until they received a letter telling them Matt couldnât attend, that is.
The Eckertons had not lived in England their whole lives. Up until three years ago, they had lived in Australia. Amy had attended the Australian School of Sorcery until she was fourteen. That was when their parents had asked the headmaster if Matt would be able to attend. He said he could not.
Everything got worse from there. Someone who held a grudge against Mattâs dad at the Ministry announced to the entire country that Matt was a werewolf (something they had successfully hidden for over two years) and then his dad lost his job because of it. He had been the Head of the Department for the Regulation and Control of Magical Creatures. After that, the man who had announced Mattâs lycanthropy became the head and passed legislation restricting the rights of werewolves.
Mattâs parents sent letters to numerous other schools asking if he could attend. Hogwarts School of Witchcraft and Wizardry in Scotland said yes. Mattâs dad found a job at the British Ministry, in Werewolf Support Services, and they moved. Life had been better since then. Amy had a hard time adjusting, but eventually began to enjoy Hogwarts.
Due to all of this, Matt knew he would get a letter from Hogwarts this summer. He had been waiting for it for weeks since he had no idea when it would arrive, but had momentarily forgotten about it that day. Despite knowing it was going to come, there was something very exciting about it actually arriving.
Matt slowly peeled back the seal and opened the envelop. He pulled the letter out and carefully unfolded it.
âMerlin, youâre slow with that!â Amy exclaimed, âI think I nearly ripped my letter from Australia when I got it.â
âThatâs why I opened mine slowly,â Matt smirked. He looked at the letter and read it aloud. There was a post script at the end, one that Matt knew the rest of his fellow students would not have received.
P.S. Please have your parents contact
us so we can set up a time for you to
come to the school so we can discuss
the precautions we have set up for
your lycanthropy.
Matt folded the letter and then looked up at Amy. He still couldnât believe that it was finally his turn to go to Hogwarts. He had been secretly jealous of Amy for years. Every time she got to go shopping for supplies and then speed away on the Hogwarts Express, he watched with envious eyes.
âItâll be both of us going this year,â Amy grinned.
Matt nodded. âI just hope Iâm in Gryffindor.â
âYou will be,â Amy assured him, âSiblings usually get sorted into the same house. Victoireâs sister and brother are in Gryffindor like she is. All their cousins are there, too.â
âI got my supply list, too,â Matt said as he pulled out another piece of parchment, âYou get yours?â Amy was entering her seventh and final year at Hogwarts.
âYup,â Amy nodded, âWe can go to Diagon Alley once youâre recovered from tonight.â
âYeah,â Matt said, wishing he didnât have to wait, âSays I canât get a bring a broom, though.â
âLike Mum would let you bring one anyway,â Amy laughed, âSpeaking of Mum, sheâll probably be back anytime. We should go back inside.â
âYou wonât tell her I was out here, will you?â Matt asked as he stuffed his letter back in the envelop.
âNah,â Amy grinned, âSince when have I been one to do what Mum says anyway?â
Matt stood up and felt dizzy as soon as he did so. He stumbled and Amy grabbed his arm. She let him lean on her as they walked slowly back to the house. The thing Matt hated even more than the actual transformation into the wolf was how sick he felt the days leading up to it. It was like getting the flu once a month.
To Mattâs relief, his mother was not back from Diagon Alley when they got back to the house. Amy helped him to the couch and he laid down on it.
âI am going to miss so many classes during the full moons,â Matt groaned.
âYeah, you probably will,â Amy agreed, âBut the teachers are nice so youâll be able to catch up. Well, most of them are nice. Washburnâs a nasty piece of work, but the rest are nice. And itâs not necessarily a bad thing to miss History of Magic. Thereâs usually about a quarter of the people in my class using Puking Pastilles or Nosebleed Nougats before that class. Youâll have a built in excuse once a month. All the rest of the kids in your class will be jealous.â
âI doubt that,â Matt said darkly. Ever since he had first seen the sweets in a Skiving Snackbox, he was bewildered that people would actually eat sweets that would make you ill. He just couldnât wrap his mind around actually wanting to be ill, even to miss a boring class. Heâd rather sit through the class.
âJust keep an open mind,â Amy shrugged, âThere have been quite a few times where I would rather be in the Hospital Wing than in class.â
Matt groaned and closed his eyes. He wished he could go all seven years at Hogwarts without ever setting foot in the Hospital Wing, but that wasnât going to happen.
âAmy, could you get me some of that headache potion?â he asked.
âWhen did you last have it?â Amy asked.
âWhen I woke up this morning.â
âSure,â Amy replied and got up.
Matt heard the door open a moment later and his mum walked in, her arms laden with grocery bags.
âAmy!â she shouted, âCan you come help me with these bags?â
âHang on!â Amy shouted from the kitchen.
The bags dropped to the floor with a thump and Matt heard footsteps coming closer. He felt his mother kiss his forehead and ruffle his blonde hair.
âHow are you?â she asked softly.
âTired and Iâve got a headache,â Matt mumbled.
âIâll get you some headache potion.â
âAmyâs already getting it,â Matt replied.
His mum kissed his forehead once more and sat down next to him on the couch. âAmy, could you bring the fever reducer, too?â
Matt squeezed his eyes shut tighter. No wonder he felt awful; he had a fever. Now he was sort of glad he came inside when he did.
âI got my Hogwarts letter, Mum,â he whispered.
âThatâs wonderful, honey,â she replied, âWeâll go shopping in a few days.â
âHereâs the potions,â Amy said.
Matt cracked open his eyes and took one of the goblets Amy was holding. He drank it quickly and then grabbed the other one. He swallowed that one as fast as he could as well and gagged at the disgusting taste.
âCan I get an owl?â he yawned.
âOf course, honey,â his mum said as she rubbed his back, âJust go to sleep now. Weâll talk more about it tomorrow.â
Matt nodded and closed his eyes. He fell asleep quickly, feeling the happiest he had ever been the day of a full moon.
******
âMatt,â someone whispered as they shook him.
Matt opened his eyes and saw his dad bent down in front of the couch. âHey, Dad.â
âI just heard you got your Hogwarts letter,â his dad smiled, âCongratulations.â
âThanks,â Matt whispered.
âWell, Iâll let you get some more sleep. Thereâs still an hour or so until you have to go downstairs,â his dad said as he gave him a hug.
Matt watched his dad walk into the kitchen and closed his eyes once more. He drifted off to sleep again, trying not to think about what would happen in an hour.
After what seemed like only a few minutes later, Matt woke up in a cold sweat with an awful headache that no potion could ever help with. He sat up and looked out the window. It was dark, but he didnât need to see the sky to know that the moon would rise soon.
âMum!â his voice cracked. He swallowed hard. The pain always started before the transformation did. It was awful. He always tried not to cry, but it never worked. He squeezed his eyes shut and tried to keep the tears from leaking out.
He heard three sets of footsteps run into the room and felt his motherâs arms wrap around him. He leaned into her and rested his head on her shoulder.
âItâs time,â his dad said quietly.
Matt shakily stood up and his parents helped him stumble towards the basement door. He could hear Amyâs footsteps behind them. Nobody said a word as they walked down the stairs and towards his transformation room.
Matt sat down on the padded floor as soon as he got into the room. His head was spinning and he didnât think heâd be able to stand up much longer anyway. His parents and Amy each gave him a hug and then left the room. They didnât say anything, but there was nothing to say. Heâd done this so many times there wasnât really any point in his parents saying anything. He knew theyâd be there in the morning.
The door locked as his parents and Amy left, and Matt let out a loud sigh as he sat down. This was it. Another full moon. There was nothing he could do now but wait.
For years, he fought the change. Heâd clench his hands and jaw and try to prevent the transformation, even though he knew it wouldnât work. The only time he hadnât fought it was the first one, where he had no idea what was going to happen. For the second one, he knew what was going to happen. He was only six, but he understood and he fought it with every part of his being. Now, five and a half years later, with five and a half years of proof that it wouldnât work, he still fought it.
Matt didnât have to wait long for the transformation to begin. His headache became unbearable and he felt his stomach lurch. He learned early on to not try and eat anything beforehand, because it always came back up during the first part of the transformation.
He curled up into a ball and let out a soft moan. He could feel his heart beating a mile a minute. His breathing was short and labored. It felt like he couldnât breathe. He always tried not to scream, but that never worked either. He felt his bones breaking and elongating and hair sprouting everywhere.
He let out a loud scream and clenched his eyes as pain coerced through his body. No amount of previous full moons would ever prepare him for the painful transformation. Nothing helped with it either. His parents had given him so many different potions, but nothing decreased the pain.
His mind was always the last thing to go. Matt hated that. He wished his mind would go first. Then he wouldnât have to remember the actual transformation. He always wished heâd pass out before the transformation began, but that never happened.
Matt took a few more ragged breaths and cried out in pain. He sat up and looked at his hands, which were quickly turning into paws of the wolf. He felt dizzy. The world was spinning around him and it felt like fog was clouding his mind. He let out one more scream and the world disappeared.
******
The wolf slowly stood up and took in his surroundings. It was dark and there was a faint smell of blood and humans lingering in the air. He was also trapped, again. The wolf was always trapped. He began to pace around the room and look for an escape route. It wasnât there. There was never an escape route.
The wolf stood up on his hind legs and pointed his snout towards the ceiling. He let out a long howl and then glared at the opposite wall. He got back down on all fours and charged at it, slamming his head into the abnormally soft wall. He stepped back and repeated the process again and again.
He was alone. Alone and trapped. Every single full moon, the wolf was alone and stuck in the small padded room. He wanted to get out. He wanted to get out and find the people he could faintly smell beyond the walls.
However, there was no way out. No matter how many times the wolf rammed his head into the wall, he could not break it. Eventually, he sat down in the middle of the room and howled once more. He then proceeded to bite at his own body to relieve the urge to attack something.
******
Matt cracked his eyes open and tried to lift his head. A stabbing pain fled through his head and he dropped it back down onto the padded floor. He closed his eyes and tried to concentrate on breathing. Each short, labored breath hurt. He couldnât even figure out which parts of his body hurt the worse. Everything hurt. From the top of his head to his toes.
âMum?â he said hoarsely. His voice was little more than a whisper. He knew there was no way his mother could hear him, but he called her name anyway.
The door clicked a short while later, but for Matt it felt like an eternity. Whoever came in the room made no sound as they walked across the mattress covered floor. They put a cloak over him and then picked him up. A wave of dizziness come over him as he was lifted up.
âItâs ok, Iâve got you,â his dad whispered.
Matt was hardly aware of being carried up to his room and he passed out on the way.
The next thing he knew, he was laying in his soft bed with layers of blankets on top of him. He could feel the warm sun shining through the window. He opened his eyes slowly and blinked as they adjusted to the brightness.
His body still ached despite the potions he knew his parents had given him. His head was throbbing dully as well. Worse yet, he was exhausted. He knew he had already slept for hours, but it felt like he hadnât slept in days.
Who was he kidding? How was he going to go to Hogwarts? How would he manage full moons when he was by himself? He couldnât even get up when he transformed back the next morning. His parents always had to carry him back to his room.
His parents. Matt felt a jolt in his stomach as he realized that they wouldnât be there every full moon when he was in school. They had been there for every full moon he had ever endured. They took care of him the day of and the days following. They got him his potions and healed all his injuries.
He hated to admit it, but he was scared about doing it by himself. He knew he shouldnât be; he was eleven years old for Merlinâs sake. Eleven-year-olds should not be afraid of going to school and being away from their parents.
It was a practical issue, he assured himself. That was all. He couldnât physically deal with full moons by himself. That was why he was worried about going to school. It wasnât like he couldnât deal with being away from home.
Then there was the issue of his classmates. What if they found out? It wasnât like he could sneak away for the full moon and be back in his dormitory the next morning before his roommates woke up. Heâd be in the Hospital Wing for at least two days. He doubted heâd be able to go to classes the day of the full moon and he usually needed two days to recover. That was three days of missed classes, but more importantly, it was three days of disappearances to explain. What was he going to say? People didnât normally get sick that much.
It was a stupid idea, he thought, going to school. He bit his lip and tried to stop the tears from welling in his eyes. Why didnât his parents just home school him? It would be easier. They were both knowledgeable in most aspects of magic. If his parents had just decided to home school him, they could have stayed in Australia. Then Amy would have been happier.
No, they couldnât have stayed. He sighed. Not after his dad lost his job and all the laws restricting the rights of werewolves had been passed. They were originally going to move so he could go to school. But then his dad lost his job. It wasnât entirely Mattâs fault that they moved, was it? Not if his dad needed another jobâŠ.
It was his fault his dad lost his job, though. If he hadnât gotten bitten, his dad wouldnât have lost his job. So, for all intents and purposes, his family had moved because of him. He couldnât not go to school after all theyâd done for him. Heâd just have to suck it up and deal with it, no matter how terrifying the prospect was.
âMatt, are you awake?â Amy peeked her head into his room.
Matt quickly rubbed his eyes and turned to look at her. âYeah.â
Amy gave a small smile and walked into the room. She set a goblet down on the bedside table and then sat on the foot of the bed.
âHow are you?â she asked quietly.
âAll-â he cut himself off and looked at Amyâs concerned expression. Ever since she had first seen him after a transformation, she had this uncanny way of knowing when something was bothering him. He wasnât sure how she did it, but somehow she managed to get him to tell her what was wrong.
It was kind of strange since Amy normally had quite the temper and was very impatient. Their mum had once told Matt that she took after his grandmother, but Amy would never admit to it. The two of them did what they wanted and often disregarded other peopleâs emotions.
Amy used to be a lot like that with Matt, too. When they were younger, their parents insisted on keeping Amy away from the house during full moons. She hated it and resented their parents for keeping her out of the loop. She really had no idea what went on during full moons.
Then life as they knew it fell apart in Australia and Amy began to realize what went on. She did resent Matt for months about having to move, but eventually got used to Hogwarts. Then, the first full moon after her fourth year, she stayed at home during the full moon and saw Matt afterwards.
Amy never told Matt what she had thought of seeing him after a transformation, but her actions spoke more than words would have. She stayed by his side after every full moon that summer. A few weeks after that first full moon of the summer, she announced that she was going to become a healer and hoped to discover a version of the Wolfsbane Potion that would work for Matt.
Matt had been a little shocked when he heard this, but not incredibly surprised. As far back as he could remember, Amy had enjoyed experimenting with potions. She was also an avid star gazer and loved Astronomy. If anyone could come up with a better version about that potion, it was Amy. She had the skills, interests, and motivation to do it.
âActually,â his voice caught in his throat, âIâm not that great.â
Amy crawled up the bed and laid down next to him, her mouth turning down in a frown. She grabbed the potion off the table and handed it to him. âWhat hurts? You should take this potion, itâll help.â
âItâs not that,â Matt swallowed the potion in one gulp, âI mean, my head hurts but no worse than usual. Itâs,â he paused, âItâs Hogwarts. Iâm just not sure if I should goâŠâ his voice trailed off.
Amy put her arm around Mattâs shoulders and looked at him sadly. âWhy not?â
âThis,â he muttered, âThis probably sounds stupid, but I donât think I can do it without Mum and Dad.â
âItâs not stupid,â Amy said quietly, âTheyâve always been there for every full moon. But I think youâre wrong. You can do it without them.â
âHow?â Mattâs voice wavered, âI canât even get back up to my room without them? How in the name of Merlin will I get from that shack in Hogsmeade back to the castle?â
âThe nurse,â Amy sighed, âYouâre forgetting about the nurse. Madam Pomfrey. Youâve met her, havenât you?â
âI think so,â Matt nodded, âBut I hardly know her.â
âWell, I do,â Amy said, âAnd sheâs one of the nicest adults at Hogwarts. Sheâll help. And Iâll be there too. Iâll be there for your entire first year.â
âAnd youâll be there? Can you go to the shack with Madam Pomfrey?â
âOf course,â Amy nodded, âAnd Iâll stay at the Hospital Wing with you except when Iâm in class.â
Matt nodded. He felt a little better knowing that Amy would be there with him. She could practically do everything in order to heal his injuries after the full moon. Their parents had been teaching her ever since she was fifteen and she had actually been performing them ever since she turned seventeen. But he still felt uneasy about the whole thing.
âI know youâll still miss them,â Amy said quietly, âAnd thereâs nothing wrong with that. I was so homesick during first year and I didnât have to deal with turning into a wolf once a month. I imagine thatâll make it even worse.â
Matt turned to his sister and laughed. He sort of liked how she just stated what was true and never tried to soften it.
âYeah, probably,â he replied.
âBut youâll get used to it,â Amy assured him, âSoon youâll make friends and get into mischief like half of Victoireâs cousins do.â
Matt shrugged. Making friends was another thing he was worried about. He didnât really have many friends. He occasionally spent time with some of his dadâs coworkersâ kids, but didnât know them very well.
âIf I make any friends,â he said.
âYou will,â Amy said.
âBut they wonât like me if they find out who I am,â Matt replied.
âThey wonât find out,â Amy said adamantly, âYouâll make plenty of friends. Victoire said a few of her cousins are starting this year and theyâre certainly to be in Gryffindor like you will be.â
Matt had only met Victoire a few times, but from what he could tell, she was really nice. Matt only hoped her cousins were as well.
âI guess that would be good,â he yawned, âWhat time is it?â
Amy glanced at her watch. âJust after one. I should let you sleep.â
Matt nodded. âOk. Thanks.â He was pretty tired. He didnât normally have such long discussions with Amy so soon after the full moon. He usually slept until dinner time.
âIâll be back later,â Amy gave him a gentle hug, grabbed the empty potion bottle, and quietly left the room.
Matt rolled over in bed and huddled under the many blankets. He closed his eyes feeling a bit better about going to Hogwarts, but still worried.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks to Luke, Moonylupin, and XDNLxtlz99 for the reviews!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter or Jared Campbellâs songs.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
And she knows that this is real
Itâs not something that sheâs made up in her head
And thereâs something that she feels but she hasnât found the words
~Itâs Love, Jared Campbell
Eleven-year-old Amanda Genevieve Tagger smiled to herself as she closed her book. She rolled over on her bed and set the it on her bedside table. Her bedside table was stacked high with at least ten books, most of which Amanda had already read.
Amanda had always enjoyed reading. Ever since she was a little girl, books had been some of her best friends. They were great company when she was sad or bored or just wanted to escape into a different world for a while. Best of all, books never made fun of her.
Amanda had always been shy and she was the first to admit it. She didnât have very many friends and kids her age tended to stay away from her. This was most likely because strange things always happened around her.
She was only five when she first realized that she was different. Amanda, her older sister, Jen, who was nine at the time, and a few of her sisterâs friends were playing outside. They decided to play hide-and-seek and Amanda climbed the biggest tree in their backyard and hid amongst the branches. Jen, who was âitâ, had the hardest time finding her. In fact, Jen never found her. Amanda didnât leave the tree until their mom called them in for a snack.
That was when it happened. Amandaâs foot caught on one of the branches and she lost her grip. She fell what must have been twenty or thirty feet out of that maple tree, hitting numerous branches on her way down.
When she was a mere five feet from the ground, she suddenly stopped falling. Then, she glided lightly to the ground, and landed softly on her feet. Amanda looked around and saw Jen staring open-mouthed at her. Their mother, who had seen Amanda falling, ran from the house and checked her over. She was completely fine, save for a few minor scratches and bruises. No one knew why it had happened, but Amandaâs mother said an angel must have been looking out for her that day.
Whatever it was, Amanda knew she was different that day. It was only the beginning. Strange things had happened to her ever since. When she was six and the class bully stole her biscuits at lunch, new ones appeared out of thin air in front of her. When she was seven and forgot to do her maths homework, it somehow did itself while sitting in her backpack.
A small, relatively harmless tornado had somehow descended upon a few boys who were chasing her when she was eight. That incident was what caused most of the other kids her age to steer clear of her.
There was one girl who did not care that strange things happened around Amanda. Jamie House, Amandaâs best friend since Kindergarten, never cared about the strange incidents. She actually thought they were funny. Amanda and Jamie were inseparable at school.
However, Jamie was currently spending a few weeks with her grandparents in Scotland. Without Jamieâs company, Amanda had spent most of her time reading. There wasnât really anything else to do. Jen was fifteen and the last thing she wanted to do was hang out with her eleven-year-old sister. Amandaâs little brother, Max, was eight and all he wanted to do was ride his bike in the empty lot down the road with the other neighborhood boys.
Amanda was left with her books for company, not that she really minded. She was getting a bit restless, though. She stood up opened her bedroom door. Maybe Jen wasnât on the computer and Amanda would be able to go online. Jamie managed to get on instant messager ever so often at her grandparentsâ house and Amanda had talked to her a few times over the past week.
The doorbell rang just as Amanda was leaving her room.
âAmanda!â Jen shouted from her room, âCould you get that?â
âSure,â Amanda said as she passed Jenâs room. She peeked inside and saw that Jen was in the process of straightening her light brown hair. Jen had straightened Amandaâs honey blonde hair a few times, but Amanda actually preferred it with its natural slight wave. Jen hated her own curly hair, though.
Amanda ran down the stairs and towards the door. She pulled it open and saw a man wearing the strangest outfit she had ever seen anyone wear on a day that was not Halloween. It looked like a black graduation gown. The man himself looked relatively sane, though. His blonde hair was neatly combed and he smiled when Amanda opened the door.
âHello,â he greeted her, âAre your parents home?â
âEr,â Amanda began, âI think so. Are you selling something?â Her parents hated door to door salesmen. Amanda wasnât exactly sure where her parents were, but she doubted theyâd want to be interrupted to listen to someone trying to sell something.
The man laughed. âNo, not at all.â
âWait right here,â Amanda said and went to find her parents, âMum! Dad! Thereâs some bloke at the door who wants to talk to you!â
âWhatâs he selling?â Mrs. Tagger shouted from the kitchen.
âNothing!â Amanda replied.
Mrs. Tagger, a short, plump woman with flecks of grey in her dark brown hair walked out of the kitchen and followed Amanda to the door.
âCan I help you?â she asked the man.
âYes,â the man replied, âIâm a teacher at a private school and Iâm here to inform you that your daughter has been accepted.â
âJen?â Mrs. Tagger asked, âI wasnât aware she applied to any private schools.â
âNo,â the man shook his head, âNot Jen. Amanda.â
Amanda gaped at the man and then turned to her mother, who was now frowning. Amanda hadnât applied to any private schools. Why would she? She had already gotten into the secondary school she was attending in the fall.
âI know Amanda hasnât applied to anymore schools,â Mrs. Tagger said.
âThis isnât one she applied for,â the man said quietly, âHer name has been down since she was born.â
Amanda was stunned. What was this about? How could her name have been down for a school since she was born?
âCould I come in?â the man asked.
âI think youâd better,â Mrs. Tagger said in barely more than a whisper.
The man stepped inside the house and followed Mrs. Tagger into the den. Amanda followed and sat down on a chair while the strange man took the couch.
âHenry!â Mrs. Tagger shouted down the basement stairs, âYouâd better come upstairs!â
A minute later a tall man with a messy shock of blonde hair on his head walked into the room with Mrs. Tagger.
âMy husband, Henry,â Mrs. Tagger replied, âAnd my name is Sarah. Who are you?â
âProfessor Neville Longbottom,â the man replied as he stood up and shook each of my parentsâ hands.
âProfessor?â Henry raised his eyebrows.
âHe told me Amanda has been accepted to a private school. One that her nameâs been down for since birth,â Sarah explained, âDid you sign her up without telling me?â
âNo,â Henry shook his head.
âIâll explain everything if youâll just sit down,â Neville said.
Henry and Sarah nodded and they sat down on the couch Neville had just vacated.
âI teach at a boarding school in Scotland called Hogwarts-â
Henry snorted and Sarah glared at him. âSorry,â he muttered.
Neville grinned. âI get that reaction a lot. Anyway, Hogwarts is not an ordinary school. It is a school of magic. Mr. and Mrs. Tagger, your daughter is a witch.â
Amanda was glad she had been sitting down. If she hadnât, she surely would have fainted. She stared in shock at Neville. What did he mean, witch? Amanda had read many stories about witches. Some had good witches and others had bad witches. Which witch was she?
How could she even be a witch? Witches werenât real. They were made up to provide entertainment. They couldnât actually exist. Magic didnât exist.
âWhat are you getting at?â Henry said defensively, âIf this is some sort of prank, itâs not funny.â
âItâs not a prank,â Neville said calmly, âMagic does exist. Witches and wizards have been hiding their world for generations. I teach at Britainâs only school of magic.â
âWhat do you teach?â Henry asked.
âHerbology. The study of magical plants.â
âProve it,â Henry said, âPull a rabbit out of your hat or something.â
Neville grinned and pulled out his wand. Amanda stared at it. A real magic wand. Just like the ones sheâd read about in books.
âAccio pillow,â Neville pointed his wand at one of the pillows next to Henry. It soared through the air and landed neatly in Nevilleâs hand.
âWhereâs the string?â Henry stood up and grabbed the pillow. He searched all over it for a string, but didnât find one.
âNo string,â Neville smiled. He took the pillow back and pointed his wand at it. He muttered something else and the pillow turned into a tea kettle.
âThat is brilliant,â Amanda grinned, âCan I learn how to do that?â
âWhen you are older, yes,â Neville replied.
âWhat else can you do?â Amanda asked excitedly.
âBrew potions, various charms, disappear and reappear in a new place-â
âSeriously?â Amanda gaped, âCan you show me that?â
âSure,â Neville replied. He disappeared from the room with a loud crack and then was back a few seconds later.
âWhat the bloody hell was that?â Jen ran into the room with her hair partially straight and partially curly.
âLanguage, Jennifer,â Sarah warned.
âIâm a witch,â Amanda grinned, âI can do magic.â
âWhat?!â Jen shouted and sat down on the nearest chair, clearly intent on staying in the room despite her hair.
âWait, wait!â Henry shouted, âWhat if we choose not to let her attend this place?â
âYou have to, Dad!â Amanda shouted.
âHenry, are you really so gullible? You canât honestly think there is a school of magic!â Sarah shouted.
âMagic?â Jen asked, âLike pulling rabbits out of hats?â
âOf course it exists, Mum!â Amanda told her.
Sarah shook her head. âNo. Amanda, you just want it to exist. Magic isnât real. Itâs fantasy.â
âIt does,â Neville said quietly, âCan you remember a time Amanda has done something that couldnât be explained? Any time where she should have been hurt and then somehow wasnât?â
Sarahâs face went pale white and she turned to Henry. âYes,â she whispered, âMany times.â
âIt can be explained,â Neville replied, âItâs magic.â
âBut what if we donât let her go?â Henry asked again.
âThatâs fine. But she wonât ever learn to control her magic and she will continue to cause strange things to happen.â
âIâm going,â Amanda crossed her arms on her chest.
âGlad to hear it,â Neville reached into his, what could only be described as a cloak, and pulled out a letter. He handed it to Amanda.
It was addressed to her. She turned it over and carefully opened it. She unfolded it and began to read it aloud.
There was another piece of paper that had a list of supplies written on it, including a cauldron, wand, and spell books. Amanda had about a million questions. Where could she buy a real wand? Had they gotten the platform wrong? There couldnât be a Platform 9 3/4, could there? What did the letter mean, broomsticks? Did witches really ride around on brooms like they do in books?
âIâm home!â the front door slammed shut and Max ran into the room, his dark hair disheveled and his face coated in dirt. He stopped at the sight of Neville and grinned. âNice costume, but Halloweenâs not for a few months.â
âItâs not a costume,â Jen said, âHeâs a wizard. He teaches at a school of magic and heâs here to tell us that Amanda is a witch.â
âThat is brilliant,â Max grinned, âAm I one, too?â
âYouâll find out the summer you are eleven,â Neville answered.
âMax, please go upstairs and clean yourself up,â Sarah groaned, âYouâre getting mud all over the carpet.â
âOh, sorry,â Max turned and ran up the stairs.
âMum, Dad,â Amanda began, âYouâve got to let me go to Hogwarts. This explains everything! I want to learn how to control my magic. I wonât be the weird girl at Hogwarts.â
Henry and Sarah shared a look. âI suppose youâre right,â Henry sighed, âWeâll let you go, so long as this professor explains everything about magic to us.â
âI will,â Neville nodded, âActually, if youâre not busy today, I could take you to Diagon Alley. Thatâs the shopping area where you will be able to purchase everything Amanda needs for Hogwarts. Itâs in London.â
âWeâre not busy,â Henry said, âWeâll just wait for Max.â
Amanda grinned as she reread her letter over and over again. She still couldnât believe it. A witch. She was a real witch! Amanda always knew she was different, but she never imagined it would be like this. She pinched herself to make sure it was real. It was. She, Amanda Tagger, was a witch. It was like she had fallen into one of her books.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Days are different then they were before
And we both exchange
Itâs only getting better
~Only Getting Better, Jared Campbell
Eleven-year-old John Malcolm Brickston was running around in a large circle as fast as he possibly could. He, along with two other boys, was spinning the merry-go-round in the park across the street from his house as fast as he could. A fourth boy was on the merry-go-round shrieking in delight.
It was a daily thing for John, playing with the other boys in his neighborhood at the park. They particularly liked spinning each other until they felt sick on the merry-go-round. Other activities included trying to push each other off the monkey bars and jumping off of the swings. They often spent all day doing this, until one of their mothers called them inside.
John had fun playing with the other boys from his neighborhood even though he was quite different from them. John was a wizard and all of his neighborhood friends were Muggles. Johnâs family was the only wizarding family living in a neighborhood of Muggles. He didnât mind, of course. He was actually glad he lived in a neighborhood full of people to play with, rather than in the middle of nowhere like so many other wizards did. Most of his cousins didnât have any close neighbors.
Without the neighborhood boys around, the only people John would have had to play with were his sisters. John had three of them and while he loved them, they got on his nerves. They were all younger than him and drove him mental on a daily basis.
Despite having so many Muggle friends, John could not wait to get to Hogwarts where he could meet other wizards his age. He knew a couple witches and wizards his age whose parents worked with his dad, but he didnât see them too often. Then there were his cousins, but they were all younger than him.
John had been trying not to think about his Hogwarts letter, which he knew would be arriving soon. Thinking about it just made the time go by slower. So, he tried to get his mind off of it by goofing off at the playground.
âEnough, enough!â the boy on the merry-go-round shouted.
John and the other two boys stepped back and watched it slow down. Once it had almost stopped, the boy jumped off and stumbled around, falling on the ground. John and the others crowded around him.
âMy turn!â John shouted as the dizzy boy sat up.
âJohnny!â someone shouted from the entrance to the park.
John turned his head towards the voice and groaned. It was his mother. The previous day she had made him watch over his little sisters when they played at the park and he really didnât want to do that again. But his sisters werenât with his mum, so maybe she wanted something else.
âWhat?â John shouted.
âYou need to come home now!â she shouted back.
John groaned again and reluctantly said goodbye to his friends. He hated it when his mum called him home without explaining why.
âWhy do I have to go home now?â John asked as he reached his mum, âItâs not dinner time.â
âYour letter arrived,â she said and began to walk across the street.
That was probably the only thing she could have said to make John no longer mind leaving his friends. He grinned and ran to catch up with his mum. Now it was official, he was going to Hogwarts!
Johnâs house was in its usual state of chaos when he entered it. Not two seconds after they stepped in the door, his second youngest sister, Gemma, ran up them screaming about how Amelia had taken her toy. Gemma was six and Amelia, his youngest sister, was five.
At any given moment there were probably five or six little kids at Johnâs house. He had a lot of cousins who were all younger than him. His mother was a stay at home mum, but a few of his aunts worked outside the home. They often dropped their kids off at Johnâs house while they were at work. Or when they had to go shopping. It was just another reason why John enjoyed spending his free time outside, away from the little kids.
That day, all his little sisters were home, of course. Plus, his cousins Isabelle, who was ten, and Isabelleâs three-year-old sister, Alyssa.
âYour Aunt Pam is grocery shopping,â his mother, Jan, replied as she picked up Gemma.
John nodded and stepped over a pile of Wendy Witch dolls that Ashtyn, his nine-year-old sister must have left in the doorway.
âAshtyn, pick up your toys!â Jan shouted as she carried Gemma back into the den.
Ashtyn and Isabelle came running through the house, scooped up the dolls, and ran back to wherever they came from.
âWhereâs my letter?â John asked as Jan set Gemma back down on the floor.
âItâs here somewhere,â Jan said as she rifled through a stack of mail, âI just had it a second ago. Hang on.â
John sighed as he leaned against the wall. He couldnât wait to get to Hogwarts. Then he wouldnât have to deal with all his little sisters and cousins anymore. He would be in a place where he was one of the youngest people. That rarely happened. John had always been the oldest, the one who was expected to be mature.
âMum!â Ashtyn shrieked from upstairs, âI think John put a dung bomb in the toilet again!â
John grinned. He may be expected to be mature, but he wasnât. Pulling pranks was one of his favorite things to do and the dung bomb in the toilet never got old, especially when Ashtyn was on the receiving end of it.
Jan sent him a withering look. âI cringe to think about the amount of owls Iâll be getting from Professor Kendrick about the mischief you get into next year,â she sighed, âAshtyn, just flush it like usual!â
âMum, she wonât give it back!â Gemma whined.
Jan groaned and walked over to the two girls, who were still fighting over a stuffed dragon. Jan wrenched it from Ameliaâs hands and stuck it up on a high shelf. She continued searching for Johnâs letter while Gemma and Amelia complained.
âI think I found it,â John said as he bent down.
Three-year-old Alyssa was holding a torn envelope in her hands and giggling playfully. John grabbed it from her and she burst out crying. Jan picked her up as John took off for his bedroom, the only toddler free place in the entire house.
The letter wasnât completely destroyed, much to Johnâs relief. He had caught Alyssa before she was able to do a lot of damage. The envelope was completely illegible, but the letter inside was spared from tears and baby slobber.
John tossed aside the damp envelope and unfolded the letter. He grinned widely as he read it, even though he already knew the gist of what it said.
He was in! John laid down on his bed and stared up at his ceiling. Of course he was in. There was never any doubt. Everyone in his entire family had gone to Hogwarts for as far back as anyone could remember. As far as he knew, his family didnât have any Squibs.
John had been looking forward to Hogwarts for a very long time. His parents had all sorts of stories to tell of the place. Although, their education had been interrupted due to the final battle and Voldemortâs defeat. They had only been first years at the time and Hogwarts had closed for a year in order for it to be rebuilt. But after that, his parents had had a somewhat normal education.
There were all sorts of things that John was looking forward to. The Sorting (although his parents refused to tell him how it was done), the feasts, exploding potions, Peeves, Quidditch, Hogsmeade trips when he got older, the Gryffindor common room. John was sure heâd get into Gryffindor even though his mum had been a Hufflepuff. His dad was a Gryffindor and everyone said he took after his dad.
Johnâs dad, Jeff Brickston, had been the Hogwarts prankster when he was in school. John couldnât wait to pull some pranks of his own. His dad had promised to get him well supplied with stuff from Weasleysâ Wizard Wheezes, although his mum wasnât too happy about it.
John remained in his room for the rest of the afternoon. A glance out the window told him that his Muggle friends had left the park. It would have been boring for him to go back. Instead, he stayed in his room and pulled out his old but trusty Nimbus Two Thousand and One.
The broom had been his dadâs when he was at Hogwarts. John grabbed a bottle of polish and began to rub it into the worn wood. Jeff had given it to John when he was only five and John had been flying on it ever since.
If John had to pick the one thing he was most looking forward to at Hogwarts, it would be Quidditch. John had been flying for as long as he could remember and he had hopes of making it onto the Gryffindor Quidditch team. If he was sorted into Gryffindor, that is. He just hoped that there was a beater position open at the right time. He doubted heâd get chosen as a beater in his second year due to the fact that beaters were generally quite a lot bigger than the rest of the players. But if a beater position opened when he was in fourth or fifth year, he just might make it.
Isabelle and Alyssa had left by the time John left his room. He wandered into the kitchen and found his mum preparing dinner. Ashtyn, Gemma, and Amelia were âhelpingâ.
âCan we go to Diagon Alley tomorrow?â John asked as he grabbed a carrot out of a bowl.
âI donât know,â Jan replied, âYour Aunt Jodie is working tomorrow and I have to watch Stephanie as well as the twins. I donât particularly want to drag three extra kids to Diagon Alley especially when two are babies. It may have to wait until the weekend. And please donât eat the carrots.â
John sighed and sat down at the table. He didnât want to wait until the weekend. He wished his mum didnât watch all of his little cousins all the time.
âIâm home!â someone shouted from the den.
John jumped up from his chair and ran into the den. He saw his dad brushing ash off of his bright green healer robes. John grinned as he saw his great-great grandpa standing just behind his dad.
âGramps!â John shouted, âWhat are you doing here?â
âWent to Mungoâs,â he replied, âHad to get this dang hip checked out. Then Jeffrey here invited me to dinner.â
Johnâs great-great grandpa, Zander Brickston, was over one hundred years old but was usually healthy as a hippogriff. He was a bit senile and forgetful at times, but it never bothered him. He was often the life of the party, too, despite his age. John loved him.
âI got my Hogwarts letter!â John said excitedly as he pulled the letter out of his pocket.
âCongratulations,â Jeff grinned and gave John a one-armed hug as he set his bag down.
âWell done, Johnny-Boy!â Zander gave him a surprisingly strong clap on the back, âGreat place, Hogwarts. Best years of my life, except for the times I found myself in Professor Dippetâs office. Youâd best stay out of there.â
âProfessor Dippetâs been dead for years, Gramps,â John laughed.
âThen you stay out of trouble with whoeverâs the headmaster now,â Zander said and lumbered off into the kitchen, âWhereâs my girls?â
Dinner was lively that evening, as it always was when Zander was there. He dominated the conversation with stories of his own years at Hogwarts. John was sort of surprised he remembered them so well. He told of the time he and his friends went for a swim in the Black Lake at midnight during the full moon in January. The nurse had not been pleased when they showed up at the hospital wing with slight cases of hypothermia. She scolded them and told them if they were stupid enough to swim in the lake during January, they could at least use cold-repellent charms on themselves.
âWhere would the fun be in that?â Zander laughed as he finished the story.
Other stories included the many pranks he pulled on the Slytherins. âPrankingâs a Brickston tradition,â he told John solemnly. The times he snuck out of the castle and into Hogsmeade. The time he fell asleep during his History of Magic O.W.L. (âWhat do they expect, when Binns makes you fall asleep during class?â) Sneaking about the castle at night with whatever girlfriend he had at the time. Jan had to shut him up at that point and she and Jeff began to relay their own Hogwarts stories.
John was, if it was possible, even more excited about Hogwarts after hearing all of the stories. He wanted to swim in the Black Lake in the middle of winter. He wanted to sneak out of school to go to Hogsmeade. He wanted to paint half his face red and the other half gold for the Gryffindor-Slytherin Quidditch match.
John didnât know how he was going to be able to wait two days until Saturday to go to Diagon Alley, let alone wait the month and a half until heâd be able to actually go to Hogwarts. It seemed so far away. He had been waiting years to go to Hogwarts, but he had a feeling the last month and a half would drag by even slower than those years had.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Cause thereâs so much yet to see, that I havenât seen yet
And thereâs so much air to breathe, yeah
I want to take it in
~Take It In, Jared Campbell
Ten-year-old Rose Elizabeth Weasley put the end of her quill to her mouth and chewed it thoughtfully as she looked up from her parchment. She smiled and dipped the quill into her pot of ink and then wrote âElandra Harvard took a deep breath and sat down on the three-legged stoolâ onto the parchment. Rose set down the quill and picked up the parchment. She looked at it for a moment and then set it down again.
The parchment was a story. A story about a Muggle-born at Hogwarts. Ever since Rose was little, she liked coming up with stories. She used to just tell them to her parents and little brother, but then she got older and began writing them down.
Rose had spent the whole morning writing about Elandra. She supposed it was because Rose herself was going to Hogwarts soon and that was really all she could think about. Although she tried to come up with other story ideas, she just couldnât. All the ideas were about Hogwarts. It was just about the only thing that could sort of keep her mind off her own Hogwarts letter.
Rose had been waiting for the letter all summer. She wished that Hogwarts would send them out in June instead of the end of July. The end of July was sort of late. That only gave a month and a half to prepare to go to school. Rose had been preparing since May, though. She knew she would get her letter this summer, as she would be turning eleven on August twentieth.
Her dad had located her mumâs old trunk in the attic and charmed an engraving of âREWâ to replace the âHJGâ that stood for Hermione Jean Granger. The trunk currently sat on the floor in Roseâs room. The only thing in it was a cauldron that her dad had found in the attic as well. It was a perfectly good cauldron, so neither of her parents saw any need to buy her a new one. Rose agreed. She kind of liked the old cauldron. There was something to be said about brewing potions in a cauldron that was older than you were.
âRose!â someone banged on her door.
Rose groaned and got up. It was Hugo, her nine-year-old brother. He probably wanted to play Quidditch or something. Rose didnât particularly like Quidditch. She preferred reading or pretty much anything that she remained on the ground to do.
âWhat?â Rose asked when she opened the door, âI donât want to play Quidditch.â
âI wasnât going to ask you,â Hugo muttered, âYouâre no fun to play Quidditch with anyway. Iâd rather just ask James and Al to play. I just wanted to give you this. The post just arrived.â
Hugo thrust an envelope into Roseâs hand and she caught a glimpse of the Hogwarts crest on the seal. The breath caught in her chest as she grabbed it. âThanks, Hugo,â she grinned.
Hugo made no move to leave as Rose shakily began to open the envelope. âHurry up!â he said.
âItâs my letter,â Rose replied and pulled it out of the envelope. Hugo peered over her shoulder as she began to read it.
Rose grinned looked at Hugo. âItâs official! Iâm going to Hogwarts!â
âAnd Iâll get the house to myself,â Hugo grinned, âI can go through your stuff and you wonât be able to do anything about it.â
âMum and Dad will be here,â Rose rolled her eyes, âAnd you better not go through my stuff.â
âYou wonât be able to do anything about it!â Hugo gleefully ran off towards his room.
Rose turned the other way and went downstairs in order to find her mum. She eventually found her in the library, pouring over numerous books.
âIt came,â Rose grinned and sat down across the table from Hermione.
Hermione looked up and smiled. âCongratulations!â She leaned over and kissed Roseâs forehead.
âWhat are you working on?â Rose asked.
âOh, work stuff,â Hermione said as she closed the book, âIt can wait. Let me see that letter!â
Rose handed her mother the letter and waited while she read it. Hermione handed it back to her and smiled even wider. âI canât believe youâre going to Hogwarts already. Time has flown by! My little girl, all grown up.â
âI canât wait, Mum,â Rose replied.
âWeâll have some shopping to do,â Hermione said as she stood up.
âRon! Hermione! Anyone here?â someone shouted from the living room.
âUncle Harry!â Rose shouted as she ran out of the library and into the living room.
Harryâs face was floating amongst green flames in the fireplace and Rose grinned when she saw him. âHi Uncle Harry! Guess what? I got my letter!â
âBrilliant,â Harry grinned, âAl got his, too. Are your parents home?â
âDadâs working at the London shop, but heâs supposed to be back soon,â Rose replied, âAnd Mumâs-â
âRight here,â Hermione said as she came into the room, âHi Harry.â
âHey, Hermione,â Harry said, âWe were going to go to Diagon Alley after lunch. Al got his letter a few hours ago. Want to come?â
âThat sounds good,â Hermione agreed, âWeâll meet you there around 1:30. Ron should be back from Weasleysâ by then.â
âSee you then,â Harry said.
âBye,â Hermione replied as Harryâs head disappeared and the green flames died down.
******
A few hours later Rose was standing with her family in front of Gringotts. She tapped her foot and sighed. They were waiting for the Potters, who were never on time for anything. Roseâs parents werenât known for being on time either, but Rose had hurried them along.
âSorry weâre late!â Harry shouted as he ran towards the Weasleys.
âJames wouldnât wake up,â Albus grinned at Rose.
âWhat else is new?â Rose smirked.
âWhere to first?â Harry asked.
âOlivanderâs!â Albus announced.
âFlourish and Blotts!â Rose said excitedly. She had been there numerous times, but never to buy books for school.
âYouâre mental, Rose,â James laughed, âI say we go to Quality Quidditch Supplies!â
Rose rolled her eyes. James was the one who was mental. He spent more time at Quality Quidditch Supplies than all the other stores in Diagon Alley combined. Half the time he didnât even buy anything. He just gawked at the broomsticks he wished he could have.
âEyelops!â Lily shouted.
âYouâre not even going to Hogwarts,â Albus pointed out.
âI donât care,â Lily huffed.
âWeasleyâs Wizard Wheezes,â Hugo suggested.
âThen itâs settled,â Harry grinned, âWeâre going to the Apothecary first.â
Rose groaned. The Apothecary was possibly her least favorite shop, next to Quality Quidditch Supplies. It didnât surprise her that Harry chose that store, though. He always did that when they argued. Roseâs parents did the same thing.
They finally made it to Flourish and Blottâs, after the Apothecary and Madam Malkinâs. Rose was the first one through the door and immediately started browsing. She didnât know where everyone else was going in the shop, but she didnât care.
Flourish and Blottâs had always fascinated Rose, ever since she was little. There were always at least five books she wanted to buy whenever she went in. Hermione usually bought her one every time they went.
âRose, are you done yet?â James tapped her on the shoulder.
Rose jumped and looked up from the transfiguration book she was reading. âNo.â
âHurry up,â James whined, âI want to go get my broom.â
âWhat makes you think youâll get it?â
âIâm trying out for the Quidditch team this year,â James told her.
âSo?â
âSo?â James gawked, âSo? I need another broom! A better one! Youâll never understand.â
James sighed loudly and then walked away. Rose shook her head and went back to her book. A few minutes later her mum told her it was time to go. It was time to go to Ollivanderâs, which was what Rose had been most looking forward to.
Rose ran ahead of the group with Albus and the two of them arrived at Ollivanderâs long before the others. Ollivander had taken their measurements and brought out a few wands for Albus to try by the time the others got there.
Albus smashed the window with his first wand, which Rose thought was incredibly funny. She secretly hoped she wouldnât do the same, though. The next wand chose Albus and then it was Roseâs turn.
The first three she tried out werenât right. Although she didnât break any windows, they didnât work properly.
âHow about this one?â Ollivander handed her another wand, âTen and a half inches, yew, dragon heartstring.â
Rose took the wand and waved it. Red sparks erupted from it and Rose knew it was the right one. She grinned at Ollivander and he smiled.
Next on the list was Weasleyâs Wizard Wheezes, despite Jamesâs constant badgering about the Quidditch store.
âRon, Ginny!â George greeted them as they entered, âAnd Harry and Hermione! Youâve got everyone with you today.â
âHogwarts shopping,â Harry grinned, âAl and Rosie just got their wands.â
Rose opened the box she was holding and showed her wand to her Uncle George. Albus did the same.
âBrilliant, both of you!â George said, âAnd now I shall get you both ready for Hogwarts in the prank departmentâŠ.â
Rose followed her uncle across the shop. The one thing she had inherited from the Weasley side of the family was the love for a good prank. So long as no one got hurt, that is.
âNow, every student needs a Skiving Snackbox or two,â George said as he handed Rose and Alubs each a colorful box, âAfter all, I canât imagine youâll want to sit through History of Magic very often.â
Rose smirked. She had heard about Professor Binns and his boring lectures, but she really didnât think sheâd ever use a Skiving Snackbox. Well, maybe if James wanted her to watch Quidditch practice, but never for skipping a class.
âAnd then youâll need some dung bombs,â George said as he led them to a different display.
âLast time I checked, those were still forbidden at Hogwarts,â Hermione said sternly.
âOh, Iâm sure they are,â George winked, âBut so long as Filch doesnât find out it was these two who set them off, it doesnât matter.â
âGeorge Weasley!â Hermione scolded, âYou should be setting a better example for these two! No wonder Fred was in detention every week last year!â
âLighten up, Hermione,â Ron laughed, âLet them have their fun.â
âRonald!â Hermione shouted, âYouâre even worse!â
A few minutes later, Ron had convinced Hermione to let Rose get the dung bombs and other mischief making products. Hermione didnât look too happy about it, though.
George and Teddy, who had also been working, closed the shop and they all went to the Leaky Cauldron for dinner. Everyone told stories about Hogwarts, which made Rose look forward to school even more.
Jamesâs whining finally paid off after dinner and they went to Quality Quidditch Supplies. Rose thought he took far too long to pick out the perfect broom and she was bored out of her mind. James, Albus, Teddy, Ron, and Harry all spent at least a half hour going over the pros and cons of each model before they finally made a decision.
âAnd it goes from zero to 60 in less than twenty seconds!â James said excitedly on their way to Eyelops.
âI donât care, James,â Rose groaned.
âThe twigs repel water,â James added, âSo there isnât any drag when youâre playing in the rain or snowâŠ.â
Rose ignored him for the rest of the walk and then lost him inside of Eyelops. She knew exactly what kind of owl she wanted. A tawny one. She had always liked that kind of owl.
She found three tawny owls together in a cage towards the back of the shop and she put her hand up to the cage. Two of the owls ignored her but the third one hopped over and rubbed its head on her hand like a cat would. Rose grinned and knew that was the owl for her.
Albus found an owl as well and the group left with two hooting owls. James started telling Albus how he was going to wind up in Slytherin, which was kind of ridiculous in Roseâs opinion. Albus then announced that he was going to name his owl Godric.
That was a good name, Rose thought. She looked at her owl and thought about names. None of the usual animal names seemed to fit her owl. Godric, she thought. That was it. She would name her owl after another founder. Roseâs owl would be Rowena. She didnât really think sheâd be in Ravenclaw, but Rowena was a good name for an owl.
The walk back to the Leaky Cauldron was quiet. Hogwarts seemed closer than ever for Rose. She was ready. She had been ready for this for years. Her mum always told her that she had a knack for learning, and Rose was ready to learn everything Hogwarts had to offer.
NĂŠsta saga
Albus waved to his parents and little sister, Lily, until he could no longer see them. âWell, weâd better go find a compartment,â he said to his cousin, Rose, who was standing next to him. Rose nodded her head and they started walking down the train corridor. It was a bit hard to walk on a moving train and Albus kept stumbling. The train rounded a corner and he fell into a rather mean looking older student.
âWatch where youâre going, midget,â the boy said as Albus and Rose quickly ran away from him.
âBetter find a compartment quickâ, Albus said. He continued to walk along the corridor, looking into each compartment as he passed. He spotted a lot of his other cousins, but didnât really want to interrupt whatever they were doing with their friends. Albus also saw a few people who looked vaguely familiar, including the Jordan-Bell twins. Scorpius Malfoy was sitting in one of the compartments with a few other boys, but Albus definitely did not want to sit with them.
Albus peeked into the next compartment and saw that there was a rather pale boy sitting on one of the seats. He seemed very small and his face was quite scarred. There was also an older girl, who looked to be about Victoireâs age, sitting next to the boy. She looked vaguely familiar. Both of them had blue eyes and blond hair. They looked friendly enough. âHow about this one?â he said to Rose.
Rose glanced into the compartment for a few seconds and replied, âYeah, looks good to me.â She opened the door and the two cousins walked in.
âCan we sit here?â Albus asked.
âSure,â the boy responded as he gestured to the seat opposite him. âMy nameâs Matt, Matt Eckerton.â
âIâm his sister, Amy. Iâm a seventh year, Mattâs just starting,â the girl told him.
âHi, Iâm Albus Potter,â Albus said, âAnd this is my cousin, Rose Weasley,â he gestured to Rose. âWeâre both first years.â
âHi,â Rose waved. Rose sat down on the seat across from Amy and Albus sat down across from Matt.
âThatâs where I know you two from! I knew Iâd seen you somewhere. My best friend is your cousin, Victoire. I think Iâve seen you at her house before,â Amy explained.
âProbably. I think Iâve seen you, too,â Rose responded. Albus nodded his head in agreement.
Mattâs eyes opened wide as he stared at Albus. âSo, youâre Harry Potterâs son? You know, you do look a whole lot like him. Youâve got his eyes and everything.â
âYeah, I know,â Albus said shortly, he often got sick of people telling him this.
âI bet you two hear loads of stories of the battle. My parents have told me some, but they donât know all the details, just the bits that are in books. You see, weâre from Australia. We moved hear when I was about eight,â Matt looked nervously at his sister.
âYeah, I know all about the battle. My parents didnât tell me the full story until I turned eleven. Same with Rose, our parents told us at the same time. They didnât want to scare us, but thought we ought to know before we went to Hogwarts, since most people there will have heard all about it. But my parents donât talk about it much. Guess it brings back bad memories,â Albus told Matt before changing the subject. He really didnât enjoy people constantly asking him about his dad. âSo, howâd you get all those scars?â
âIâm, um, er, very clumsy,â Matt glanced at Amy and started to stare absentmindedly out the window.
âOh, thatâs ok. A friend of my parentsâ was very clumsy, kind of a problem since she was an Auror. But she was killed in the battle at Hogwarts. Along with her husband. My dad is their son, Teddyâs, godfather, so we see a lot of him,â Albus told Matt.
Matt just continued staring out the window. Albus didnât know what to say, he hoped he hadnât said anything to bother Matt. âSo, do you have any other siblings?â Albus asked.
Matt turned away from the window. âNope, just me and Amy. I know youâve got siblings. Iâve read about you and them in books. A brother James and a sister Lily, right? And I think youâve got a little brother, right, Rose?â
Albus just looked at Matt. It was a bit strange having other people know all about you. He supposed this was what it was like for his father when he went to Hogwarts. âYup, James is a second year and Lilyâs just nine, so sheâs not here yet.â
âYeah, my brother, Hugo, is nine, too,â Rose told him. Roseâs family was mentioned in numerous books as well, although not nearly as many as Albusâs.
At that moment, the compartment door opened and James walked in with two of their cousins, Ben and Cedric, and their friend Nathan. âHowâs it going, little bro?â James asked. âStill worrying about being in Slytherin?â
âJames, shut up!â Albus responded, blushing a little.
âOh, I see youâve met someone, whatâs your name?â James asked Matt.
âMatt Eckerton.â
âHi,â the boys responded.
âOh, and hi Amy,â Ben added.
âHi, Ben. How are you?â Amy asked.
âIâm good. So this is your brother?,â Ben said. Ben was Victoireâs brother, so he had seen Amy loads of times.
âYeah, Mattâs just starting his first year,â Amy told him.
âGood luck with the sorting, then, Matt,â Ben grinned at Matt.
âAh, well, we best be off, the trolleyâs on itâs way to our compartment, wouldnât want to miss that!â James said as he walked out of the compartment with his friends.
Matt stared at Albus. âYou think youâre going to be in Slytherin?â
âNo,â Albus said, turning more crimson.
âSo, what house do you want to be in?â
âGryffindor, just like my parents,â Albus told him, âAnd James and all my cousins are in Gryffindor, too. So were most of my aunts and uncles.â
âI hope you get in, then,â Matt said, âIâm hoping for Gryffindor, too. Amyâs in Gryffindor.â
âHope youâre there, too.â
âIâm also hoping for Gryffindor,â Rose announced, âAlthough Ravenclaw looks nice, too.â
âRavenclaw wouldnât be so bad,â Matt agreed, âThatâs where all the smart kids go, right?â
âIn essence, yeah,â Amy told him.
The compartment door opened again. Another boy walked in, along with a scared looking girl. The boy was dark skinned, very tall, with brown hair and dark eyes. The girl was quite a bit shorter than the boy, with long, wavy, honey colored hair and light brown eyes.
âCan we sit in here?â the boy asked. âA bunch of Slytherins kicked us out of our compartment.â
âSure,â Albus and Matt responded.
âGood. Iâm John Brickston and this is Amanda Tagger. Weâre both first years,â the boy told Albus, Rose, Matt, and Amy.
âHi. Iâm Albus Potter, this is my cousin Rose Weasley, and thatâs Matt Eckerton, weâre also first years,â Albus responded, âAnd sheâs Amy, Mattâs sister.â Albus pointed to Amy, who waved.
âWow!â John exclaimed. âMy dad said youâd be starting this year, Albus.â Amanda still hadnât said anything.
Albus just smiled a little and his cheeks turned redder yet.
âWell, I think Iâll go find Victoire,â Amy grabbed her bag and got up, âYou going to be ok, Matt?â
âYes, Iâll be fine,â Matt told her.
âYou sure?â
âYeah, you can go. See you later,â Matt waved as his sister left the
compartment.
âAnd youâre Rose Weasley?â John asked. Rose nodded. âIâve heard of you, too,â John continued. âYour family owns Weasleyâs Wizard Wheezes, right?â
âWell, itâs really my Uncle George who owns it. Heâs Albusâs uncle, too. But my dad works there a lot. My Uncle George opened it with my Uncle Fred after they left school. Theyâre twins. But Uncle Fred died in the Battle at Hogwarts, so after that my dad helped Uncle George with it,â Rose explained.
John grinned, âI love that place. So does my dad. Heâs always buying me stuff from there. Mumâs not always happy about it since Iâm always using the stuff to pull pranks on my little sisters.â
Albus, Rose, and Matt laughed. âIâve done that quite a bit, too,â Albus commented. âBut now that Lilyâs a bit older itâs harder to pull pranks on her.â
âAnything from the trolley?â A witch had appeared in the doorway with a trolley laden with delicious sweets.
âDefinitely!â John shouted, as he jumped up from his seat and ran out into the corridor. Albus smiled. John reminded him of James. Albus, Rose, Matt, and Amanda followed John. All five returned with their arms full of food.
âSo, what is all this stuff?â Amanda spoke for the first time since entering the compartment.
âWell, you have your cauldron cakes, pumpkin pasties, chocolate frogs, and Bertie Botts Every Flavor Beans,â John explained, as he pointed to the various items. âJust be careful with the beans.â
âWhy?â Amanda asked as she tried a greenish colored bean. âUgh!â she exclaimed. âBogey!â Amanda spat out the bean and it landed on John. Albus, Rose, and Matt broke out in fits of laughter.
âThey mean every flavor!â Matt shouted. âSo, you must be Muggle-born?â
âYes,â Amanda answered. âMy mum is a teacher and my dadâs a doctor.â
âWhatâs a doctor?â John asked.
âA muggle Healer,â Matt explained. âMy mumâs Muggle born, but sheâs a witch, and my dadâs a wizard. He works at the Ministry, in the Department for the Control and Regulation of Magical Creatures,â Matt told everyone. âAnd my mum doesnât work, but sheâs thinking of getting a job now that Iâve started school.â
âOh, my parents are a witch and wizard. My familyâs mostly all magical, except for a few Muggle aunts and uncles and cousins. My dad is a Healer and my mum stays at home with my younger sisters, Iâve got three of them. Theyâre nine, six, and five. But before I was born she worked at the Ministry,â John explained. âHow about your parents, Rose?â
âWell, like I said before, my dad works at Weasleyâs Wizard Wheezes, but heâs also an Auror, which is a Dark Wizard catcher. And my mum works at the Ministry. Sheâs the one who started all the House-Elf rights stuff.â
âWow, your dadâs an Auror, too? Thatâs bloody brilliant!â John grinned.
âWhat do your parents do, Albus?â Amanda asked.
Albus was a little shocked at this question, since the whole magical world knew about his parents, but of course Amanda didnât. âWell, my dadâs an Auror. And my mumâs a sportswriter for the Daily Prophet.â
âYeah, Albusâs parents are famous!â John shouted. âTell Amanda, wonât you, Albus?â Albus suspected John secretly wanted to hear all about the Potters directly from him, even though heâd probably read all about them in books.
And so, Albus, with a little help from Rose, told the story about how Lord Voldemort had killed his grandparents and tried to kill his dad, but his dad survived. He told them all about his parentsâ years at Hogwarts, about the Horcruxes, and how Lord Voldemort met his downfall.
All three students stared at Albus and Rose with their mouths wide open. Matt and John had obviously heard the whole story before, but never this accurate an account. Amanda was practically in tears.
âBlimey,â John let out a low whistle, âYour dadâs amazing.â
âYeah,â Matt agreed.
Albus blushed, âI guess, but I just think of him as my dad.â
The group of five first years spent the rest of the journey discussing what they knew was true about Hogwarts and what their siblings and cousins had told them about the ancient school. Everyone agreed that the Giant Squid did not eat a different first year each year while they crossed the lake on boats, despite what Albus and Roseâs cousin, Fred, had said.
âWell, youâd better change into your robes,â Rose said an hour or so after the sky turned dark. Rose had been wearing her robes since before sheâd even gotten on the train. The four other students changed into their robes quietly.
Once the train arrived at Hogsmeade, the five students got off and looked around.
âFirsâ years! Firsâ years, this way!â a man shouted.
Albus and Rose ran up to him. âHagrid!â Albus shouted.
ââello, Albus! âEllo, Rose!â Hagrid responded. âReady ter go? Hereâs a boat for yeh.â Albus hurried into the boat, followed by John, and Matt, who were all gaping at Hagrid. Rose and Amanda got into a nearby boat and were joined by the Jordan-Bell twins. Another tall boy quickly joined Albus in his boat.
âYou know him?â John pointed at Hagrid with an amazed look on his face.
âYep, heâs a family friend,â Albus answered.
âIâve never seen someone so big,â Matt commented.
âWell, heâs half-giant,â Albus told him.
âThatâs so cool!â John grinned.
The boats started moving magically across the lake once everyone was in them. They sailed for what must have been at least a half hour before arriving at Hogwarts. Once they got there, Hagrid lead them into the castle and up a flight of stairs. The castle was incredible. It was big and intimidating looking on the outside. But once Albus stepped inside, it seemed warm and inviting, like he was home.
The first years came to a stop in front of strict looking woman. âGood evening. Iâm Professor Patil, I teach transfiguration. In a moment, you will be able to join your fellow students in the Great Hall for dinner, but beforehand, you will need to be sorted into your houses. They are Ravenclaw, Gryffindor, Hufflepuff, and Slytherin,â she said Slytherin with a note of disgust in her voice. âWhile youâre here, you will be able to earn points for your house for any achievements. Likewise, any misbehavior will cause points to be taken away. At the end of the year, the house with the most points earns the House Cup. Now, follow me, please.â
âââ-
A/N: I hope you liked it! Feel free to leave a review. Iâd like to thank my brother and sisters for reading this first and letting me know what they thought.
I donât own Harry Potter. Nothing you recognize is mine.
******
The students followed Professor Patil into a large dining room. The ceiling looked just like the night sky outside. âItâs enchanted to look like the sky,â Rose whispered to Albus. The older students at all four of the tables were whispering to each other and pointing wildly at Albus. Once the first years reached the head table, Professor Patil turned around. The older students were still whispering, and they seemed to be doing so more loudly by the minute. Albus looked out at them and then inched his way to the back of the group so no one could see him. Sometimes, he hated how much he looked like his father.
âQuiet, please,â Professor Patil announced, and the students immediately stopped talking. An old, patched hat sat on a stool and all of a sudden it broke out in song. A few of the first years were quite shocked at this and jumped back. Once it stopped, Professor Patil started talking again. âWhen I call your name, you will come forward and try on the Sorting Hat.â
âAsterley, Elaine.â A short, blond haired girl ran forward and tried on the hat. âHufflepuff!â the hat shouted.
âBrickston, John.â John ran up and jammed the hat on his head. It was only there for a second when it shouted out, âGryffindor!â John let out a loud whoop and ran for the Gryffindor table, where he was patted on the back by a few older Gryffindors.
âCreevey, Janie.â She was also made a Gryffindor.
âEckerton, Matthew.â The headmaster suddenly sat up straight in his seat and stared as Matt tried on the hat and was made a Gryffindor. The headmaster relaxed again. âThat was strange,â Albus thought. Matt walked calmly over to the Gryffindor table and sat next to John.
âEubert, Carter.â Albus recognized the other boy from their boat as he walked up to the Sorting Hat. He put it on and a few seconds later it shouted out, âRavenclaw!â
A few more students were sorted and then Professor Patil called âMalfoy, Scorpius.â Albus watched as a blond haired boy with a smug look on his face was made a Slytherin before the hat even touched his head.
âPotter, Albus.â A whisper went through the crowd. The headmaster had sat up straight again. Albus froze. He couldnât do this. What if he was made Slytherin in front of all these people? All these people who expected him to be in Gryffindor? âAlbus Potter?â Professor Patil said again. Someone pushed Albus forward. He walked up to the stool and put on the hat.
âAh, yes, another Potter. I see it all here. The bravery, yes, yes, itâs all here,â the hat told Albus.
âNot Slytherin,â Albus thought, âAnything but Slytherin.â
âOh, oh, this sounds familiar,â said the hat, âYes, indeed, just like your father. And just like your father, Slytherin would help you achieve greatness, but if you insist, Gyffindor!â
Albus breathed a sigh of relief as he jumped off the stool and ran to sit across from John and Matt at the Gryffindor table. Albus didnât even pay attention to the next few sortings. He was just so happy to be in Gryffindor.
Albus next looked up when Professor Patil called out âTagger, Amanda.â Albus watched as Amanda cautiously put on the hat. âGryffindor!â it shouted. Amanda ran to sit down across from John, with a smile on her face. Only one student was left to be sorted.
âWeasley, Rose.â Rose was made a Gryffindor before the hat had even touched her head. âJust like how James was sorted,â Albus thought. It never hesitated for them. But it had for him. Albus stared glumly at his golden plate.
The headmaster rose from his chair. âWelcome back to Hogwarts to all returning students and welcome to those who are new. For those of you who donât know, Iâm Professor Kendrick, headmaster of Hogwarts. Now, I know the older students have noticed we are short one staff member,â the headmaster gestured to the empty chair beside him. âBut I shall inform you about that later. Right now it is time to eat.â And the golden plates filled with food.
Albus stared in amazement as the food appeared in front of him. He started piling his plate with as much as would fit. John was using not only his plate, but an empty one that he found as well.
âThis is amazing!â John exclaimed. âI might actually get full here! I hope all the meals are like this.â
âYeah, it all looks very good,â Albus said. Albus started eating his food and couldnât help but overhear a conversation between two older students.
âI wonder where Professor Torro is? Itâs not usual for a teacher to miss the start of term feast,â a brown haired girl asked the boy sitting next to her.
âYeah, quite strange, really. I hope heâs all right. Maybe heâs ill or something?â the boy responded.
âWhat does he teach?â John said, interrupting the two older students.
âDefense Against the Dark Arts,â the girl told him. The two older students continued their conversation, but in lower voices so John couldnât overhear him.
*********
After the students had eaten their fill of dinner, the golden plates became clean for a moment, and then dessert appeared. Albus immediately helped himself to his favorite, treacle tart. While he was eating, he heard a scream coming from his left. A ghostly head had appeared right out of Amandaâs plate.
âOh, so sorry to have scared you!â the ghost said as he glided out of Amandaâs plate. âIâm Sir Nicholas.â
âYouâre Nearly Headless Nick!â John shouted. âGreat to meet you. Can I see you pull off your head?â
Amanda looked like she might faint, but Nick grudgingly pulled on his ear and his head came partially off.
âWow! Thatâs bloody brilliant!â John exclaimed. âDid you see that, Albus?â
âYeah,â Albus responded. He didnât think it was as neat as John did, and was beginning to wish he hadnât eaten nearly as much treacle tart.
The headmaster got to his feet again as the golden plates became clean once more. âIs everyone satisfied? Good. Now, I have a few start of term notices. The village of Hogsmeade is out of bounds for first and second years, as well as the Forbidden Forest to everyone. As always, stay away from the Whomping Willow. Mr. Filch has added a few new items to the list of forbidden things and if you wish to inspect the list, it is pinned to Mr. Filchâs door.
âNow, as many of you have noticed, Professor Torro is not with us tonight. I regret to inform you that he has been discovered dead only a few hours ago,â Professor Kendrick stated with a sad expression on his face. There was a sharp intake of breath from the students. âCause of death has not been determined. Until I can find a suitable replacement, Defense Against the Dark Arts classes will not take place. Now, it is time to go to your dormitories. Classes begin tomorrow and you will need to be well rested. First years, please follow a prefect to your common rooms.â
Albus got up and looked for his cousin, Georgia, for she was one of the Gryffindor prefects. Albus found her, and he, John, Matt, Rose, and Amanda all followed her up to the common room. As they walked through the castle, there was a whole lot of whispering about Professor Torro.
âHe wasnât even that old,â one student said.
âYeah, and wasnât DADA the subject that was jinxed years back?â another responded.
Albus and the others arrived at the portrait of the Fat Lady. Georgia told her the password, Cornish Pixie, and everyone walked inside.
âBoys to the right, girls to the left. I hope everyone has a good night,â Georgia told the first years.
Albus walked up the spiral staircase to his dormitory with Matt, John, and two other boys Albus had not met yet. Albus thought their names were Bilius and Ethan. Albus was rather quiet while he got into bed. All the other boys were laughing and talking. But Albus couldnât shake that he was considered for Slytherin. He was also a bit nervous about the fact that a professor had died. That didnât happen often, did it? Albus was still thinking about these things as he drifted off to sleep.
******
When Harry, Ginny, and Lily walked back into their house after taking James and Albus to Platform 9 3/4, Harry noticed an owl waiting on the windowsill. He walked over to it and opened the letter.
Dear Harry,
I would appreciate it if you would come to Hogwarts later tonight, around 9pm.
I have something to ask you, and would prefer to do it in person, rather than by letter.
Please return this owl with your answer, thank you.
From,
Fabius Kendrick
âThatâs strange,â thought Harry. Surely one of his boys couldnât be in trouble already? âGinny, Iâm going to have to go to Hogwarts tonight. Fabius has requested that I meet with him. He hasnât told me why,â Harry told his wife.
âOkay, just let me know before you leave. That is strange, though. Why wouldnât he have met with you before term started? I hope James and Albus arenât in trouble.â
*********
Later that night, Harry Apparated into Hogsmeade. It was a chilly night, but there was not a cloud in the sky. The stars and moon shone brightly. Harry thought the students must be in their common rooms by now, judging from the time. âThatâs good, Albus and James have no idea Iâm hereâ, thought Harry. He walked along the path and soon found himself walking through the big oak doors into the Great Hall. Kendrick was waiting for him there.
âGood evening, Harry,â Fabius greeted.
âHow are you? Whatâs this about? Are James and Albus okay?â Harry asked anxiously.
âOh, donât worry, theyâre fine. But I would prefer if we discuss what we need to discuss in my office,â Fabius responded. Harry followed Fabius up to the stone gargoyle. It leaped aside as Fabius murmured, âWoolen coat.â
Harry walked into the familiar circular office. He saw all the various possessions that Dumbledore had left to the school. He also noticed the sleeping portraits of previous headmasters. Only one was awake, the one of Albus Dumbledore. Harry smiled as he saw him.
âPlease, sit down,â Professor Kendrick said as he gestured to a chair in front of his desk. Harry sat. âI have some bad news. Professor Torro was found dead in his house this morning.â
âWhat?! How did he die? He wasnât very old,â Harry exclaimed. Professor Torro had been teaching DADA since Hogwarts reopened after the battle.
âI know, shocking, and very, very sad. His cause of death was Avada Kedarva, but I didnât tell the students this. It does worry me. It is quite suspicious. Especially since DADA was the subject that Voldemort jinxed.â
âBut heâs gone! I saw him die, I was there!â Harry shouted. âThis canât be the work of him, can it?â Harry knew there would be an investigation awaiting him when he returned to work the next day. He had taken the day off to see James and Albus onto the Hogwarts Express, and hadnât heard a thing about Professor Torroâs death until just now.
âOf course not. But there are still Death Eaters out there. I have reason to believe that one of them killed Torro and the Minister agrees with me. But onto the reason I have summoned you here.
âWe are, of course, in need of a new DADA teacher, and I was wondering if you would like the job. I think it would be a good idea to have an Auror here after recent events and you are the ideal candidate,â Kendrick told Harry.
âMe? A teacher? Well, I canât say Iâve never thought about it. It would be nice to be back at Hogwarts. But what about Ginny and Lily? I canât leave them.â
âOf course. And feel free to leave every weekend to spend time with them. Neville Longbottom does the same thing to visit Hannah,â Kendrick explained.
âI guess I could do it, but only if Ginny is okay with it. I tell you what, Iâll Apparate home tonight and ask her. Youâll have your answer in the morning, okay?â Harry asked.
âThatâs fine. Iâll see you in the morning, then. Good night.â
ââNight,â Harry said as he walked out of the office.
As Harry left the castle, he pondered the death of Torro. Harry had only met Torro a few times, and he was not particularly close to him, but his death still troubled Harry. Was this another random Death Eater attack? There had been a few of them throughout the years after the battle. But why was Torro killed? He didnât even live in Britain during the time of Voldemort, he lived in France then. Why were the Death Eaters going after Hogwarts teachers? Harry had a nagging feeling that this wasnât like the other deaths, this had significance. Surely, Voldemort couldnât return? He was dead. There were no more Horcruxes. Harry kept telling himself this, but he still felt very uneasy about it. The headmaster and the Minister felt the same way. Why else would they want an Auror at Hogwarts? Of course, Harry was the one who defeated Voldemort, so who else knew more about DADA?
Harry found himself back in Hogsmeade and he Disapparated. He appeared a moment later in his backyard and he walked into the house. It was time to tell Ginny what had happened. Luckily, Lily would be in bed.
*********
Early the next morning, Harry Apparated into Hogsmeade once again. This time he had his old Hogwarts trunk with him, along with a large, black owl named Harvey. This is familiar, he thought. Harry wheeled his trunk over to Hogsmeade station, where he would wait for a carriage to take him to the castle. Ginny had said yes right away. She felt that Harryâs presence in the school would protect her sons. Ginny was also quite worried about the death of Torro.
The carriage arrived and Harry loaded his trunk into it. âThis sure is strange,â he thought. Back at Hogwarts, once again. It kind of felt good, comforting in a way. Hogwarts had always felt like home to Harry. But he still couldnât shake the uneasy feeling he had about Torroâs death. The carriage gave a lurch, and the thestrals pulled Harry up to the school.
âGet up, Albus! Get up!â Albus awoke with a start and saw Johnâs face looking down at him.
âHuh? Whaâs going on?â Albus said sleepily.
âFirst day of lessons! Letâs go down to breakfast,â John responded, excitedly. He was bouncing around the room, waking up all his fellow Gryffindors.
Albus got up and put on his robes. âOkay, Iâm ready,â
âGreat! Bilius and Ethan are up too. But I canât get Matt up. He sleeps like a log,â John said as he shook Matt some more. Matt finally got up and put his robes on.
The five Gryffindor first year boys met the girls in the common room. Rose, Amanda, Janie Creevey, and the Jordan-Bell twins. Albus knew heâd met the twins a few times, but couldnât remember their names They introduced themselves as Karina and Marina. They were identical with long black hair and blue eyes. The first years walked down to the Great Hall together, only getting lost once.
When Albus walked into the Great Hall, he glanced up at the head table and his jaw dropped. He stopped walking and an older Hufflepuff bumped into him.
âSorry,â she said as she walked past.
Albus didnât pay any attention to her. He continued to stare at the staff table. Sitting next to the headmaster, was his father. Albus shook his head and ran over to the Gryffindor table, where his fellow first years had already sat down.
âJames! James!â Albus shouted, âLook whoâs sitting next to Professor Kendrick! Isnât that Dad? Whatâs he doing here? He doesnât teach here!â
James was staring at Harry. âYeah, I know. Funny how he never mentioned it. But I guess he must be the new DADA teacher. All the other teachers are there.â
âHonestly, James! He couldnât have told us yet. Torro just died yesterday. Obviously, Kendrick asked him last night. It was only a matter of time, wasnât it? I mean, heâs got to be the most qualified wizard for the job, right?â Georgia had sat down next to James and talked some sense into him.
âI suppose,â James said as he started to eat his eggs.
âHere are your schedules!â Neville Longbottom had appeared near the Gryffindor table.
Albus took his schedule from him and looked at it. He had DADA right after breakfast, then Charms, and after lunch he had double Herbology.
âLooks like a decent schedule,â John said, âShould be interesting having your dad as a teacher, Albus! I canât wait! Iâve got so many questions for him.â
âYeah, should be wonderful,â Albus said glumly as he dug into his waffles. Truthfully, Albus did not want his dad teaching at Hogwarts. With his dad here, Albus would be even more famous than usual. He did not like the staring eyes and the constant questions about his dad.
**********
After breakfast, the Gryffindors headed to the DADA classroom, with John leading the way. Albus hung back with Matt, who was going pretty slow.
âYou okay, Matt?â Albus asked, âYou look kind of sick. You want to go to the Hospital Wing?â
âNo, Iâll be fine,â Matt replied with a yawn, âGuess I didnât get to sleep until late, too nervous about lessons.â
When they arrived at the classroom, Albus ran and took the table in the back. Matt and Amanda followed him. John hesitated, apparently torn with joining his new friends and sitting up front. Finally, he, too, went and sat in the back.
âWhy are we sitting back here?â John asked.
âCause itâs my dad, John. How would you like it if your dad taught at Hogwarts?â Albus said in a rude tone. John didnât say anything.
At that moment, another group of students came into the room. They were Slytherins. Scorpius Malfoy was leading them.
âGreat, weâre with the Slytherins,â John whispered to Matt, âHope theyâre not going to ruin everything.â John was about to launch into a tirade about Slytherins, but Harry walked in.
âGood morning,â Harry said as he walked to the front desk, âIâm Professor Potter.â A few of the girls in front giggled. âIâll start by taking attendance.â Harry ran down the attendance sheet. Everyone was there.
âPlease open your books to page 5,â Harry told the students.
âProfessor? Can you tell us about the battle? Please?â one of the twins asked, Albus didnât know which one.
Harry sighed. âWell, I really donât like to talk about it much. But I suppose I could. I know you wonât let it rest until I do,â he smiled and looked at Albus, âI know my own kids, nieces, and nephews kept asking me until I told them.â
Albus sunk lower in his chair. John was sitting straight up, staring at Harry, hardly blinking. Amanda and Matt were also paying close attention.
Harryâs story about the battle lasted the whole period. The bell rang shortly after Harry finished.
âPlease read chapter one for next time, since we didnât get a chance to cover it in class,â Harry told the students as they left. âAnd Albus, could you stay for a moment?â
âYou guys go on ahead,â Albus told his friends, âIâll meet you in Charms.â Albus approached his fatherâs desk after all the other students had left.
âHi, Al, how was the Sorting? I see you did make it into Gryffindor. I knew you would,â Harry said with a proud look on his face.
âYes, I did,â Albus said, his eyes brimming with tears as he remembered what the hat had told him, âBut it wanted to put me in Slytherin!â Albus started crying and he couldnât stop. âI told it to put me in Gryffindor, thatâs the only reason it did!â
Harry quickly shut the door before responding. âI told you at the station that it did that to me, too.â
âBut thatâs cause you were a Horcrux!â Albus sobbed, âIâm not a Horcrux, so why should I have done well in Slytherin? It put Rose in Gryffindor before it even touched her head. And James said it did that with him, too.â
âYes, I know, but everyoneâs different. It means that you have qualities of many different houses. It doesnât mean you should be in Slytherin. The hat put you in Gryffindor because you wanted it to. A great man once told me âit is our choices that show who we really are, far more than our abilitiesâ. Albus Dumbledore was that man. He told me that when I was wondering the same thing youâre wondering right now. You chose to be in Gryffindor, which makes you very different from the Slytherins. Donât worry about it,â Harry explained, as he drew Albus into a hug.
âO-k-kay,â Albus stuttered, âJ-just, d-donât tell J-James.â
âDonât worry, I wonât. James doesnât even know that the hat considered putting me in Slytherin,â Harry confided, âNow, I think you should be off to your next class. And donât worry about me teaching here. Iâll treat you just like the other students, detentions and all.â
Albus laughed. âWell, you donât have to do that.â
âSee you later, Al.â
âBye, Dad.â
**********
Albus was a bit more cheerful for the rest of the day. He thoroughly enjoyed double Herbology. He had known Professor Longbottom since he was born, and Albus was very interested in magical plants. Charms, however, wasnât as enjoyable. The Charms professor, Professor Washburn was not very nice, and for some reason he seemed to have something against Gryffindor.
Soon enough, dinner came, and right when Albus walked into the Great Hall, James came running over to him.
âSo, how was having Dad as a teacher?â James asked, breathlessly.
âYou know, it wasnât as bad as I thought it would be,â Albus said, while sitting down and grabbing the nearest bowl of potatoes. âHe spent the whole period telling everyone about the battle because he figured no one would leave him alone until he did.â
âSounds familiar!â James laughed, âRemember when we kept bugging him about it when I was 10? And then he said heâd tell us the whole story the summer before our first year of Hogwarts.â
âYeah, I was kind of surprised he was so willing to tell the story. You know how he hates talking about it.â
âI know, but I suppose itâs better for everyone to hear it sooner rather than later, and now Dad can get on to teaching,â James explained as he shoved his mouth with chicken, âShould be pretty cool having him teach, he knows so much DADA.â
âHey, Albus!â John shouted to Albus as he ran over to the Gryffindor table. Matt sat down on Albusâs other side.
âHi John, Matt,â Albus said, passing them the pumpkin juice.
âWow, this is just as good as last night!â John exclaimed as he piled his plate high with food, âI could definitely get used to this.â
âWhat? Did your mum starve you?â Albus joked.
ââCourse not. But she didnât make as much variety,â John explained. He turned to Matt. âYou okay? You look kind of pale.â
That was an understatement. Matt looked like he was about to pass out in the potatoes. He hadnât touched any of the food and his golden plate was still empty. Matt was leaning his head on his hand and was yawning a lot. âIâm all right, I guess, just tired.â
Albus and John eyed him warily. âYou sure?â Albus asked.
âYeah, Iâm just not hungry tonight. Iâll be fine.â
At that moment, the headmaster stood up. âIf I could have your attention for just a bit, I have some more announcements.â The room immediately fell silent. âThank you. Now, as many of you have noticed, I did have success in securing a new DADA teacher and I would like to introduce him. This is Professor Potter.â Kendrick gestured to Harry. âNow, I know many of you will have questions for him when you have your first DADA lesson, but I ask you not to pester him. He will tell you what he wants to, and nothing more. I would also like to tell you that if you want to try out for your house Quidditch team, please give your name to your head of house. That is all. Thank you.â Kendrick sat back down again and proceeded to talk to Harry.
âWell, Iâm trying out for Seeker this year!â James announced to the whole Gryffindor table, âIâve been down to the Pitch practicing on my Firebolt during lunch.â
âGood luck, James,â Albus told him, âDadâll be proud if you make the team.â
âI sure hope I do. Itâll be great having him watch the games.â
Albus turned to John. âYou finished? We should probably get started on that homework.â
John groaned, âYeah, I suppose. You gonna come, Matt?â
Matt looked up from his plate. âSure.â The three boys started walking back up to the Common room, with Matt lagging behind.
âMatt, are you sure youâre ok? Youâre going pretty slow,â Albus asked, with a nervous look on his face. âI think you should probably go to the hospital wing.
Matt looked out the window. âI suppose youâre probably right. You guys go on ahead, Iâll meet you back in the Common room.â
âNo, weâre going to take you. You look ready to collapse,â John insisted. They all trekked back down the stairs and to the Hospital Wing. When they got there, Madam Pomfrey was right by the door.
âMatt! Come here, you look dreadful,â she said, grabbing his shoulder and leading him to the bed, âThanks for bringing him, boys, you can leave now.â Madam Pomfrey shooed them out of the room.
âYou know, it almost looked like she was waiting for him,â Albus said as he walked up the stairs.
âYeah, and she knew his name. Thatâs odd. I donât think heâs been there yet,â John stated, âI wonder if he gets sick often? Or maybe he gets hurt a lot, heâs got loads of scars.â
âI know. I asked him about them on the train, before you came in. He said he was clumsy and quickly changed the subject.â
âWell, Iâm sure heâll tell us about it when heâs ready,â John reasoned, âCornish Pixie.â The portrait opened and the two boys walked into the common room. They settled down to doing their homework with Amanda, Rose, Janie, Bilius, Ethan, and the twins. After a few hours, Albus bid them good night.
He walked up to his dormitory, changed into his pajamas, and climbed into bed. He pondered his lessons and the rest of his day. Albus was happy that having his dad there wasnât as bad as he thought it would be. But why did Professor Washburn dislike him and the other Gryffindors so much? And was Matt okay? He still hadnât returned to the common room. As Albus was worrying about Matt, he drifted off to sleep. Just after he drifted off, the Shrieking Shack shrieked for the first time in decades.
Harry was in the Great Hall. Ropes bound him to the Headmasterâs chair. His scar was searing in pain. Blood was pouring down his arms as he struggled against the restraints. He opened his eyes and glanced around, looking for his wand. There it was, lying uselessly halfway across the room. All around him, other people were bound to the other professorâs chairs, they were surrounding Harry in a circle. A cloaked figure was circling around the outside of the circle, while other cloaked figures stood stationary around the room. Bodies lay in pools of blood on the floor.
Harry glanced around at the other people bound to the chairs. The person directly across from him had long red hair. Harry screamed. âNO!!!! Ginny!â He looked at the other people. âJames! Albus! Lily! Take me instead, not the kids!â
The hooded figure looked up and entered the circle. He stood directly in front of Harry. âWell, well, someoneâs decided to regain his consciousness. As you see, the rest of them didnât fair too well without you. Most are dead. But Iâve saved your dear family for last. I will torture them and kill them. And then, I shall kill you. At last, Iâve waited so long. You should have known you couldnât kill me.â Voldemort rounded on the smallest child tied to a chair.
âCrucio!â he shouted.
âNO!!!! Do it to me instead! Lily!â Harry screamed. His scar started to hurt even worse, it burned so bad he couldnât keep his eyes open anymore.
Harry awoke with a start. He was covered in sweat and his heart was beating fast. His hand automatically went to his scar, but he was not in any pain. He shakily got out of bed and went to the window.
âWill it never end?â he thought. The nightmare kept returning, but why? It was always the same one. It had been going on ever since the last battle. Only before he had kids, the people surrounding him were Ginny, Ron, Hermione, Neville, and Luna. As soon as James was born, Ron, Hermione, Neville, and Luna disappeared. Once Albus was born, he appeared too. Same with Lily.
Harry had no idea what the dreams meant, and neither did anyone else. Harry could think of only one person who may have been able to explain it, Dumbledore. However, as soon as Harry had a few of these dreams, he had gone to see the portrait in Dumbledoreâs office. He was only 18 then. Unfortunately, Dumbledore had no useful explanation. Since Harry was no longer a Horcrux, he couldnât possibly be seeing into Voldemortâs thoughts. Especially since Voldemort was dead. But the dreams continued.
Tonightâs dream had been more vivid than any of the past ones. Maybe it was because Harry had spent all day reliving the horrific scenes from his childhood to various DADA classes. He wished he hadnât done that now. Oh, how he regretted it. But heâd have to put up with it the rest of the week, seeing as it wouldnât be fair not to tell the other students.
Harry walked away from the window. He slowly walked into the corridor. His whole body was clammy. He needed a sleeping draught. Heâd been relying on these more and more as time went on. âI really should learn how to brew them myself,â he laughed to himself.
Walking through the corridors at night brought back many memories. He still felt like he was disobeying the rules, even though he was now a professor. It seemed like Snape was right around the corner waiting to catch him doing something wrong. Harry climbed the stairs to the hospital wing. He hated to wake Madam Pomfrey at this hour, however he knew heâd never get to sleep without it. Maybe she would give him a large supply to keep in his office.
Harry walked into the ward, only to see that Madam Pomfrey was already up. She was tending to a girl in one of the end beds.
âHello, Poppy,â he whispered.
âOh!â Madam Pomfrey jumped, âYou frightened me. I wasnât expecting you at this hour, Harry. You know, itâs almost like youâre a student again, coming in so late.â
âYeah, I was thinking the same thing,â Harry glanced down at the girl, âIs she okay?â
âYes, sheâll be fine. Someone levitated her in her sleep. She screamed and that scared the student who did it to her, that student gave the countercurse, and she promptly fell onto the floor and broke her arm.â
âWow, doesnât take very long for things to get interesting around here,â Harry said.
âNow, why are you here, Harry?â
âWell, er, remember after the battle and I had all those nightmares? They never completely stopped, and now they seem to be getting worse. I was wondering if I could have a sleeping draught. Iâd also like to just have a supply of it on hand. Iâve never been much of a potion brewer and havenât attempted to make it myself. I just can never manage to get to sleep without one after one of these nightmares,â Harry explained sheepishly. He felt like he was a kid again. How could he, the wizard who defeated Voldemort, who was known as the bravest wizard of the times, be afraid of a nightmare?
A sad gaze fell over Madam Pomfrey. âYou know, this kind of reminds me of how you were so susceptible to the dementors in your third year. I know most people think youâre brave and nothing frightens you, but everyone has nightmares and being frightened is nothing to be ashamed of.â She walked over to a cabinet and came back with a large bottle filled with potion. âHere you go. Just come back to me whenever you need more.â She handed him the bottle.
âThanks,â Harry replied, as he walked out of the Hospital Wing.
As he walked back towards his office, Harry thought about what Madam Pomfrey had said. He knew she was right, but he still couldnât help but feel weak whenever he had one of these nightmares. He just wished he knew why he was having them and what he could do to stop them.
******
When Albus awoke the next morning, Matt still hadnât returned from the Hospital Wing. John suggested that they go visit Matt before class, but since the two boys had gotten up late, they only had time to grab a quick bite to eat before heading to Potions in the dungeons.
âGood morning, class!â an old, round, professor greeted them, âIâm Professor Slughorn, your Potions Master. Today, we shall be learning about the basics of potion brewing, including the importance of proper stirring, heat, and ingredients. Please open your books to page 6.â
The class opened their books and spent the whole lesson listening to Slughorn and copying down notes.
âWell, weâre pretty much out of time, so Iâll see you all next lesson. Could I have Albus Potter and Rose Weasley please stop by my desk on their way out?â Slughorn told the class.
âIâll see you in Transfiguration, John. Tell Professor Patil where I am,â Albus told his friend. He had a feeling he knew what Slughorn wanted. James had warned him about it.
Albus and Rose walked cautiously up to Slughornâs desk after everyone else had left.
âAh! Young Mr. Potter and Miss Weasley. Now, I would like to tell you about a little gathering I have scheduled for Friday. Itâs for the students in the school whose parents are, for lack of a better term, popular. Or those who have shown exceptional magical skill. Of course, Iâd be pleased if the both of you would attend. Iâm sure your cousins will be attending. They seemed to like them in the past years,â Slughorn informed them.
âWell, er, I guess we could make it,â Albus told Slughorn, while looking at Rose.
âYes, weâll be there. See you next lesson, Professor,â Rose told him, as the two of them left the dungeon.
âI knew it was only a matter of time before we were invited to the Slug Club,â Albus groaned. James loved the Slug Club. It gave him a whole lot more attention and more people for him to tell his stories too. But Albus didnât like the fame. He would have rather skipped the party, but as James and his cousins were going, it would be hard not to.
âWell, maybe itâll be fun,â Rose stated in a hopeful tone. Albus rolled his eyes and the two of them went to Transfiguration.
***********
Matt didnât show up in classes all day. Albus and John were really starting to worry. They decided to visit him before dinner. When they got into the Hospital Wing, they didnât see Matt right away. There was one girl occupying a bed with her arm in a sling. Madam Pomfrey was fussing over her.
âI really think you need to stay here tonight. You can leave in the morning!â
âBut, Madam Pomfrey, Iâve been here all day. My armâs fine!â the girl exclaimed.
âNo, I will not have it! You can leave in the morning,â Madam Pomfrey said in a tone that was not to be argued with. The girl pouted and stopped talking.
Albus and John approached Madam Pomfrey. âUm, whereâs Matt Eckerton? We brought him here last night,â John said tentatively.
âHeâs back there,â she said, pointing to a bed with the curtains pulled around it.
âWell, can we see him?â Albus asked.
âNo, Iâm sorry, but you canât. Heâs not in any state to have visitors at the moment. You can come see him this time tomorrow,â Madam Pomfrey said hurriedly.
âBut could you at least tell us if heâs ok?â Albus asked.
âHeâll be fine in a few days. Now, you two should head down to dinner. You can see Matt tomorrow.â
Albus and John walked glumly down to the Great Hall. âThat was strange. James said you can usually visit your friends when theyâre in the Hospital Wing,â Albus told John.
âVery weird. You know, I think Mattâs keeping something from us. Madam Pomfrey seemed like she was expecting him last night, and now no one can visit him,â John told Albus in a worried tone.
âWeâll ask him about it when he gets out of the Hospital Wing. I donât think heâll be inclined to tell us tomorrow,â Albus reasoned.
*********
The next day, Gryffindor first years had DADA again. Nothing extraordinarily exciting happened during class. They mostly took notes on using Expeliarmus, the disarming spell. Harry said they would start being able to practice it on each other in the next class. John and Albus were really looking forward to this, as they really hadnât used their wands for anything yet.
Charms, however, was quite eventful. Professor Washburn started class by taking attendance as usual. He gave a menacing glare to all the Gryffindors as he called their names. But Albus thought he stared especially long at him.
âTake out your wands,â snarled Wahsburn, âweâre practicing levitation today. Everyone take a feather.â Washburn waved his wand and a feather appeared in front of each student. âRemember to swish and flick.â
âSwish and flick,â murmured Albus from the back table. He waved his wand and said, âWingardium Leviosa!â Nothing happened. He tried over and over again. Still, nothing happened. John, however, managed to do it.
âLook, Albus!â John exclaimed, âIâve done it!â Johnâs feather had rose a few inches off the table, and fell down again.
âCongratulations,â Albus said flatly, his feather still remaining quite still on the table.
âIâve done it, too!â Rose shouted. Her feather had also rose off the table, but it managed to make it a few feet in the air before falling.
Washburn stormed out from behind his desk and rounded on the back table, where Albus, John, Rose, and Amanda were sitting. âWell, do it again!â he growled.
John and Rose looked at him nervously and picked up their wands. âWingardium Leviosa!â they said at the same time. Both their feathers rose feebly into the air and fell down again.
âPathetic,â Washburn muttered, âPotter! You do it!â he shouted at Albus.
âBut, Professor, I havenât managed it yet,â Albus muttered quietly.
âYouâll do what I tell you to do! Perform the spell!â Washburn seemed to be getting angrier by the minute.
Albus nervously picked up his wand. His arm was shaking, this would not turn out good. âWingardium Leviosa,â he muttered very quietly. His feather leaped into the air and caught fire. The whole class, which had been staring at the back table for quite some time, screamed.
The flame from the feather caught onto Washburnâs robes and set them on fire as well. âBloody Hell!â Washburn screamed. He grabbed Albusâs wand out of his hand and produced water from it to douse the flames. âPotter! Youâll getting detention and 20 points from Gryffindor!â he shouted, glaring at Albus. âClass dismissed. Get out, all of you except Potter.â
Albus was visibly shaking now. The rest of the class quickly left, the Gryffindors glancing anxiously at Albus. He walked slowly up to Washburnâs desk.
âWell, you seem to have a knack for causing trouble, Potter,â Wahsburn spat.
âIâm sorry, Professor, I didnât mean to,â Albus muttered, on the verge of tears.
âYouâll be doing detention tonight, I donât care what other plans you might have. See you at 8pm.â
âBut-â
Washburn cut him off. âI said tonight, now get out!â he screamed.
********
Later that night, Albus trudged his way back to the common room after doing detention with Washburn. He had Albus do lines, so it wasnât too bad. But Washburn stared at Albus the whole time, his eyes like fire.
Albus climbed through the portrait and saw just who he needed to talk to. âJames, Iâve got to ask you something.â
âWhat is it?â James asked, walking away from his friends.
âWhy does Washburn hate me?â Albus asked. âDuring the first class, I thought he just hated all Gryffindors, but today he made it clear that itâs me he hates.â
âReally? Itâs well known he hates Gryffindors. But heâs always seemed to hate me more than everyone else,â James explained, âI always assumed itâs because I cause so much trouble. You on the other hand, have always been so quiet. What did you do to him?â
Albus mumbled something incoherent.
âWhat?â
âI set him on fire.â
James burst out laughing.
âItâs not funny! I didnât mean to do it. We were doing levitation, and he asked me to levitate the feather in front of everyone, when he knew I hadnât managed to do it before. My arm was shaking so much I knew the spell wouldnât work. The feather caught fire as soon as I muttered the spell, and then it spread to Washburnâs robes. I got lines and 20 points taken from Gryffindor,â Albus looked down, ashamed.
James looked stunned. âBut thatâs a mistake any first year could have made. I do see how he got mad, though. I think you should just try to avoid him. Sit in the back, donât say anything. Ignore him in the halls. Thatâs what I do. I still get way more detentions from him than any other teacher, but I think Iâve become immune to them. Well, Iâd better get back to my friends. See you later.â
Albus contemplated this information. Washburn hated all Gryffindors, but he hated James and Albus the most. Why? It didnât make sense. Neither Albus nor James had met Washburn before Hogwarts.
âAlbus!â John came running into the common room, âIâve just been with Matt.â
âHow is he?â Albus asked.
âNot good. Heâs covered in cuts and bruises. Said heâd tripped on his way to the bathroom. He kept avoiding talking about being ill. Just wanted to talk about whatâs going on in the school. So I told him about you setting Washburn on fire. He thought it was hilarious.â
âItâs NOT!â Albus shouted. He was sick of everyone thinking it was funny. The story had already made it around the school and at dinner everyone was staring at him more than usual. Some students even high fived him and patted him on the back. It seemed like Washburn was disliked by many students.
âOkay, okay,â John said, putting his hands up, âAnyway, Matt said heâd be back in class tomorrow morning. Madam Pomfrey just wanted him to stay the rest of the night.â
âGood. Letâs go to bed. Iâm exhausted,â Albus said. He and John climbed up the circular staircase to the dormitory.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Hereâs the next chapter! I combined two short chapters into one, so this oneâs a good bit longer than the previous ones.
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Friday came too quickly for Albusâs liking. He was not looking forward to the Slug Club meeting. Since the meeting and Gryffindor Quidditch try-outs were at the same time, James wouldnât be joining Albus at the meeting. Albus had tried to get out of the meeting by watching try-outs, but the team captain decided to not let any spectators at the try-outs. A large number of students had wanted to attend just to see James, and the captain didnât want anyone to disrupt the try-outs.
Later that day, Albus and Rose walked down to the dungeons together. Albus was dreading the meeting. They walked into the meeting to see that most everyone else was already there. Albus already knew most of them. Some of his cousins were there, along with various other Order membersâ children. However, there were a few faces Albus had never seen before.
âAh! Albus and Rose!â Slughorn gestured to a few chairs in the room, âPlease have a seat. You already know many of the people here. But I donât believe you know Tami Tobias, Frank Belleville, and Quinton Willinson?â he said, gesturing to a blond haired girl, a black haired boy, and a very sullen looking boy. âTami is a 6th year Ravenclaw who brews the most excellent potions, Frank is a 4th year Hufflepuff who can already perform nonverbal spells! And Quintonâs a 7th year Slytherin whose father works at the Minsitry.â
âEr, hi,â Albus responded.
âHello,â Rose smiled.
Unfortunately for Albus; Tami and Frank, along with Slughorn, spent much of the meeting hounding Albus with questions about his dad, the battle, and Albusâs childhood. Eventually, Albus just got fed up with it.
âLook, my dadâs told you all he wants to tell you. Youâre not going to learn anything else from asking me!â Albus shouted.
Slughorn looked taken aback. âI thought youâd enjoyed talking about it. Your brother always enjoys telling stories about his childhood.â
âWell, Iâm not James, now, am I?â Albus shouted. Everyone else was now staring at him. Albus jumped up from his chair and stormed out the door, slamming it behind him.
Albus stamped his feet the whole way up to the common room. He went through the portrait and was immediately bombarded by James.
âAlbus! I got it! Iâm the new Seeker!â James shouted over the noise, jumping up and down and spilling his butterbeer all over the floor.
âThatâs great, James, really great,â Albus told him, trying to sound somewhat excited.
âWhat? Youâre not happy for me? I thought you would be. Dadâs ecstatic. I told him as soon as I was done at tryouts,â James said tentatively.
âNo, I am excited,â Albus responded glumly. All he wanted to do was go to bed, but James blocked his path.
âWhatâs wrong? I can tell somethingâs wrong. Tell me,â James said, in a voice that sounded strangely like their motherâs.
âItâs the Slug Club. I just left. All anyone wanted to do was listen to me blabber on about my childhood,â Albus shouted, all the anger coming back in full force. âThey wouldnât stop bothering me until I screamed at them and stormed out.â
James just stared at Albus. âAnd to top it all off, Slughorn said he thought Iâd LIKE talking about all that, just because you do!â Albus screamed at James and punched the nearest armchair.
âBoy, you do have Dadâs temper,â James told Albus, âIâm sorry I couldnât be there. Iâll be there at all the others. I swear. Well, unless thereâs Quidditch practice.â
âOthers?! You really think Iâm going to another one of those?â Albus shouted disgustedly.
âWell, Slughorn has them all throughout the year. Sometimes theyâre kind of fun. You know Dad used to go to them.â
âFun?! Fun?! How could that possibly be fun? And I know Dad used to go to them, he didnât exactly enjoy them, now did he?â Albus seethed.
âYeah, some of them are fun,â James shifted from foot to foot. Albus could tell he was nervous.
âJust go back to your party. You deserve it. Good job at making Seeker, I really do mean that. But I think Iâm going to bed. Good night.â
ââNight,â James said as he rejoined his party.
Albus walked up to his dormitory. It was still relatively early, so Albus was surprised to see Matt there. Matt had returned at breakfast yesterday morning, but he still didnât seem himself, so John and Albus did not bring up the question of him being ill.
Albus went over to Mattâs bed and pulled back the curtains. He was sound asleep. That was strange. He just spent 2 days in the Hospital Wing, why was he still tired? Was he still sick? Albus sighed, he wouldnât be able to question Matt tonight. Well, turning in early would do Albus some good too. Maybe heâd be able to calm down after the eveningâs excitement. He got into his pajamas and got into bed.
********
Unfortunately, Albus did not have a restful sleep. He was having vivid nightmares which involved Slughorn questioning him while James stood behind him, laughing. This same image kept recurring over and over again. Albus tossed and turned and eventually, a new dream came over him.
Albus was sitting in a dark empty room. A man in a dark cloak appeared next to him.
âHe will return,â the man said.
âWhat?â Albus asked. âWhoâs returning?â
âHeâs coming. Heâll find a way. He will return.â
âTell me! Who?â Albus shouted.
âHe will return, he will return, he will returnâŠ.â the man said over and over again.
Albus awoke with a start. He was sweating. What was that about? He had never had such a vivid dream. Who was going to return? Albus raked his brains, and then it hit him. It felt like heâd been punched in the stomach. Of course! He jumped out of bed and put on his dressing robes. It must be late, he thought. Matt, John, Ethan, and Bilius were still sleeping. Albus tip-toed out of dormitory and carefully shut the door behind him.
Albus had to see his dad. He didnât care that it was the middle of the night. He ran out of the common room and into the empty corridor. It was strange wandering around this late. Albus had never walked around the castle at night. He didnât care that he wasnât supposed to be out of his dormitory this late. All he thought about was telling his dad about that dream. Albus ran down the stairs, probably making too much noise. As he rounded the corner, someone reached out and grabbed his shoulder. Albus screamed.
âShut up!â a man shouted, âYouâll wake the whole school. Then weâll have a real problem.â
Albus looked into the eyes of the man who had caught him. It was Professor Washburn.
âWell, well, Mr. Potter is out of bed. And this late at night? Surely, he must be up to no good,â Washburn sneered. Albus heard the happiness in his tone. âWeâd better be off to my office, shall we?â
Albus stood where he was. âNo, I have to see my dad.â
âRunning to Daddy, are we? Isnât that sweet. Unfortunately for you, wandering corridors at night is against the rules, therefore, I will punish you.â
Washburn grabbed Albusâs hand and dragged him to his office. Albus was really shaking now. What would Washburn do to him?
When they entered Washburnâs dark office, he forced Albus into a chair directly in front of his desk.
Washburn slammed his hands on his desk. âSo, decided to have a little midnight stroll? Care to tell me what you were up to?â he glared at Albus, not blinking.
âIâve already told you. I need to see my dad,â Albus told him, nervously.
âSurely that could wait till morning? I bet you were setting up some kind of prank. Am I right? You know, Iâve caught your brother out of bed many a time for just that reason.â
So that was it. Washburn hated James, so he in turn hated Albus too. That was the second time in the past 12 hours that Albus had been compared to James. âI am NOT like my brother!â he stood up, fists clenched and stared at Washburn.
Washburn smiled. âI seem to have struck a nerve. But it hardly matters what you were doing out of bed. The fact remains that students are not to be out of bed at,â he glanced at his watch, â1:37 in the morning. Now, to discuss your punishment.â
âYou can discuss my punishment after I see my dad,â Albus glared at Washburn.
âSit back down, Potter. I know youâre just trying to get dear old Dad to save you.â
Albus remained standing. âI AM NOT!â he screamed, âI have something really important to discuss with him!â
âFine, but Iâll take you to see him, so I can make sure youâre punished,â Washburn spat.
Albus didnât say another word and ran out the door.
âWait! Get back here, boy! I told you Iâm taking you!â Washburn ran to catch up with Albus, breathing heavily. He was clearly out of shape. The two of them walked to Harryâs office in complete silence.
âWell, here we are,â Washburn stated, pushing Albus aside and opening the door. âPotter! Wake up! I caught your son out of bed.â
Harry quickly walked out of his bedroom. He had also been up after having a nightmare of his own. Harry looked at Albus and Washburn and jumped. âSorry, I expected it to be James.â
âSo did I. He insists that he discuss something with you before I punish him,â Washburn told Harry in a disgruntled voice.
Harry looked worriedly at Albus. âWhat is it? Are you okay, Al?â
âI just need to tell you somethingâŠâ Albus replied, looking warily at Washburn.
âI must ask you to leave, Professor Washburn. I think this needs to be private.â
âFine! Iâll wait outside the door, but he will be punished!â Washburn yelled as he walked out the door and slammed it behind him.
As soon as he left, Albus relayed his whole dream to Harry.
Harry pulled Albus into a hug and told him, âAlbus, I donât think your nightmare had any kind of significance. It was just a bad dream.â
âBut, it seemed so real! And you had dreams like this when you were younger, and they were real!â
âYes, thatâs because I could see Voldemortâs thoughts. You know that. I think that hearing so much about the battle over and over again this week and being bombarded with questions about it has caused you to be worried,â Harry explained. âI understand your fears. I still have nightmares about it. But I think the best thing for you to do is just forget about it.â
âBut, what if it is real?â Albus asked in a worried tone.
âThink about it, Al. How could he come back? Heâs dead. Even in the Wizarding world, no one can come back from the dead.â
âYeah, I suppose youâre right. It was just so vivid and scary.â
âI know. Now I only hope that as you spend more time at Hogwarts, people will stop asking you so many questions. For tonight, I think you should have some Sleeping Draught,â Harry walked over to his cabinet and poured a potion into a small bottle. Iâll take you back to Gryffindor Tower, and drink this before you get into bed.â
âBut what about detention?â
âDonât worry. You wonât get detention. But wandering the corridors is against the rules, so please donât do it anymore. Just send word with a portrait from the common room if you need me, and Iâll meet you in the common room. Now, letâs get you back to bed. Just follow me and donât say anything. Iâll deal with Washburn.â
Harry opened the door and left the room. Albus followed. âThere will be no detention tonight, Professor Washburn. Albus really did need to tell me something that was worrying him. Itâs perfectly understandable what he did. Iâve talked to him and he wonât do it again,â Harry explained calmly.
âBut, he broke the rules!â Washburn screamed.
âCareful, youâll wake the whole castle,â Harry told him as he continued to walk down the halls with Albus following quickly behind.
They left Washburn standing with his mouth open in the hallway. When Albus got back to his bed, he took his potion and had a dreamless, restful sleep.
******
As the weeks past, people slowly got over the excitement of having Harry as a DADA teacher. Harry had explained the battle to every single one of his classes, and in the following classes he was able to teach without being disrupted with questions pertaining to the downfall of Voldemort. Harry was grateful for this. He was still having his nightmare more often than usual, but thanks to Madam Pomfreyâs potion, he was able to get a few decent nightâs sleep a week.
Things seemed to be calming down for Albus too. There had not been anymore Slug Club meetings since the disastrous first one, but Albus had no intention of going to one even if he got invited. His classes were going well. He seemed to struggle the most in Charms, but that was to be expected. At least Albus now knew why Washburn hated him so much, it was because he hated James. As much as Albus hated being compared to James, it was nice to know it wasnât anything Albus did to irritate Washburn. Unfortunately, Albus was earning a detention a week in his class.
Matt seemed to recover from his illness within a few days. However, as September grew into October, and the weather started getting colder, Matt got sick again.
Albus, John, Matt, Bilius, Ethan, Rose, Janie, Amanda, Karina, and Marina sat together at one table in the common room after dinner one Wednesday. They were working on a particularly hard Transfiguration essay.
âNo, youâve got that wrong,â Rose told Albus.
âWell, why donât you tell me what the right answer is, then?â Albus said disgustedly.
âBut then you wonât learn anything!â
âYouâre just like your mother,â Albus told him, shaking his head. âMatt, whatâs wrong?â
Matt had put his head down on his parchment, he had only written the first sentence of his essay.
âHuh?â he said, lifting up his head. He glanced out the window. âIâm not feeling too good. I think I might be sick.â
âAgain? You do look a bit pale,â Amanda told him with a worried look on her face. âYou better go to the Hospital Wing.
âAll right. Iâll see you guys later,â Matt slowly got up from his chair and shuffled out of the common room. âYou guys donât have to come,â he said to Albus and John, who had gotten up.
Albus looked at him warily. âIf youâre sure.â But Matt had already left the common room.
âI hope heâs all right. Thatâs the second time heâs been sick here and itâs only October,â John said.
âYeah, I know. I guess weâll just have to wait and see how long he spends in the Hospital Wing this time,â Albus told him.
âWell, Iâm never going to get this done!â Janie shouted, exhaustedly. âIâm going to bed,â she got up and left, the other 4 girls following her.
âWeâd better turn in, too,â Bilius told the other boys.
âYeah, probably,â Albus agreed. The three boys walked up the circular staircase and got into bed.
*********
Matt didnât get out of the Hospital Wing until Saturday. Although, he spent most of that day sleeping in his four poster bed. His friends werenât all that surprised, since this exact same thing had happened during his previous illness. They gave him his space until classes started again on Monday.
Albus had started to dread Potions class. He was always afraid that Slughorn was going to bring up what happened in the previous Slug Club meeting. Unfortunately for Albus, after double potions that week, Slughorn called Rose and him up to his desk after class.
âSee you in Transfiguration, then, Albus,â John told him as he and Matt started to walk out of the room.
âNo, stay, please,â Albus hissed at them, âHe wonât talk about what happened last time if youâre here.â
âAll right,â John sighed and dropped his bag on the nearest desk.
âRose and Albus! I just wanted to invite you to my next get together. Itâs happening on Halloween. Itâll be a kind of Halloween party. You can each bring a guest,â Slughorn said, delightedly.
âCool!â John shouted, running to the front of the room, âBring me, Albus!â
âNo, bring me!â Matt said louder, pushing past John.
âDonât worry, boys, you can both come, all right?â Slughorn told them with a smile on his face.
âBut, but-â Albus stammered, staring at John and Matt.
âWell, off you go, donât want to be late for your next class!â Slughorn shooed them out of his classroom.
âJohn! Matt! Why did you do that?â Albus shouted, once Slughorn was back in his room.
âWhat? I wanted to see what all the fuss is about with those meetings,â John said innocently.
âUgh! Now I have to go!â Albus threw his hands up in the air, âYou knew I didnât want to go to anymore.â
âWell, weâll be with you, itâll be all right,â Matt said sympathetically.
*********
Before Albus knew it, he, Matt, and John were trudging down to the dungeons for the Halloween party. John and Matt were running along excitedly, while Albus lagged behind. They walked into the dungeon, to find it packed.
âGood, maybe no one will notice me,â Albus said as he gazed around at the crowd. The same members who were at the last meeting were there, along with their guests and numerous adults. âLetâs go get some food.â
The three boys walked through the crowd and over to the food table. They each piled a plate high with food. When Albus turned around, he almost ran into someone.
âWatch it!â the boy shouted, he was a rather large Slytherin. The boy looked at Albus and then sneered. âAh, Potter, can I ask you a few questions about your childhood? Or will that make baby Potter cry?â
âShut it,â Albus muttered, trying to push past the boy.
âTrying to run away, are we? Well, that wonât do. I thought youâd enjoy talking about yourself. I certainly enjoy talking about me. So, Iâll talk. Iâm Quinton Willinson.â Albus glanced at him again and now recognized him as the Slytherin that Slughorn introduced him to at the previous meeting.
John snorted into his pumpkin juice.
âYou think thatâs funny? Who are you?â Quinton glared at John.
âJohn Brickston. Pleased to meet you. This is Matt Eckerton,â he gestured towards Matt.
âEnough about you, more about me. My father high up at the Ministry. He does a variety of tasks and makes a load of gold from it. Iâm a 7th year. Fatherâs getting me a Ministry job once Iâm done here. I canât wait until I get out of here and make gold like he does,â Quinton stole a cookie off of Albusâs plate and started to eat it.
âSo,â he said in between bites, âWhat was it like growing up with âThe Chosen Oneâ?
âI said, shut it!â Albus said, a bit louder.
âOh, are we going to have a repeat of last meeting?â Quinton asked excitedly, stealing another cookie.
âDefinitely not,â shouted John, who drew his wand, âAfter this one, youâll wish youâd never been born.â Matt quickly drew his own wand.
âNo, guys, itâs okay, donât get in trouble for him, heâs not worth it,â Albus told them.
âGonna curse me, ickle firsties?â Quinton giggled, âIâm so scared.â
âWhatâs going on over here?â James asked as he walked over to the food table, âWhat do you want, Willinson?â
âJust thought Iâd ask Albus about his life growing up,â Quinton told James innocently.
âWell, I think he said to stop, didnât he?â James said, drawing his own wand.
âHe mightâve mentioned it,â Quinton sneered as he, too, drew his wand, âBut I donât see whatâs so wrong about wanting to know about âThe Chosen Oneâ. Maybe you could tell me how he managed to defeat the greatest wizard of all time?â
âExpeliarmus!â James shouted, and Quintonâs wand flew across the room.
Slughorn looked up at the shouting and hustled over to see what had happened. âYou cannot duel at my party!â
âThey started it,â Quinton said, pointing to Albus and his friends, âLittle Potter had to have his big brother defend him.â
âWell, youâll all put your wands away now so we can enjoy the rest of the party in peace. Or youâll all get detention,â Slughorn growled as the boys all hastily put their wands away.
Quinton gave Albus one last sneer and he stalked off. Albus watched him go and turned and ran out of the room. He heard his friends following him, but didnât stop to talk. He didnât stop or turn around until he reached the Fat Ladyâs portrait. He gave the password and ran into the common room and up to his dormitory.
Albus knew going to that party was a bad idea. He shouldnât have gone. Never again. He punched his pillow. What did Quinton want with him anyway. And why did he call Voldemort âthe greatest wizard of all timeâ? Voldemort was defeated before Quinton was even born, he couldnât possibly have been a Death Eater.
The door to the dormitory opened and Matt and John walked in. âYou okay?â Matt asked.
âOh, Iâm just fine,â Albus told them sarcastically, âIâm never going to one of those again, even if you two want to go as my guests. You saw what itâs like now, not much fun, is it?â
âYeah, not that much fun, although wasnât that cool how James disarmed Willinson?â John said excitedly. âI mean, heâs 5 years younger than him!â
âReal cool,â Albus said flatly, âI think I just want to go to bed.â Albus pulled the hangings of his bed closed and laid down. He fell asleep relatively quickly, but it wasnât a restful sleep. He had the nightmare again. It happened a few times a week now, and try as he might, Albus couldnât seem to forget about it.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Sorry for the wait! I had to rewrite something and combine chapters because I thought this one was too short.
As usual, I do not own Harry Potter.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
As the first few days of November passed, the weather became gradually colder. The wind was blowing fiercely, and soon snow would be falling. The first year Gryffindors were not at all surprised when Matt got sick again and spent a few days in the hospital wing.
âHey, Matt! How are you feeling?â Albus asked at dinner when Matt reappeared from the hospital wing.
âAll right,â Matt told him while putting food onto his plate.
âYou know, you get sick a lot, Matt. Are you sure youâre okay?â John chimed in.
âYeah, I know. Iâve got this, er, illness. And it makes me get sick quite a bit. I didnât want to worry you, so thatâs why I never told you,â Matt replied quickly.
âBut youâre better now, right?â Albus asked, nervously.
âUm, sort of. I mean, Iâm better now, but itâll happen again,â Matt told them and quickly changed the subject, âSo, first Quidditch match in 2 weeks! Gyrffindor vs. Hufflepuff. Should be a good game!â
âUh, yeah, it should be,â Albus looked warily at Matt. Clearly he didnât like talking about his illness. Albus and John didnât bring it up again during the meal. Albus, John, and Matt spent the rest of dinner talking about the upcoming match.
The next two weeks dragged by. As the time before the Quidditch match drew shorter, the anticipation and excitement increased. Both captains were holding practices more often than usual. They alternated evenings for the pitch, so each team was practicing every other night. The Gryffindor players trudged back into the common room well after ten oâclock at night on the days of their practices. They were usually muddy and cold, as the weather was not cooperating. Even the professors were getting into the spirit and were not assigning much homework to the players, however they still piled it on the other students.
Excitement was extremely high in the Gryffindor common room the night before the first Quidditch match. No one was getting much homework done. The only ones trying were a few 7th years and Rose, who was reading a book with her fingers in her ears.
âOi! Rose!â Albus called across the common room as he walked over to her, âYou actually trying to get homework done? Why donât you take a break? Youâve been studying all day.â
âYes, I know I have,â Rose said irritably, âWeâve got a big History of Magic exam this week, you know. And we havenât even won the match, so why celebrate yet?â
âYou know, youâre just like your mum,â Albus laughed as he left Rose to her book. He decided heâd find James and wish him good luck.
James was standing in the middle of the common room, surrounded by his fellow teammates. âJames!â Albus shouted, âCould I have a word?â
âSure!â James shouted back, as he left the group, âWhatâs up?â
âJust wanted to wish you luck, wasnât sure if Iâd see you before the match. You know, youâll do fine,â Albus told his brother. âAre you nervous?â
âA bit, yeah,â James responded, âItâs just everyone thinks Iâll be a great Seeker because Dad was, so I donât want to disappoint them.â
âYou wonât. Iâve seen you play. Youâre the best Seeker this house has, thatâs why youâre on the team,â Albus said reassuringly.
âI suppose. I guess Iâd better get back to the team, weâre talking strategy,â James told him.
âOk, see you tomorrow.â
********
Albus was right that he wasnât able to talk to James before the match. Albus saw him briefly at breakfast, he was looking a bit sick and wasnât eating anything. Shortly after Albus arrived at the table, however, the whole team left for the locker rooms. After eating some breakfast, Albus walked down to the pitch with John and Matt. They found themselves seats high in the stands next to Rose, Amanda, Janie, Marina, and Karina.
âIs James nervous?â Rose asked Albus.
âA bit, yeah, heâs afraid everyoneâs going to compare him to Dad, so heâs afraid heâs going to disappoint everybody,â Albus told her.
âWell, he wonât,â Rose said reassuringly.
âI know.â
The weather conditions couldnât have been worse for a game of Quidditch. The wind and rain from the previous week had not let up at all. Albus had a hard time seeing onto the pitch. Visibility was terrible, so the spectators had to mainly rely on the commentary to tell them what was going on.
âWelcome to the first Quidditch match of the season!â a booming voice shouted. Albus recognized it as Todd Smith, one of his cousin Georgiaâs friends. âGryffindor vs. Hufflepuff!
âAnd here come the teams! Gryffindor, Samantha Meyers, Ryan OâMalley, James Potter, Bradley Weasley, Fred Weasley, Georgia Weasley, and Heather Weasley. Blimey, thatâs a lot of Weasleys! Here are the Hufflepuffs! Shawn Ames, Jason Bristol, Lisa Galivant, Jessica Harper, Andy Kaper, and Stacey Manson!
âCaptains Meyers and Harper have shaken hands, and the Quaffle is up!â
14 players and Professor Oteski rose up into the sky on their brooms. Albus could just make out the red robed Gryffindors and the yellow robed Hufflepuffs. Although he had no idea who was who.
âGryffindor is in possession of the Quaffle. Heather Weasley is storming up the pitch, headed for the Hufflepuff goal. Oh! Saved by Keeper Bristol. Hufflepuff now in possession. Nice beater work by Bradley Weasley, too bad Ames swerved just in time to avoid the bludger. And Hufflepuff scores!â
âDarn it!â Albus shouted. John and Matt were hissing at the Hufflepuffs.
âFred Weasley is in possession of the Quaffle, passes to Meyers, who then passes to Heather Weasley and back to Fred. Thatâs the way to do it! Confuse them! Harper sends bludger to Fred, but it is intercepted by OâMalley! Great job! And Gryffindor scores!â
âWoohoo!!!â Albus shouted. Despite the rain, he was loving every minute of the game. Quidditch games always sounded so exciting when his dad told him about them, but Hogwarts games were much better in person. Albus had been to a few professional games, but it somehow seemed better to watch a game that had your own family on the team.
The game continued on for what seemed like hours. The rain and wind had long since made Albusâs hands numb. But he didnât care.
âBlimey, do you think this could go on all day?â John asked as Hufflepuff scored.
âI sure hope so!â Matt shouted over the wind, âIâve been putting off an essay for Potions and have no urge to start it anytime soon.â
âMatt! You should have done that essay days ago,â Rose scolded, âI hope it ends soon, I still have some more studying to do do for History of Magic.â
âAnd Heather Weasley scores for Gryffindor!â Smith shouted, âThe score is currently 100-90 Gryffindor. With no sign of the Snitch! Both Seekers are flying slowly around the pitch, eyes peeled for that golden ball. Of course, the big excitement this game is James Potter, the new Gryffindor Seeker. His dad, Harry Potter, was one of the best Seekers Gryffindor house has ever seen. But will James live up to his dadâs legacy? Only time will tell. Captain Meyers has been quite secretive about their practices and would not let anyone watch James fly until this match.â
âDoes Quidditch always last this long?â Amanda asked Albus.
âNot usually, but they do vary quite a bit. One world cup lasted over a month. All depends on the Seekers and the weather, usually. Weather like this, who knows when the Snitch will be seen,â Albus explained.
âWell, I think I like watching Quidditch. Course, I could never play. You saw me on my broom in flying lessons. The thing wouldnât get up in the air,â Amanda laughed.
The first years had had a few flying lessons over the past few weeks. Amanda wasnât the worst in the class, but wasnât having much luck with her broom. Albus was pretty good. Not as good as James, but he thought he might be able to try out for Chaser next year when Samantha Meyers left.
âGryffindor scores again! Blimey, if the match goes on much longer, weâll be in for a Hogwarts record! Itâs past lunch time, the match has been going on for 4 hours in case anyone had been wondering. Oh, look at this! I think Galivant has seen the Snitch!â Smith shouted.
Indeed, she had. Lisa Galivant was flying directly towards the ground, where the little golden winged ball was hovering. James was flying a few feet above her and noticed her dive. He quickly pulled his broom into a dive as well.
âAnd both Seekers are neck in neck, heading towards the ground, where the golden Snitch has been spotted! Potter is now pulling ahead a little. Kaper is headed towards a bludger that is right above both Seekers. And Kaper hits the bludger towards Potter, who hasnât noticed it!â
Whack! The bludger collided with Jamesâs skull, just as he reached for the Snitch. He fell, headfirst off his broom from a height of 10 feet, and landed on the ground, not moving.
âJames!!!â Albus shouted, as he tried to move past all the students who were standing up in their seats looking at the pitch.
âPotter is knocked off his broom by a bludger sent by Andy Kaper. Surely, Galivant has caught the Snitch. But wait, sheâs landing empty-handed. Where is the Snitch?â
Albus had managed to extricate himself from the stands, running onto the pitch, followed by John, Matt, Amanda, and Rose.
âJames!â Albus shouted again, as he ran towards the crowd of teachers surrounding his brother. He pushed his way in between Profesor Patil and Professor Longbottom and saw his dad leaning down at Jamesâs side. He had an extremely worried look on his face.
âIâm taking him to the Hospital Wing,â Harry told the teachers as he picked James up. Harry started walking towards the castle. Albus ran after him, followed by his friends.
They burst through the wooden doors and ran up the stairs to the Hospital Wing. When they got inside, Harry deposited James onto a bed. Madam Pomfrey was striding towards them.
âWell, whatâs happened? Quidditch, right?â she clicked her tongue, âSuch a dangerous sport. I donât know why they still allow it.â She bustled over to James and examined him. âCracked skull. Iâll have it mended in no time, but heâs unconscious, so it might be a while before he comes round.â
The doors of the Hospital Wing burst open and a few teachers made their way into the room and stood by Harry.
Madam Pomfrey ran over to a cabinet and grabbed some potion to put on Jamesâs head. She went back over to James and started applying potion. Once she was done, she tapped her wand to his head and muttered a spell. She applied bandages and turned to his hand, which was clamped shut around something.
âLooks like he managed to catch the Snitch,â Madam Pomfrey announced as she pried the still struggling golden ball from his hand.
âWow,â Harry smiled, âThatâs impressive.â He took the Snitch from Madam Pomfrey and pocketed it. Harry sat down on a chair next to Jamesâs bed and started stroking his hair.
âHeâs going to be an incredible Seeker,â Neville commented.
Albus walked over to the bed and sat down next to Harry. âIs he going to be all right?â Albus whispered.
âI think heâll be fine, Al,â Harry reassured Albus, âAlthough I canât tell you it didnât scare me half to death when I saw him fall from his broom. I never really thought much about the dangers of Quidditch when I was playing it, but now that my own son is getting hurtâŠ.â
Albus stared at his father. âYouâre not going to make him stop playing, are you?â
Harry laughed, ââCourse not! Iâd be the hypocrite of the century. I just worry about him. Iâm sure heâll be fine, though. This certainly wonât be his last Quidditch injury. I had my fair share. Iâm just in for a worrisome next 6 years.â
âMore than that, Dad,â Albus laughed, âIâm going to try out for Chaser next year.â
âAnd Iâm sure youâll be great at it, Al. Iâll worry about you too. Although, Seekers tend to get injured the most out of all the players,â Harry got up from his chair, âWell, Iâve got to send an owl to your mother. She insisted I tell her how the game went, although she wonât be too happy once Iâve told her. Why donât you and your friends go down and have some dinner? Itâs been a long day,â Harry kissed James on the forehead and left the Hospital Wing.
James didnât regain consciousness until 3 days after the match. Two days after that, Madam Pomfrey allowed him to leave the Hospital Wing. He was thrilled that he had managed to catch the Snitch and win Gryffindor the match, and was eager to tell the story over and over again to anyone who listened. Once James was out of the Hospital Wing, the Gryffindors had a loud and rowdy party until the wee hours of the morning to celebrate the win.
******
The next few weeks flew by for Albus and his friends. Their work load was steadily increasing as fall term drew to an end.
âWhy did Patil have to give us an essay due the same day Slughorn did?â John asked disgustedly, one night in the common room.
âThey always do that,â Albus groaned.
âYeah, Iâm never going to get this potions done. Why canât they alternate days for homework giving? Itâs stupid, really. I think they must all compete to see who can give the most homework,â John told Albus as he feverishly finished up his Transfiguration essay.
âEven my dad is giving us a huge load. I thought heâd go easy on us cause he used to tell me how much he hated how much homework he was given.â
âDone!â John exclaimed, as he slammed his Transfiguration book shut. âNow, on to that potions essay.â He dug around in his bag for his potions book. âCould I borrow your notes, Rose?â
âNo, use your own notes,â Rose said coldly. Even she was faltering under the immense work load, and was huddled at a corner table which was buried under all her notes and books, doing her own potions essay.
âUgh! You know I donât take notes!â John groaned.
âWell, why not?â Rose asked.
ââCause itâs boring,â John explained, âCan I borrow yours, Albus?â
âSure, theyâre in my bag,â Albus told John as he frantically finished up a History of Magic homework.
John dug around in Albusâs bag until he found the notes. âThanks, mate! Matt, do you need to use them, too?â John looked over at his friend.
Matt was curled up in an armchair, wincing in pain.
âHey, are you okay?â John asked with a concerned look on his face. He and Albus had been so preoccupied with their large amounts of homework that they hadnât noticed Matt leave the table.
âHuh?â Matt looked up, with his hand pressed to his head. He yawned. âI guess I must be getting sick again. I think Iâll go to the Hospital Wing.â Matt stood up to leave, but he swayed on the spot and had to lean on the armchair for support.
âMatt!â John ran over to his friend and grabbed his arm, âIâll take you, okay? You look like youâre about to fall over.â
âOkay, thanks,â Matt mumbled as the two of them left the common room.
Albus had stopped writing his essay and watched the two of them leave.
âI wish I knew some way to help him,â he murmured to Rose. âHe hasnât even told us what disease heâs got. I wonder if itâs some really rare kind that not many people have heard of.â
Rose looked up. âIsnât it obvious?â
âWhat?â
Rose got up from her table, walked over to Albus, and whispered in his ear. âHavenât you noticed that he always gets sick during the full moon? I realized that after he got sick in November, and Iâve been watching him the past few days.â
Albus just looked at her with a blank look on his face. âSo? And why would I pay attention to full moons?â
âUgh!â Rose groaned, âPut it together. I donât want to say what I think it is right now with so many people around. And you should pay attention to full moons for Astronomy.â
âWell, then letâs wait until they all go to bed. Iâve certainly got enough homework to do between now and then,â Albus said impatiently.
âFine, but it still seems obvious to me.â
The cousins spent the next few hours working on their homework, waiting for the common room to empty out. After a half hour or so, John came back. Albus filled him in on what Rose said, and he had no idea what she could be on about. He got out his potions essay and continued to work on it. Eventually, around midnight, Albus, John, Rose, and Amanda were the only ones left in the common room.
âSo,â Albus whispered, âWhat have you figured out?â
âWell,â Rose said slowly, looking up from her Herbology reading, âThe clues are that Matt always gets ill around the full moon, the few days before it he sleeps a lot and looks paler than usual. He always goes to the Hospital Wing the night of a full moon, and when he comes back, he usually is covered in cuts and bruises.â
âThatâs cause heâs clumsy,â John said confidently.
âThatâs what he wants you to think! Donât you get it?â Rose shouted.
âKeep your voice down, Rose, someoneâll wake up,â Amanda whispered, âNow what do you think Matt has?â
âHeâs a werewolf,â Rose said quietly.
âWhat?!â John shouted, âNo way.â
âWerewolf?! You mean, those are real?â Amanda squeaked.
ââCourse theyâre real, Amanda,â John told her, âSo are vampires. Muggles just donât think they are.â
âThe only thing Iâm still wondering about is why he doesnât take Wolfsbane Potion,â Rose continued, âYou know, that potion Teddyâs dad took to keep him from harming himself and others.â
Albus had started to pace the common room. âYou know, Rose, it fits, it really does. Matt sounds just like Teddyâs dad. But I donât know. Why wouldnât he have taken the potion?
âOf course it fits! Iâve had a hunch about it ever since October, but I wanted to wait a few months to be sure. I donât know why he wouldnât take the potion. But remember one of our first nights here and there was that horrible shrieking?â Rose asked.
âYeah, I heard that,â Amanda told her.
âWell, it must have come from the Shrieking Shack. Thatâs where Teddyâs dad went to transform when he was a student here. You can get in there from the Whomping Willow, but I donât know how that works. Matt must go there to transform as well,â Rose explained.
âI wonder why he wouldnât take the potion?â Albus wondered aloud as he continued to pace. âDad said Teddyâs dad always took it.â
âI dunno, Albus,â Rose said sadly, âBut Iâve heard itâs really painful to transform if that potion isnât used.â
âIt fits, but Iâm still not sure. Are you absolutely sure? I donât know if we should jump to conclusions,â Albus responded.
âIâm pretty sure. I mean, Iâm not positive, because I havenât heard him say it or seen him transform. But Iâve read all about werewolves and Matt fits the description,â Rose persuaded.
âIf itâs true, and Iâm not saying it is or it isnât, what are we going to tell him? I mean, what if it isnât true, and we tell him we think heâs a werewolf? He wouldnât be too happy,â John asked. He was sitting completely still in one of the armchairs, apparently in shock. Amanda was doing the same.
âI donât think we should say anything. Especially since weâre not entirely sure,â Albus stated, while looking warily at Rose. Rose rolled her eyes. âWe wonât tell him we know. He obviously doesnât want us to know. Otherwise, heâd have told us himself, if itâs true. Iâm sure heâll tell us what disease he has when heâs ready.â
âBut what if he doesnât?â Amanda asked, âI donât know anything about werewolves, but he probably doesnât want anyone to know.â
âThatâs probably true. Wizards havenât treated werewolves very well. Teddyâs dad couldnât get a job after he was done at Hogwarts. He did manage to get a job as DADA teacher here, but he quit once people found out he was a werewolf because parents wouldnât want him teaching their kids,â Rose told Amanda, âItâs sad, really. Werewolves are harmless while theyâre not transformed.â
âHeâs probably afraid what we would think,â John said, âIf heâs a werewolf, that is. I say we keep track of when he transforms.â
âGood idea. But if it turns out weâre right and he still doesnât tell us, I guess weâll have to let him know that we know,â Albus said.
âYeah, I suppose we will,â John agreed.
âOh, and mine and Roseâs Uncle Bill was bit by a werewolf, but the werewolf wasnât transformed at the time. Uncle Billâs not a werewolf, but I suppose I could ask him some questions over Christmas Break, to try and get some more information,â Albus told everyone.
âGood idea, Albus! Iâll ask him with you,â Rose exclaimed, while walking over to the dormitory door. âI think we should probably go to bed. Good night, everyone.â
âNight,â Albus, Amanda, and John responded.
Albus walked up the stairs to his dormitory. He could not stop thinking about Matt. How could he be a werewolf? Who bit him? When? Albus knew werewolves were perfectly harmless as long as they werenât transformed, but the idea still troubled him. Teddyâs dad had been his grandfatherâs friend at school, and he had been his dadâs DADA teacher when he was in school. He had died in the fight against Voldemort. If only he could talk to him. Ask him questions about it. Was there anything Albus could do?
Albus got into bed and pondered these questions. Eventually, he fell into a restless sleep. He started out dreaming about failing a Charms test and Professor Washburn chasing him through the castle with a beaterâs bat. But soon, the dream shifted and became the nightmare that had plagued him since the first week of school.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Please review! No reviews from the last chapter, but thanks to my sister, Dancer_of_Starlight for reading this and giving me her opinion.
Disclaimer- Like usual, I donât own Harry Potter or anything else you recognize.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Chapter 7: Dueling and Detention
Harry was sitting in a dark empty room. A man in a dark cloak appeared next to him.
âHe will return,â the man said.
âWho?â Harry asked. âVoldemort? Thatâs not possible, I made sure of that.â
âHeâs coming. Heâll find a way. He will return.â
âNo, he wonât!â Harry shouted.
âHe will return, he will return, he will returnâŠ.â the man said over and over again.
Harry awoke with a start, he sat up in bed, breathing fast. That was odd. Harry had not had a dream that seemed so real since before Voldemort had died. But Harry couldnât possibly be seeing things through Voldemort anymore, not if he was dead.
Harry got up and paced the room. What did the dream mean? Was someone trying to bring Voldemort back to life? And was that even possible? And why would he be dreaming about it? Harry didnât think so. Then it hit him, he remembered that Albus had had the same dream months ago! Did this mean something? Was there something significant about their dreams? Or were they just dreams?
Harry walked over to his wardrobe and got out his cloak. He had to discuss this with someone. As much as he thought that the dreams were just dreams, his gut told him they meant something. Harry remembered that Ron was stationed in Hogsmeade tonight. Ever since Professor Torro was murdered, Harry was having an Auror stationed in Hogsmeade at all times. Something just didnât sit right with him about that murder.
Harry quietly left his office and walked into the corridor. It seemed deserted, which wasnât unusual since it was one oâclock in the morning. Harry started to walk down the corridor. He turned a corner and nearly bumped into someone.
âWhoâs there?â the person shouted and pointed his wand at Harry. âPotter? What are you doing out so late?â
âThe same could be said of you, Washburn,â Harry responded. âPut your wand away.â
Washburn stowed his wand back in his cloak. âWhat are you doing wandering the halls at this hour? I now see where Albus gets his ideas about late night strolls from.â
âItâs none of your business, but I need to discuss something with someone,â Harry growled. âAnd what are you doing? Plotting ways to put my sons in detention? I know youâve got something against them, and I will find out what.â
âIâve nothing against your sons, Potter, they just seem to misbehave more than the average student,â Washburn sneered at Harry.
âJames, yes, Iâll believe that. He seems to take after his Uncle George and his grandfather,â Harry agreed, âBut Albus? He has only ever gotten detention from you, Washburn. All the other professors say heâs quiet in class.â
âMaybe in their classes. Heâs always making trouble in mine. He talks while Iâm talking, irritates the other students, doesnât do his homework, and doesnât listen to me. Not to mention the time he set me on fire!â Washburn shouted.
âKeep your voice down, youâll wake the whole castle,â Harry whispered, âAnd why on earth would Albus only do that stuff in your class, Washburn?â
âHow should I know how a delinquentâs mind works? Maybe you should ask him,â Washburn spat.
âJust remember, Iâm watching you, Washburn. So are the other professors,â Harry told him, âNow if youâll excuse me, I have some business to attend to.â Harry strode past Washburn and ignored any further communication attempts from him.
There was something fishy about Washburn, Harry thought. He had never met the man before starting as a teacher at Hogwarts. But for some reason Washburn seemed to dislike Harry as soon as they met. Maybe it was because James misbehaved so much in class last year? Is that why he hates Albus as well? Harry did not know, but he hoped to find out.
Harry found Ron standing near The Three Broomsticks. âHey, Ron.â
Ron jumped. âBlimey, Harry, you scared me!â Ron whispered as he lowered his wand.
âSorry. Iâve got to talk to you about something,â Harry whispered back.
âWhat is it?â Ron asked.
Harry relayed both his and Albusâs dreams to Ron. âAnd when Albus told me about his dream, I just thought it was a nightmare, but it seems odd that we would both have the same dream.â
âHow could you both have the same dream?â Ron questioned.
âNo idea. The only thing I could think of is that someone is using Legilimency on both of us.â
âWell, itâs possible. Youâve never been very good at Occlumency, have you? And Albus has certainly never used it. Plus whoever is doing it must be pretty stupid. Why would someone plant that dream in your head if they wanted to do something evil? Why wouldnât they just read your mind and be done with it?,â Ron reasoned.
âYeah, thatâs what I thought of, too. Who would want me to know theyâre reading my mind and make me think Voldemort is coming back? It would also have to mean someoneâs either getting into the castle at night or itâs a teacher or student,â Harry said worriedly.
âWell, I havenât seen anyone near the castle grounds tonight and how could they get past the protection?â Ron asked.
âI know, thatâs what makes me think itâs a student or teacher. And no student would be able to do Legilimency like that. Maybe a 7th year could, if they studied and practiced enough,â Harry told Ron.
âWell, whoeverâs doing it, itâs pretty worrisome,â Ron stated.
âI know. And what about the dream itself? I mean, if someone is making Albus and I dream this, then they must be trying to bring back Voldemort.â
âBut how on earth could they do that?â Ron asked.
âIâm not sure, exactly. But I have a hunch. The Resurrection Stone,â Harry replied.
âBut that doesnât really bring people back.â
âI know, but it does bring back a form of them that only the person with the stone can see. And you can talk to them. I talked to my parents, Sirius, and Lupin with it, remember?â Harry explained.
âYeah, thatâs true. If whoeverâs doing this had the stone, then theyâd be able to talk to Voldemort?â Ron asked, âBlimey, thatâs scary. But how could they find the stone? Us and Hermione are the only ones who know where it is.â
âI know, but if theyâre using Legilimency, then theyâd be able to find out from me,â Harry said quietly.
âWell, what are we going to do?â Ron asked nervously.
âI donât know, Ron, I really donât,â Harry confessed, âIâm going to have to think of a plan. If someoneâs been reading my mind, then they mightâve already seen where the stone is. I think Iâll have to increase the protection near the forest. Iâll assign more Aurors to Hogsmeade. Ask Hagrid if heâs noticed anything funny happening in or around the forest.â
âSounds good. But whatever you do, I think it might be best for you to at least try to use Occlumency again,â Ron suggested.
âI know, Iâll try. Iâve gotten better over the years, and hopefully itâll be good enough,â Harry replied.
âWhat are you going to tell Albus?â Ron asked.
âNothing. He still thinks the dream means nothing and itâs better that way. Heâd be so scared if he knew what was going on. Plus, we never told the kids about the Hallows. I wanted to wait until they were older. Didnât want them blabbing about them to half the school. You know how James is.â
âI know, thatâs why I never told Rose or Hugo either,â Ron agreed.
âWell, Iâd better get back up to the school. Keep your eyes peeled and your wand out. As Mad-Eye would have said, âConstant vigilanceâ. We still donât really know that itâs a student or teacher yet, and Iâd prefer not to have to start questioning my colleagues.â
âAll right, Harry, youâre the boss,â Ron joked. âGood night, then.â
ââNight.â
******
The next few days passed quickly. Albus, John, Rose, and Amanda visited Matt in the hospital wing a few times but nobody mentioned the conversation about him being a werewolf. Instead they just talked about what had been going on in class. Matt left the hospital wing one morning a couple days later and met his friends in the Great Hall for breakfast. Again, nobody mentioned the conversation from the full moon.
Albus looked up from his toast for a few seconds and noticed that Quinton Willinson was striding over to the Gryffindor table with a smug look on his face. What did he want?
âGuess what, Potty?â Quinton leered at Albus. âSlughornâs having a Christmas party. Have you heard? Just told me about it yesterday.â
âSo?â Albus said flatly, not looking up from his porridge.
âSo, are you going then?â Quinton laughed. âAre we going to be treated to yet another Potty show?â
James walked into the Great Hall and immediately noticed Quinton near his brother. He ran over to see what was going on.
âWhat are you doing here?â James asked, crossing his arms across his chest.
âAh, the older Potty! What a pleasure to have them both here at once,â Quinton said excitedly, âI was just telling your dear brother about Slughornâs Christmas party. I was merely wondering if he would be attending.â
âThatâs none of your business,â James glared at Quinton.
âWill you be going as well?â Quinton asked, ignoring Jamesâs comment. âThen we could have a running commentary about your Quidditch skills as well as listen to your brotherâs outbursts!â
âShut it!â James shouted, turning beet red and drawing his wand.
âJames! Itâs ok, just ignore him,â Albus told his brother.
âNo, itâs no ok,â James responded.
âGoing to duel me, Potty? I can take both of you,â Quinton drew his wand and pointed it at James.
âBet you canât take us as well,â John said as he and Matt both drew their wands.
âEasy,â Quinton snorted.
âWhat is going on here? Dueling at breakfast?â Professor Washburn walked over to the table and sneered at James.
âNo, Professor, just defending my brother,â James responded.
âI believe that qualifies as dueling, Potter,â Washburn spat, âDetention for you and your brother, plus Brickston and Eckerton as well. And 50 points from Gryffindor.â
James gaped at him. âBut what about Willinson? He started it! And Albus doesnât even have his wand drawn! He didnât do anything.â
âIâd suggest you shut your mouth, Potter, or Iâll make it 2 detentions,â Washburn growled as he walked up to the staff table. âIâll tell you all the date and time in your next charms class. And I donât care if you have Quidditch practice during the time of detention.â
âWell, I guess Iâll see you at Slughornâs party, then,â Quinton told them as he walked back to the Slytherin table.
âThis is ridiculous!â James shouted, âWe didnât do anything! He hates me, I tell you.â
âI know, he hates me too,â Albus agreed, âAnd I havenât even done anything to him. Iâve had a detention a week from him.â
âQuidditch practice is tonight at 7! He better not make it tonight!â James groaned.
âWonder what heâll have us do?â John asked.
âDunno? He usually has me do lines, while he glares at me,â Albus told him.
âI hate lines,â Matt sighed, âTheyâre so boring.â
âWell, thereâs a lot worse detentions than lines,â James told him.
âTrue. Blimey, look at the time!â Matt shouted as he glanced at his watch. âWeâre going to be late for DADA!â
Matt, Albus, and John got up from the table and murmured rushed goodbyes to James, who was rushing off to History of Magic. Albus noticed that the girls had already left for class.
******
âWell, that was boring, John groaned as he, Albus, and Matt left DADA a while later, âWhy do we have to read about the spells before we get to do them!â
âBecause otherwise you wonât understand what the spell does and what the point of it is,â Rose said, exasperatingly. She was often explaining the point of reading to John.
âIâd rather read in DADA than do spells in Charms,â Albus sighed. The Gryffindors were on their way to their least favorite class.
âMe, too,â Matt agreed, âAnd weâll be learning what our detention will consist of.â
âUgh! Iâve done way too many detentions with Washburn,â Albus groaned. âAnd you can bet that heâll purposely have us doing the detention while James is supposed to have Quidditch practice.â
âOf course,â Matt agreed, as he pushed open the door to the Charms classroom. The boys walked inside and found their usual table at the back of the room.
Washburn stormed into the room a few minutes later, he was obviously in a bad mood. âToday weâll be starting to learn how to make a strawberry walk across the table. Itâs not very difficult, if youâve been practicing the incantation and reading up on it.â Washburn swished his wand and a strawberry appeared in front of each student. âWell, get to it then!â
John looked at Albus, âYou been practicing or reading up on this, Mate?â
âNope, how about you?â
ââCourse not,â John laughed. âLooks like Rose has, though.â
Albus looked over at the table Rose was sharing with Marina and Karina. Sure enough, her strawberry was walking across the table. Washburn, who had been glaring at the students from behind his desk, got up and strode over to Rose.
âApparently someone in this class has shown that they might have a small bit of talent,â he spat at Rose. âI suppose if this were any other class, Gryffindor may have gotten a few points. But I, on the other hand, donât think this is very remarkable, considering youâve supposedly been studying this for a few days and every one of you should be capable of doing what Miss Weasleyâs done. Now, back to work!â
âBlimey, heâs mad,â John whispered to Albus and Matt.
âSure is, I mean, Rose did a good job. None of us can do it,â Matt agreed.
Albus looked around the room and noticed that most of the classâs strawberries were not so much as moving a leaf. A few of them had made a feeble attempt to roll over, but that was it. As the class progressed, Washburn started to stand behind the back table and glare as Albus, Matt, and John tried to make their strawberries walk. By the end of the class, they had made no progress whatsoever.
âPathetic!â he shouted, âFor homework, write a foot-long essay on the proper way to make a piece of fruit walk, due on Friday. And Potter, Eckerton, and Brickston come up here to arrange your detention.â
The rest of the class stared at Albus, Matt, and John as they left the room. The three boys walked slowly up to Washburnâs desk after the rest of the class had left.
âYour detention will be this Saturday, at noon. You will meet me in the Great Hall, where you will be polishing the portrait frames, house points hourglasses, and whatever else needs cleaning. Potter, you tell your brother this, I expect him there as well, despite his Quidditch practice,â Washburn barked, âYouâre dismissed.â
Albus, Matt, and John ran out of Washburnâs room as fast as they could. They went straight to the Great Hall for lunch.
âBlimey, he was angry about something today,â Matt groaned as he helped himself to some potatoes.
âYeah, but I wonder why he wants us to clean for our detention?â Albus wondered. âHeâs always had me do lines, before.â
âBet he thinks itâll be funny, watching us clean. Plus, itâs a Saturday, thereâll be lots of people around to stare at us. Heâll probably enjoy our humiliation,â John said.
âWhat are you talking about?â James asked as he sat down next to John.
âDetention. Saturday at noon, cleaning in the Entrance Hall,â Albus told him.
âBloody hell! Iâve got Quidditch practice at noon!â James shouted as he slammed his goblet on the table.
âI know, thatâs probably why he made the detention then,â Albus said.
âHe hates us, I swear he does,â James growled, âHeâs always hated Gryffindors, thatâs a known fact, but he seems to hate us more than everyone else.â
âDonât you think itâs a bit strange?â Albus asked.
âNot really. Some teachers just donât like certain students,â John explained, ââCourse, the students never really find out why.â
âSucks, though. I mean, what if heâs always giving me detention during Quidditch practice? Thisâll be the 4th practice Iâve missed for Washburnâs detentions. Samantha wonât be too happy about it.â
âYouâll just have to watch yourself around him. Donât say a word during his class,â Albus advised.
âI know, Iâve been doing that since beginning of last year,â James explained, âAfter I set off a dungbomb during the second class.â
âWell, thatâs why he hates you!â Matt laughed, âAnd he probably thinks Albus is just like you.â
âHe does,â Albus groaned.
âI guess Iâd better be off to class,â James told them as he got up from his seat. âSee you lot later.â
âBye,â Albus told his brother. He turned to John and Matt. âI guess weâd better go too.â
âYeah, probably. Double potions,â John said as he got up.
âUgh, just what I need. Slughornâll probably invite me to his Christmas party.â
Sure enough, at the end of class, Slughorn asked Albus and Rose to see him after everyone left.
âWeâll wait for you,â John told Albus. He, Matt, and Amanda waited at the back of the room.
âAlbus and Rose!â Slughorn beckoned them to his desk, âGreat job, today, great job. Both of your potions were superb!â
âThanks,â Albus muttered.
âIt was a challenge, but I think I did all right!â Rose said excitedly.
âWell, as you both probably know, Iâm having a little Christmas party on the last day of term. You are both invited, of course, and may bring guests. I hope to see you there! I have some interesting people coming that Iâm sure youâd like to meet!â
âWho?â Albus asked warily.
âOh, donât want to spoil the surprise!â Slughorn laughed, âIâll see you later, then!â
âSo, you going to go?â John asked Albus nervously as they walked out of the dungeon.
âNo way,â Albus mumbled.
âWell, someone told me your dadâs going,â Rose said, âSo you might have to go.â
âI donât care.â
âOh, come on, Albus! What if he has really neat famous people there! I heard once he had some Quidditch players come!â John told him.
âI really donât think anyone would start anything with Uncle Harry there,â Rose said reassuringly.
âWell, maybe not. But what about Willinson?â Albus asked.
âHeâs a git, but he wonât do anything with your dad around. Washburn may give Slytherins special treatment, but Professor Potter doesnât,â Matt said confidently.
âIf you do go, can I be your guest?â Amanda asked, âIâve never been to one.â
âYou can be my guest, Amanda,â Rose told her, âI told you Iâd take you to the next one after I took Janie to the Halloween one.â
âOh, yeah.â
âFine, if you guys want to go so badly, Iâll go, but if anyone starts anything, Iâm leaving,â Albus said flatly.
********
Before Albus knew it, Saturday had arrived and so did detention with Washburn. Albus was used to Washburnâs detentions, but he had never had to do one that wasnât lines before. He was a bit nervous about what the detention would involve and about having to do it in public.
When Albus, John, and Matt arrived in the Great Hall, neither James nor Washburn were there yet. âJames better get here before Washburn does,â Albus said nervously.
âYeah, Washburnâll give him another detention if heâs late,â Matt agreed.
At that moment, James came bursting through the oak doors. âOh, good, heâs not here yet!â
âYouâre lucky,â John told him.
âWhat is Potter lucky about?â a cold voice from behind John said.
John turned around to see Washburn staring down at him. âNothing, Professor.â
âGood,â Washburn spat. âNow, if youâll each take a bottle of cleaner and a rag, we can get started.â He gestured to a bucket of cleaning supplies at his feet. âWeâll be doing Muggle cleaning. I want you each to start out by polishing the House points hourglasses. They must be spotless.â
Albus, James, John, and Matt each took a rag and started to polish the hourglasses. Washburn paced behind them, staring at each one in turn. Every once and a while, he would inspect the cleanliness of the hourglasses.
âYou missed a spot, Potter,â Washburn growled at Albus.
While the boys were polishing the hourglasses, various students and professors would walk by and stare at them. Much to Albusâs disgust, Quinton Willinson passed by a lot.
âOh, look, Pottyâs doing his detention for trying to duel with me,â Quinton laughed, âFunny how he thought he could actually duel me.â
Albus just ignored his taunts and rubbed the Hufflepuff hourglass even harder.
âThat slimy git,â John whispered to Albus. âIf any of us taunted him in detention, weâd get a detention ourselves.â
âYeah, and he had his wand drawn, too,â Matt agreed, âWashburn seems to like him best.â
âNo surprise there,â Albus told them as he scrubbed a particularly stubborn piece of dirt. âTheyâre both horrible.â
âI just wish it had been some other teacher who passed by our table that morning,â John groaned, âThen Willinson would have at least gotten detention, too.â
âGet back to work, Potter!â Washburn shouted at James, who had stopped polishing the Gryffindor hourglass and was resting his head on it.
âSomething wrong, James?â Albus whispered.
âI dunno. My head just felt funny all of a sudden.â
âDâyou think youâre ill or something?â Albus asked, âMaybe you should go to the Hospital Wing.â
âNah, Washburn would never let me. Heâd think I was faking. I used way too many Skiving Snackboxes in his class last year.â
âYeah, but if youâre really ill, heâll have to let you go,â Albus said with a look of concern on his face.
âI know, but heâd make me do the detention over again.â
âShut up, Potters! Both of you back to work or Iâll give you another detention!â Washburn screamed.
For the rest of the detention, James was very quiet. The boys worked until two oâclock, at which point all four hourglasses were cleaner than they had been in years.
âI think you should go to the Hospital Wing,â Albus told James.
âYeah, probably,â James agreed.
âI need to go, too,â John told them, âMy hand feels like itâs going to fall off! I hate Muggle cleaning.â
âMe, too,â Matt agreed, while rubbing his hand.
âI doubt Madam Pomfrey will fix it, though,â Albus told them, âShe usually doesnât do that after teachers make us do Muggle cleaning.â
John and Matt decided to go with Albus and James to the Hospital Wing anyway. When they got there, Madam Pomfrey was already tending to Bradley Weasley, who had taken a bludger to the arm during Quidditch practice.
âYes, yes, what is it?â Madam Pomfrey asked the boys.
âWell, I was doing Muggle cleaning for Washburnâs detention-â James started to say, but Madam Pomfrey cut him off.
âYou know I donât fix aching hands due to detentions! If I did, you wouldnât learn anything from them!â
âItâs not that. I was polishing the Gryffindor hourglass, and my head felt funny all of a sudden. It wasnât like a headache. Iâve never felt that way before. I kept seeing my own memories.â
Madam Pomfrey quickly looked up from Bradley and bustled over to James. âReally? Well, that sounds an awful lot like someone was using Legilimency on you.â
âWhat?â James shouted.
âSomeone was reading your mind. Thatâs why you were seeing your own memories,â Madam Pomfrey explained, âWho else was in the Great Hall with you?â
âWell, Washburn of course,â Albus told her. James appeared to be in shock and couldnât speak. âAnd Quinton Willinson, a couple of his friends, the Gryffindor Quidditch team, a variety of Hufflepuffs and Ravenclaws I donât know, a few other professors. They all wandered in and out of the Great Hall.â
Madam Pomfrey sighed. âThat doesnât really help any. We really donât have any way to know who was doing it. Seeing as youâre not really ill, thereâs not much I can do for you. But I will inform the headmaster and your father about this.â
James had found his voice again. âOkay.â
Madam Pomfrey went back to tending to Bradley, and James, Albus, John, and Matt left the room.
âThatâs so strange,â James told them, âWhy would anyone want to read my mind?â
âNo idea,â Albus shrugged.
âI bet it was Willinson,â John growled. âWhat a git.â
âYeah, he was probably just doing it to scare you,â Matt agreed.
âWas he even in the room when your head felt funny?â Albus asked.
âI donât really remember,â James told him.
âWell, I bet Dadâll take care of it,â Albus reassured his brother.
âI guess,â James said distractedly, âI think Iâm going to go back to the common room.â
âOkay, see you at dinner,â Albus waved goodbye as he, Matt, and John walked back down the stairs so they could enjoy the new fallen snow.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Hope you enjoyed it! That one was longer than usual, but if I split it up, it would have been two extremely short chapters. Please leave a review and I will answer it! Thanks as always to Dancer_Of_Starlight for reading this before I posted and to my brother and other sister who are not on HPFF.
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Chapter 8: Parties and Pranks
During the next few weeks, the teachers had increased their homework, each insisting that the students needed to increase their studying time. Albus found himself doing homework every day after dinner, and finding it hard to have time to have snow ball fights outside.
Albus hadnât forgotten about his cleaning detention with Washburn, and was doing even more to try to stay away from him. During class, Albus wouldnât even look at Washburn. He did not say a single word during Charms anymore. No more talking to John and Matt while they were practicing making fruit walk across their desks.
Albus had noticed that James had changed since the detention. He was quieter, and often sat in a corner of the common room with their cousins Cedric and Ben, whereas he used to be at the center of attention, talking about Quidditch matches. Albus guessed he was still scared about what happened during detention. Albus hadnât mentioned the incident to anyone, so only him, John, and Matt knew. Of course, James had told Cedric, Ben, and his friend Nathan, but Albus rarely noticed them talking about it. He was also a bit afraid of what the incident meant, but not nearly as much as James was.
Before they knew it, Christmas holiday was upon them. There was one day left, which was the day of Slughornâs Christmas party. The entire school was talking about it, and envious students who had not received invitations were constantly dropping hints to invited students about going with them. Albus would have gladly given up his invitation, but since all his cousins, James, and his dad were going, he had to go too.
Albus, John, and Matt had decided they should go a little later than the party actually started, so they could try to slip in unnoticed. John in particular, was very excited about going.
âWhich Quidditch player do you think Slughornâs invited?â he asked as they walked down to the dungeons.
âDunno. Maybe heâs invited a couple!â Matt responded excitedly.
âYeah! I sure hope so,â John said.
âGuess weâre about to find out,â Albus told them as he opened the door and walked into the dungeon. It was packed. Albus noticed most of his cousins, with their flaming red hair. The few who had not inherited the hair were blending in with everyone else.
âBlimey! How are we supposed to find the Quidditch players with all these people here?â John exclaimed.
âNo idea. How about we head for the food and hope we find them on the way?â Matt asked.
âSounds good. Câmon, Albus,â John said as he pushed through people to get to the food. Albus and Matt followed.
âYou see Willinson anywhere?â Albus whispered.
âNo, but itâs hard to tell if heâs here or not,â John answered.
âIâm sure heâs here somewhere. Keep your eyes peeled for him,â Albus told his friends. âIâve got to stay away from him.â
When the boys arrived at the food table, they saw that Rose and Amanda were already there. âHi. Did you just get here?â Rose asked.
âYup, wanted to slip in unnoticed,â Albus told her as he grabbed a plate and started filling it. âSeen anyone interesting yet?â
âYeah, actually. The rumor about the Quidditch players was right,â Rose responded.
âReally!? Whoâs here?â John shouted, as he scanned the crowd.
âOliver Wood. He used to be Keeper for Puddlemere United,â Rose told him.
âI know who he played for, Rose. Heâs really here? Thatâs brilliant. Puddlemere Unitedâs my team,â John told them.
âWe know, youâve told us a million times,â Rose said exasperatingly.
âWho else?â Albus asked.
âHelena Yaspies, current Chaser for Chudley Cannons,â Amanda told them.
Matt started choking and spat out his mouthful of butterbeer. Albus slapped him on the back. âYou okay, mate?â
âIâm fine!â Matt coughed, âThe Chudley Cannons are my team! Iâve got to find her! Anyone got a quill for an autograph?â
Rose laughed. âYou guys are crazy.â
âNothing crazy about wanting to meet your favorite Quidditch players,â John told her. âBlimey, Oliver WoodâŠâ
âI ever tell you that my dad used to play on the Gryffindor team with Oliver Wood?â Albus asked John.
This time it was Johnâs turn to spit out his butterbeer. âNo! You never did! Why not?â
Albus laughed. âYou never asked. Anyway, he was captain when my dad joined the team in his first year. They played on the team together until my dadâs third year.â
âBlimey! Thatâs brilliant! So, you could have met him?â John asked.
âI have,â Albus smiled.
âYouâre kidding!â John shouted, âWell, what are we waiting for? Go introduce me!â
Albus laughed. âOk, letâs go find him. You want to come, Rose and Amanda?â
Rose sighed, âSure, I guess.â
âAny chance you know Helena Yaspies?â Matt asked.
âNope, sorry. Never met her,â Albus told his friend as they maneuvered their way through the crowd.
âThere he is, Albus!â John shouted, pointing to the back of the room. âHeâs talking to your dad.â
Albus made his way to the back of the room, his friends following behind him. The room was slightly less crowded in the back. There was still no sign of Willinson.
âHi, Al!â Harry waved at Albus.
âHi, Dad.â
âWhatâs up? Enjoying the party? I know youâre not a fan of these, but thanks for coming,â Harry told Albus. He bent down so only Albus could hear what he next said, âYou know, I wasnât a fan of these either, when I was in Hogwarts.â
âHow are you, Albus? Enjoying school?â Oliver asked.
âYeah, itâs great!â Albus responded. âThese are my friends, John Brickston- heâs a big Puddlemere United supporter, Matt Eckerton, and Amanda Tagger.â
âHi, nice to meet you,â Oliver told Albusâs friends. âSo, you support Puddlemere United, John?â
âYeah!â John shouted, his eyes lit up. âIâve been to a few matches. I saw you in the last one you played in! I was 9, but I remember it like it was yesterday. Such spectacular saves.â
Oliver laughed, âThat was a good game. Iâm glad you enjoyed it.â
âIt was awesome!â John said.
A tall brunette came walking over to the group, carrying a small boy on her hip. A little girl was trailing behind her with a plate of Christmas biscuits.
âHey, Heather,â Oliver put his arm around the woman. âJohn, Matt, Amanda, this is my wife, Heather. And this,â Oliver took the little boy from his wife and put him on his shoulders, âis my 2 year old son, Alex. And my daughter, Holly who is 6.â
âHi,â John and Matt said together.
âI stopped playing Keeper shortly after Alex was born. Couldnât keep up all the traveling with 2 kids.â
âI remember that,â John told him, âI was kinda mad, but was just glad I got to see your last match.â
Oliver laughed, âI understand. I would have been mad if I were you, too. But Iâve got high hopes for little Alex here. He can already fly his toy broom expertly. And Hollyâs already flying a real broom!â Oliver beamed, he was obviously proud of his kids.
âThatâs pretty neat!â Matt replied, âMy mum wouldnât let me on a broom until I was 9.â
âHolly was on one at 5. But just because you start late doesnât mean youâll be a bad Quidditch player,â Oliver explained, âLook at your DADA teacher! Hadnât set one leg over a broom until he was 11.â
âYeah, but Iâm rubbish at Quidditch,â Matt told him.
âHey, Mr. Wood, could you sign my Quaffle?â John produced a Quaffle from his bag and held it out to Oliver.
âYou brought a Quaffle?!â Rose exclaimed.
ââCourse! After hearing those rumors, how could I not bring one?â
âSure, Iâll sign it,â Oliver took the Quaffle and signed it with a quill that he pulled out of his robes. He then handed it back to John.
âThank you,â John whispered, as he stared in awe at the Quaffle.
âHow âbout you, Matt?â Oliver asked, âYou want an autograph?â
âSure! But I donât have a Quaffle.â
âThatâs okay. Iâve got some parchment,â Oliver signed some parchment and gave it to Matt.
âThanks!â Matt pocketed the parchment.
Alex started whining. âHungy, hungy!â
âWell, boys, Iâve got to go get some food for little Alex, here,â Oliver told them, âEnjoy the party!â He and Heather walked towards the food table with Holly behind them.
âWow, just wow,â John told his friends, âThat was so cool.â
âIâll say,â Matt replied.
âI canât believe you two know him!â John told Albus and Rose.
Rose rolled her eyes, âItâs no big deal.â
âYou just donât like Quidditch that much,â Albus told her, âItâs cause youâre horrible on a broom.â
âShut it, Albus,â Rose glared at him.
âWhereâs Helena Yaspies?â John scanned the crowd, âAny of you lot seen her?â
âNope, not yet,â Albus told them.
âNo, but look over there near Slughornâs desk. Itâs Willinson,â Matt whispred.
Albus groaned.
âExcellent!â John grinned.
âWhat?â Albus looked at him like he was crazy, âWhy on earth do you want to see him?â
âIâve been plotting a little prank,â John whispred, âCâmere.â He pulled them behind a table and they all crouched down. John pulled a box out of his bag. âThis is an Exploding Eclair.â
âWhat?â Amanda asked.
âExploding Eclair,â John repeated, âI bought it through owl-order from your uncleâs store, Albus.â
âWhat are you going to do with it?â Albus eyed him warily, he happened to have been on the receiving end of an Exploding Eclair at the family dinner before start of term. His cousin, Bradley, had done it.
âPlant it on Willinsonâs plate,â John told them, âBut Iâll need your help. When Willinson sets his plate down, walk by him. Close enough that he can see you, but far enough that heâll have to leave his plate unattended. Then Iâll put the eclair on it. And when he bites into it, bam! Itâll explode.â
âBrilliant!â Matt shouted.
âI dunno. Itâll make him real mad,â Albus said.
âBut he wonât know itâs us! Thatâs the beauty of it. Thereâs so many people here,â John explained, âBut to be on the safe side, weâll leave right after. We donât want to stay if heâs here anyway.â
âTrue,â Albus agreed.
âEveryone in, then?â John asked, grinning.
âYep,â they all stated.
âThen letâs go,â John got up from under the table and his friends followed. Willinson was still by the desk, so Albus, Matt, Amanda, and Rose headed over. They walked next to the food table and waited until Willinson noticed them. It didnât take long. He spotted them, smirked, and set down his food. Albus saw John close in on his plate.
âHello, Potty, Weasel, and company,â Willinson glared, âEnjoying the party? Iâm just waiting until the moment you explode again, Potty.â
âWillinson,â Albus snarled, âIâm not planning on exploding. Are you?â
ââCourse not. When have I ever exploded? You on the other hand,â Willinson laughed, âDonât like the popularity, do you, baby Potty?â
âShut it,â Matt stepped towards Willinson.
âWhatâre you going to do about it, Shrimp?â Willinson towered over Matt by at least a foot.
âYou think Iâd tell you what Iâd do? Think Iâm stupid? If I told you, youâd know how to block it,â Matt growled.
âI doubt thereâs a curse you know that I donât know how to block.â
âProbably, but I know you wouldnât start anything with Professor Potter a few feet away,â Matt jerked his head in the direction of Harry.
At that moment, Albus looked over and saw John. John winked at him and walked away from Willinsonâs plate.
âWell, I think Iâve had enough of your company tonight, Willinson,â Albus annonced, âHave a horrible Christmas.â Albus started to walk towards John, and his friends followed.
âGot it planted, then?â Albus asked when they reached John.
âYup,â John gave him a thumbs up, âWeâre on.â
They walked over to the door of the dungeon so they could escape easily if needed. Willinson picked up his plate and wandered back over to his friends. As they were talking, he picked up the eclair and bit into it.
The explosion was amazing. As soon as Willinson bit the eclair, cream exploded all over his face and in a 2 foot radius around him. A few bystanders were hit as well. It didnât seem possible that that much cream could fit in one eclair.
âBloody Hell!â Willinson shouted, and the whole dungeon went silent. Everyone looked at Willinson and started laughing.
Willinson looked around the room and his gaze fell on Albus. âIâll get you for this, Potty,â he seethed as he stormed out of the dungeon.
âThat was bloody brilliant,â John said once Willinson had disappeared into the hallway.
âYeah, it was!â Matt agreed.
The girls and Albus nodded. âBut he said heâd get us. Weâd better be on the lookout. He knows it was us,â Albus told them.
âHe canât know it was us!â Matt said.
âYeah, I guess. But heâd still get us even if he doesnât know who did it,â Albus reasoned.
âBut itâs Christmas break tomorrow, so it doesnât matter!â John grinned.
âI suppose youâre right,â Albus smiled, âBut letâs get to the common room anyway. His friends agreed, and the five of them made their way to Gryffindor tower.
*******
It was still early when they made it back to the common room, so it was quite crowded. However, Amanda spotted a few chairs in the back for them to occupy.
âSo, whoâs excited about Christmas?â John asked, âI sure am, I could use a break from studying.â
âYouâre not going to get a break,â Rose told him, âWeâve got loads of homework.â
âWay to put a damper on things, Rose,â John answered, âBut at least thereâs no classes!â
âIâm looking forward to Christmas,â Albus said, âI love Christmas.â
âWhat do you usually do for the holidays?â Amanda asked.
âOh, itâs great! We all go to my grandma and grandpaâs house. Everyone. My family, Roseâs family, all our aunts, uncles, and cousins. Plus Teddy and his grandma. Itâs pretty crowded, but itâs still fun. I love it. Usually someone winds up having too much to drink and thereâs loads of jokes played on people,â Albus said excitedly.
âYeah, itâs pretty neat. We donât all stay the whole break, though. Because most of us have other family to visit. My family usually stays until a few days after Christmas and then we spend the rest of the holiday with my mumâs parents,â Rose explained, âBut Albusâs family spends the whole break at the Burrow, thatâs what we call my grandparentsâ house.â
âYep. But most of our cousins go straight to the Burrow from Hogwarts. My family always goes home first, to visit my grandparentsâ graves. We always do that on Christmas Eve. Dadâs been going ever since he was 17, every year on Christmas Eve. Then we get the Burrow late that night.â
âWhat do you do you lot do for Christmas?â Rose asked.
âOh, I love Christmas too,â John smiled, âWe stay at my house and my aunts, uncles, cousins, and grandparents all come over. They never all come at the same time, though, so it gets pretty crazy. My mum freaks out because she never knows how much to cook. And usually someone starts arguing about something, but itâs all right. My family loves to argue, but we never get real mad at each other.â
âSounds pretty cool. You have a lot of cousins, John?â Amanda asked.
âA fair amount. Most of them are all younger than me, though. âCourse that means theyâre great to play tricks on,â John laughed.
âWell, my family celebrates Hannukah,â Amanda told everyone.
âOh, thatâs neat,â Albus told her.
âYeah, itâs good. Iâm just glad Hannukah is late this year, so Iâll be home for it. Sometimes itâs at the end of November. But anyway, I have a pretty small family. Just 3 cousins and my aunt and uncle. And my little brother and older sister. My cousins usually come over for two days or so and we all exchange presents. Itâs quiet, but fun.â
âSounds fun,â John agreed, âBut I love my huge loud family. What do you do, Matt? Youâve been awful quiet.â
Matt looked up from the table. âChristmas has never been all that fun for me, I guess. We usually go down to Australia to visit my grandparents.â
âThat sounds like fun to me,â John told Matt.
âWell, itâs not. I donât like Australia. Thatâs where-â But Matt suddenly stopped talking.
âWhere what?â John asked.
âNothing, nothing. Itâs just, thatâs where I, er, got sick for the first time. You know, how I get sick so much.â
âOh.â
âYeah, anyway, well, we visit my grandparents. My parents, me and my sister go. My mumâs a muggle born, and we visit her parents. Itâs always very formal when we visit them. Theyâre rich and stuck up. Never let me do anything there. I have to just sit still and theyâre always staring at me. Guess they donât want me to break anything. Luckily we only visit them at Christmas. I donât have any cousins. My dadâs got a brother, but heâs living in the States, so we donât see him much either. We sometimes visit him over the summer. My dadâs parents died a long time ago, before I was born. So I donât have much family. I just wish weâd spend Christmas at home.â
Albus, John, Amanda, and Rose just looked at Matt. âIâm sorry, Matt. I wish you had a better Christmas,â Rose said sympathetically.
âWhy donât you spend Christmas with us?â Albus asked, âNo one will notice another person in the Burrow.â
âThatâs a great idea!â Rose shouted.
âI dunno. I donât think my parents will let me. Especially this short notice,â Matt looked down glumly. âMy mum likes all of us to be together on Christmas. She seems to think every year it will be different. That my grandparents will loosen up. But they never do.â
âBlimey,â John whispered, âThat stinks.â
âI know,â Matt agreed.
At that moment, James came bursting in with his friend, Nathan. They both made a beeline for Albusâs table.
âWas it really you?â James shouted breathlessly, âDid you give Willinson the Exploding Eclair?â
John grinned. âIt was my idea.â
âBrilliant, just brilliant,â James smiled, âThe look on his faceâŠâ
âYeah, but you lot had better watch out when you next see him. He seemed to know it was you,â Nathan told them.
âIâm not worried,â John answered, âHeâll probably forget about it over Christmas.â
âI sure hope so,â Albus stated. He looked at his watch. It was midnight. âWell, Iâm off to bed. Iâll see you guys in the morning.
âWeâd all better go to bed,â Rose stood up, âI think the train is leaving at noon tomorrow.â
Albus got up out of his chair and headed to the staircase. He couldnât wait to go to the Burrow. He missed being surrounded by his family all the time. He missed his grandmotherâs cooking. Thoughts of the delicious food filed his head as he drifted off into a pleasant, dreamless sleep.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Hope you guys like it! Please read and review. Thanks as always to Dancer_Of_Starlight and my other sister and brother. Also, thanks to QUEEN and teddysxxgirl for their reviews! Next chapter is Christmas Eve.
know this chapter is short, but I didnât want to combine it with anything else. It stands on its own.
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
âLily!â Harry shouted into the living room, âAre you ready to go? All packed?â Harry was standing with Ginny in front of the front door, with a couple trunks and suitcases at his feet. James and Albus were standing nearby, having a sword fight with a couple fake wands. Albusâs wand turned into a fake parrot and emitted a loud squawking noise.
âAlbus! James!â Ginny scolded them, âBehave yourselves.â James and Albus quickly stowed the wand and parrot into their trunks.
A small, red-headed girl walked into the room, trailing a pink rolling suitcase. âAre we leaving now?â
âYes, we are. What were you doing in there, dear?â Ginny asked.
âI was packing. I couldnât find all my Wendy Witch dolls and had to look all over the house for them.â
James laughed. âDo you have to take them everywhere?â
âOf course I do! I couldnât leave any of them home. It wouldnât be fair,â Lily explained. Albus and James laughed even harder. âMum! Tell them to shut up.â
âBoys, be nice to your sister. Now, does everyone have everything? Iâm sending the trunks to the Burrow and we wonât be coming back after we visit Godricâs Hollow,â Ginny informed them.
âYes, weâve got everything,â Albus told them.
âGood,â Ginny waved her wand and the trunks and suitcases disappeared, âNow, then, itâs time to go. Lily, take my arm. Boys, take your fatherâs.â And with a loud crack, the Potter family disappeared from their house.
A few seconds later, they reappeared in a field a little ways away from a small town. The sun was setting and their was fresh snow on the ground. From the field, Harry could see tiny people walking along the streets.
âDaddy, why do we have to walk so far?â Lily whined, âWhy canât we just Apparate in town?â
âIâve told you before, Lily, we canât let the Muggles see us,â Harry explained.
âBut Iâm tired.â
âOh, shut it, Lily,â James snapped at his sister, âItâs not that far.â
âIs, too,â Lily stomped away from him.
James reached down and made a snowball and then threw it at the back of his sisterâs head.
âOw!!!â Lily screeched and ran to Harry.
James and Albus started laughing. âGood one, James,â Albus gave his brother a high five.
âBoys!â Harry shouted, âEnough! Lily, itâs not that much further. Iâll carry you.â Harry picked up his daughter, who started sobbing into his jacket.
âSheâs really tired,â Harry whispered to Ginny.
âI know. Sheâs been real excited about you and the boys coming home for the holiday. Sheâs been up until midnight every night the past week,â Ginny said.
âShe wonât be getting much sleep for the next week either, staying at the Burrow,â Harry told Ginny.
âThatâs for sure.â
As the Potter family moved into the town, some people occasionally stopped to stare at them. A few stopped to say hello, but hurried off quickly. Others completely ignored them. Many people were finishing up last minute shopping or hurrying off to church.
The little church was already full of people singing. The Potters could hear the carols as they walked by. They crunched through the snow in silence. Even James and Albus were quiet. Lily had fallen asleep on Harryâs shoulder shortly after he picked her up. Harry appreciated how his kids were always behaved when he visited his parents graves. It was sort of an unspoken thing. He had never once had to tell them to behave themselves in the cemetery. The kids would fight and bicker along the streets in the village, but would always get along once they entered the cemetery.
Harry walked into the cemetery, with Ginny, James, and Albus following him. As he walked the familiar path to his parents graves, he thought about his previous visits. There was the first visit, of course. He couldnât forget that. Voldemort had showed up and tried to kill him. Ever since then, he had been visiting every Halloween and every Christmas Eve. He had taken Ginny once they were married, and the kids once they were born. Harry always felt sad when he visited, but this year he felt worried as well. Who was attempting to read his and his kidsâ minds? What about the mysterious death of Professor Torro?
Harry made his way towards his parentsâ grave and stopped in front of it. He bent down and put his hand over the names. James and Lily Potter.
Before the downfall of Voldemort, mysterious deaths were expected. Of course, nowadays, there were murders every once and a while. These were usually attributed to Death Eaters still at large or witches or wizards who believed in Voldemortâs ideals. Harry or one of the other Aurors usually caught them quickly and they were in Azakaban at the moment. Harry had had Aurors on the case of Torro ever since September, but there were still no leads. This reminded him of very much of the days when Voldemort was at large.
What was he supposed to do? He was doing all he could to catch Torroâs killer. He couldnât help but think the death was somehow related to the legilimency that was being performed on him, James, and Albus. And what could he do to help reassure his sons? The other teachers had told Harry that James was more subdued in class ever since the episode during his detention with Washburn. James was obviously quite worried about it. Albus was, too. Harry had met with Ron shortly afterward and neither of them could come up with any new ideas of who did it. It must have either been a student or a teacher. As much as Harry hated to do it, he realized he was going to have to investigate his colleagues. Ginny was worried, too. However, she believed that the boys were safe with Harry at the castle. Harry knew she took comfort in knowing he was near them at all times. Harry only wished he felt as confident in his abilities as Ginny did.
Ginny knelt down next to Harry and wordlessly took the sleeping Lily from his arms. Harry reached into his cloak and pulled out a bouquet of lilies. He bent down again and placed them in front of the grave stone. Harry stood up and looked at the grave, his eyes glistening with tears.
âHappy Christmas, Mum and Dad,â Harry whispered. Ginny put her arm around Harry, and the two of them turned around and headed out of the cemetery, with James and Albus in their wake.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Longer chapter is coming up next! Itâll be Christmas at the Burrow. Thanks as always to Rain_is_Liquid_Moonlight, my other sister, and my brother. Thanks as well to siriusgirl1 for reviewing. Please read and review!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter! Although I do own the OCs, the plot, and most of the Weasley cousins!
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A little while later, the Potter family appeared in the yard behind the Burrow. They walked up to the back door and Harry opened it. He walked inside, followed by his family, and saw the usual chaos. The entire Weasley family was standing inside. It was a sea of flaming red hair. Most of the children had inherited the Weasley red hair. The few exceptions were Albus, who looked just like Harry, and Victoire and Gabrielle, who had their motherâs silvery blonde hair.
âMum, make him give it back!â six-year-old Lindy shouted as her brother held her doll in the air.
âCedric! Give her back her doll!â Corrine Weasley yelled at her son. He reluctantly handed Lindy her doll and ran from the room.
The Burrow was crammed with people. There didnât seem to be room for anyone else. Teddy Lupin was currently entertaining the younger Weasley children by changing his ears and hair color. The older kids were eating various sweets and talking about all sorts of things. Many of the adults were drinking eggnog and getting louder and louder by the minute.
Ron was the first to notice the Potters. âOi! Harryâs here!â he shouted and ran towards the door, âHi Harry! Great to see you, mate!â
âHey, Ron!â
âHarry, Ginny!â Molly Weasley came bustling into the kitchen, âCome in, come in! Are you hungry? Want any stew?â
âSure,â Harry told her and he sat down at the table next to Ginny. Molly went over to the stove and got five bowls of stew.
âThis is great, Mum, thanks,â Ginny told Molly.
Albus and James were already digging into their stew. Lily ate a few bites and then ran off to find her cousins, apparently not tired at all anymore.
âWell, everyoneâs here,â Molly told them, âTheyâre all in the living room. I donât know if weâll ever get the kids to bed.â
âItâs Christmas Eve, donât even bother,â Harry laughed.
Albus finished his stew and got up from the table. He went into the living room with James and found Rose, along with his cousins Bradley, Cedric, Ben, and Mark sitting together on the floor. Cedric and Ben were second years, and Bradley and Mark were third years.
âWhatâs new?â Albus asked.
âOh, not much,â Ben told him, âUncle George and Uncle Charlie are pretty drunk. Grammy is trying to get the younger kids in bed. All the aunts are talking about all kinds of stuff. My dad, Uncle Percy, Uncle Ron, and Grandpa are all drinking eggnog and eating cookies over there,â he pointed to a few chairs grouped together around a small table. âAnd letâs see, Teddy and Victoire were snogging earlier. It was pretty gross. Who wants to see their sister snogging someone? Grammy made them stop. Now Teddyâs changing his hair color all the time for the entertainment of the little kids, which is making it hard for Grammy to get them to go to bed.â
James and Albus laughed. âShould be an interesting holiday,â James said, âWhat have you lot been up to?â
âOh, not much, just talking about Quidditch,â Cedric said, âOh, and Rose is trying to get some studying done.â
âRose! Weâre on holiday!â James looked shocked, âNowâs not the time to study!â
âWell, youâll be scrambling to get your work done on the last day, like always. Maybe you should study tonight, too.â
âYouâll never get anything done with all this racket,â Cedric told her. âWhatâs up with you, James and Albus?â
âOh, not much. Lilyâs been complaining a lot. She got really mad when I threw a snow ball at her while we were walking into Godricâs Hollow,â James told them.
âYeah, sheâs been kind of a pain, and weâve only been on holiday for a day!â Albus said as he snatched a cookie from a nearby platter. âIâm sure going to enjoy this time off, though. I havenât gone a week without detention in ages.â
âMe too!â James agreed, âI need a break from Washburn, heâs crazy.â
âDefinitely,â Bradley agreed, âYouâve missed so much Quidditch practice because of him.â
âHe hates me, I tell you. Hates Albus, too.â
âRemember that dung bomb in first year, James?â Cedric asked.
âYeah, how could I forget that? Thatâs when he started hating me,â James reminisced. âDidnât learn many charms that year due to the amount of times I used nosebleed nougats.â
âIâm hoping I get new Snackboxes for Christmas this year,â Cedric told them, âIâm running out. Canât wait till next year and I can go buy them at Hogsmeade.â
âDefinitely. Hogwarts wonât know what hit it when weâre able to buy prank stuff all the time,â James laughed.
âGoing to Hogsmeadeâs great,â Mark chimed in, âIâve bought so many sweets at Honeydukes this year.â
âNot to mention everything else there. Like the Three Broomsticks. What a great place. And the Shrieking Shack. You know itâs shrieking again this year,â Bradley added.
Albus and Rose glanced at each other nervously.
âYeah, Iâve heard it. But I wonder why? It hasnât shrieked since Teddyâs dad was at Hogwarts,â James wondered aloud.
âYou donât think-â Cedric started to say, but was cut off by Molly.
âIf youâre not in Hogwarts yet, itâs time for bed!â she shouted, âItâs nearly midnight, way past your bedtimes. Go on! Lily, Hugo, Angie, Samantha, Lindy, and Eddie! Bed!â
âBut Grammy!â Lily whined, âI donât wanna! Iâm not a little kid!â
âNo buts, Lily, bed, now!â
Lily pouted and then stomped up the stairs to the room she shared with Angie, Samantha, and Lindy.
âI see what you mean about Lily,â Cedric told James and Albus.
âYup, sheâs been doing it all evening. Dad actually carried her at Godricâs Hollow. And she fell asleep on his shoulder. âCourse now she doesnât want to go to bed, figures,â James said.
âSo, what does everyone think the chances of England making it to the World Cup next year?â Albus asked quickly, before everyone could return to the topic of the Shrieking Shack.
âUgh!â Rose sighed, âBack to Quidditch again.â She pulled out her copy of The Standard Book of Spells, Grade One and continued reading.
The subject of Quidditch carried the boys the rest of the night and Albus was very relieved that no one mentioned the Shrieking Shack again. After a while, Molly decided it was time for everyone else to go to bed, too. James, Bradley, Cedric, Mark, Ben, and Albus were all sharing Ronâs old bedroom on the top floor. They trudged up the stairs while continuing their Quidditch conversation. When they reached the room, they found three sets of bunk beds crammed into the room, just as they were every other Christmas. It was a bit cramped, but they all had enough room. Albus climbed into the bottom of the bunk he shared with James and fell into a restful sleep.
******
âAlbus! Wake up! Itâs Christmas!â a shrill voice screamed as Albus opened his eyes. He sat up and bumped his head on the bed above him.
âOuch!â Albus rubbed his aching head. He had forgotten he was at the Burrow. âWhat is it?â
âItâs Christmas, Albus!â Lily screeched.
âWhat time is it? Is anyone else up?â
âItâs six in the morning!â Lily said excitedly. âIâm the first one up. Look, youâve got presents!â Lily pointed at the pile near the foot of Albusâs bed.
âExcellent! Looks like a good load this year,â Albus smiled. âHave you opened yours?â
âNot yet. I think I will now, though!â Lily grinned and ran from the room.
Albus heard stirring from the bed above him. âYou up, James?â
âYeah, I am now. Sheâs always the first one up on Christmas,â James yawned.
âI know, sheâs even up before the twins, Angie, and Eddie,â Albus laughed. âWell, mine as well get started on the presents!â
Albus crawled to the end of his bed and examined his presents. He picked up a large, soft package and knew what it was before even opening it. He tore off the wrapping and unfolded a scarlet sweater with a Gryffindor lion on it. Albus knew heâd be getting one of these this year. His grandmother always knitted everyone a sweater every year, but for each kidâs first year at Hogwarts, they got a Gryffindor sweater. Albus pulled his over his head and smiled. âWhat sweater did you get this year, James?â
âScarlet with a gold Snitch,â James told Albus, âYou get the Gryffindor one?â
âYup.â Albus reached for his next present. It was from his Uncle George and Aunt Alicia. He opened it up and found a Skiving Snackbox. He grinned. He never had much use for these sweets before, but now that he was at Hogwarts, they would definitely come in handy. âWhatâd you get from Uncle George?â
âExtendable Ears,â James responded.
The next present was in the shape of a book. Albus knew it was from his Aunt Hermione before he even looked at the tag. When he unwrapped it, he found it was Hogwarts, A History. Albus laughed. James had gotten the same book last year.
âDid you get Hogwarts, A History?â James asked.
âYeah, howâd you know?â Albus sniggered. The next package was from his Uncle Ron, a box of Honeydukes sweets.
Albus reached into his pile of presents and found the one from his parents. It was a long rectangular box. Albus opened it and found a dragon skin wand cover. It was scarlet and embossed with gold lions. Albus stared at it in awe. He had seen one of these in Diagon Alley when he was there buying his school supplies. He had wanted it, but his dad had said no. It came with a small bottle of wand polish. âWhatâd you get from Mum and Dad?â
âHavenât opened theirs yet,â James said, âLemme find it.â Albus heard rustling from the bed above and ripping paper. Then silence. âWow! This is awesome! They got me a wand cover!â
âMe too!â Albus exclaimed, âWhatâs yours have on it?â
âSnitches! Itâs like my sweater, scarlet with gold Snitches.â
âMineâs scarlet with gold lions.â
âPretty impressive,â James said.
âYeah,â Albus agreed.
Albus continued opening his presents until there were none left. He got a lot of sweets and Weasleyâs Wizard Wheezes products. He also got a few books, including Quidditch in the Twentieth Century. But his favorite present was his wand cover, he kept staring at it. When Bradley, Cedric, Mark, and Ben woke up, they opened their own presents.
By the time the boys had all finished opening their presents, everyone else in the house was up. When they went downstairs they found Molly cooking breakfast. All the other adults were sitting around the table talking and having coffee and tea. The younger kids were running around playing with their presents. The older kids were all clustered around one of the armchairs in the living room. The boys went over to investigate.
âWhatâs going on over here?â James asked, while squeezing in between Stanley and Fred.
âGeorgiaâs gotten a new broom!â Fred exclaimed. âNewest model, a Firebolt 3000.â
âOh, wow!â James exclaimed, âCan I touch it?â
âSure,â Georgia was sitting in the armchiar, with her new broom resting on her lap. Everyone was admiring it.
âThis is so cool,â Heather gazed at the broom, âWait âtill the Slytherins see we have one of these on our team.â
âYeah!â Fred agreed, âSupposed to be the fastest broom yet. Just came out last week.â
âCan I fly it later?â James asked.
âYeah, sure, but I want to try it out first,â Georgia laughed, âWeâll go out after breakfast.â
âDo you know if anyone else has one at Hogwarts yet?â Bradley asked.
âNo, I donât think anyone else has one!â Georgia said.
âWow, wait âtill everyone finds out itâs my sister who got the first Firebolt 3000,â Bradley sighed, âBut I do wish I got one.â
âWell, I was riding a Nimbus 2000. Youâve got a regular Firebolt.â
âI know, but I hope I get one for my birthday.â
âBreakfast is ready!â Molly called into the room.
Everyone scrambled into the kitchen and got plates of food. There wasnât enough room at the table for everyone to eat at. The kids all went back into the living room to eat. Albus sat down next to Lily, who was playing with her new toys and eating at the same time.
âWhatâd you get, Lily?â Albus asked his sister.
âNew My Little Hippogriffs,â she told him, gesturing to her toys. âAnd a stuffed owl, which I named Hedwig. Some candy, a few fake wands, a sweater, some socks, a couple books, and a Gryffindor hat and scarf.â
âThatâs good,â Albus responded, as he started eating his eggs. Rose came and sat down next to Albus.
âHi, Rose. You get good presents?â
âYeah, I got a lot of books!â she told him.
âI got a few books. But the best thing is my new wand cover,â Albus grinned, âItâs upstairs, Iâll show it to you later.â
âWow, thatâs neat.â
âDid you see Georgiaâs new broom?â Albus asked, âIts only been out a week. Sheâs probably one of the first to get one.â
âYeah, I saw it. Itâs pretty impressive. You going to try it out?â
âDefinitely. Itâs got to be great to fly. Maybe Iâll be able to get a broom next summer. Iâm trying out for Chaser next year,â Albus told her.
âIâm sure youâll get it,â Rose told him as she ate her toast.
âI dunno. I mean, thereâs only one chaser position opening up next year. Samanthaâll be leaving. I bet Georgiaâll be made Captain.â
âProbably. Sheâs the next oldest. And sheâs a good leader,â Rose agreed.
âPlus sheâs got the best broomstick ever!â Albus said.
âTrue,â Rose said, âBut just because youâve got a good broom, doesnât mean youâre a good captain.â
âYeah, but Georgiaâs a great player. Her new broom will only make her better. Slytherin wonât stand a chance. I think weâre playing them shortly after we go back in January,â Albus told Rose. âYou gonna try out the broom?â
âProbably not. Iâm not very good and I wouldnât want to break it.â
âI doubt youâd crash it. Youâre an ok flyer,â Albus told her. âBut Iâm definitely trying it.â
âLetâs go play Quidditch!â Georgia stood up and held her broom over her head. Everyone who had been eating breakfast dropped their plates and either stormed up to the bedrooms to get their own brooms or ran out into the field that was used for Quidditch practice. Albus, since he did not own his own broomstick, went directly outside. Georgia had already ran out the door and was standing in the middle of the field, with a huge grin on her face.
âReady, Albus?â she asked.
âDefinitely! I canât wait!â he told her, and he looked over to the back door of the house. James, and everyone else who had their own broom had come out and were running over to the field.
âCan I try it after you?â Teddy shouted from behind everyone else.
âSure!â Georgia shouted back.
âThen me!â James waved his arms around.
âAnd me!â Fred screamed.
âMe!â Heather pushed her way in front of Fred, trying to block him.
âShut it!â Georgia shouted over the noise, âEveryone will get a turn! But right now, Iâm flying it!â Georgia mounted her broom and kicked off from the ground. The speed was amazing. She could make turns at top speed and brake seconds before she would have crashed into the ground.
âWow!â James screamed excitedly. âThatâs brilliant!â Everyone started talking at once and Albus was not able to make out anything. Georgia flew around the field for fifteen minutes before landing beside her siblings and cousins. She dismounted and handed the broom to Teddy.
âThanks!â Teddy grinned and changed his hair to red. He flew into the air did a series of spins and turns. He flew for about ten minutes and landed next to Georgia. âWow, I wish Iâd had that when I was Seeker, we never would have lost a match!â
âWe barely lost a match anyway,â Georgia laughed. She took the broom and handed it to James. For the next two hours, everyone took a turn on the broom. Even Rose got into the spirit of things and flew around for a few minutes. After everyone had had a turn, Georgia decided to organize a Quidditch match.
âOk, Iâll be captain of my team and Teddy can captain the other team,â Georgia decided. The two captains took turns picking their team and eventually their were two teams of six players each. As there werenât enough players for full teams, six players for each had to work. Georgiaâs team consisted of James, Bradley, Cedric, Stanley, and Gabriella. Teddyâs team consisted of Heather, Fred, Victoire, Ben, and Mark. Since Albus did not have a broom, he couldnât play. He and Rose watched from the sidelines, while the younger kids played in the snow nearby.
âThat was close last night, about the Shrieking Shack, I mean,â Albus whispered to Rose.
âI know,â she whispered back, âEveryoneâs suspicious about it. I hear people whispering about it sometimes in the Great Hall.â
âThat means Mattâs hearing it, too,â Albus groaned, âItâs got to be horrible for him.â
âDoes this mean you definitely believe heâs a werewolf, then?â Rose asked.
âIâm not totally convinced, but it does seem that way. I donât think Iâll be fully convinced until I hear him say so himself.â
âI suppose youâre right, but Iâm pretty sure of it,â Rose told him.
âHowâd you find out, anyway? How do you know so much about werewolves?â Albus asked.
âIâve read about them, of course. Once I found out that Teddyâs dad was a werewolf, I read all about them in Mum and Dadâs old school books,â Rose said.
âOh, yeah, that makes sense. You sure do read a lot.â
âI know,â Rose agreed, as she pulled her copy of Hogwarts, A History, out of her jacket.
âYou got that for Christmas, too?â Albus questioned.
âYup, itâs quite interesting. Iâm already on chapter three.â
âI havenât even started reading it yet.â
Rose laughed and opened up her book. Albus looked out towards the field and watched the rest of the Quidditch match. It was a pretty good match. Quite different than Hogwarts matches, though. There was no referee, so a few arguments erupted. After an hour or so, Teddy caught the Snitch and his team won. Albus and his cousins trooped back into the house, snowy, wet, and cold. It was almost time for Christmas supper, and Molly was cooking in the kitchen, with help from Ginny and Fleur. Albus ran up to the top bedroom and got out his new Quidditch book and read it until supper was ready.
Christmas supper was always an interesting event at the Burrow. The kitchen table was not big enough to seat everyone, so usually the younger children sat there, while the oldest kids and the adults found seats in the living room. There was always a lot of food, too. The food was kept in the kitchen and people got up to get some when they wanted it. As Albus was walking into the kitchen, he distinctly saw James sneaking around the living room doing something with one of the arm chairs.
Sure enough, after Albus sat down at the table and started eating his food, he heard a scream from the living room. He jumped up from his chair and followed his cousins into the room.
âWhat was that?!â Harry shouted, looking down at the chair he had been sitting in.
Molly came into the room and pushed past Albus. âJames Sirius Potter! What did you do?â
James looked sheepishly at her, âHow did you know it was me? You didnât see it happen.â
âI raised your Uncle George! I know a guilty look when I see one,â Molly screamed at him, âWhat did you do?â
âShocking Seat,â James explained, âItâs a little thing you hide on a chair and gives a mild electric shock to the person who sits in it.â
Harry started laughing, âAnd I suppose itâs from your shop, George?â
âYup, newest product. Just came out a few weeks ago. I got James a few for Christmas. Thought heâd like them,â George told him.
âIâd say he does like them,â Harry grinned, âJust donât use them on any teachers.â
âToo late. I just did,â James laughed. Everyone else started laughing as well, except Molly, who went back into the kitchen.
The rest of supper went by with only a few minor pranks. Someone snuck a Ton Tongue Toffee into Albusâs pudding and his tongue grew two feet before Harry found out and fixed it for him. A few glasses exploded and a few bowls of soup crashed to the ground, mostly because Stanley had just turned seventeen and wanted to use magic to bring things to the table for people. Eventually, everyone had enough to eat and they migrated into the living room. The adults had all had quite a bit of eggnog and fire whiskey and were not paying a whole lot of attention to the kids. This enabled Teddy and Victoire to sneak off into the kitchen, to be alone.
Albus and Rose decided to play Wizardâs Chess. Lily and Hugo sat down to watch. It didnât take Rose too long to beat Albus. Rose was very good at chess and she was much better than Albus. After that, the four of them played a few rounds of Exploding Snap, most of which Albus won.
Eventually, Molly decided it was time for everyone to go to bed. Albus climbed slowly up the stairs and got into his bunk. He was very tired. It had been a great Christmas. With his stomach full and his heart happy, Albus fell into a deep sleep.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Hope you liked it! I wrote this before Jo posted the Weasley/Potter family tree, so thatâs why I made up my own Weasley cousins. Although I did guess correctly that Jamesâs middle name is Sirius! I know itâs a bit confusing with the large amount of cousins I made up, so Iâll try and post a family tree with one of the upcoming chapters.
As always, thanks to Rain_is_Liquid_Moonlight, my other sister, and my bro. Thanks also to inkheart for their reviews. Please read and review!
Disclaimer- As usual, I do not own Harry Potter.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Boxing Day was usually a lazy day at the Burrow. Everyone slept late and ate whatever whenever they wanted. Albus awoke around noon, and found that a few of his aunts, uncles, and cousins were getting ready to leave. His Uncle George and Aunt Alicia and their kids were getting ready to leave to visit Aliciaâs parents. His Uncle Charlie and Aunt Katherine and their kids were also leaving to visit other family.
âBye, guys,â Albus waved as his Uncle Charlie stepped into the fireplace with Eddie.
âBye, Albus,â Charlie waved back, âHave a good time at school.â
Albus walked into the kitchen and found Rose sitting at the table reading Hogwarts, A History. Hugo was also there.
âMorning, Rose,â he said as he sat down next to her.
âHi,â she said, not looking up from her book.
Albus went to the counter and made some toast. Hugo got up from the table and ran into the living room. When Albus brought his breakfast back to the table, Rose had set her book down.
âGood, he left,â Rose whispered, âI want to talk to you about Matt.â
âWhat about him?â
âHis little âproblemâ,â Rose said, âListen, I went snooping around Grandpaâs study this morning while everyone was asleep. I want to do some more research about lycanthropy.â
âWell, did you find anything?â Albus asked eagerly.
âYeah, I did. I found a few books that have information in them. I took them and hid them in my trunk upstairs. Now that Heatherâs left to see her other grandparents, Iâve got my room to myself. We can go read them after weâre done eating.â
âSounds good,â Albus whispered back, âAnd weâve got to ask Uncle Bill about it too.â
âI know, Iâve thought of that too. Weâll ask tomorrow. Thereâll be less people. Uncle Bill, Aunt Fleur, Victoire, Gabriella, and Ben arenât leaving until day after tomorrow. Uncle Percy, Aunt Corrine, Georgia, Bradley, Cedric, and the twins are leaving tomorrow. I donât want to be overheard.â
âGood thinking,â Albus said as he took a bite out of his toast. At that moment, James, Cedric, Bradley, and Ben came in.
âWhat were you two talking about?â James asked, as he stole a piece of Albusâs toast.
âNothing,â Albus said abruptly.
James looked at him warily, âHmm, well, weâre going to go play Quidditch. You want to watch?â
Rose looked at Albus. âUm, no, me and Rose have, er, homework to do.â
James laughed. âThereâs plenty of time left to do homework. Oh, well, suit yourself.â Jame shoved the last bit of his toast into his mouth and he, Cedric, and Ben went outside.
âThat was close,â Rose whispered, âWe canât let anyone find out. Are you ready?â
âYeah,â Albus said as he got up from the table. Rose got up, too, and Albus followed her to the bedroom she stayed in. They went inside and Rose closed the door quietly. She went over to her trunk, pulled out a few heavy books, and dumped them on her bed.
âIf anyone bursts in and asks us what weâre doing, we say itâs homework,â Rose told Albus. She picked up a book and handed it to him. âHere you go. Just look through it and read anything you find about werewolves.â
Albus took the book and looked at it. It was entitled Modern Magical Remedies. He opened it to the index and looked for âwerewolfâ, but it wasnât there. However, âwolfsbaneâ was. There was a whole chapter on it. Albus turned to the chapter and briefly leafed through it. It was long and the print was very small. It was not the kind of reading Albus would normally do, but his curiosity about Mattâs condition triumphed over his dislike of tedious reading. Albus and Rose read for close to two hours. In the time it took Albus to read about the Wolfsbane potion, Rose had gone through two of the other books.
âWell, what did you find?â Rose asked once Albus had finished his chapter. She looked a bit pale and kind of scared.
âLoads, how about you?â Albus told her, âAre you okay?â
âYeah, I guess,â Rose whispered, âItâs just, the other books Iâve read didnât really go over what itâs like to transform. These did. Oh, Albus, it sounds horrible! Really dreadful! And painful. I just feel so bad for Matt, if that is whatâs going on. Apparently, when a werewolf is in wolf form, they must bite other animals or people. Theyâre not in their human mind, they donât know what theyâre doing! And if thereâs no other animals or people to bite, they bite themselves. That must be where Matt got all those cuts and bruises from. Heâs doing it to himself.â
Albus stared at her with his mouth open, âThatâs horrible! Thereâs got to be something someone could do! Healers or someone must know a cure or something.â
âThereâs not. Thereâs no cure for lycanthropy. Just the Wolfsbane potion,â Rose told him.
âOh, yeah,â Albus had momentarily forgotten what he had been reading about, âThe Wolfsbane potion does work. If a werewolf takes it every night a few nights prior to transformation, they will transform, but will be harmless to themselves and other people. Itâs really complicated to make, but apparently it makes the transformations loads better.â
âBut why doesnât Matt take it then?â Rose wondered.
âI dunno. I guess the only way weâd find out is to ask him,â Albus told her.
âSo you believe me, then? Youâre convinced heâs a werewolf?â Rose asked.
âYou know, I think so. I guess Iâm still not positive, but Iâm as convinced as I could be without him actually telling me.â
Rose got up from the bed. âI guess weâve learned everything we can from these books. Iâll sneak them back early tomorrow morning.â She picked up all the books and put them back into her trunk.
âI think Iâll go see what everyone else is up to,â Albus got up from the floor and opened the door, âYou coming?â
âYeah, sure,â Rose followed Albus out the door.
The cousins walked down the stairs from Roseâs room. The house was very quiet. Most of their cousins were outside playing Quidditch or in their rooms enjoying their presents. Since two of the families had already left, it was quite a bit calmer. As Albus and Rose strode past the kitchen, Albus stopped short. Rose bumped into him.
âOuch!â she screeched as she bumped her head on his back.
âShush!â Albus whispered as he pressed his head to the door of the kitchen, âI heard someone say my name.â
Rose leaned her head against the door as well and the two of them tried to listen for a minute or so. âItâs no use! Theyâre whispering. I canât hear anything.â
âMe neither, but I swear one of them mentioned me!â Albus listened again, âIâm pretty sure itâs my mum and dad, and your dad as well.â
The front door banged open and James, Cedric, Ben, and Bradley stormed in, dropping their brooms on the floor. âItâs bloody freezing out there!â James shouted as he tore off his gloves and scarf.
âAnd someoneâs locked the kitchen door!â Cedric added, as he pulled off his frozen hat.
âShush!â Albus shouted back.
âWhat?â James asked as he came rushing over, followed by Cedric, Ben, and Bradley.
âThe kitchenâs locked because some of the adults are in there talking about me!â Albus whispered back.
âReally?â James looked at him curiously, âWhat about?â
âI dunno!â Albus whispered back, âI canât hear them, theyâre being real quiet.â
James thought for a moment, and then a grin appeared on his face. âTime to break out one of my Christmas presents.â
âThatâs right!â Albus said excitedly, âYou got Extendable Ears for Christmas!â
âYep, sure did Iâll go get them!â James announced, and then he ran upstairs. He appeared a minute later holding a blue box with a large ear pictured on it. âHere they are.â James tore open the packaging and pulled out seven fleshy tubes. He handed one to everybody and stowed the extra in his pocket.
Albus hastily pushed one end of the Extendable Ear into his own ear and sent the other end to the bottom of the door. Albus had used Extendables once before, when his cousin Gabriella had bought some at Hogsmeade and let Albus try them out. That was two years ago, and he hadnât heard anything interesting. Gabriella had bought them in order to listen in on Victoireâs conversations with her friend who had stayed for Christmas break. Victoire only talked about how much she liked Teddy, and Albus found that rather boring. This time, however, Albus was sure heâd hear more interesting conversations.
âIâm really not sure I should tell them,â Albus heard his dad say.
âI know,â his mother responded back, âIf someone invading thieir minds, itâs best they did not know right now.â
âI mean, I hadnât really thought about when I was going to tell them,â Harry responded, âI guess I was planning on doing it when they were much older. I worry about what they would do with the information. James especially.â
James turned away from the door and looked at Albus. âTheyâre talking about me, too!â
âI know, shush!â Albus said as he turned his attention back to the conversation in the kitchen.
âI honestly would only trust Rose with the information, Harry,â Ginny told her husband.
This time it was Roseâs turn to look at Albus. âMe, too! But whatever it is, they trust me.â Rose couldnât help but grin as she turned back to the door.
âI donât want her to know, given the current circumstances,â Ron said.
âMe neither,â Hermione agreed.
âI know, but it seems as if whoeverâs doing it is focusing on James and Albus,â Harry informed them. âI was always leery about telling them, but especially nowâŠâ
âHarry, we didnât even tell my brothers,â Ron said, âWhy are you worrying about telling the kids?â
âPart of me wants them to understand what we think is going on,â Harry went on, âBut the other part of me doesnât want them to know.â
âIâm siding with that part of you,â Ginny said, âWe shouldnât tell them.â
âEver?â Hermione asked tentatively, âI do think they should be trusted with that information at some point.â
âI agree, Hermione,â Harry told her, âBut not now. I guess Iâd just been waiting for the opportunity to present itself, havenât really thought about when Iâd tell them. I suppose the best thing to do would be to wait until theyâre out of school, theyâll be more mature and thereâll be less of a chance of it leaking out.â
âThat sounds reasonable, Harry,â Ginny agreed, âSomeday, weâll tell them about the Hallows. But right now I think we need to talk about whatâs been going on with-â
âJames, Bradley, Cedric, Benedict, Rose, and Albus, what on earth are you doing?!â a livid voice caused Albus to drop his Extendable Ear and he was not able to hear what his mum had been about to say.
Molly Weasley ran over to the five cousins, a look of rage on her face. âHave you been listening in on that conversation? Obviously you have! You have no right! Your parents wanted to be alone! And give me those!â
Albus, James, and their cousins did not even think about not listening to their grandmother and handed over their Ears at once. âAnd the other one?â She eyed Jamesâs pocket. Albus glanced at it and noticed the little bit of flesh sticking out of it. James sulkily pulled it out and handed it to her.
âIâll be having a word with your Uncle George! Heâs lucky heâs not here right now. He shouldnât be giving you those for Christmas, honestly, the nerve of himâŠâ Molly stormed over to her desk and grabbed a piece of parchment and a quill and started writing while she mumbled to herself. Albus knew she was going to send a Howler to her son.
The commotion outside the kitchen caused Harry, Ginny, Ron, and Hermione to cease their conversation and come out to see what the commotion was about. Once Albus heard the door start to open, he made a mad dash for the stairs, and the thundering behind him told him his brother and cousins did the same.
Albus didnât stop running until he made it to Roseâs room, and once James and their cousins were inside, he slammed the door shut.
âWhat was that all about?â Albus asked as he sat down on one of the beds.
âI dunno,â James responded, âThey obviously know something we donât and they donât want to tell us about it. But what did they mean by they didnât want me to know about it especially?â James stomped back and forth across the floor, obviously mad that his parents wouldnât trust him with something.
âWell, thatâs not the only reason theyâre keeping it from us!â Rose argued, âThey said they trust me, but still wonât tell me.â
âMust be something really secretive because only your parents know about it,â Ben reasoned. âI suppose Bradley, Cedric, and I wonât ever find out.â
âYeah, you will!â James insisted as he threw himself onto a bed, âOnce I find out, Iâll tell you!â
âJames!â Rose shouted, âThat must be why they wonât tell you right now! They donât want anybody to know. If itâs something so secretive that they wonât even tell any of our uncles, then they must not want a whole lot of people to know.â
âBut what would my parents, Aunt Hermione, and Uncle Ron know that none of the other aunts and uncles know about?â Albus asked Rose.
âI dunno,â Rose answered. The five of them sat in silence for a few minutes, trying to think of what this could be.
âYou donât thinkâŠâ James started, ââŠthat maybe it has something to do with the war?â
Albus looked at him, âBut Dad said he told us all about the war.â
âIt makes sense, Albus,â Rose told him, âWhat else besides the war do my parents and your parents have, but none of our aunts and uncles do?â
âBut my parents were involved in the war!â Cedric insisted.
âI know they were,â James said as he got up from the bed again and started pacing, âBut my dad and Roseâs parents were a lot more involved. They destroyed most of the horcruxes and they were off by themselves for almost a year doing it.â
âTrue,â Cedric agreed.
âWhatever it is, theyâre keeping something from us,â James told everyone as he pounded his fist on the night stand, âAnd I donât like it. Especially since Dad said he told us everything.â
âAnyone catch what they were talking about?â Bradley asked.
âYeah,â Albus responded, âHallows. Whatever they are.â
âNever heard of them,â James said.
âMe neither,â Cedric said. Bradley and Ben shook their heads. Albus looked expectantly at Rose. Whenever someone else didnât know about something, Rose always knew.
âIâve never heard anything about them either, Albus, Iâm sorry,â Rose sighed, âBut once weâre back in school, we can look in the library.â
âI guess,â Albus said, looking down at his feet. He did not like the idea of his parents keeping something from him. It made him feel betrayed. Harry had always told Albus that he told him everything about the war. But if these Hallows had anything to do with the war, like James suspected they did, then Harry and Ginny were keeping something from them. What were the Hallows? And why were his parents so intent about not letting him know about them? Why did they think he wasnât trustworthy enough to know about them?
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Sorry for the wait! I have been on vacation, so havenât been able to update. Hopefully, Iâll get my Weasley family tree up with the next chapter.
Thanks as usual to Rain_is_LIquid_Moonlight, my other sister, and my brother. Also thanks to inkheart, Ashley, Black Fires, and e.jones for their reviews!
Disclaimer- I do not own Harry Potter.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Chapter 15: Occlumency and Potions
By the time Albus woke up the next morning, his Uncle Percy, Aunt Corrine, and their kids had already left. Albus had not slept very well. Although he hadnât had any nightmares, Albus couldnât stop thinking about what his parents were keeping from him, and the thought had kept him tossing and turning almost the whole night. Once he fell asleep, he slept until it was nearly one oâclock in the afternoon. He never even had the chance to say goodbye to his aunt, uncle and cousins. However, he didnât have long to dwell on it because shortly after he had gotten dressed, James burst into the room.
âGood, youâre up,â James greeted him, as he sat down on one of the bottom bunks.
âYeah, Iâm up,â Albus yawned, âJust got up, couldnât sleep well last night.â
âMe, neither, but Cedric woke me up before he left. Tried to get you up, but you were out like a log.â
âWell, whatâs been going on? Do Mum and Dad know that we listened to them?â Albus asked.
âThey do. Grandma told them. Iâm never getting those Extendables back,â James groaned. âBut I donât think theyâre too bothered by it.â
âWell, thatâs good,â Albus told him, âBetter they donât know that weâre trying to find out what theyâre keeping from us.â
âDefinitely. Oh, but they do want to talk to us in a few minutes,â James informed Albus, âThey sent me up here to wake you up.â
âYou donât think they want to yell at us about listening in, do you?â Albus asked nervously.
âNo, I donât reckon thatâs what itâs about. They just want to talk to us. Not Rose,â James answered.
âThatâs odd. What else could they want?â Albus wondered.
âDunno,â James glanced at his watch. âWell, weâd better go. Theyâre waiting in the kitchen.â
Albus followed James slowly down the stairs. He had no idea what this could be about. For a moment, he thought that maybe his parents were going to tell them about whatever âHallowsâ were, but he knew that couldnât be it. They had seemed so adamant about not telling James, Albus, or Rose about them.
Albus made his way into the kitchen after James. His parents were in there, along with Uncle Ron and Aunt Hermione. Harry gestured for them to sit down. Albus sat down in one of the chairs and James sat next to him, neither of them saying a word. Harry went over to the door, closed it, and pointed his wand at it while muttering a spell. Albus figured it was some kind of spell that rendered Extendable Ears useless.
âFirst,â Harry told his sons, as he walked over and stood next to Ron, âI want to tell you that Iâm not punishing you for what you did yesterday. Both of you look like youâre sitting in a detention.â
Albus smiled a little, but James did not move.
âI would have done the same thing if I were you,â Harry grinned and continued, âWell, let me rephrase that. I have done the same thing you did. Plenty of times. Right after your uncles Fred and George invented Extendable Ears.â
Harry started pacing around the kitchen. Albus had noticed that his father did this whenever he was thinking about something serious. It was the same kind of pacing that James had done the previous day.
âHowever, what I do want to talk to you about is a serious matter,â Harry lowered his voice, âItâs about whatâs been going on in the school.â
Albus looked at James. Neither of them really knew what their dad was getting on about.
âJames, when you were in detention a few weeks ago and you said your head felt funny. Madam Pomfrey had the suspicion that someone was using Legilimency against you. I think she was right. Well, Iâm sure she was right. The way you described it is just like how it feels,â Harry told his son, âJames, someone is trying to invade your mind.â
James looked shocked. Albus noticed he was a bit paler than usual. He looked very much the same as he did in the days following that detention. Albus guessed that the days at the Burrow had made James forget about that awful experience.
âAlbus, about that dream-â Harry started, but was cut off.
âYou said it didnât mean anything!â Albus reminded his dad.
âI thought that it didnât, until I started having the same one,â Harry informed them, âI talked to your Uncle Ron about it and we both agree that theyâre not normal dreams. Someone is using Legilimency on us as well.â
Albus felt the blood drain from his face and he was sure he looked as pale as James did. âBut whoâs doing it?â he whispered.
âI honestly donât know, Al,â Harry softened his voice and sat down next to his son. âBut your Uncle Ron and I are trying very hard to find out who it is.â
âWhy does someone want to read our minds?â Albus asked his dad.
âI, have a few ideas,â Harry answered slowly, âBut Iâm afraid I canât tell you just yet.â
Albus nodded. It was strange that his dad couldnât just solve this problem. During Albusâs younger childhood years, Harry had always been able to fix everything for him. Broken toys, minor injuries, his dad was always there to solve the problems. But this time, Harry couldnât just wave his wand and make it better.
Harry drew Albus into his arms. âNow, Al, I do need to know if youâve had anymore of those nightmares since that first one.â
âYeah, I have. I get them a few times a week.â
âAlways the same one?â Harry asked.
âYes.â
âAnd have you had any while youâve been at the Burrow?â
Albus thought for a moment. âYou know, I havenât. I hadnât really thought about it, but I havenât had any since I left Hogwarts.â
Harry glanced at Ron and got up from the chair. âI think thatâs all I need to know about the dreams for now. But if they start changing at all, youâve got to let me know right away. Just ask one of the portraits in the common room to find me. Donât leave the common room to tell me, itâs very important that you do not wander around at night.â
Harry started pacing again and he turned to face James. âAre you ok? I know itâs a scary thought, that someoneâs invading your mind. But I will find out whoâs doing it. I donât want you to worry about it too much.â
James just nodded, apparently still unable to speak.
âGood. Now, itâs obviously very disturbing that someone is trying to see our thoughts and memories. Ron and I, as well as a few other Aurors are working to figure out who it is and why theyâre doing it, so we can stop them. But for now, you two have to learn how to protect yourselves.
âRon and I have decided that you should start to learn Occlumency. I know you both already know what that is, but neither of you have had any training in the subject. If youâre able to learn it properly, then no one will be able to read your thoughts.â
âAre you going to teach us, Dad?â James spoke for the first time since he entered the room.
âNo, I canât,â Harry told him, âIâm not a very good Occlumens and am having a hard enough time trying to close my own mind, let alone trying to teach you two.â
âThen whoâs going to teach us?â James asked, with a worried look on his face. He and Albus looked at each other. Harry had told them the stories of when Professor Snape had tried to teach him Occlumency in his fifth year.
âDonât worry,â Harry reassured them, seeing the looks on their faces, âI know from experience that in order to learn Occlumency properly, itâs much better if you trust your teacher. Thatâs why your Aunt Hermione will be teaching you.â
Albus breathed a sigh of relief. Although his Aunt Hermione was strict, he knew she would be able to teach him well. There was hardly an aspect of magic that she did not do well.
âIâll be coming to Hogwarts two nights a week until you are both capable of protecting your minds from intruders,â Hermione informed them.
James opened his mouth and was about to speak when Hermione cut him off. âNot to worry, James, it wonât interfere with Quidditch practice! I know Quidditch is the most important thing in this family.â She glared at Harry and Ron, who both grinned sheepishly.
âIâll send an owl to the school once the first lesson is set up, telling you which classroom it will be in. We still need to run this by the Headmaster, but Iâm sure he will not mind,â Hermione informed them.
âWell, I think thatâs it, boys,â Harry strode back over to James and Albus and gave them each a hug. âI donât want you to worry about this too much. Your Uncle Ron and I have things under control. Just concentrate on learning Occlumency. Try to keep your guard up, as well. Constant vigilance, as Mad-Eye would have said. Iâve got to run into the Auror office for a few hours, but Iâll be back before dinner.â
When Harry opened the door to the kitchen, Rose fell into the room. She had been leaning on the door, trying to listen in. She stood up, blushing furiously and ran out of the room and up the stairs. James and Albus burst out laughing and ran out of the room after her. They found her up in her room.
âSo, what was that about?â she asked eagerly, once Albus had shut the door behind him and James. âAny chance they told you what theyâre trying to keep from us?â
âNo,â James said bitterly, it was obvious to Albus that he was still mad about that.
âWell, what was it then?â Rose pushed.
âRemember that detention that me, James, Matt, and John had to do with Washburn? The one where we cleaned the hourglasses in the Entrance Hall?â Albus asked.
âYeah,â Rose said warily.
âWell, someone tried to read Jamesâs mind during it. And someoneâs been trying to read my mind and Dadâs while weâre sleeping, too. Iâve been having weird dreams ever since school started, and apparently they mean someoneâs using Legilimency on me.â
Rose stared at him, then she glanced at James, who had sat down on Roseâs bed. âYouâre serious?â
âYep,â James confirmed, âAnd Dad wants me and Albus to learn Occlumency to try and stop them. I get the feeling somethingâs happening. Iâm not sure what, but all the adults seemed a bit worried when they were telling us this. Dad doesnât know whoâs doing it or why. Well, he has an idea why, but he wonât tell us. Figures.â James punched one of the pillows. âI guess Iâm not trustworthy.â
âWhoâs teaching you?â Rose asked.
âYour mum,â Albus answered. âSheâs coming to the castle two nights a week as soon as everythingâs straightened out with Professor Kendrick.â
âWell, thatâs good, then. I hope you two are good at Occlumency,â Rose said, âBut do you two get the feeling this whole mind reading thing might have something to do with what theyâre keeping from us?â
âSeems likely,â Albus agreed.
James nodded. âWeâve got to figure out what theyâre keeping from us. Weâll start once weâre back at school. And I donât think we should tell anyone what weâre doing, since Dadâs teaching there. I donât think heâd be too happy if he found out what weâre up to.â
âI suppose youâre right,â Rose responded.
âYeah,â Albus said. He didnât like the idea of keeping something this big from John, Matt, and Amanda, but he could see Jamesâs point. Their father didnât want them to know about whatever this is, and if he found out they were looking, it would make it harder to discover the secret.
âJames!â a voice shouted from downstairs, âCome help with dinner, please! Iâve got Ben cutting up vegetables and you can help him!â
James got up and went over to the door, âAw, Mum! Why canât Teddy do it? He can do it by magic and itâd go faster!â
âTeddyâs helping Victoire study! Now get down here, please!â Ginny screamed back.
James snorted and looked at Albus and Rose, who were giggling. They were sure that Teddy and Victoire were not studying, but were in fact hiding away somewhere, snogging.
âJames!â his mother shrieked.
James stomped out of the room and down the stairs, muttering something about Muggle cooking.
Rose got up from the bed and shut the door behind James. She turned back to Albus. âOk, weâve got to ask Uncle Bill what he knows about werewolves tonight after dinner.â
âYeah, we should. Heâs leaving tomorrow. Do you really think he knows something that we havenât already read in the books?â Albus asked.
âIâm not sure. But what I want to know is why someone wouldnât take the Wolfsbane potion or why it wouldnât work,â Rose told Albus as she sat down next to him.
âGood idea. The book I read didnât mention anything like that. But if Mattâs a werewolf, then heâs definitely not taking that potion every month.â
âOr itâs not working for him,â Rose suggested.
âYeah, that too. But what are we going to tell Uncle Bill when he asks why we want to know about the Wolfsbane potion?â
âIâve got it taken care of,â Rose told him, âIâll tell him that Professor Slughorn gave us extra credit to research an advanced potion. And weâll say that Slughorn let us do it in groups of two and youâre my partner.â
âWow! Thatâs good thinking, Rose,â Albus said excitedly, âIâd never be able to come up with that.â
âIt just came to me last night. I knew weâd need an excuse because we donât learn about werewolves until third year.â
âRose! Albus! I need your help for dinner, please!â Ginny screamed up the stairs.
âAlright, Mum!â Albus answered, âWeâll be right there!â He and Rose went downstairs, where they were immediately put to work slicing bread.
*****
Supper was late that night, and not nearly as enjoyable as Christmas supper. Everyone wanted to wait until Harry returned from the Auror office to eat, and he did not get back until nearly eight oâclock. Once Harry walked in the door, everyone sat down and started eating.
âIâve got some bad news,â Harry announced as he poured some butterbeer for himself. Everyone stopped eating and looked at him. âSomeone was found dead this morning in their house. Jasmine Lomski. She worked in the Magical Law Enforcement Office. Avada Kedavra was the cause of death. Itâs looking very suspicious. Iâve got someone investigating, but so far nothingâs been found.â
âLomski?â Ben asked, his face was white. He was looking at James, whose face was equally pale. âThereâs a girl in our class, a Ravenclaw, Rachael Lomski. Are they related?â
Harry nodded, âYes, thatâs her mother. Jasmineâs husband, Connor, was taking Rachael and the other kids to see their grandparents for Christmas, so they were not home at the time. Jasmine did not go with them because she had to work tomorrow.
âBut I want everyone to know that the other Aurors and I are doing all we can to find out who did this, and who killed Professor Torro, and hopefully weâll be able to arrest whoever did it soon.â
âYou think the two murders are related, then?â Arthur asked.
âI really canât be sure yet, but I do have a feeling they are,â Harry answered.
The rest of the meal was spent discussing the suspicious killings, and no one really had much of an appetite anymore. Hugo and Lily did not pay much attention to the conversation, and after they finished eating they ran off to play with their Christmas presents. Albus mostly pushed his food around his plate. He couldnât help but wonder if the mysterious killings had something to do with his strange dreams. James seemed to be worried, as well. He was also not eating, and his face had not regained any color since their dadâs announcement. Ben and Rose werenât eating either, although they looked less worried than James did. Teddy, Victoire and Gabriella spent much of the meal whispering to each other with worried looks on their faces.
After everyone had eaten whatever they could, Bill excused himself to the kitchen to get a cup of tea. Rose glanced at Albus and they both got up and followed him.
âUm, Uncle Bill?â Rose asked tentatively, âI was wondering if Albus and I could talk to you, er, in private?â
âSureâŠâ Bill answered warily, he was obviously wondering what they were up to. âLetâs go into your grandpaâs study.â
Grandpa Weasleyâs study was always an interesting place to visit. It was filled with all sorts of muggle devices that were in various states of disrepair. When Albus walked into the room, the first thing he noticed was the broken computer sitting on the desk. That had been a present from Albusâs Aunt Hermione. Hermioneâs parents had recently gotten a new computer and Hermione was able to get their old one to give to Arthur. He had been thrilled and had spent much of the holiday taking it apart.
âSo, what can I help you with, Rose?â Bill asked.
âWell, um, I was wondering if you knew anything about the Wolfsbane potion,â Rose told him.
Bill spat out the mouthful of tea that was in his mouth. âWolfsbane potion? Well, I do know a bit about that. But why do you need to know about it?â
âWeâre doing an extra credit essay for Slughorn on advanced potions. We picked the Wolfsbane potion. Now, weâve learned a bit about it from books, but Iâve got a few other questions,â Rose said.
âSure, go ahead and ask,â Bill sat down in Arthurâs chair and put his feet up on the desk.
Rose and Albus sat down in two other chairs. âI guess I was wondering if thereâs ever been a case where the Wolfsbane potion hasnât worked?â Rose asked.
âItâs rare,â Bill told them, âBut not unheard of. There have been a few people that the potion hasnât worked on. Itâs hard to know for sure how many because there arenât a whole lot of werewolves to begin with anyway. And many do not report how the potion works for them.â
âOk,â Rose said, while she pretended to take notes on a piece of parchment, âWhy wouldnât it work? Or why wouldnât someone take it?â
âA few werewolves have been allergic to the potion, or to one of the ingredients in it, so thatâs why it doesnât work for some. And theyâd obviously stop taking it if that happened. Thereâs also a fairly new study about the affects of emotions on the potion. A few people have reported that the potion does not always work well, depending on what kind of mood the person is at the time of transformation. Which makes sense, since the nature of the transformation depends on emotions as well. Then thereâs a second study thatâs trying to figure out why the potion just doesnât work. There are a few werewolves where it has no effect whatsoever. As far as why someone wouldnât take it, itâs a very difficult potion to make. Not many people are able to make it. Because of that, itâs hard to obtain it.â
âOh,â Rose looked up from her parchment, âI think thatâs all I need to know for now. Iâve gotten loads of information from books. Albus and I should be able to write the report now.â
Bill got up from his chair, âGood. Glad I could help.â He walked quickly out the door, Albus guessed he wanted to get back to the discussion about Jasmine Lomskiâs murder.
Albus and Rose left the room and went back up to Roseâs bedroom. âWell, what do you think?â Rose asked Albus.
âI dunno. Maybe heâs not able to get the potion?â
âOr heâs allergic to it,â Rose suggested.
âBut what about that whole emotions affecting the potion thing?â Albus asked.
âIâm not sure. Do you remember what Mattâs been like every time heâs gotten sick?â
âNo. I mean, usually heâs tired, but thatâs not really emotion. Iâd assume heâs nervous about it, but I bet all werewolves are nervous about transforming.â
âProbably. I guess weâre just going to have to keep watching him,â Rose told Albus.
âI suppose. I wish heâd just tell us.â
âHeâs probably afraid to. Afraid we wonât be friends with him anymore,â Rose said in a pained voice.
âWell, thatâs not true! Weâd never abandon him like that!â
âI know, Albus,â Rose sighed, âI just wish there was a way to let him know that.â
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Weasley-Potter Family Tree
Bill-Fleur Charlie-Katherine (witch) Percy-Corrine (Muggle)
Victoire, 7th year Stanley, 6th year Georgia, 5th year
Gabriella, 5th year Heather, 4th year Bradley, 3rd year
Ben, 2nd year Mark, 3rd year Cedric, 2nd year
Eddie, 5 years old Samantha & Lindy (twins), 6 years old
George-Alicia Spinnet Ron-Hermione Ginny-Harry
Fred, 4th year Rose, 1st year James, 2nd year
Angie, 8 years old Hugo, 9 years old Albus, 1st year
Lily, 9 years old
*all in Gryffindor*
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: I hope you liked it! My Weaslye-Potter family tree is above. I hope it helps clear up any confusion. I put Ron & Ginny in there even though I donât own their kids. I thought it would be more complete that way. Any similarities between the above (besides Ron & Ginnyâs families, obviously) are merely a coincidence.
Thanks as always to Rain_is_Liquid_Moonlight, my other sister, and my brother. Thanks to inkheart for their review. Please read & review!
Disclaimer- I do not own Harry Potter. Nor do I own Nintendo, the Nintendo DS, or Animal Crossing.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Before Albus knew it, the Christmas holiday was over. The rest of the break was not nearly as eventful as the first few days. The day after Harry came home with the news of Jasmine Lomskiâs death, Bill, Fleur, Ron, Hermione, and the rest of Albusâs cousins left to visit other family. Life at the Burrow became much calmer. James and Albus spent much of their time playing Quidditch outside. Harry had let Albus use his broomstick. James was able to help Albus practice his skills as a Chaser, and seemed pretty confident by the end of the holiday that Albus would make the team next year. Whenever Teddy wasnât working at Weasleyâs Wizard Wheezes, he visited and played Quidditch with James and Albus. Lily often hung around while the games were taking place and would beg the boys to let her have a go on one of the brooms. Occasionally, one of them would take pity on her and lend her their broom. Eventually, James and Albus realized that they had neglected their homework long enough and had to spend the whole last day of break working on it. It took them much longer than usual, as they did not have Rose there to help.
Harry spent much of the last few days of break popping in and out of the Auror office. He left early in the day and came back late in the evening. He always came home looking tired, and Albus could tell that the investigation was not going well. His mum, grandma, and grandpa, seemed worried as well, although they tried not to mention details in front of the children. James and Albus had tried repeatedly to listen in on their conversations, but Molly was much more watchful of them ever since she caught them using Extendable Ears. She had a hard time keeping Teddy out of the conversations, though, because he was of age and out of school. However, Molly prevented Teddy from giving any information to James or Albus.
On his way back to Hogwarts, Albus found himself wandering down the corridor in the Hogwarts Express with Rose, yet again looking for a compartment. Only this time, he was in search of a specific one, the one that John, Matt, and Amanda were in.
About halfway down the train, Albus and Rose spotted their friends in one of the compartments. There was another girl in it, too. Albus recognized her as Mattâs older sister, Amy.
âHi!â Albus grinned at his friends as he entered the compartment and sat down next to John.
âHi,â everyone greeted him and Rose.
âSo, how was everyoneâs holiday?â Rose asked.
âGreat!â John smiled widely, âGot a good load of presents. All my relatives were there at some point or another. Saved all my homework for yesterday, but somehow managed to get it done.â
âMine was nice, too,â Amanda answered, as she reached into her bag, âBut Iâve got to show you guys something.â She pulled out a small, rectangular object and opened it to reveal two screens, one above the other.
âWhat the bloody hell is that?â John asked, gaping at it.
âItâs called a Nintendo DS,â Amanda answered, âI got it for Hannukah. Itâs something you play video games on.â
âOh, Iâve heard of video games,â John said, âBut Iâve never seen one before. Do you have any games for it?â
âIâve got a few,â Amanda told him, âMy favorite is Animal Crossing. You get to make your own town and animals are your neighbors. Iâve named my town Hogsmeade.â
âAwesome,â Matt smiled. âI got one of those a while ago.â
âI hate to tell you, but thatâs not going to work at Hogwarts,â Rose announced.
âWhy not?â John looked at her like she was crazy.
âToo much magic around. Makes electronics not work right,â Rose explained, âItâs in Hogwarts, A History.â
âOh,â Amandaâs smile faded as she put her DS away, âI guess Iâll just have to play it at home over the summer. My parents thought I would like it and itâs pretty fun. They werenât really sure what to get me. They couldnât get me anything to do with magic. It was quite strange, really, not being able to talk much about magic during break..â
âAnd how was your holiday, Matt?â Rose asked.
Albus turned to look at Matt. He was just now noticing how tired he looked. He also had some nasty looking partially healed cuts all over his face and arms. His arms were bruised as well, and he looked like he was about ready to fall asleep. Albus and Rose exchanged glances, but didnât say anything.
âIt stunk,â Matt said flatly. He looked at his sister, who gave him a look.
âWhy?â John asked.
âWell, I told you how I hate going to Australia. We spent the whole break there, at my grandparents house. Theyâre so formal, I couldnât do anything fun.â
âHowâd you get all those cuts?â John wondered, as he stared at a particularly nasty cut on Mattâs forearm.
Matt shifted his eyes and once again looked at Amy, who nodded her head. âI fell out of a tree.â
âWhat?!â John exclaimed, âHowâd you manage that?â
âWell, you know how clumsy I am. And I was outside, trying to have some fun, because my grandparents wonât let me do anything in the house. I was up pretty high and I slipped. I fell all the way to the ground, hitting every branch as I went. Got knocked out halfway down. My grandma heard the noise and ran outside and found me unconscious on the ground. She freaked out, saying this is why I needed to stay inside and do homework all day,â Matt informed them. Everyone was staring at him, unable to think of something to say. âAnyway, my mum and dad came rushing out, and I wound up spending a few days in the hospital down there.â
âWhoa,â Amanda whispered, âIâm glad youâre all right. Thatâs scary, though.â
âYeah,â John agreed, âIs that why youâre so tired?â
âNope, thatâs the jet lag,â Matt answered.
âThe what?â
âJet lag,â Matt repeated, âItâs what you get when you fly to different time zones. Your sleep gets all messed up.â
âYou flew to Australia?â Albus looked amazed, âBlimey! Thatâs a long time to be on a broom.â
Matt laughed, âOh, no! We flew in an airplane.â
âWow!â John looked impressed, âBut why didnât you just Apparate or something? Or Flooed?â
âThe Australian Ministry doesnât allow out of country Apparition,â Amy said, speaking for the first time. âAnd our grandparents are Muggles, so we couldnât Floo.â
âThatâs pretty awesome,â Rose told Matt, âMy grandpa loves all things to do with Muggles. One of his lifeâs ambitions is to find out how airplanes stay up.â
Everyone laughed. The compartment door opened and Victoire walked in. âHi, Amy! Iâve been looking for you.â
âHey,â Amy greeted her, âWant to stay her with us?â
âSure,â Victoire sat down next to Amy. She glanced at Matt, who was leaning up against the window. âIs your brother ok?â
âYeah, heâs fine. He just fell out of a tree over break and spent a few days in the hospital. That and the jet lag are why heâs so tired,â Amy said quickly.
At that moment, the compartment door opened again to reveal the person Albus wanted to see the least. A smug looking Quinton Willinson walked in and and shut the door behind him.
âSomething you want, Willinson?â Victoire stood up and stared at him.
âOh, just a word with your cousin,â Willinson glared at Albus, âMind if we speak in private?â
âYes, as a matter of fact, I do,â Victoire growled, âWhatever it is, you can say it here, in front of all of us.â
âFine,â Willinson turned to Albus, âJust thought Iâd let you know that youâd better watch yourself, Potty.â
Victoire stepped between Albus and Willinson. âAnd why is that?â
âOh, you didnât know?â Willinson smiled at her, âBaby Potty here put that Exploding Eclair on my plate at Slughornâs party. Him and his little posse here.â
âHow dâyou figure that?â Victoire continued to stare at him.
âI just know,â he answered, âSo, youâd better watch out, Potty and friends.â
Amy got up and stood next to Victoire. âIs that a threat, Willinson? Because anyone who does anything to my little brother regrets it.â
âOh, maybe itâs a threat, maybe itâs not,â Willinson sneered at her, âBut I wouldnât worry too much about your baby brother. Looks like heâs got enough damage already. Looks like heâs been hit by a truck.â
In a span of five seconds, Amy had whipped out her wand and had Willinson pinned against the wall, holding her wand to his face. âDo not touch Matt, or you will learn to regret it. You understand? Do not do anything to him. I will find out, and you will wish youâd never even talked to him. Get it?â Amy let him go, but did not put her wand away.
âYou wouldnât try anything with the Head Girl here,â Willinson gestured to Victoire, as he pulled out his own wand.
âThis Head Girl does not care what Amy does to anyone, if they do anything to her family. And, I can add that if you do anything to my family, youâll regret it as well,â Victoire pulled out her own wand and pointed it at Willinson, âNow I suggest you get out, before weâre forced to hex you.â
Willinson, realizing defeat, scowled and put his wand away. He opened the compartment door and with one last glare at Albus, he left.
âWow,â Albus muttered, gazing at Victoire and Amy, âIâve never seen him back down before.â
âWhen youâve spent almost seven years in the same castle as him, you learn that he only does something when he has the upper hand. Heâd never try anything when there are a couple people up against him. Especially people who are better witches and wizards than he is. Heâs really quite stupid, honestly. He brags, but I donât think heâd win a duel against anyone above third year,â Victoire told them.
âEvery year, he picks a new first year to torment. Weâve never been able to figure out why he picks the one he does. Usually itâs the smallest or most frightened one. Iâve got no idea why heâs picked you, Albus,â Victoire continued, âHe was picked on a lot when he was a first year. Ever since then, heâs done the same thing to other first years. Itâs pretty low, if you ask me. If heâs got to torment someone, he ought to do it to someone closer to his age.
âItâs because he canât win a duel with someone his own age. If he tried anything with anyone in our class, heâd be hexed so much you couldnât recognize him. But anyway, I would not put it past him to try something on you, Albus. Just make sure youâre never alone in the corridors and youâll be fine. He wonât try anything where thereâd be witnesses or someone to stop him.â
Amy nodded in agreement, âSame with you, Matt,â she looked at her brother, but heâd fallen asleep. âAnd probably the rest of you, too.â
Albus nodded, âWhoâd he pick on last year?â
âJames,â Victoire said, âBut after James pulled a few pranks on him, he gave up. It was quite funny, really. He tried picking on Ben after that, but I stopped him.â
âHow?â Rose asked.
âHeâs got this weird crush on me. Has ever since second year. But Iâd never go out with him, of course. Heâs such a git. Actually asked me to go to Hogsmeade our third year,â Victoire laughed, âBut boy was he mad when I started going out with Teddy. Still hasnât given up. Somehow he thinks that with Teddy out of the castle, Iâll decide to go out with him.â
âItâs the Veela blood,â Amy told them.
âHeâs about the only one, though. Everyone else gave up once I started going out with Teddy.â
âWow,â Rose said, âI just thought he didnât like us for some reason.â
âWell, he doesnât. But I donât know why. Itâll be good for everyone when heâs gone next year,â Amy stated, âBut for now, just make sure youâre never alone in the corridors.â
*******
Once the new term started, Albus and his friends found themselves up to their ears in homework. The teachers had already started warning them about final exams, despite the fact that they were months away. It wasnât only the first years that were bombarded with work. It seemed that all the students had more work than normal. The common room often did not empty out until past midnight, with some students falling asleep in their reading. The fifth and seventh years were spending more time than everyone else studying, due to the fact that their O.W.L.s and N.E.W.T.s seemed much closer from this side of Christmas.
Albus and his friends tended to divide their time evenly between the common room and the library. They went wherever it was less crowded. Albus and Rose were finding it difficult to find time to research about whatever Hallows were, especially since they were rarely without John, Matt, and Amanda. Albus doubted whether James was getting any research in either, because Samantha Meyers had increased Quidditch practice to four nights a week due to the impending Gryffindor vs. Slytherin match.
One night, Albus and Rose did manage to find time to research because Matt, John, and Amanda were all doing detention with Filch. Filch had caught them dueling with Scorpius Malfoy and put all four of them in detention. The only reason Albus was not involved was because Harry had been speaking to Albus about his dreams. They had resumed once he was back in school, although they hadnât changed at all. Rose had been talking to Professor Patil about a homework she thought she had messed up on, but it turned out she had a gotten a 100% on it like usual. Albus had been trying to do a charms essay when Rose came up to him and asked him if he wanted to go research. Albus was all too eager, since his charms essay was not going very well. So, the two cousins made their way to the library.
âI suppose we could start by researching about the downfall of Voldemort,â Rose suggested as they browsed through the books, âSince weâre pretty sure it has something to do with that.â
âAll right,â Albus agreed, âThat makes sense.â Albus bent down and picked out a book, âThe Rise and Fall of Lord Voldemort, by Minerva McGonagall. Hmm, McGonagall, that sounds so familiar⊠Where have I heard that before?â
âProfessor McGonagall,â Rose reminded him, âShe taught Transfiguration when our parents were here, and our grandparents. She was in the last battle, so thatâd be a good book to look at.â
Albus took the book over to a table and started reading it. Rose found another book and sat down next to him. Albus decided just to start at the beginning, as he had no idea where Hallows would come into the picture. The first chapter was about Voldemortâs childhood. Albus already knew about that, so it was all basically review. But he read intently anyway, just hoping that heâd read the word âHallowsâ. However, as the evening wore on, and Albus grew steadily more tired, he did not find out anything new.
âFind anything yet?â he asked Rose.
Rose looked up from her book, which was entitled The History of the Dark Arts in Great Britain, âNo, nothing I donât already know. And no mention of any Hallows.â
Albus sighed, âMe either. Curfewâs soon. Why donât we just take the books out?â
âSounds good to me,â Rose agreed. She walked over to Madam Pince while Albus followed.
Madam Pince glared at them as they handed her the books. She read the names and gave them a strange look, like she was wondering why they wanted to read them. Albus didnât meet her gaze, but he knew why she was staring at them. Why would Harry Potterâs son need to read about the downfall of Voldemort? After she seemed satisfied with staring at them, she checked the books out and handed them back. âTheyâre due in a month. Do not write in them or bend them or injure them in any way.â
Once they were out of the library, they relaxed, âSheâs a nutter,â Albus whispered.
âSheâs a bit strange, yeah,â Rose agreed.
âActs like the books are gold,â Albus giggled.
âShe thinks weâre up to something, the way she stared at us like that,â Rose said.
âI know, but that makes sense.â
âYes, I suppose it does. I just hope she doesnât tell your dad,â Rose told him as she walked up a set of stairs.
âShe probably wonât. I donât think theyâre particularly close. Dad got in a trouble a few times at the library.â
Rose laughed, âOh, yeah.â
Albus and Rose continued their trek to the common room. Once there, Albus quickly went to the dormitory to hide his book before his friends came back from detention. But after an hour of waiting for them, Albus fell asleep. It was a restless sleep, as he had the same nightmare he usually had. Despite this, he did not wake up when John and Matt came in at midnight.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks as usual to Rain_is_Liquid_Moonlight, my other sister, and my brother! Please read and review.
I am not sure when Iâll next update, since I might be in school by the time this validates. I will try to update soon, but I canât make any guarantees. But Iâll still be writing! I am well into the sequel to this, Iâm on chapter 30, I believe. Iâm also working on another fic, details to come later, which I will start posting as soon as I get past a certain chapter in this. There are spoilers for this fic in my new one, so it will have to wait a little while to be posted.
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter. Or Ron Weasley. Or Hermione Granger. I donât even own the smallest owl in the owlery. Or the owlery for that matter. But I do enjoy writing this for fun!
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
âThat was brutal last night!â John groaned as he sat down next to Albus at breakfast the next morning. Albus had awoken early and couldnât get back to sleep. John and Matt were both sound asleep, so Albus had just gone down to breakfast with out them.
âIâll say,â Matt sat down on Albusâs other side and winced as he did so, âI ache all over.â Matt was just starting to get back to normal after his tree incident over break. In the few days after returning to school, he had walked very slowly and Albus could tell that he was sore. Albus had assumed he had gotten a few broken bones from the incident, but never asked, as Matt didnât seem too keen on discussing it.
âWhatâd he have you do?â Albus asked while he watched Matt rub his arm.
âClean Moaning Myrtleâs bathroom,â John answered as he piled his plate with eggs and bacon, âIt was torture. He had us do it the Muggle way of course. He had us doing it for 3 hours. We couldnât manage to get it clean the way he wanted it. And he made Matt scrub the floor, so he had to be down on his hands and knees the whole night. I could tell it was making his injuries from falling out of that tree hurt worse, so I suggested to Filch that I could do the floor and Matt could do the sinks, but Filch said no. He seemed to take delight in seeing Matt suffer. It was awful. Amanda had to do the toilets with Malfoy. He did something to one of them that made it regurgitate. That was gross. So she had to clean that one again and Matt had to re-scrub the floor.â
âMaybe you should see if Madam Pomfrey can do anything for you?â Albus asked Matt. Matt had only eaten a few bites of toast and was wincing every time he moved.
âYou know she doesnât do anything for pain induced by Muggle cleaning,â John said disgustedly.
âActually, I think I will go see her,â Matt mumbled and got up from the table, âIâll see you in Defense Against the Dark Arts.â
Once Matt left, John shook his head, âYou know she wonât do anything to help him.â
âI know, she probably wonât if he says the injuries are from cleaning. But she will if he says theyâre leftover from that whole tree thing,â Albus reasoned.
âHope so,â John agreed, âHe was worse last night when we were doing the detention. Filch was horrible to him, told him to scrub faster. And Malfoy smirked at him every time he looked over from his toilets.â
âI really donât like that Malfoy kid,â Amanda added. She had come into the Great Hall and sat down across from Albus. Rose sat down in Mattâs vacated seat.
âDetentionâs bad enough with Filch, but Malfoy kept muttering about Matt not even being able to Muggle clean. Filch didnât hear any of it.â
âUgh,â Rose groaned, âI hope Iâm never in detention with him.â
âYouâre never in detention,â Albus chimed in.
âI know. I never get caught,â she grinned. This was true. Albus knew she had pulled her fair share of pranks on the Slytherins, usually involving some kind of sweet from Weasleyâs Wizard Wheezes that turned various body parts into different colors. And there was no way anyone could pin it on her.
At that moment, the owls arrived with the mail. âLook, itâs Patches,â Rose announced as a large tawny owl arrived at Albusâs place. Patches was Roseâs familyâs owl. âHeâs got a letter for you and James.â
Albus called James over and the two of them looked at the letter. Albus opened it and read it silently.
Dear James and Albus,
I hope the new term is going well. I imagine you
spending much of your time studying. I have managed
to secure an empty classroom for our Occlumency
lessons. They will take place in the Transfiguration
room on Tuesday and Saturday evenings, at eight oâclock.
We will start this Saturday. Iâll see you then.
Say hi to Rose for me.
With Love,
Aunt Hermione
Albus looked at James, âWell, I guess weâll go on Saturday.â
âYeah, I suppose. Blimey, I canât imagine this is going to be fun,â James responded.
âProbably not. But itâs got to be better than the Occlumency lessons Dad had,â Albus reminded him.
âYeah,â James agreed, âWell, Iâm off to Potions. Iâll see ya later.â
âBye.â
âOcclumency, cool,â John said, âI wondered when youâd start those.â
Albus had told John, Matt, and Amanda all about the dreams and Legilimency shortly after they arrived back at the castle. âGuess weâre starting on Saturday.â
âWeâd better be off to DADA,â John reminded them. Albus got up and followed John out of the Hall, with Amanda and Rose following.
Matt never showed up in DADA. Albus doubted that he would because he looked pretty worn out at breakfast. Albus figured his dad must have known that Matt was in the Hospital Wing because he skipped right over his name during attendance. It was a good DADA lesson. They spent the majority of it practicing disarming each other. Albus and John had a good time doing so, as both of them were quite skilled with that particular spell. They were the few who were good at it. Most of the other students had a hard time with it, which was why Harry had them practicing it so often. He stressed that it was one of the most important spells to master. Amanda, in particular, was having a hard time with it, but she did manage to disarm Rose once during the lesson.
Charms, on the other hand, was another disaster. Professor Washbburn stormed into the room, and Albus immediately stopped talking. He was sitting at his usual back table with John, Rose, and Amanda.
Washburn quickly ran down the attendance list, stopping at Mattâs name. âWhereâs Eckerton?â he barked loudly. No one answered. âPotter! Whereâs Eckerton?â
âIn the Hospital Wing,â Albus whispered.
âSpeak louder!â Washburn screamed.
âI said heâs in the Hospital Wing, Sir,â Albus said.
âHeâs always in the Hospital Wing. Whatâs wrong with him this time?â Washburn muttered to himself.
Albus chose not to answer that question and he sat lower in his seat.
âWell, weâre going to have another attempt at levitation today,â Washburn growled, âBut weâre not levitating feathers this time. All of you who are somewhat skilled at this class have managed that already,â he glared towards the back table and his eyes rested on Albus. âYouâll be levitating books, so donât hit anyone with them. Go on, get started.â The class all took out their books and wands, while Washburn took his usual seat behind his desk and glared at them.
Albus reluctantly muttered the incantation and his book moved an inch off the desk and fell back again. He looked at John, Rose, and Amanda. After a few attempts, Rose had managed to levitate her book, although she received no praise from their professor. John was able to do it after a half hour of practice, not receiving any praise either. Amanda was having a bit more trouble, but was still doing better than Albus.
With ten minutes left in the class, Washburn started making his rounds to all the students, and much to Albusâs dismay, he stopped at his table.
âWell, Potter, letâs see if youâre better with books than feathers. Go ahead, levitate it,â Washburn sneered.
Albus muttered the spell quickly and his book managed to get a few inches off the table before falling back down.
âDo it again,â Washburn glared at him.
Albus did it again, this time making the book float a full foot off the table. Albus was so shocked that he jerked his wand and caused the book to start speeding towards one of the windows. Albus knew what was going to happen right before it did. The book flew right at the window, not stopping when it reached it, and soared straight through. The glass shattered and showered a few students with shards. They screamed as the glass cut their arms.
âPotter!â Washburn shouted, âMust you always make trouble in this class?!â
Albus did not say a word, he just stared down at his desk.
âDetention! Saturday night!â Washburn screamed, âYou,â he pointed at the students who were showered with glass, âGo to the Hospital Wing. The rest of you, class dismissed.â
âUm, Professor,â Albus whispered, âI canât do detention on Saturday night.â
âAnd why on Earth not?â Washburn seethed, âIâll decide when youâll do detention.â
âIâve got a meeting with my aunt.â
âYour aunt can wait.â
âNo, she canât. Iâm supposed to get, er, lessons from her,â Albus said, not wanting to reveal what the lessons were. âYou can ask the Headmaster.â
âFine. Iâll do that, then,â Washburn told him, âNow get out!â
Albus ran quickly out of the room and managed to catch up with his friends as they were entering the Great Hall for lunch. âThat was horrible.â
âI know,â John agreed.
âI hate charms,â Albus groaned as he sat down at the table, âI donât want to do that detention. Itâs gonna be worse now that heâs got to put it off until after Saturday.â
âHe definitely will,â Rose agreed, âHey! Matt, youâre back!â
Matt came over to the table, looking a bit better than he did that morning. âYeah, sorry I missed two lessons. I heard about what happened in Charms. That Washburnâs an idiot.â
âSo Madam Pomfrey actually helped?â John looked at Matt in awe.
âYeah, she did,â Matt told them, âAnd itâs a good thing. I donât think I could have gone to any classes today if she didnât.â
âBut why?â John asked, âDid you say the injuries were leftover from the fall?â
âNope,â Matt responded, âShe knew they were from detention. But she healed them anyway. I guess because I wasnât totally over the whole tree thing. She seemed pretty upset about the whole thing. Kept going on about how irresponsible Filch is and how he shouldnât have made me do all that cleaning. Said she was going to talk to the Headmaster about it and everything.â
âBlimey,â John looked at Matt warily, âIâve never seen her mad about injuries from Muggle cleaning before. Always says we bring it upon ourselves.â
Matt shrugged and piled his plate with food and started eating, not elaborating on his trip to the Hospital Wing.
Albus had a strange feeling that there was more to the tree story than Matt was letting on about. He could tell that Matt was trying to cover something up, and he couldnât help but think about the werewolf research that he and Rose had done over break. There had been a full moon over the holiday and Albus kept thinking that the tree story was just a cover up. He saw how Matt had looked at his sister before telling the story and he seemed a bit leery on telling it in the first place. As Albus started eating his lunch, he decided to watch Matt carefully around the time of the next full moon, which was in two weeks.
Double potions with the Slytherins was after lunch that day. Albus thought the class went pretty well. Slughorn lectured on the Shrinking Solution during the first half and the second half was spent attempting to make the potion. Albus was partnered with John, and although their potion was a shade lighter than the desired color, both boys thought they did pretty well.
âWhatâs that, Potty?â Scorpius Malfoy appeared behind Albus as he was putting his vial of Shrinking Solution on Slughornâs desk at the end of class.
âA potion, what else do you think it could be?â Albus answered flatly.
âLooks more like cat sick,â Malfoy laughed as he put his potion, which happened to be the perfect color, onto Slughornâs desk. âCanât even brew a simple Shrinking Solution.â
âAt least I can disarm someone, which is a whole lot more useful than making potions,â Albus retorted as he started to leave the room. Malfoy had extreme difficulty in disarming his partner during that morningâs DADA class.
âAs if Iâd try disarming if someone were attacking me,â Malfoy laughed. A few of his cronies giggled behind him. âA hex would work loads better.â
âYou know perfectly well that disarming works better than hexes, Malfoy,â Matt had caught up to them in the dungeon corridor, âProfessor Potter says that every time we practice disarming.â
âAnd I suppose youâre an expert on defense now, Eckerton? Judging by the way you looked last night, a five year old could beat you in a duel,â Malfoy sneered at him. âBy the way, rumor has it that Madam Pomfrey actually healed your injuries from last nightâs detention. That true?â
Matt froze and stared at Malfoy. âYeah, so?â he whispered.
Malfoy smirked, âAfter I heard that I went up to see if sheâd heal my injuries. My handâs been aching all day. She glared at me and told me if I should think about my hand the next time Iâm about to break the rules, then she shooed me out and said to get to class.â
âGood for you,â Matt answered.
âWell, why? Whyâd she heal you, but not me? Whatâs so special about you?â Malfoy asked.
âI dunno,â Matt glanced around at his friends.
âThereâs something weird about you,â Malfoy stepped towards Matt.
âWhy donât you just shut it?â John shouted and pulled out his wand.
âGonna rescue your friend, Brickston?â Malfoy pulled out his own wand, âOr maybe you could tell me why heâs always in the Hospital Wing.â
âDonât reckon I can,â John answered, âBut I could make sure you spend the rest of the day there, if you like.â
âOoo, gonna duel me?â Malfoy turned to John, âWell, I dunno whatâs up with Eckerton, but Iâm going to find out.â
âWhatâs going on here?â Amy came running up behind Malfoy, âWhat do you think youâre doing!?â she shouted at Malfoy, once she realized that his wand was still pointed at Matt.
âAh, Eckertonâs sister! Maybe sheâll tell me why Madam Pomfrey treats him special?â Malfoy grinned maliciously at Amy.
Amy stood between Malfoy and Matt and glared at Malfoy, âThatâs none of your business. And if you point your wand at him again, youâll regret it.â She turned around, threw her arm around Matt, and dragged him away towards the stairs.
âBelieve me, Iâll find out,â Malfoy smirked at John, put his wand away, and sauntered off towards the Slytherin common room.
âBlimey,â John said, once Malfoy was out of earshot, âHeâs mad.â
âYeah, he is,â Albus agreed, âHe knows somethingâs up with Matt, too. And I donât think heâs going to give up until he finds out.â
âWell, we canât let him find out, then,â John stated.
âBut we donât even know for sure!â Albus reminded him.
âTrue,â John shrugged, âBut I think weâre right. And Amyâs so protective of him. Did you see her face when Malfoy asked her to tell him?â
âShe was seething. Just like on the train after break,â Albus said, while starting to walk up the stairs to the Entrance Hall.
âWeâve got to find out for sure.â
âHeâll tell us what it is eventually,â Albus insisted, âHeâll realize that he can trust us.â
âThatâs the thing, I donât know if he will, especially if it is what we think it is,â John sighed.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Thanks as always to Rain_is_Liquid_Moonlight, my brother, and my other sister! Also thanks to inkheart for the review. Please read and review!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter, or anything related to it.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Albus and his friends spent the next few days trying to avoid Malfoy. It wasnât difficult since most of their spare time was spent in the common room doing homework. Matt was especially leery of Malfoy and made sure to hide behind John, who was a head taller than him, whenever they passed Malfoy in the halls. Despite this, Matt seemed to act like the confrontation with Malfoy had never happened, and did not appear to want to tell Albus or his other friends what his secret was. John did not seem surprised at this, but Albus had thought that maybe after what had happened with Malfoy, Matt might want to confide in someone. Amy also had started keeping a close eye on Matt after this event, which was odd because during fall term, she would often go a day or two without talking to Matt. Now it seemed that she was checking up on him at least once a day.
âHi, guys,â Amy greeted Albus and his friends on Saturday evening. Albus, John, Matt, Rose, and Amanda were all clustered around a table in the common room, working on various homework assignments. âWhatâs everyone up to?â
âHomework,â Matt groaned. He was working on a particularly difficult essay for Potions.
âWell, some of us are working on it,â Rose chimed in, glaring at John.
âWhat?â John smiled innocently, âIâve got all tomorrow to do it.â
Rose sighed, âYouâd do better to start it today.â
âI know,â John agreed, âBut right now Iâm enjoying watching you study, while I sit and do nothing.â Rose groaned and went back to her reading.
âSo,â Amy started, as she sat down next to Matt, âHow are you?â
âIâm fine,â Matt replied, âBut Iâd be better if youâd do this essay for me.â
âNot gonna happen,â Amy grinned, âIâm glad youâre doing good. Have you all been staying away from Willinson? He hasnât bothered any of you, has he? If he has, Iâll get Victoire to put him in his place.â
âNo,â Albus answered, âHavenât talked to him since the train. Strange, really.â
âWell, good,â Amy said, âHopefully itâll stay that way. But donât go alone anywhere. He doesnât give up this quickly.â
âWe know, Amy,â Matt snapped, âYouâre not our mum.â
Albus looked up from his work at the sound of the impending argument. He could have sworn he saw Mattâs eyes flash gold, but they were back to their usual blue within a second.
âJeez, Matt. Iâm just making sure he doesnât bother you. Mum said-â
âI know what Mum said!â Matt cut her off loudly.
âCould you please be a bit quieter?â Amanda asked in a frazzled tone.
âSorry,â Amy and Matt mumbled and continued arguing in softer voices.
Albus glanced over and saw that she was working on her astronomy charts. She had been having a tough time in astronomy all year. âNeed any help?â
âUgh,â Amanda groaned, âItâs astronomy. Iâm rubbish at it. Iâve been doing this chart for the past hour. Anyone know when the next full moon is?â
Both Amy and Matt jerked their heads toward Amanda. âTwo weeks from tonight. The 24th,â Matt whispered quickly, then looked back at Amy. Amy glared at him and they resumed their argument.
âUh, thanks,â Amanda looked cautiously at both Matt and Amy, and then started writing furiously on her chart.
Albus glanced across the table at Rose, who was already trying to catch his attention. The cousins looked at each other for a few seconds, and then quickly returned to their homework. Nobody said anything for a few minutes, with the exception of Amy and Matt, who were still arguing. However, they were doing so so quietly that Albus was unable to make out any of the words.
âBlimey!â James had walked over to the table and standing behind Rose. âWho died?â
âHuh?â Albus looked up from his work.
âYouâre so quiet!â James replied.
âOh, uh,â Albus glanced at Amy and Matt, âThey were arguing about something.â
âAh, sibling love, itâs a wonderful thing,â James grinned, âSo, you ready to get your mind read by Aunt Hermione?â
Albus looked up at the clock, it was quarter to eight, âBloody hell, I forgot about that!â
âGood thing I remembered,â James said.
âYeah,â Albus put his books into his bag and got up, âIâm ready.â
Rose got up as well, âIâm going too. I want to see Mum.â
âOk,â James turned around and started walking towards the entrance.
âGood luck,â John waved as Albus followed his brother. Amanda waved, but didnât look up from her work. Matt and Amy were too busy arguing to notice Albus and Rose leave.
Albus, James, and Rose left the common room to find a deserted corridor. âGood, no oneâs out here,â Rose whispered.
âWhy?â James asked.
âWanted to talk to you two alone about our, er, research,â Rose answered. âHave either of you found anything?â
âNope,â Albus told her, âIâve been reading bits of McGonagallâs book before I go to bed every night. Itâs the only time I can do it in secret. I just pull the hangings closed, and everyone thinks Iâm sleeping.â
âIâve been doing the same thing,â Rose revealed, âBut I havenât so much as read the word âHallowsâ.â
âEr, I havenât even found a book to read yet,â James confessed.
âWell, find one soon!â Rose scolded, âWeâve got to find out what our parents are hiding from us!â
âI know, I know,â James said.
âIâve read a couple so far, and Madam Pince keeps eying me when I check them out,â Rose told them, âBut Iâve got a feeling weâre not going to find anything in books.â
âReally?â James grinned, âAre you doubting books?â
âShut it, James,â Rose warned, âIâm going to start looking at the old Prophet articles they have in the library.â
âSounds good,â Albus said as they rounded the corner and walked towards the transfiguration room.
When they walked in, Hermione was standing near a stone basin that Albus recognized as the Pensive. Hermione was pulling thoughts out of her head with her wand and placing them into the basin. Albus wondered if maybe those thoughts had to do with what his parents were keeping from him. If only he could see the memories without Hermione knowing.
Hermione turned around when Albus shut the door behind them, âHi, boys!â she greeted.
âHi,â James and Albus said back.
âOh, and Rose, youâre here too!â Hermione walked over to her daughter and gave her a hug.
âHi, Mum!â
âHowâs term going?â Hermione asked.
âOh, pretty good,â Rose answered, âLoads of homework, but Iâm getting it done. Iâm afraid I lost a few points on the last Charms essay. I hope I didnât, though.â
âIâm sure you did fine on it,â Hermione reassured her. âHow about you two? How are your classes going?â
âAll right,â James replied, âBut Iâm afraid I lost more than just a few points on my last Charms essay.â James laughed.
âAnd Iâm not so sure you did fine on it,â Hermione responded, âAnd you, Albus?â
âOh, itâs going well, I suppose,â Albus told his aunt, âAnd Iâm afraid I completely failed the Charms essay.â
âDonât worry, Iâm sure you at least scraped a passing grade,â Hermione said.
âI dunno, Washburn hates me.â
âProfessor Washburn, and I donât think thatâs true,â Hermione told him, âBut thatâs not why weâre her tonight. Tonight, you will start learning Occlumency. Rose, are you staying?â
âCan I?â Rose asked, âIâve read a bit about Occlumency and it sounds very interesting.â
âOf course you can stay. I donât think I will have you do any practical work, but youâre welcome to learn the theory,â Hermione informed her.
âYou mean, weâre going to have reading to do?â James asked disgustedly.
âOf course,â Hermione laughed, âWhat did you expect?â
âI dunno, Dadâs Occlumency lessons were all practical,â James reminded her.
âI know, but I feel itâs better for you to learn the theory as well,â Hermione informed them, âNow, could you all sit down?â
Albus, James, and Rose all sat at the table closest to the teacherâs desk.
âGood, now Iâve got some books for you,â Hermione picked up two books and placed them in front of Albus and James, âRose, I didnât know youâd be studying this as well, so I donât have a book for you. You can look on with your cousins and if you decide to keep coming to our lessons then Iâll get you a book, too.â
Albus looked at his book. It was entitled, Legilimency and Occlumency: The Art of Seeing Othersâ Thoughts and Protecting Your Own Mind.
âCreative title,â James whispered and they both laughed.
âOpen the books to page five, please,â Hermione told them, âNow, as you are both aware, Legilimency is what is used to see into another personâs thoughts, or as some say, read their minds. When the spell, Legilimens, is used, a person can see into anotherâs thoughts. This can be done if the person getting the spell performed on is awake or asleep. When the person is awake, they feel an odd sensation in their head, kind of like a headache, but not exactly. They often also see their own memories. If the person is asleep, then they often have strange dreams or dreams about their memories.â
âHey, Voldemortâs in this book!â Rose exclaimed. Albus notice that she was leafing through the first chapter.
âYes, he is,â Hermione responded briskly, âLord Voldemort, although he was a horrible, evil person, was one of the most skilled Legilimens and Occlumens the Wizarding World has ever seen. He is a perfect example of why Legilimency and Occlumency are both very dangerous if used in the wrong way. Voldemort was able to tell exactly where his Death Eaters loyalties really lay, as well as keep others from knowing his innermost thoughts and secrets.â
Hermione continued her lecturing for a half hour, giving a brief overview of the first chapter. This chapter explained what Legilimency and Occlumency were and went over the basics needed to try Occlumency. James and Albus were expected to read the first chapter and answer a few questions before the next class.
âNow, for the next half hour, Iâd like to start the practical aspect of this lesson,â Hermione stood up and picked up her wand. âWho wants to go first?â
James and Albus looked at each other. âYouâre older, you go first,â Albus told his brother.
âAll right,â James stood up and pointed his wand at his aunt.
âRemember, thereâs no spell. Youâve got to close your mind. Take a few minutes to try to clear all thoughts from your head.â
James lowered his wand and started to stare directly at the wall behind Hermione. After a few minutes, a blank look appeared on his face.
âGood,â Hermione said, âReady?â
James looked back at her with a nervous look on his face, âI suppose.â
âLegilimens!â Hermione shouted.
James looked horrified as he stared at his aunt. He dropped his wand and pressed his hand to his forehead. Hermione continued to point her wand at him, but it was obvious that he wasnât succeeding at closing his mind. He had sunk down to the floor, with his hands on his head. Hermione lowered her wand and walked over to him.
âAre you all right?â she asked, extending her hand for James to grab.
âFine,â James mumbled as he took Hermioneâs hand and stood up again, âItâs just, thatâs exactly what it felt like when someone did that to me during detention.â
âThatâs because that was what someone did to you during detention,â Hermione explained.
âBut I didnât hear anyone shouting âLegilimensâ,â James told her.
âThey were doing it non-verbally. Weâll get to that point in our lessons eventually, but for now I will do it verbally so you know whatâs going on,â Hermione said, âNow, that was a pretty good attempt for the first time. You see now how hard it is to close your mind.â
âYeah,â James agreed as he sat back down.
âYour turn, Albus,â Hermione announced.
Albus had momentarily forgotten that he, too, had to have his aunt read his mind. He got up, his heart beating fast. He had never had Legilimency performed on him while he was awake, and he did not know what to expect.
âTry to clear your mind,â Hermione told him as she walked a few feet away and turned around to wait.
Albus tried to clear his mind, but it was hard. His thoughts were consumed with whether Matt was a werewolf or not. He was also constantly thinking about what âHallowsâ could possibly be. Not to mention the reason why he was having these lessons in the first place. It was difficult not to think about someone seeing his thoughts.
âReady?â Hermione asked. Albus nodded with a nervous look on his face.
âLegilimens!â she shouted.
The classroom seemed to disappear as Albus was thrown into his own memories. He was four years old and James had stolen the toy broom he had received on his birthday. James was flying it around while Albus chased him. The scene changed and he saw the time he dropped a sharp knife onto his foot, but instead of slicing it open, the knife just bounced off it. He had been four then, as well, and that was the first magical thing he did. The scene changed yet again and Albus was seven and was playing with his cousins at the Burrow. Then he was at home, reading his Hogwarts letter. The scene changed for a final time, he and Rose were sitting in Roseâs bedroom at the Burrow, researching about werewolves. Albusâs heart beat faster. He couldnât let his aunt see that.
âNo!â Albus exclaimed, and the classroom reappeared in front of him. He glanced around and was half surprised that he was still standing up, since James had collapsed during his attempt.
Hermione was looking at him and then she glanced at Rose, then back to Albus. She had obviously seen a bit of the last memory. âWell, you actually managed to stop me, although not by normal means of Occlumency. But that is very good for a first try. What was that last memory?â
âNothing, nothing,â Albus replied quickly, averting his gaze from his aunt.
âVery well, I think that is enough for tonight. Albus, James, keep practicing. Try to close your minds before you go to bed. Iâll see you all on Tuesday. Good luck with all your classes. And try to behave yourselves during Charms,â Hermione added.
âWe do!â James insisted, âProfessor Washburn just doesnât like us.â
âBe that as it may, you do need to pass his class,â Hermione reminded them, âGood night.â
âNight,â Albus, James, and Rose said as they left the classroom.
âSo, what was that memory that you didnât want my mum to see?â Rose asked curiously once they were out of earshot of the classroom.
âLater,â Albus whispered, glancing at James.
âBlimey, thatâs some strange stuff, Legilimency and Occlumency,â James announced after a few moments of silence, âBut you seem good at it, Albus.â
âMaybe,â Albus responded.
âBetter than me. I couldnât do anything during it. Just kind of forgot everything except the memories I was seeing. Couldnât think of anything to do about it,â James explained.
âYouâve just got to practice it,â Albus told him, âPlus, this was just the first time. And anyway, Iâve got to think of something better to do than just shouting out random things. People will think Iâm a nutter if Iâm just shouting out ânoâ all the time.â
James laughed, âWell, I already know youâre a nutter.â
âOh, shut it, James,â Albus laughed and punched James in the arm. James punched him back and they continued that until they reached the Fat Lady. Rose followed behind and muttered something that sounded like âboysâ.
When they arrived back at the common room, James immediately went to his dormitory so he could tell his friends about the lesson.
âSo, what was the memory?â Rose whispered to Albus.
âWhen we were researching about werewolves,â Albus told her, âI didnât want Aunt Hermione to know about that.â
âWhy not?â Rose asked.
âI dunno, really. I mean, itâs not like she had a problem with Teddyâs dad. I guess she just came awfully close to seeing our other research,â Albus explained.
âGood point,â Rose agreed, âBut you know, youâve got to practice this. What if she does find out about that? Sheâll tell Uncle Harry.â
âI know, I know, Iâll practice,â Albus assured her.
âGood,â Rose seemed satisfied, âNow, weâd better get to bed. Good night.â
âNight,â Albus said as he walked to the door to the dormitory. As he lay in bed trying to get to sleep, listening to Biliusâs snoring, he tried to close his mind. âThink about nothing,â he kept repeating in his mind. But it didnât work, because Albus yet again had the same nightmare.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Hope everyone liked it! I am a bit embarrassed to admit that I have been typing my own sisterâs username wrong in the past few Authorâs Note Iâve done for this fic. Her name is Dancer_Of_Starlight. I must be mixing it up with another site. So thanks, Dancer_Of_Starlight for reading this and helping me with it! Thanks also to my other sister and my brother. Thanks as well to inkheart, for the review, youâre awesome! Please read and review, everyone!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
During the next two weeks, tensions ran high between the Gryffindors and Slytherins. As the impending Quidditch match grew nearer, there were more and more duels in the corridors. These usually resulted in various players having to go to the Hospital Wing. Luckily, no one had been severely injured yet. However, both Houses were starting to be very protective of their players. Samantha Meyers forbade anyone on the Gryffindor team from wandering the corridors alone. She was also getting more and more intense with her practice schedules. Samantha had started scheduling a practice for every night of the week. Every evening, the Gryffindor team came trooping back into the common room well after dark, looking tired and worn out. Slytherin was also practicing each day, but they got an earlier time in the evening.
Nightly Quidditch practices did not bode well for Jamesâs Occlumency lessons. He had asked Hermione if he could skip the lessons until after the match, but she would not allow it. James grudgingly skipped his Quidditch practice, much to Samanthaâs dismay. She was not happy about James missing practice. Hermione actually sent her a letter, which got her to stop badgering James about practice.
Albus thought he was making a bit of progress with his Occlumency. He had been reading the book and doing the homework, although he did not enjoy it. Occlumency was like having another class to take, so he wound up with more homework than the rest of his classmates. Albus had not yet succeeded in preventing Hermione from entering his mind, but he usually managed to force her out after a little while. He was relieved that he had so far prevented her from discovering his Hallows research. Despite this, he was still having strange nightmares a couple of nights a week. James was not making nearly as much progress as Albus. He had yet to stop Hermioneâs Legilimency at all, and was still collapsing on the floor occasionally. James was getting increasingly fed up with Occlumency and did not enjoy the lessons at all.
As the Quidditch match, and the full moon, grew closer, Albus started to watch Matt for signs of illness. The day before the match, Matt almost slept through breakfast. John had to wake him up before he left for the Great Hall. Albus watched him throughout DADA and noticed that he was much more tired than usual. He kept his head on the desk the entire class and didnât take any notes. Harry did not say anything about this, which Albus thought was strange because whenever anyone else fell asleep in other classes, the teacher woke them up. Albus couldnât remember a time when someone fell asleep in DADA, though, because usually that class was exciting.
âAre you ok?â Albus asked Matt as they were walking to Charms.
âFine,â Matt responded. He was walking a bit slower than usual, âJust tired.â
âOk,â Albus said warily, âBut if you want to go to the Hospital Wing during Charms, Iâll volunteer to take you.â
âI will too,â John agreed, âAnything to get out of that class.â
The boys immediately stopped talking once they entered the Charms classroom and went to their usual back table. Once he sat down, Matt put his head down on top of his book. Washburn stormed into the room a few seconds later and started taking attendance.
âIâm lecturing today, take out your notes,â he barked at the class. Everyone silently found quills and parchment as Washburn pointed his wand at the board. Notes appeared on it and Albus started copying them down. Washburn started talking and droned on for about half the period without stopping, even when students raised their hands to ask questions. Albus did not glance up to look at him at all. Once he finished copying his notes, he looked over at Matt and noticed that he had fallen asleep. Unfortunately, Washburn had noticed, too.
âEckerton!â Washburn shouted while he walked towards the back table, âThis is not nap time!â
âI donât think heâs feeling well, sir,â John said tentatively.
âI didnât ask how heâs feeling!â Washburn growled at John. âNow wake up and pay attention!â he shouted again.
Matt slowly picked up his head and stared at Washburn, âHuh?â
âI said this is not nap time!â Washburn screamed.
âOh, sorry,â Matt mumbled. He stared down at his book and rested his head on his hand.
Washburn grumbled something incoherent and got back to his lecture. Matt kept his head up the rest of the class, but didnât take any notes. Although he did go to Astronomy after lunch, Matt did not seem to pay much attention in that class either. After class was over, he went up to the dormitory and slept straight through dinner.
âWhat other explanation could there be?â Rose wondered aloud in the common room that night. She, Albus, John, and Amanda were sitting around a table after dinner. The pre-Quidditch match excitement kept the chaos and noise in the common room up, so no one was paying much attention to what they were talking about.
âI donât think there is another one,â Albus told her, âHeâs got to be a werewolf. He gets sick every full moon and leaves overnight. When he comes back heâs still sick and heâs got injuries.â
âIâm sure he is one,â John agreed, âJust hope he tells us soon, or Iâm just going to have to tell him I know. Itâs gonna be hard to hide that we know.â
âThink how hard it is for Matt? Hiding that from everyone,â Albus reminded him.
âTrue.â
âSo, who thinks weâll win the match tomorrow?â Albus asked, changing the subject.
âI do!â John shouted, âWith your cousinâs new broom, weâll be unbeatable.â
âDefinitely,â Amanda agreed, âI canât wait to see it in action.â
âYouâve really gotten into Quidditch, havenât you?â Rose giggled.
âSure have, itâs so much better than football,â Amanda told her.
******
The match was to be held in the early afternoon, which was a bit later than the previous Gryffindor vs. Hufflepuff match. Albus and his friends spent the earlier part of the day playing Wizardâs Chess and Exploding Snap in the common room. Matt seemed too tired to play anything, so he laid on one of the couches and watched the games. Albus noticed the Gryffindor team huddled in one corner of the room, reviewing last minute tactics. James looked a bit nervous, which was understandable considering the last match landed him in the Hospital Wing.
The morning dragged by, but eventually, everyone started to make their way down to the pitch after lunch.
âShould be a good game,â Albus said to John as they were walking towards the pitch.
âDefinitely. Iâve been looking forward to a Gryffindor vs. Slytherin game. Iâve heard theyâre the best ones,â John told him.
âThatâs what Iâve heard, too. Dad says they were usually the most exciting ones in his days here,â Albus informed John.
âConditions couldnât be worse, though,â John lamented. He was right. The weather was not cooperating for a game of Quidditch. Although the visibility seemed to be a bit better than Gryffindorâs last match, the snow was falling at a steady rate and it was bitterly cold.
âHopefully it wonât last as long as last time,â Rose pulled her cloak tighter, âIâm freezing.â
âMe, too,â Matt agreed. He was already shivering, and was a few paces behind everyone else.
Albus and the rest of the group slowed down to allow Matt to catch up with them. âWell, I just hope James doesnât get injured again,â Albus said.
âHope not,â Amanda agreed.
The five first years made their way through the crowds and found their way to a few seats on Gryffindorâs side of the stands. As they were walking slowly to match Mattâs pace, they were some of the last people in the stands. They found their seats just before the commentary started.
âWelcome to the Gryffindor vs. Slytherin match!â Todd Smith shouted over the crowd, âThis is a highly anticipated match that should prove to be as exciting as always. The weatherâs brutal, but that shouldnât stop a well trained team.
âAnd here come the teams! First onto the pitch is the Gryffindor team. Captain Samantha Meyers, followed by Georgia Weasley, Fred Weasley, Heather Weasley, Bradley Weasley, Ryan OâMalley, and James Potter!â
The team flew around the pitch once and then landed next to each other on the ground.
âHere are the Slytherins. Captain Talan Flint, followed by Lance Goyle, Jackson Naiser, Ferris Fielding, Peyton Haines, Hailey Odele, and Glenna Dabney.â
The Slytherins flew once around the pitch and landed in front of the Gryffindors. The referee, Alan Oteski, had the captains shake hands, and the teams were off.
âProfessor Oteski releases the Quaffle, Bludgers, and Snitch, and the players are up! Quaffle goes to Fielding and heâs flying towards the Gryffindor goal posts. Oh, nice Bludger work by OâMalley! Quaffle goes to Meyers, she flies down the pitch, passing to the two Weasley chasers. And Heather Weasley scores the first goal!â
The Gryffindor team scored three goals within the first five minutes. Slytherin had not managed to get any goals past Georgia.
âOf course, the exciting part of this game is Georgia Weasleyâs new broom. Itâs a Firebolt 3000. The fastest broom yet! It seems to be proving itself in this game. What with Georgiaâs incredible skill, and that broom, Iâd be surprised if Slytherin scores any goals at all!â Todd shouted excitedly.
âSheâs amazing!â John exclaimed, âI want one of those brooms!â
âMe, too,â Albus agreed, âI flew it over holiday. It was amazing.â
âWow! Think sheâd let me ride it?â John asked.
âMaybe. If you come to my place over the summer, Iâll ask her,â Albus told him.
âAwesome!â John grinned.
âAnother goal scored for Gryffindor! Making the score 40-0 in favor of Gryffindor! Fred Wealsey has the Quaffle, heâs storming up the pitch, headed to the Slytherin goal posts. Ouch! Hit in the back with a Bludger sent from Naiser. Odele has the Quaffle now and is headed towards Georgia Weasley. She passes to Fielding, who attempts to score a goal. And saved! Wow, I didnât think a broom could move that fast,â Todd was jumping up and down at the commentatorâs podium now.
âFlint does not look happy,â Albus commented.
âNo, he doesnât. Looks like heâs ready to hex someone,â John agreed.
âWouldnât put it past him,â Rose chimed in, âThese matches are known to get ugly.â
The game continued for a while, with Gryffindor scoring a few more goals. Slytherin did manage to get one goal after Flint sent a Bludger at Georgia right when Odele was attempting to score.
âThink this match will last much longer?â Matt asked.
âDunno. Doesnât look like James or Dabney have seen the Snitch yet,â Albus peered out at the field. âTheyâre just hovering above everyone else. Looks like theyâre trying to stay out of it. I can see why. The Bludger work is getting nasty.â
And it was. All the Gryffindor chasers were sporting some kind of injury. Georgia had a nose bleed, but seemed to be ignoring it. Odele and Haines both had taken Bludgers to arm and it seemed to have affected their ability to catch the Quaffle.
Albus looked over at Matt. He was sitting down, shivering, with his head resting on his hand. âYou ok?â
âI guess. I just hope the match is done soon,â Matt winced.
âWant to go back inside?â Albus asked.
âNo, Iâll be fine,â Matt insisted.
âAnother goal for Gryffindor! Making the match 110-10 Gryffindor!â Todd bellowed, âAnd the match is getting ugly. Ouch! Fred Weasley takes a Bludger to the head, causing him to drop the Quaffle. But itâs caught by Meyers! She passes to Heather, who scores another goal!
âFlint appears to have abandoned the Bludgers and is soaring up towards Potter and Dabney. Whatâs he up to? Meanwhile, Bradley Weasley hits a well aimed Bludger towards Fielding, who drops the Quaffle. Back to Flint. It appears that he is getting into an argument with Dabney. I wonder what theyâre saying? Hope itâs important. Looks like his neglect of beater duties has caused his uninjured Chaser to get hit.â
Flint turned his head around and flew straight towards Georgia. Odele was flying towards the goal posts with the Quaffle. âWhatâs he doing now? Heâs grabbed hold of Georgiaâs broom! Foul! Flint has grabbed Georgiaâs broom and appears to be preventing her from keeping! Foul!â Todd screamed angrily. Odele took advantage of the situation and scored a goal.
Oteski blew his whistle, âPenalty shot for Gryffindor! Unnecessary grabbing of opposing keeperâs broomstick. Honestly, you should know better! Such an obvious foul! And that goal does not count!â
âGryffindor captain, Meyers, easily scores the penalty shot, bringing the score up to 130-10 Gryffindor,â Todd announced, âSlytherin chaser, Fielding, manages to get the Quaffle and is flying towards the Gryffindor goal posts. Bradley Weasley sends a Bludger towards him and, ouch! Heâs knocked off his broom. Lucky for him, he was low to the ground. But looks like heâs out for the rest of the game, probably broke his arm or something.â
âThis is amazing!â John exclaimed, âIâve never seen Quidditch like this. I wonder if Slytherinâs ever lost by this much before.â
âI dunno,â Albus responded, âBut I donât think their Seekerâs very good. All sheâs doing is following James around. And Flint was yelling at her for something.â
âProbably telling her just to catch the Snitch so they can end the misery,â John laughed.
âJames better catch the Snitch soon,â Matt groaned, âI donât think I can take much more of this.â He was huddled on his seat, holding his stomach in pain.
âSure you donât want to go in?â Albus asked.
âI dunno,â Matt moaned, âMaybe.â
âLooks like Potterâs seen the Snitch!â Todd shouted. James had started speeding towards the Gryffindor goal posts, with Dabney following closely behind. âThe Slytherin beaters seem to be trying to hit Potter with the Bludgers. But, hang on, the Gryffindor chasers and beaters seem to have surrounded Potter, protecting him from Naiser and Flint. Blimey! Iâve never seen anything like it! And it worked! Potter caught the Snitch!â
The crowd erupted into applause, Gryffindors storming the ground, lifting James up into the air. They started walking back to the castle. The Slytherin team was looking murderous and Flint was screaming at Dabney.
âLetâs go,â Rose said, looking at Matt.
âOh, good,â Matt moaned as he slowly stood up.
âYou want to go to the Hospital Wing?â Albus asked.
âNo, I donât think so,â Matt said, leaning on John for support.
The five friends slowly made their way up to the castle. By the time they got there, everyone else had already made it back. It took them a while to climb the stairs to Gryffindor Tower, but eventually, they made it.
When they entered the common room, a party was already in full swing. Matt made a beeline for the dormitory and didnât look back.
âAlbus!â James came running up to him, butterbeer in hand, âWe did it! Beat Slytherin! They are pathetic. And here I was, thinking they actually had a good team. No way theyâre in the running for the Cup now. Blimey, losing 10 to 300âŠâ
âYou did great!â Albus grinned at him, âDad would be very proud.â
âProud of what?â a voice came from behind them.
Albus turned around, âDad?!â
âWhat are you doing here?â James asked.
âCame for the party. Blimey, things havenât changed a bit. The parties after we beat Slytherin were always best. Anyway, congratulations, James!â
âThanks!â
âWeâre not being too loud, are we, Professor Potter?â Samantha Meyers had come over to see what was going on.
âNo, âcourse not!â Harry grinned, âCanât expect you to be quiet after that win. Just quiet down by midnight.â
âSure, no problem! It was amazing, wasnât it?â Samantha said excitedly.
âOh, it was brilliant,â Harry agreed. Harry and Samantha quickly settled down to rehashing every bit of the match, and were soon joined by Georgia.
âNever grow out of Quidditch, right?â James laughed.
âRight,â Albus agreed, âHonestly, I thought itâd be a bit strange having him as our teacher, but it hasnât been weird at all.â
âYeah, itâs been pretty neat.â
******
The party in the Gryffindor common room lasted well into the evening. Most of the Gryffindors did not even go down for dinner. Albusâs cousins had managed to bring a good bit of food up to the common room, so there was really no need to go to the Great Hall. Harry left shortly before dinner, though, so he could join the rest of the staff for the meal.
âHonestly, Iâll never get any work done with this noise,â Rose sighed. She, Albus, John, and Amanda were sitting around one of the tables in the common room eating sweets. Rose was the only one trying to get any work done.
âWhy bother? Youâve still got tomorrow,â John commented, âHey, I got your dad, Albus.â John held up a Chocolate Frog card.
âI donât see why everybodyâs got to party so late into the evening,â Rose said, âIt wasnât that spectacular a win. Slytherin was dreadful.â
âThatâs the point,â John told her, âSlytherinâs usually got a pretty good team. Itâs the principle of the thing. Gryffindor and Slytherin are huge rivals, and when we beat them, itâs a reason to celebrate. Even if theyâre rubbish.â
âWhatever,â Rose put her fingers in her ears and continued to read.
âAnd their new Seekerâs horrible,â Albus said, âI bet she couldnât see the Snitch if it was right in front of her face.â
âYeah, sheâs no match for James,â John agreed, âIâve heard from some of the older students that heâs as good as Ted Lupin was.â
âWell, he should be,â Albus laughed, âTeddyâs been training him ever since James could get on a broom. I think they started when James was about five.â
âBut heâs got it in his blood, too,â Amanda chimed in, âI mean, Albus, your dad was the best Seeker Gryffindorâs ever seen. And your Uncle Charlie was a great Seeker, too. Plus, your mum played for the Holyhead Harpies.â
âYup,â Albus grinned, âQuidditch is a high priority in my family.â
âGuess Rose just didnât get any of those Quidditch genes,â John poked Rose and she jumped.
âShut it, John,â Rose told him, âWhereâs Matt?â
âStill sleeping,â Albus said, glancing at the door to the dormitories, âBeen there ever since the end of the match.â
âWell, why donât you go check on him?â Rose suggested.
âAll right,â Albus got up from his chair and walked to the dormitory. When he got there, he saw that Matt was sound asleep in his bed.
âMatt!â Albus whispered, âHey, Matt! Get up!â Albus lifted Mattâs arm up and it fell limply back onto the mattress when he let go. âWake up!â Albus shouted a little louder.
âHuh? Whaâ?â Matt groggily lifted his head and grimaced.
âYou all right?â Albus asked with a look of concern on his face.
âUgh,â Matt groaned and sat up. âWhat time is it?â
âAlmost six,â Albus told him.
âOhh,â Matt slowly got up off the bed and swayed, âIâve got to go to the Hospital Wing.â
âWell, Iâll take you,â Albus grabbed Mattâs arm so he wouldnât fall.
âNo, Iâll be fine,â Matt said.
âNo, Iâm taking you,â Albus insisted. Matt did not protest any further and leaned on Albus for support. They made their way down into the common room, where the party was still in full swing. Albus led Matt straight out of portrait hole and into the corridor towards the Hospital Wing.
âCâmon, weâre almost there,â Albus said as they walked down a flight of stairs.
âI think Iâm going to be sick,â Matt groaned and clutched his stomach.
âItâs ok, weâll be there soon,â Albus winced under Mattâs weight. Matt was leaning on Albus more and more by the minute, âMadam Pomfrey will fix it.â
âNo she wonât. She canât,â Mattâs voice wavered as he talked.
âHere we are,â Albus opened the door to the Hospital Wing and led Matt inside. Madam Pomfrey was waiting and rushed over to Albus and Matt.
âItâs ok, dear, come on,â she pulled Matt away from Albus and let him lean on her, âIâll take it from here, Albus. Youâd best go back to your common room.â
Albus turned to leave, but not before seeing Madam Pomfrey soothing Matt, who had started to cry. Albus shut the door, wishing he could do something to help. Matt seemed to be doing worse this month than he had the past months. He hadnât seemed any different during the past few days, but maybe he was just good at hiding his emotions. Albus had forgotten to focus on figuring out what Matt was feeling in the days leading up to the full moon due to being preoccupied with homework and Occlumency lessons. Why did this month seem worse? What was going on?
Albus pondered these thoughts as he walked slowly back to the common room. How could he convince Matt that it would be safe to tell Albus his secret? Would he ever tell? And more importantly, was there anything anyone could do to help?
âSomething troubling you, Potty?â a cold voice said. Albus looked up and saw Quinton Willinson, flanked by two other Slytherns, standing at the top of the stairs that Albus was climbing. âFancy a stroll by yourself?â
âGo away, Willinson,â Albus growled as he reached the top of the stairs.
âItâs a free castle. Not curfew yet. Iâm free to wander the corridors just as you are, Potty,â Willinson sneered at Albus.
âJust leave me alone,â Albus tried to walk past him, but the other two Slytherins blocked his path.
âNo, donât think I will. I still havenât forgotten that Exploding Eclair,â Willinson said, drawing his wand and pointing it at Albus, âI know it was you.â
âHow?â Albus asked nervously as he drew his own wand and pointed it at Willinson.
âI just do,â Willinson snapped his fingers and his cronies pulled out their wands and pointed them at Albus, âAnd now youâll pay.â
âExpelliarmus!â Albus shouted, and Willinsonâs wand flew out of his hand and landed on the floor. A split second later, two jets of light came from the other two Slytherinsâs wands and hit Albus in the chest. Before he knew what was happening, he stumbled backwards and fell down the stairs. He blacked out halfway down, and the last thing he saw was Willinson and his two friends running in the opposite direction.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Sorry for the cliffie! Well, not really, I do like putting them in. Originally, this chapter did not have a cliffie, but it was quite short so I stuck about half the next chapter at the end of this one. So now itâs a bit longer than usual.
Thanks as usual to my sister and now official beta, Dancer_Of_Starlight. Thanks as well to my brother and my other sister. Please read and review!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
âYou have no idea who did it, then?â Albus heard his dad ask.
âNo, when Neville found him, there was no sign that anybody else had been there,â Madam Pomfrey whispered.
âWell, when I find out who did it, thereâll be trouble,â Albus heard a bang and he figured his dad had just slammed his fist onto something hard.
âHarry, please be a bit quieter. Iâm sure whoever it is will be punished.â
âIâll be sure of that.â
Albus opened his eyes and looked around. He was in the Hospital Wing. Judging by the darkness outside, it must have been the middle of the night. He had no idea how many hours had passed, but he guessed it must have been quite a few. Albus tried to sit up, but was immediately hit by a searing pain in his head and had to lay back down.
Harry rushed over upon seeing that he was awake, âAlbus! What on earth happened?â
âHowâd I get here?â Albus groaned.
Harry bent over and hugged Albus tight. âOuch!â Albus winced.
âReally, Harry, Iâve only just healed those bones!â Madam Pomfrey pulled Harry away.
âNeville found you a couple hours ago. You were laying unconscious at the bottom of one of the staircases. It was obvious youâd fallen down, but it looked like someone had stunned you as well. Youâve got a cracked skull, a few broken ribs, and a broken arm.â Harry answered, once he sat down in the chair next to the bed. âBut who did it?â
âQuinton Willinson, and two other Slytherins I donât know,â Albus told him.
âWhat year are they in?â
âWillinsonâs a seventh year, I dunno about the others,â Albus answered.
Harry slammed his hand onto the bedside table and stood up, âSeventh year?! Bloody hell! What in the name of Merlinâs saggy left-â
âHarry, calm down!â Madam Pomfrey rushed over to pick up the water jug that had fallen off the table.
âSorry,â Harry resumed his seat, âBut honestly, what seventh year gangs up on a first year?â
âVictoire and Amy Eckerton warned me. They said he picks a first year every year to torment. And they told me not to go anywhere alone, because he never picks a fight unless youâre alone. Apparently heâs not a very good dueler. But I totally forgot about that when I took Matt here,â Albus looked around at the empty beds around him, âBy the way, where is he?â
âNothing to worry about now,â Madam Pomfrey said shortly.
âWell, Willinson will be getting detention, and loads of it. And those two other Slytherins as well. Iâll be talking to Slughorn,â Harry muttered.
âOh, Dad, I disarmed Willinson!â Albus said excitedly, âIâd forgotten about that. Right after I disarmed him, the other two stunned me and I fell down the stairs.â
Harry grinned, âBrilliant. Youâre great at disarming. And if the other two werenât there, youâd have been fine. But, itâs hard to disarm three wizards at once.â
âItâs getting late, I think youâd better give Albus a chance to sleep, Harry,â Madam Pomfrey came over holding a goblet of potion.
âAll right,â Harry stood up and gave Albus a gentle hug, âIâll be back in the morning. Gânight, Al, I love you.â
âLove you, too,â Albus awkwardly hugged his dad back, âGood night.â
âIâve got a potion to help you sleep,â Madam Pomfrey handed him the potion, âDrink up.â
Albus took the goblet and downed it in one gulp.
âKnew it was only a matter of time before you showed up here,â Madam Pomfrey muttered, âPotters seem to be unable to keep themselves out of this placeâŠâ
*****
âWhat happened, Poppy?â Albus heard someone ask.
âBad transformation, really bad,â Madam Pomfrey replied grimly.
âWhat can you do?â the voice asked, Albus recognized it now as Neville.
âIâm really not sure,â Madam Pomfrey sighed, âIâll administer the usual potions and heal the bones, but other than that⊠Iâve got to contact St. Mungoâs.â
âIâll do it,â Neville announced, âIs Albus ok?â
âHeâll be fine,â Madam Pomfrey assured him, âIâll keep him here until tomorrow morning.â
Albus heard Neville leave and Madam Pomfrey tug the curtains shut around one of the beds. She moved quickly around the room whispering to herself and loudly grabbing bottles off of shelves. Albus opened his eyes briefly and saw that the bed at the end of the row had the curtains shut. Thatâs where Matt was. And Albus had been right. He was a werewolf. Any doubt that Albus had was gone. He felt sick with dread at the thought of Matt going through that transformation every month. Stuck with a curse that prevented him from living a normal life. Albus knew what life was like for a werewolf. He heard about Teddyâs dadâs life. After Hogwarts, what would Matt do? Would he be able to get a job?
âAre you awake?â Madam Pomfrey came bustling over with a breakfast tray, âGood, eat up.â
âIs Matt going to be ok?â Albus asked nervously.
âNever you mind,â Madam Pomfrey answered as she walked back to Mattâs bed and disappeared behind the curtains. She spent much of the next hour bustling back and forth between Mattâs bed and her study, where Albus could see her consulting books and mixing potions. Albus watched her and noticed she looked much more worried than usual. What was going on?
Neville returned about an hour later, followed by a tall, balding man in lime green robes. Albus recognized them as Healer robes. Madam Pomfrey came out from behind the curtains when she heard the door open and walked quickly over to the two men.
âIâd better go find Amy, Poppy,â Neville announced.
âYes, I suppose you should,â Madam Pomfrey answered, âPoor dear will be worried sick when she sees him.â
âI know,â Neville sighed and left the room.
Madam Pomfrey turned to the other man, âOh, good, theyâve sent you, Healer Sterling,â she welcomed the Healer with a sigh of relief, âI was afraid theyâd send one of the trainee Healers.â
âNo, no, I insisted on coming,â Healer Sterling assured her, âIâm the one in charge of the study-â
Madam Pomfrey cut him off and gestured to Albusâs bed, âShush! Weâll discuss it shortly. Albus, why donât you finish your breakfast?â
âIâm not hungry,â Albus mumbled.
Madam Pomfreyâs face softened, âAlbus, Matt will be ok. You mustnât worry.â
âBut whatâs going on?â Albus asked, âIâve already figured it out. I know heâs a werewolf.â
âBe that as it may, I cannot inform you about the situation,â Madam Pomfrey said as she and Healer Sterling walked towards Mattâs bed, âNow, itâs best for you to get some rest.â
Madam Pomfrey drew her wand, muttered a spell, and she and the two men disappeared behind the curtains. Albus knew she had casted the Muffliato charm on him. He had witnessed his parents using that spell before. He sighed and picked at his eggs, but he really couldnât eat anything. He knew that Madam Pomfrey really was not sure whether Matt would be ok. Albus sat pondering about what could be wrong, when a loud bang jolted him out of his thoughts.
Albus turned around in his bed and noticed that the banging was coming from the door. Madam Pomfrey ran out from behind the curtains and headed towards the door. âWhoâs there?â she shouted.
âRose Weasley,â Albus heard his cousinâs voice, âWhy are the doors locked? Canât we come in and see Albus?â
âIâd rather you didnât. Iâve got another student in here who needs quiet,â Madam Pomfrey said through the closed door.
âIs it Matt?â Rose asked, âBecause heâs still not back yet.â
Madam Pomfrey sighed, âYes.â
âWeâll be quiet,â Rose answered, âI promise.â
âOh, all right,â Madam Pomfrey opened the door, âBut only for a little while.â
Rose walked through the door, followed by John, Amanda, and James. âOh, Albus, are you all right?â she whispered as they neared Albusâs bed.
âIâll be fine,â Albus told them.
âWhat on earth happened? Never saw you after you took Matt here last night,â John asked. He, James, Amanda, and Rose sat down on the bed next to Albusâs.
âMet up with Willinson,â Albus groaned, âHim and two other Slytherins.â
âHeâs trouble, I tell ya,â James shook his head, âDrove me mad until Victoire talked to him last year.â
âYeah, well, he doesnât seem to be listening to Victoire this year, does he?â Albus responded, âAnyway, I disarmed him, but his two friends stunned me at the same time and I fell down the stairs. Got knocked out halfway down and woke up here.â
âWhoa, are you ok?â Amanda asked.
âIâm fine. Got a few broken bones, but theyâre healed now. My head still hurts, though,â Albus rubbed his forehead.
âWe were so worried when you were still gone this morning,â Rose told him, âWent straight to Uncle Harryâs study and he told us you were here. By the way, he said heâd be visiting later this morning.â
âDad was here last night, too,â Albus said, âHeâs really angry about it. Heâs going to give Willinson loads of detention.â
John grinned, âExcellent. Heâll finally be getting what he deserves.â
âWell, Iâve got to get going. Quidditch practice,â James announced as he got up from the bed.
âBut you just had a match yesterday,â Rose shook her head.
âDoesnât matter. Sundayâs one of our usual practice days,â James reminded her. âGlad youâre better, Albus.â James waved and left the room. As he left, Neville, Victoire, and Amy came rushing through. Amy ran straight to Mattâs bed with tears in her eyes and Neville following quickly behind. Victoire stared at her questioningly, but turned to Albusâs bed.
âI told you not to go anywhere alone!â she sighed.
âI know!â Albus replied, âSorry. I was just taking Matt here. He was pretty sick last night, and it didnât occur to me that Iâd be walking back to the common room alone.â
âOh, I understand that,â Victoire answered, âBut just be careful from now on.â
âI will,â Albus assured her. Sometimes, it felt like his older cousins were just extra parents.
âWell, Uncle Harryâs furious, so I donât think youâll have to worry much anymore,â Victoire told him, âI heard him talking to Slughorn earlier. Apparently, Harry and Professor Longbottom are going to take turns overseeing his detentions and letâs just say heâs not going to have much free time in the coming weeks.â
âGood,â Albus responded.
âIâd better be off,â Victoire said, âIâm due to tutor Mark in Transfiguration in a few minutes. I was just with Amy, she started getting hysterical when Neville came and found her in the common room. But she wouldnât tell me whatâs going on. I donât suppose you know?â
âNope,â Albus said.
âWell, Iâll see you later,â Victoire started to head towards the door, âWhatever it is, I hope Mattâs ok.â
âOk, now that sheâs gone, Iâve got to tell you about Matt,â Albus whispered, âCome closer, I donât want Madam Pomfrey to hear.â
Rose, John, and Amanda climbed onto Albusâs bed. âWhat about him?â John asked.
âHeâs a werewolf,â Albus muttered.
âWhat?â John exclaimed a bit too loudly, âHow do you know for sure?â
âShush!â Albus whispered, âHe wasnât here last night when I woke up. And this morning, Professor Longbottom and Madam Pomfrey brought him here, but he was unconscious.â
âI knew it,â Rose whispered.
âAnyway, Madam Pomfrey said heâd had a really bad transformation,â Albus told them, âHeâs still unconscious. And thereâs a Healer from St. Mungoâs here. Theyâre all behind the curtains on Mattâs bed. They wonât tell me anything. They casted Muffliato, so I canât hear anything.â
âFigures,â Rose groaned, âAdults never let us know anything.â
âYeah,â Albus agreed, âBut what are we going to do about Matt?â
âWell, weâve got to figure out how to tell him we know,â John answered.
âI donât know about that,â Albus responded, âThereâs a reason heâs not telling us. I think we should let him tell us.â
âHow do we hide that we know, Albus?â John asked.
âWe just do,â Albus said adamantly, âAnyway, itâs got to be harder for Matt to keep this secret than us hiding the fact that we know. Heâs got to tell us sooner or later.â
âI think Albus is right, John,â Rose agreed, âHeâll tell us soon. This has got to be something he tells us. He has to be ready.â
âFine,â John sighed. The four friends sat in silence for a moment, succumbing to their own thoughts about Mattâs lycanthropy.
Madam Pomfrey and Healer Sterling came rushing out behind the curtains, and once they did, the Muffliato charm broke.
âI think I can treat him here, Poppy,â Sterling said to Madam Pomfrey, âI donât think thereâs any need to move him to St. Mungoâs, unless he gets worse.â
âOh, good,â Madam Pomfrey sighed with relief, âThat must mean itâs not as bad as I thought.â
âNo, itâs not quite that bad. It will take a while to treat, but he will recover perfectly fine,â Sterling assured her, âRight now Iâve got to take these notes back to St. Mungoâs and consult with some other Healers. Iâll also contact his parents. I should be back sometime in the afternoon. Just keep administering the potions every hour until then.â
âIâll see you later, then,â Madam Pomfrey bade him goodbye as he left the room.
âI think itâs time for you three to leave,â she announced, âMr. Potter needs his rest and heâs got to take a few more potions.â
âSee you, Albus,â John got up and started towards the door.
âBye,â Amanda followed behind John.
âGlad youâre ok,â Rose got up, âWhen do you get to leave?â
âTomorrow morning,â Madam Pomfrey answered.
âCan we see Matt?â Rose asked.
âAbsolutely not,â Madam Pomfrey said sternly, âHeâs in no condition for visitors.â
âOk, ok,â Rose responded, âBye, Albus.â
âBye.â
******
Throughout the rest of the day, Healer Sterling popped in and out of the Hospital Wing, bringing with him various potions from St. Mungoâs. Shortly after lunch, Mattâs parents showed up and they stayed until the evening. Everyone kept using the Muffliato charm against Albus, so he was unable to listen in on any conversations. Eventually he gave up on trying to find out any information about Mattâs condition and fell asleep. Madam Pomfrey let Albus leave the Hospital Wing early Monday morning, while breakfast was still going on in the Great Hall. Albus was quite bored with the Hospital Wing and once Madam Pomfrey had deemed him well, he ran straight to the Great Hall. John, Amanda, and Rose were all sitting together, whispering.
âAlbus!â John shouted once Albus had sat down next to him, âAll better then?â
âYeah, Iâm fine,â Albus assured him, âBit hungry, though.â Albus piled his plate with eggs and toast.
âWe were just talking about Matt,â Rose informed him, âHow is he doing?â
âIâm really not sure,â Albus said through a mouthful of toast, âI couldnât hear a word anyone was saying. Theyâre being very secretive.â
âIs he awake yet?â Amanda asked.
âNo, heâs not,â Albus sighed, âAt least I donât think so. The bits of conversation that I have been able to hear are mostly about figuring out how to wake him up.â
âNo chance of visiting him, then?â John wondered aloud.
âDonât think so,â Albus told him, âI mean, Madam Pomfreyâs still keeping the door locked. You have to say who you are and what you want in order to get in. The only ones whoâve been allowed to visit are his parents and Amy.â
âOh,â John sounded disappointed, âI hope she lets us in soon.â
âScorpius Malfoy tried to get in,â Albus lowered his voice, âLast night.â
âWhat the hell did he want?â John growled, âSlimy git.â
âWanted to find out whatâs wrong with Matt,â Albus answered, âHeâs way too nosy. Anyway, he banged on the door and told Madam Pomfrey he had a nose bleed. But heâd only taken a Nose Bleed Nougat, because once he got in, I saw him eat the other half and the blood stopped immediately. While Madam Pomfrey was shutting the door after him and locking it, he ran over to Mattâs bed.â
âHe didnât see him, did he?â Rose asked anxiously.
âNo, the curtains were up. Amy noticed him and she was looking murderous. She yelled at him to go away and mind his own business. Then Madam Pomfrey came back over and noticed he wasnât bleeding anymore and made him leave. Said she was going to tell Slughorn about it. I hope he gets detention.â
âWow, he doesnât give up, does he?â John responded.
âNo, he doesnât,â Albus agreed, âWeâre gonna have to be careful about him.â
âPost is here,â Amanda looked up and commented on the owls swooping into the room.
âAlbus, look,â Rose pointed to a copy of the Daily Prophet that had been delivered to the girl sitting across from them.
Albus glanced at the paper and immediately noticed what Rose was showing him. The front page headline was âMysterious Deaths Mystify Ministry Aurorsâ with a rather large picture of Harry below it. Albus turned to Rose, âWhatâs that about?â
âI donât know, but I donât like the sound of it,â Rose answered. âCan I borrow that?â she asked the girl.
The girl looked at them, and then the article, âSure, but Iâd like it back when youâre done.â She gave them one last look and then turned to her friend and the two of them started whispering.
Rose took the paper and put it in between her and Albus.
Mysterious Deaths Mystify Ministry Aurors
It started with the murder of Hogwart DADA teacher, Eric Torro, in the beginning of September. Supposedly, the Aurors looked into the death immediately, but there have been no leads. Harry Potter, the Boy Who Lived, the Chosen One, Head Auror, and Hogwarts DADA teacher, has been leading the investigation. But are his teaching duties getting in the way of his Auror duties? There have also been no leads in the death of Jasmine Lamski, which occurred a month ago. We asked if these deaths are connected, but the Auror office responded with âno commentâ. Do they know more than theyâre telling us? It is these kinds of murders that remind many of us of Lord Voldemortâs time of terror. Could there still be Dark Wizards among us? Is the Auror Office doing enough to stop them? And more importantly, should Harry Potter be teaching kids when his efforts are obviously needed in the Auror Office? Despite this, Harry Potter assures the Wizarding World that things âare under control and there is no need to worry.â People are being murdered and the murderers are not being caught. It might indeed be time to worry.
âThatâs rubbish!â Albus shouted when he finished the article.
âWhat?â John asked, trying to read upside down.
âRead this,â Albus grumbled as he handed John and Amanda the paper. âWho wrote it?â he asked Rose.
âRita Skeeter,â Rose told him.
âFigures!â Albus shouted, âSheâs always twisting the truth.â
âDoesnât look like the teachers are too happy about it,â Rose pointed to the staff table, where all the teachers were whispering amongst themselves. Most of them wore looks of worry and anger. The only one who wasnât whispering was Washburn, who was glaring at the students, just like he usually did. Harry was noticeably absent from the table.
âBlimey,â John let out a low whistle, âThatâs the way to scare everybody.â
âThere arenât really still Dark Wizards are there?â Amanda asked quietly, she was pale as a ghost.
ââCourse there are,â Albus told her, âThereâs always evil in the world. But itâs not like Voldemortâs coming back or anything. If my dad says thereâs nothing to worry about, then there isnât.â
âOk, but itâs still scary,â Amanda responded.
âThatâs what Rita Skeeter wants,â Albus informed her, âThatâs what she does. Sheâs rarely ever written anything thatâs she hasnât stretched the truth.â
âBut what about those dreams and Legilimency?â Rose asked, âEven your dad admits thereâs something going on with that?â
âI know, but heâs taking care of it,â Albus assured her, âI mean sure, itâs scary, but I donât think it required an article that strikes worry and fear into everyone. No one besides you lot and my family know anything about those dreams. So to them, itâs just like someone just started randomly killing a few people.â
âThatâs true,â John agreed, âWhereâs your dad?â
âI dunno,â Albus told him, âI saw him last night in the Hospital Wing. Heâs probably at the Ministry, trying to smooth everything over with this article. If people start complaining that the Aurors arenât doing enough, then he could lose his job here.â
âBloody hell,â John exclaimed, âThat wouldnât be right. Iâm sure the Aurors are doing a good job.â
âQuiet!â Professor Kendrick had stood up. The room fell silent as he did so. âThank you. Now, Iâm sure most of you have read todayâs front page article in the Prophet. I want to assure you all that we are perfectly safe and there is no need to worry. Certain journalists often have the habit of stretching the truth in order to scare people, and that is what is going on here. The Aurors are doing everything in their power to catch whoever murdered Professor Torro and Jasmine Lamski. I also need to inform you that DADA lessons will not take place today, because Professor Potter is spending the day at the Auror Office and the Ministry, trying to calm everyone down. If you have DADA today, please use the time to study for your upcoming exams. That is all.â Professor Kendrick sat back down and resumed his conversation with Neville.
Once Kendrick had finished his speech, whispering resumed amongst the students. Anyone who had not seen the article before, was now scrambling to find a copy of the Prophet.
âWell, whatâre we going to do with our free period, then?â John asked. The Gryffindor first years had DADA first that day.
âIâve got homework to finish,â Amanda groaned, âEssay for Herbology.â
âUgh, donât remind me,â John groaned as well, âI havenât finished it either.â
âWell, then you do need reminding!â Rose exclaimed, âI finished that over the weekend.â
âMe, too,â Albus commented.
âWhy donât we go finish it, then, John?â Amanda suggested, âThe common room will be pretty quiet with everyone off in class.â
âFine,â John reluctantly agreed. He stood up and headed off with Amanda to finish the essay.
âThat couldnât have worked out better,â Rose whispered to Albus, âNow we can go to the library and resume our research.â
âGood thinking,â Albus told her, âIâve finished that other book. Returned it a few days ago. Iâd better get another.â
âIâve looked through three, but thereâs loads others,â Rose informed him. She started walking out of the Great Hall, with Albus following, âBut I havenât found anything useful.â
âMe, neither.â
Albus and Rose were pleased to find that the library was rather empty. There were a few older students who had a free period, but all of them seemed too busy studying to notice the two first years. They headed straight to the book shelf that held the books they had previously looked at.
âAre we really going to have to look through all of these?â Albus wondered aloud.
âHopefully not,â Rose said as she pulled out a rather large book, âOnce we find something about Hallows, we can stop.â
âIâm beginning to doubt if thatâs going to happen,â Albus responded.
âI sure hope we find something soon,â Rose opened her book and glanced quickly at the table of contents, âExams will be in a few months, so weâre going to have to start studying more, which means less time for this.â
âYeah, maybe weâll get lucky today,â Albus hoped, âWant to go find a table?â He had picked out two books to look at.
âSure,â Rose followed Albus into a secluded part of the library, away from Madam Pince and the other students. They read silently for fifteen minutes.
âWell, this bookâs absolute rubbish,â Albus closed his first book, âSays Dad and Voldemort dueled for half a day before Voldemort finally died.â
Rose broke out laughing, âReally?! Wow, amazing that got published.â
Albus set aside that book and opened the other one, âThis looks a bit better.â
âWell, look who it is?â someone said from behind Rose.
Albus glanced up. âAnd what do you want, Malfoy?â
âJust seeing what youâre up to on your free time,â Malfoy smiled smugly, âIâm assuming you read the article.â
âYeah, I did,â Albus said coldly, âBut itâs not true. Just someone trying to stir up trouble.â
âNever can tell, though, can you?â Malfoy sat down at their table, âThe Ministryâs often hushing things up.â
âWhat do you know about that?â Rose asked.
âNothing, nothing, just stuff Iâve overheard my father saying,â Malfoy looked over at the book Rose was reading.
âA History of Lord Voldemort,â Malfoy read the title, âInteresting title. Why are you reading it?â
âJust a bit of background reading, never can learn too much.â
âHmm,â Malfoy looked at Albus, âSo, I hear you got into a bit of a duel the other day.â
Albus turned red, âUh, yeah.â
Malfoy smirked, âCanât really take on three seventh years.â
âHe disarmed Willinson,â Rose said angrily, âAnd is it really your business?â
âNo, not really, but I still want to know.â
âI couldâve taken on Willinson,â Albus added, âHeâs horrible at dueling. But his two mates got me.â
âThatâs true, Willinsonâs dueling skills leave a lot to be desired,â Malfoy agreed, âBut heâs smart enough not to duel without others on his side.â
âGood for him,â Albus mumbled.
âWell, weâd better be off to Charms,â Rose slammed her book shut and got up.
âYeah, bye,â Albus muttered and followed Rose. They checked out their books, which got them more inquiring glares from Madam Pince, and headed off to Charms.
Charms was surprisingly uneventful. Professor Washburn did inquire where Matt was, but he seemed satisfied with âin the Hospital Wingâ as an answer. Double Herbology went as usual, although Neville seemed kind of tense and distracted during the class. Albus had assumed this was because of Rita Skeeterâs article. Both John and Amanda had managed to finish their essays, although Johnâs wasnât long enough.
âWe should see if we can visit Matt tomorrow evening,â Rose announced at dinner.
âDefinitely,â John agreed, âIf Madam Pomfrey lets us.â
âI canât,â Albus said, âIâve got Occlumency tomorrow.â
âOh, thatâs right!â Rose responded, âIâd completely forgotten. Iâll just skip that lesson, then.â
Albus laughed, âWell, you donât even have to do it anyway.â
âI know, but itâs really interesting stuff.â
âI hope Mattâs ok,â Albus said in a worried tone, âMadam Pomfrey seemed so worried.â
âI wonder how long heâll be stuck in there,â John asked.
âI dunno,â Albus answered, âI just hope heâs conscious now.â
âWe should probably bring his homework,â Rose suggested.
âThatâll cheer him up,â John said sarcastically.
âHe needs to do it if heâs going to keep up with classes!â
âTrue,â John agreed, âSpeaking of homework, has anyone finished that essay for Slughorn thatâs due tomorrow?â
âI did,â Rose said, âBut let me guess, you havenât?â
âNope,â John grinned, âWant to lend me your notes?â
âNot really,â Rose shook her head.
âI finished it,â Amanda added, she had been rather quiet throughout the whole conversation. Albus could tell that the idea of Matt being a werewolf freaked her out a little bit. He could understand, considering up until a few months ago, she hadnât even known werewolves were real. But he did hope Amanda wouldnât start treating Matt differently.
âGood, Iâll use your notes!â
âIâm not quite finished with it either,â Albus informed them, âIâve just got to write three more inches, then itâll be done.â
The four friends finished up their pudding and headed back to the common room. John worked on his essay with Amandaâs help, while Albus finished his. Rose did other homework, and eventually she decided to help John as well.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Longest chapter yet, I think! I didnât want to split it up because then it would have been two really short chapters. And I know when I read stories, I prefer longer chapters.
Thanks as usual to my sister and beta Dancer_of_Starlight, and my brother and other sister. Thanks as well to inkheart for the reviews.
Iâd also like to share that it was about a year ago that I started writing this. So, happy birthday to the story! I finished it about six months ago.
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter, or any of his many relatives.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Shortly before seven the next evening, James and Albus headed to Occlumency, while John, Rose, and Amanda went to the Hospital Wing. As it turned out, the teachers told Rose that they had already sent Mattâs homework to the Hospital Wing and there was no need for her to collect it.
âPeople talking about that article in your classes?â Albus asked his brother on the way to the Transfiguration classroom.
âYeah,â James responded, âThey always stop right when the teacher comes in, though.â
âEveryone in my classes have been whispering about it. They try to talk quietly so I canât hear them, but I can,â Albus informed him.
âThatâs what itâs like for me, too,â James said, âBut you know Peyton Haines, the Slytherin Chaser? Well, he keeps loudly discussing how the Auror Department unable to do anything and everyoneâs in severe danger. Always within earshot of me, too.â
âGit,â Albus growled.
âI heard he scared the hell out of the Hufflepuffs in Charms today. Said he heard all the Death Eaters had broken out of Azkaban and no one had caught them yet. Load of rubbish. Got away with it, too, because Washburn wasnât in the room yet.â
âProbably wouldnât have mattered if he was in the room,â Albus muttered, âSlytherins can do no wrong in his eyes.â
James opened the door to the Transfiguration room and walked inside, Albus followed. Hermione was already there.
âHi, boys!â she smiled and gave them each a hug.
âHi, Aunt Hermione,â Albus and James greeted her.
âWhenâs Dad coming back?â Albus asked.
âYeah, good question,â James chimed in, âAnd whatâs with that article?â
Hermioneâs smile faded and she gestured for the boys to sit down. âHeâll be back later tonight, so donât worry about that. And as for the article⊠Well, you both know that most everything Rita Skeeter writes is rubbish.â
James and Albus nodded.
âThat article was written for the sole purpose of scaring people. All the it did was raise questions. The article itself was just a load of questions. The murders do remind people of Voldemortâs reign, so it was quite easy to just write this article and send people into a panic. The fact that the Aurors have no leads in either murder just fueled the fire. But I can assure you that whatever is going on, your father and the other Aurors are taking care of it. And he is perfectly capable of teaching here and heading the Auror department,â Hermione told them.
âSo there is something going on?â Albus asked.
âYes, of course somethingâs going on. There have been two mysterious murders, and someone is trying to see your thoughts,â Hermione explained, âBut it is nothing the Ministry canât handle.â
âSo, do you know whatâs going on?â James asked.
âYour dad has a few inklings and he has expressed them to me, but I canât tell you them,â Hermione answered, âNow weâve got to start the lesson. Open your books to page 50.â
Albus and James opened their books and Hermione lectured them for a half hour. Albus found this part of the lessons extremely boring, but every lesson started this way. Albus didnât expect any different from his Aunt Hermione, who was always trying to get him to read a lot of books. Eventually, the lecture part of the lesson was over and the practical part began.
Albus had been getting better at Occlumency. He had yet to prevent Hermione from entering his mind, but usually managed to force her out after a few minutes.
âAlbus, you first.â
Albus got up from his chair and stood in front of his aunt. âRemember to close your mind. Legilimens!â she shouted.
Albus stood there, being flooded with his own memories, for a few minutes. He saw James levitating Albusâs glass of pumpkin juice at last summerâs family reunion, the time he got lost in a Muggle grocery store when he was five, and the first time he ever rode a broom. Albus concentrated hard on blocking out all thoughts, and he was able to force Hermione out of his mind.
âGood job, Al!â Hermione congratulated him, âIt took you less time than last lesson.â
Albus tried two more times, both times producing the same results as the first, and then he sat down to watch James.
James had been having a much more difficult time than Albus. He had only been successful once, and it had taken him nearly ten minutes. This time proved to be no different, and after fifteen minutes, James had not been able to force Hermione out of his mind. The last try, he had even wound up laying on the floor. Hermione had thought that was enough, and James and Albus went back to the common room.
âHowâd it go?â Rose asked, when Albus sat down next to her. Rose, John, and Amanda were all sitting at one of the tables, doing homework.
âPretty good,â Albus answered, âItâs taking me less time to get your mum out of my mind. But James canât get her out at all.â
âHeâll get there eventually,â Rose responded.
âDid you get to see Matt?â Albus asked as he pulled out his Potions homework.
âNo,â John said sadly, âHeâs still unconscious. And Madam Pomfrey still has the doors locked. Sheâs got a really short temper, too.â
âYeah, Scorpius Malfoy was skulking around!â Rose exclaimed, âWe went up there and he was trying to listen in through the door.â
âLittle git,â Albus muttered, âSo what happened?â
âWe told him to go away, but he wouldnât,â John explained, âHe whipped out his wand and tried to hex Amanda, but missed her. Madam Pomfrey came out when she heard the commotion and told him to get back to his common room or sheâd get Slughorn. Then she told us Matt was still unconscious and we wouldnât be able to see him.â
âMalfoyâs really got to stop investigating this,â Albus responded, âHe canât find out. Heâs got to mind his own business.â
âWe canât let anyone find out,â Rose agreed.
âBut heâs still not up?â Albus sighed, âWhatever is going on, it sounds really bad.â
âI know,â Rose shook her head.
âWell, his birthday is next week,â John reminded them.
âOh, yeah, on the sixth, Wednesday,â Albus remembered.
âI think we should do something for it,â John stated, âEven if heâs still in the Hospital Wing.â
âI bet he will be,â Rose said, âBut we can still do something if weâre allowed in.â
âLetâs plan it, then,â John announced, âOur first Hogwarts birthday party. Because you guys didnât do anything for mine,â he added.
âYour birthday was over the holiday!â Rose lightly smacked him with her DADA book.
âI know,â John grinned, âAnyway, we could bring some food into the Hospital Wing and have the party there.â
âGreat idea!â Albus grinned.
âBut none of us know where the kitchens are,â Amanda reminded them.
âNo problem,â Albus glanced around the common room, âOi! Bradley, Mark!â he waved his two cousins over.
âWhatcha need, Albus?â Bradley asked as he sat down in an empty chair at the table.
âWeâre going to have a little birthday party for our friend, Matt,â Albus told them, âBut none of us know where the kitchens are. So, since thereâs a Hogsmeade visit on Saturday, could you get us some stuff?â
âSure, no problem,â Mark said, âButterbeers and some stuff from Honeydukeâs sound good?â
âYeah, thatâd be great.â
âWhat should we get him for a present?â Rose asked.
âHmm, I dunnoâŠâ John stopped to think, âStuff from Weasleyâs is always good.â
âHow about a Chudley Cannons jersey?â Albus suggested.
âSounds good!â John agreed. Rose and Amanda nodded their heads.
âAnywhere in Hogsmeade that you could get one of those?â Albus asked his cousins.
âThe Quaffle Shop should have it. Iâve only been there once. It just opened up this past summer,â Bradley told them, âI can get you one.â
âThanks!â Albus grinned.
âBut youâll have to give us money for everything,â Mark told them.
Albus, John, Rose, and Amanda each forked over a couple sickles and handed them to Mark.
âOk, weâll get the stuff and give it to you when we get back,â Bradley said, and he and Mark rejoined their friends on the other side of the common room.
âItâs really rotten luck that heâs going to be in the Hospital Wing on his birthday,â John commented.
âYeah, but weâll try to cheer him up,â Albus reasoned.
âWhat if Madam Pomfrey doesnât let us in?â Amanda wondered.
âShe better,â Rose stated, âBut sheâs got to, itâll be his birthday. If anything, we can always get Amy to let us in.â
âTrue, sheâd be able to convince Madam Pomfrey. Sheâs got some temper,â John laughed.
âJust as long as we donât ask her too many questions,â Rose said, âAmy obviously doesnât want anyone knowing about Mattâs, er, problem.â
âWe wonât,â Albus told her, âHopefully Madam Pomfrey will just let us in and we wonât need Amy to do any convincing.â
Rose glanced at her watch, âWell, itâs getting kind of late. Iâm going to bed,â she started packing up her books, âDid you all finish your homework?â
âYep,â they all answered.
âGood night, then,â Rose got up and walked over to the girlâs dormitories.
âI guess Iâll go to bed, too,â Albus put his books away and got up.
âMe, too,â John and Amanda put their stuff away. Amanda caught up with Rose and followed her up the stairs.
John headed up to the boyâs dormitories with Albus. As Albus got ready for bed, he thought about Mattâs birthday party. He hoped that Matt would be up for it, and that Madam Pomfrey would let them in. Hopefully, they would be able to have the party and that it would cheer him up. He also wondered how much longer Matt would be able to keep his secret from his friends. Albus only hoped that someday, he would trust them enough to tell them. He got into bed and his thoughts drifted to Scorpius Malfoy and how suspicious he was about Matt. Would they be able to keep him from finding out? And what would happen if he did find out one day? The thought of Scorpius finding out worried Albus right until he fell asleep.
******
âHis ideals will be realized,â a cold voice surrounded Albus.
âWhose ideals?â Albus asked.
âThe one you fear the most,â the voice answered. It was coming from a cloaked figure that was circling Albus. They were in a dark, small room. Albus was sitting in a hard chair in the middle.
âVoldemort?â Albus responded nervously, âBut heâs dead.â
âIt doesnât matter!â the voice screamed, âThere are others to carry out his plans!â
âTheyâre all in Azkaban.â Albus tried to make out who the cloaked figure was, but it was too dark.
âNot all of them. There are some who roam free,â the figure whispered in Albusâs ear, âNow, perhaps you can help me.â
âSorry, I canât,â Albus glared at him, feeling braver than he had a second ago.
âOh, I think you can,â the figure pulled out his wand and pointed it at Albus. He muttered a spell and Albusâs hands and feet became bound by magical rope. âNow, maybe you can tell me where the Hallows are?â
Albusâs eyes widened and he stared at the man, âWhat do you know about Hallows?â
âNot nearly as much as you do,â the man answered, âNow tell me where they are!â
âI donât know!â Albus shouted, feeling the ropes constrict his hands. He winced in pain.
âIâm sure you do!â
âNO! I donât!â The ropes dug into his wrists even more as he felt the circulation to his hands being cut off.
âTell me!â The man forcefully shook Albusâs chair. âYou donât want to know what Iâll do if you donât!â
âBut I donât even know what Hallows are!â Albus screamed in pain, âWhat are they?!â
âYou know perfectly well what they are! Now tell me where they are!â
âNO!â
âTell!â the man shook the chair so hard it fell over, taking Albus with it. He screamed as his head hit the cold, hard floor.
âAlbus!â an anxious voice whispered, âWake up!â
âNo, no, no, I donât know what they areâŠâ Albus moaned in his sleep.
âItâs just a dream, wake up,â a warm hand shook him gently, and Albus wrenched his eyes open. He saw John looking down at him with a scared look on his face. Bilius and Ethan were behind him, glancing around nervously.
Albus rubbed his eyes and noticed he was not on his bed anymore. He was laying on the floor, in a tangle of blankets. He was sweating profusely and his heart was beating fast.
âShould I get Madam Pomfrey?â Bilius asked tentatively.
âMaybe we should get Professor Potter,â John responded.
âIs he back yet?â Ethan questioned.
Albus started to detangle himself from the bedclothes. He knew what the dream had been. And he knew he needed to see his dad as soon as possible. âIâm fine, Iâve just got to go talk to my dad.â
âDâyou want me to go with you?â John asked.
âNo, Iâll be fine,â Albus got up and rummaged in his trunk for his dressing robe.
âAre you sure? You donât look too good.â
Albus pulled on his robe and stepped into his shoes, âI told you, Iâll be fine.â He left the dormitory and went down to the deserted common room. A glance at the clock told him it was just past four a.m. He was about to exit through the portrait hole, when he remembered what his dad had told him over Christmas. No more wandering the corridors. He looked around the room to try and find a portrait that was awake. He spotted one in a picture of a herd of cattle, it was a short knight riding atop a fat pony.
âExcuse me,â Albus asked tentatively as he walked over to the picture, âI was wondering if you could do something for me? If itâs not too much trouble. I need you to go get someone for me.â
The knight puffed out his chest and turned his pony towards Albus, âA quest?â
âEr, well, I suppose you could consider it a quest. Who are you?â
âI, am Sir Cadogan, at your service!â the knight saluted Albus and bowed his head low.
âUm, ok, and Iâm Albus Potter. I was wondering if you could go get my dad. Harry Potter.â
âHarry Potter! Quite the nice young lad, I remember him well. I helped him on a quest once! And you are his son. Well, I shall help you on your quest. I shall not let scoundrel nor beast stop me! I will find your dad or I shall perish trying!â
âThanks, then,â Albus responded, thinking that this was the strangest portrait heâd ever met. And that heâd have to ask his dad about the âquestâ Sir Cadogan had helped him with. âJust tell him to come to Gryffindor Tower, and that itâs very important.â
âI will do just that!â the strange knight replied, âOff I go then! Nothing shall stop me. Sir Cadogan lets nothing get in the way of his quests. A quest to find the great Harry Potter! On with ye, then!â he shouted at his pony. Sir Cadogan traveled through a few portraits in the common room, waking up the occupants and earning nasty looks from them as he went. Eventually, the noise died down and Sir Cadogan exited the room.
Albus looked around the common room as he waited for his dad. It was very different in the dead of night. He was the sole occupant and had his choice of places to sit. As a first year, Albus rarely got the good arm chairs near the fire. He walked over and sat down in one, but as the fire had died away hours ago, it was just as cold as the rest of the room. Albus sighed as he stared into the empty fireplace. What had that dream meant? Who was the hooded figure and why did they think that Albus knew where the âHallowsâ were? As Albus thought about this, he realized that as horrible as the dream had been, it did give him more information on the âHallowsâ. He now knew that they were objects. Objects that someone was trying to locate and probably steal. He would have to tell Rose when she got up. But what were the âHallowsâ? And why did this person want them? It must have something to do with Voldemortâs âidealsâ, of course. Whoever was creating these dreams in Albusâs mind must want to try to carry out Voldemortâs plans. The very thought of another Voldemort sent shivers up Albusâs spine. He jumped as he heard a noise behind him. When he turned around, he noticed that Sir Cadogan was back in the picture of the cows. Albus got up and walked over to it.
Sir Cadogan placed his sword into its holster and saluted Albus, âI have had success with the quest! The Great Harry Potter has been found and shall be entering the room shortly!â
Albus looked at the knight and grinned nervously, âThanks, Sir Cadogan.â
âAnytime! Anytime!â the knight said excitedly, âI must be off now, for I spotted someone on the way back and Iâve got to see what they are up to! No scoundrel gets past Sir Cadogan!â
âRight,â Albus responded.
âWell, then, Iâll be off!â Sir Cadogan drew his sword again, âBut if you are ever in need of knightly service again, be sure to call on Sir Cadogan!â The strange knight and his pony sped out of the portrait, yet again waking the occupants of the portraits he passed through, and left the room.
The portrait hole opened and a very tired looking Harry crawled through. He looked at his son and grinned, âAh, the amount of times I snuck back through here in the dead of nightâŠâ
Albus ran towards his dad and hugged him tight. Harry hugged him back and led him over to the large arm chairs near the fire. Harry sat down in one and pulled Albus onto his lap. âWhatâs going on? I was just getting to sleep when that mad knight came in and told me you needed to talk to me. Wouldnât give me any details, just said it was urgent. I thought he was going to wake half the castle, the way he was shouting through the corridors,â Harry laughed.
Albus looked at his dad and laughed nervously, âHe was the only one awake. Seemed very eager to go on a quest. And he said heâd taken you on a quest once. Iâd like to know all about that.â
Harry grinned, thinking back to the time in his third year when Sir Cadogan had led him, Ron, and Hermione to the Divination classroom. âOf course. How could I forget that? I was in third year and your Uncle Ron, Aunt Hermione, and I were trying to find the Divination room. Sir Cadogan helped us find it. We did get there, but he is a bit insane. Later on that year he was recruited to guard the Gryffindor common room entrance after Sirius slashed the Fat Ladyâs portrait. Of course, everyone thought he was a mass murderer and when Sir Cadogan let him into the tower later on, his days as the guard of the room were over.â
Albus stared at him, âWow. Well, heâs got to be the most insane portrait Iâve ever met.â
âMe, too, Al,â Harry agreed, âNow, what was so urgent?â
âI had another dream,â Albus whispered, âOnly this one was different.â
Harryâs smile faded away and was replaced by a more serious look, âWhat happened in this one?â
Albus quickly rehashed the dream to his dad, and by the end he was shaking again and almost in tears. Harry wrapped his arms around Albus and held him close.
âItâs ok, Al,â Harry reassured him, âBut thanks for letting me know. I hate to say it, but that dream does help confirm what I thought this was leading to.â
âAnd what would that be?â Albus asked, blinking back his tears.
âIâm sorry, but I canât tell you. You will find out, though, once itâs all sorted out.â
âBut what are Hallows?â
âThatâs another thing I canât tell you. I will tell you sometime down the road, though,â Harry responded, âAnyway, Hermione tells me your Occlumency lessons are going well.â
âApparently not well enough,â Albus groaned, âAfter tonightâs nightmare.â
âIt takes a while, Al, and itâs harder when youâre sleeping.â
âI know, and I am trying.â
âI know you are.â
âSo,â Albus said, changing the subject, âDid everything go ok at the Ministry?â
âOh, that went fine,â Harry told him, âEverythingâs smoothed over. Rita Skeeterâs received a warning and so has the editor of the Prophet.â
âEveryone hereâs been pretty worried. Rita Skeeter succeeded in scaring everyone,â Albus responded.
âYeah, but itâll die down. Once the next Quidditch match comes around itâll all be forgotten,â Harry grinned, âNothing like Quidditch to take your mind off everything.â
âDefinitely,â Albus agreed, âNext match is in three weeks. Hufflepuff vs. Ravenclaw. I bet Ravenclaw will win.â
âYouâre probably right. Iâm betting itâll be between Gryffindor and Ravenclaw for the cup.â
âYeah, and I hope we win it!â Albus said excitedly.
âMe, too, Al,â Harry smiled and lifted Albus off his lap, âNow, Iâve got to get a few hours sleep and you probably should, too.â
âOk,â Albus yawned.
âIâll see you in class later on, Al,â Harry stood up and gave his son one last hug, âI love you.â
âLove you too,â Albus watched as his dad left the common room. He smiled as he walked up the circular staircase to the dormitory. He felt a whole lot better after talking to his dad.
âAlbus,â John whispered from his four poster bed, âAre you all right?â
âYeah,â Albus whispered back as he climbed into bed, âAre Ethan and Bilius sleeping?â
âI think so, one of them started snoring a few minutes ago,â John told him.
âGood. I had another one of those dreams where someoneâs using Legilimency on me.â
âI figured. Was it the same one?â
âNo, this one was different. My dad says it confirms some of his suspicions, which isnât really good. Heâll take care of it, though.â
âGood. So heâs back, then?â
âYup, everythingâs fine with the Ministry and the Prophet, now. Well, Rita Skeeter and the editor of the Prophet got into a bit of trouble,â Albus laughed.
âThatâs great! Iâm glad your dadâs back. Now things can get back to normal. Well, as normal as they ever are around here.â
âYeah,â Albus said softly, âWell, good night.â
ââNight.â
******
Albus didnât get much sleep that night. Thoughts of his new nightmare kept him up the rest of the night. He gave up trying to sleep by 7am and got up. By the time John woke up, he was ready to go to breakfast. The two boys met Rose and Amanda at the Gryffindor table and had breakfast. Albus noticed that there was a lot of whispering going on and he suspected it was due to the fact that Harry was back from the Ministry. Albus continued thinking about his nightmare during breakfast and was very quiet. John and Amanda did not notice this because they were in the middle of arguing about whether the Potions essay had to be a foot of parchment or just six inches. Albus suspected Amanda was right and the essay had to be a foot. Rose, however, kept looking at Albus while she ate her food.
âIs something wrong?â she asked him.
Albus glanced around to check if anyone was paying attention to them, luckily, no one was. âYeah, I had another weird dream last night. This one was different.â
âReally?â Rose stared at him with wide eyes. âWhat was it about?â
âCanât tell you here. Iâll tell you at lunch. Iâve got to tell James, too. The common room should be empty when everyoneâs at lunch,â Albus whispered.
Morning classes seemed to drag on forever. Albus kept looking at the clock throughout both DADA and charms, waiting for lunch. He really wanted Roseâs opinion of the dream and couldnât wait to tell her about the Hallows aspect of it. Harry started DADA by telling the class that everything was straightened out with the Ministry and they had nothing to worry about. Albus suspected he was going to tell every class that. Charms was just as horrible as usual, and it ended with Washburn rescheduling the detention that Albus couldnât attend earlier due to Occlumency. He would be doing lines at noon on Saturday.
Once Charms was over, Albus and Rose went to find James. Rose had told John and Amanda that the Potions essay did have to be a foot, so John was spending his lunch in the library trying to come up with another half foot of essay. Amanda had gone along to help him. Albus and Rose found James in the Great Hall and after the three of them ate a rushed lunch, they headed up to the common room. It was, as suspected, deserted.
âOk, so whatâs so important that I had to practically skip lunch for?â James asked once they were in the room.
âI had another funny dream last night,â Albus told him, âThis one was different.â Albus explained the dream in detail, including the parts about the Hallows.
James and Rose stared at Albus for a few moments before Rose spoke, âWell, this is is kind of good. Now we know that the Hallows are objects. I was almost thinking that they were a series of spells or something.â
âBut we still donât know what they are,â James sighed.
âOr why I should know where they are,â Albus stated, âThis would be a whole lot easier if Dad would just tell us.â
âBut he wonât,â James replied angrily.
âAnd I hate to say it, but I donât think weâre going to find any answers in the library. Weâve looked in practically all the books that have to do with the war and Iâve looked through all the Prophets from that year, too,â Rose told them.
The three of them stood in silence for a few minutes, trying to think of some answers. James had started pacing. Albus sat down in a chair and tried to think of some other way they could find out what the Hallows were.
âWell, letâs go over the clues again,â Rose announced, âThe Hallows are something secretive, and our parents wonât tell us what they are because they donât want us to tell anyone. None of our aunts or uncles or cousins know about them either. So, maybe itâs just our parents who know about them? If thatâs true, then no wonder we couldnât find the answer in a book. None of our parents have ever written a book.â
âYeah,â James agreed, âItâs got to be something just our parents know about.â
âWell, they were the ones who destroyed most of the Horcruxes. Maybe itâs got something to do with that?â Albus suggested.
âThat could be,â James agreed, âIf only there was someone else we could ask about it.â
The room fell silent again, as they sank into their thoughts again. Suddenly Rose jumped up from her chair. âIâve got it!â
âWhat?â James and Albus asked at the same time.
âWho we can ask about the Hallows! I canât believe I didnât think of it before!â
âWell, who is it?â Albus asked.
âDumbledore!â
âWhat?!â James shouted, âBut heâs dead!â
âI know that,â Rose said, âBut thereâs a portrait of him in Kendrickâs office!â
âOh, yeah.â
âAnyway,â Rose began, âDumbledoreâs the one who told Uncle Harry about the Horcruxes, so he might know something about the Hallows, too!â
âThatâs genius, Rose!â Albus grinned at her.
âThanks. We just have to figure out how to get into Kendrickâs office.â
âThat could be tricky,â Albus said, âEither of you know where his office is?â
Rose and James shook their heads. âNeither do I,â Albus sighed.
A mischievous grin spread across Roseâs face, âBut I know how we can get in.â
The boys looked at her skeptically. âHow?â James asked.
âWell, if you get in enough trouble, you get taken to Kendrickâs office.â
âBut what if we get expelled?â Albus asked warily.
âDonât worry, you wonât.â
âYouâve got a plan, then?â James inquired.
âSort of,â Rose told them, âIâve got a vague idea. Itâll be me and Albus who are doing it. Iâm going to cause some kind of mayhem in Washubrnâs class-â
âWashburn?! Are you crazy?â Albus shouted.
âJust let me explain. Washburn doesnât hate me nearly as much as he hates you. So heâs going to assume the chaos was caused by you since we sit at the same table. Heâll start screaming, which will probably cause another teacher to come running. Washburn will tell that teacher what you supposedly did and youâll get taken to Kendrickâs office. Youâll talk to Dumbledoreâs portrait about the Hallows. Simple as that.â
James and Albus looked at her with shocked expressions on their faces. âBut Iâll get in huge trouble,â Albus said flatly.
âNo, you wonât,â Rose assured him, âI might, but you wonât. After Washburn dismisses the class, Iâll run to Uncle Harry and tell him it was really me who caused the distraction.â
âBut I donât want you to get in trouble, either,â Albus told her.
âItâs ok. I have hardly been in trouble at all this year. Anyway, all we need is the distraction.â
âIâve got it,â James announced, âOne of Uncle Georgeâs fireworks. Iâve got a whole supply up in my dormitory.â
âExcellent!â Rose said excitedly, âAnd Iâll just tell Uncle Harry that it went off accidentally. Iâll probably just end up with lines or something for having a banned object in my possession.â
âPerfect,â Albus smiled, finally satisfied that no one would get in huge trouble.
âI think we ought to wait a few weeks to do it, since you just got a detention from Washburn, Albus,â Rose told them.
âOk, just let us know when you think we ought to do it,â James responded.
âI will,â Rose assured him, âWeâd better be off to class. See you later.â
âBye,â Albus said to James as he followed Rose to Potions. He was excited and nervous at the same time at the prospect of talking with Dumbledore about the Hallows. Would he finally learn what was being kept from him? Only time would tell.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Iâve done it again! I merged 2 chapters, due to the shortness of each. This resulted in the longest chapter yet. Hope you enjoyed it!
Thanks as always to my beta and sister, Dancer_of_Starlight. She has been especially helpful in coming up with characters for Albusâs third year. Thanks as well to my brother and other sister, and to inkheart for the review!
Disclaimer- As usual, I do not own Harry Potter
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
The rest of the week flew by in a flurry of classes and homework. Albus and his friends found that they had no time to do anything other than homework during their spare time. They had not even found time to visit Matt, but they didnât even know if he was awake yet. Rose was already freaking out over the end of term exams, which were still over four months away, and was using every waking moment to study. Albus was not yet worried about exams and was more concerned about just completing all the assigned homework.
Quinton Willinson had not bothered Albus or any of his friends since Albus had left the Hospital Wing. Albus was not sure whether this was due to Willinsonâs upcoming N.E.W.T. exams, the large amount of detentions he received, or fear of what Harry would do if he continued tormenting Albus. Albus did not care which one it was, he was just glad Willinson had given up for the time being. However, the same could not be said about Scorpius Malfoy. Malfoy continued to pester Albus, Rose, John, and Amanda about what was wrong with Matt whenever they were in class together. Albus found this more annoying than anything else, because Malfoy rarely ever brought out his wand during these confrontations. Malfoy kind of reminded Albus of his Great Aunt Petunia because she was also very nosy. Malfoy stood no chance of ever finding out about Matt from Albus or the others, but Albus did worry about what would happen if Malfoy found out on his own.
Albus slept late on Saturday morning and woke up with just enough time to grab a bite to eat in the Great Hall before rushing off to his detention with Washburn. As much as Albus hated these detentions, he had become kind of immune to them. Albus had been upset about the first few, but lately he had started to take them in stride. As long as it was just lines, Albus didnât worry about them too much.
When Albus arrived in the Charms classroom at noon, Professor Washburn was sitting at his desk with the usual scowl on his face. âSit down, Potter,â he barked.
âYes, sir,â Albus responded quietly while taking a seat at the front table.
âGet out your parchment and ink. Write âI will not misbehave in Charmsâ until I tell you to stop.â
âYes, sir,â Albus repeated as he took out a roll of parchment and a quill. He started to write. Washburn never told Albus how many times he would have to write the line. He supposed Washburn liked to keep Albus there until he looked sufficiently tired and uncomfortable. Washburn had no way of knowing how many lines that would take. However, he never kept Albus in detention for less than an hour. Albus kept repeating the line on his parchment while trying hard not to look at the clock. He found that looking at the clock just made the time go by slower. Eventually, Albus stole a glance at the clock and found that it had only been 45 minutes. He sighed.
âYou say something?â Washburn growled.
âNo, sir,â Albus said without looking up from his paper. He wrote a few more lines and was startled when he heard footsteps come into the room. He glanced up to see that a tall man he didnât recognize walking towards Washburn. The man was wearing a black cloak and had short brown hair. It reminded Albus of the kind of haircut Muggles in the army had. Washburn got up from his seat when the man approached.
Washburn turned to Albus, âDonât go anywhere. If you do, Iâll have you in detention for the rest of term.â
Albus nodded, but didnât say a word. The strange man followed Washburn into his office and shut the door behind them. There was silence for a moment and then Albus was able to hear raised voices coming from the office. They had forgotten to cast Muffliato before they started talking. It sounded like they were arguing about something, but Albus couldnât make out what it was. He wished theyâd argue a bit louder. Albus put down his quill and strained to hear what they were saying. The two men stayed in the office for about fifteen minutes before Washburn stormed out of it, looking quite angry, followed by the other man who seemed rather calm. Albus quickly picked up his quill and continued his lines.
Washburn returned to his desk while the strange man walked over to the door. He turned around to look at Washburn and said icily, âRemember, this is your job, no one elseâs. And I expect you to complete it soon.â Then the man left, shutting the door behind him.
Washburn stared at the back of the door for a few minutes, before turning and glaring at Albus. âYouâre done. Get back to your common room,â he seethed.
Albus did not hesitate. He got up quickly and ran out of the room. Todayâs detention had been much shorter than others. Albus suspected that this was due to whatever Washburn and the other wizard were talking about. Washburn was definitely up to something. Apparently he had a job to do. But what could it be? Albus couldnât help but wonder if the Charms professor was involved with something evil. He ran all the way to the common room to tell his friends what he had overheard.
When Albus rushed through the portrait hole, he immediately spotted his friends at one of the tables. He grabbed a chair and sat down next to Rose.
âThat was short,â Rose commented.
âI know, I lucked out today,â Albus responded, âBut Iâve got to tell you about Washburn.â
âWhat about him?â John asked, looking up from his book.
âIn the middle of my detention, some strange wizard came barging into the room,â Albus told them.
âWho was he?â Rose asked.
âI dunno, thatâs the thing. Iâd never seen him before.â
âWhat did he look like?â Amanda asked. Albus described the man, but none of his friends recognized the description either.
âMaybe he was a parent of one of the students,â Rose suggested.
âWho knows?â Albus said, âBut he got into a huge argument with Washburn.â
âWell, thatâs not difficult,â John laughed, âAnything will set him off.â
âWhat did they argue about?â Rose asked.
âIâm not sure. They were in Washburnâs office. I couldnât make out what they were saying, but they were definitely rowing about something. And then, right before the guy left, he said âremember, this is your job to do and I want it done soonâ to Washburn. Or something like that.â
Rose, John, and Amanda stared at Albus for a moment before Rose replied, âThatâs so strange. So Washburnâs doing something for this wizard?â
âYeah, I think so. Heâs definitely up to something. And I donât think itâs anything good,â Albus informed them.
âYou think theyâre doing something evil?â John asked skeptically.
âMaybe, but I donât really know.â
âI dunno,â John said warily, âI mean, Washburnâs horrible to you and James, and all the Gryffindors, really. But I donât know if heâs really into the Dark Arts or anything.â
âYeah,â Rose agreed, âThat âjobâ could be anything. It doesnât have to be something bad.â
âBut Washburn seemed so mad about it. Just seems weird to me.â
âItâs definitely fishy, but I donât think we should jump to conclusions,â Rose replied, âI mean, look at Snape. Uncle Harry thought he was evil, but he wasnât.â
âI suppose,â Albus sighed.
âAnyone want to go see if we can visit Matt?â John asked a few minutes later.
âGood idea,â Albus agreed, âI hope Madam Pomfrey lets us.â
âI hope heâs awake,â Rose closed her books and put them away in her bag.
âWe can at least try to convince Madam Pomfrey to let us visit him on his birthday if she doesnât let us today,â John reasoned.
The four friends packed up their books and put them away in their dormitories. A few minutes later, they found themselves walking to the Hospital Wing. They walked in silence the whole way there, each one knowing what the other was thinking about. All four of them were hoping Matt was awake and worrying about him. Albus had been worrying ever since the morning he found out Matt was a werewolf. But at the same time, Albus felt a bit angry that Matt wouldnât trust him with his secret. Albusâs rational side knew why Matt wasnât very trusting, but couldnât help wishing that Matt would confide in him. Albus supposed that part of this was due to his dad not trusting him with knowing what the âHallowsâ were. He wished more people would trust him.
When they reached the Hospital Wing, they noticed that the doors were still shut, and when John tried to open them, they found out that they were still locked as well.
âThis isnât a good sign,â John sighed.
Rose banged on the doors and shouted, âMadam Pomfrey!â
A minute later, Madam Pomfrey opened the door a crack and stuck her head out. âWhat do you need?â
âIs Matt awake?â Rose whispered.
âYes, he woke up last night.â
âWell, can we see him?â Rose asked hopefully.
âNo, Iâm sorry, but he really canât have visitors right now,â Madam Pomfrey sighed.
âIs he all right?â John interrupted.
âHeâll be fine in a couple of weeks or so.â
âCan we come visit him on his birthday? Itâs next Wednesday. Please?â Albus pleaded.
Madam Pomfreyâs expression softened, âI think that would be all right. Not before Wednesday, though. Iâll see you then.â
âGreat! Thanks, Madam Pomfrey,â Albus smiled as she closed the door to the ward.
âIâm glad heâs awake now,â Rose said as they walked back to the common room, âAnd we get to see him on his birthday.â
âYeah, and we didnât even need Amy to convince her!â John grinned.
âCanât wait until Wednesday,â Albus said.
âDefinitely,â Amanda agreed.
âBoo!â a voice said from behind them. Amanda shrieked and they all turned around. Bradley and Mark were laughing.
âGotcha!â Bradley shouted.
âWe got your stuff from Hogsmeade,â Mark told them. He handed them two bags filled with butterbeer and sweets.
âAwesome,â Albus took the bags.
âAnd hereâs the Chudley Cannons jersey. Although, what he sees in themâŠâ Bradley shook his head as he handed John the jersey.
âThanks, guys,â Albus said to his cousins.
âNo problem,â Bradley said, âI remember the days of not being able to go to Hogsmeade. We always got Stanley and Heather to get our stuff for us. Glad those days are over now.â
âI canât wait to go to Hogsmeade,â John announced, âThink of all the pranking stuff weâll be able to buy. Thereâs only so much you can fit in your trunk and bring from home.â
âEndless possibilities, Mate,â Mark told John, âWell, weâd better be off. Weâve put off the homework long enough. Play first, work later. Thatâs our motto.â
âBad motto, if you ask me,â Rose whispered as her cousins took off for the common room.
âTheyâll survive,â Albus assured her, âHavenât failed a class yet, have they?â
âNo, they havenât,â Rose agreed, âWeâd better go, too.â
âYeah, Iâve still got to write that whole essay for Potions,â Amanda sighed.
Albus groaned, âIâd forgotten about that. Havenât even started.â
Albus, Rose, John, and Amanda continued walking to the common room. Once they were there, they spent the remainder of the afternoon writing essays about the properties of moonstone.
******
During the next few days, Albus and his friends debated about whether they should ask Matt how he wound up in the Hospital Wing when they went to see him on his birthday. Albus thought they should avoid the topic altogether, still believing that Matt would tell them when he was ready. However, Rose thought it would seem suspicious if they didnât ask what happened, because if your friend gets injured, you would want to know what happened. As it stood right now, the only people in the castle who knew what really happened were the teachers, Amy, Albus, Rose, John, and Amanda. Of course, no one knew that Albus and his friends knew what happened. Despite this, many people asked them what happened. Albus just told them he had no idea and after a few days, they gave up asking. Albus had heard quite a few ridiculous rumors about it. He overheard a few second year Hufflepuffs telling a couple Ravenclaws that Matt had been attacked by a thestral. This same story had been repeated throughout the castle, only with a different creature being substituted each time, including a Hippogriff and a centaur. The centaur story was especially ridiculous and Albus was sure the centaurs would not be happy if that story reached their ears.
In the end, Albus and his friends decided that they would ask Matt what happened, but they would not dwell on the subject. Albus was sure that Matt, or maybe even Amy, had come up with some kind of story to cover up what happened. Despite this, Amy was not telling anyone the story. She just ignored anyone who brought it up. Her friends, including Victoire, stayed close by her at all times and wouldnât let anyone push the matter. Albus suspected that Victoire had already been fed the fake story, but he didnât ask her about it.
After dinner on February sixth, Albus, Rose, John, and Amanda found themselves walking to the Hospital Wing armed with party supplies and a wrapped present.
Rose was the first to reach the door and when she went to knock, everyone was surprised to find that the door pushed open. âItâs unlocked!â Rose gasped.
âThat must mean Mattâs doing better!â Albus said excitedly.
âLetâs go, then!â John pushed past Albus and Rose and walked into the room. Amanda followed him and then Albus and Rose walked in. Albus spotted Mattâs bed, but the curtains were pulled around it. He didnât see Madam Pomfrey anywhere.
âMadam Pomfrey!â Rose shouted, âAre you here?â
Madam Pomfrey peeked her head out from behind the curtains and smiled at them. âRose! You can visit as soon as Iâm done giving him his evening potions.â
âOk, thanks, Madam Pomfrey,â Rose responded.
A few minutes later, the nurse came back out and walked over to where Albus and his friends were standing. âWhat do you have in those bags?â she eyed their packages suspiciously.
âOh, just some Honeydukes stuff, Butterbeer, and a present,â Albus told her.
âBut none of itâs Weasley products, is it?â
âNo.â
Madam Pomfrey relaxed, âOk, good. The last thing I need is to have this place destroyed while you have your party! You can go see him now.â
Albus ran to the bed, followed by his friends, and pulled back the curtain. Amy was sitting in a chair next to the bed and whispering to Matt. She stopped abruptly when the curtain opened.
âHey, Matt!â Albus grinned and sat down at the end of the bed. âHow are you?â
âIâm all right,â Matt replied hoarsely, âBut Iâve been better.â
âGlad to see youâre awake, mate,â John sat down next to Albus and set the bag of party stuff on the floor.
Rose and Amanda smiled and sat in chairs that Amy had conjured after they came in. Rose pulled the curtains closed and handed Matt his present. âHappy Birthday!â everyone shouted.
âThanks, guys!â Matt grinned and tore open the wrapping. âWow! A Chudley Canons jersey! This is brilliant!â
âIâm glad you like it,â Albus said, âMy cousins picked it up in Hogsmeade for us. They also got us butterbeers and sweets.â
âExcellent!â Matt replied excitedly.
John picked up the bag and passed out butterbeer and jelly slugs. âSo,â he began once everyone started eating, âWhat exactly happened to you? Weâve heard the craziest rumors. You didnât really get attacked by a herd of thestrals, did you?â
Matt started choking on his butterbeer and Amy slapped him on the back. He gave her a worried look and then looked back at John. âReally?â he sputtered.
It was a bit hard to believe that Matt had been attacked by thestrals, when Hagrid had the school thestrals very well trained. But on the other hand, Matt did look like heâd been attacked by a large creature. He had partially healed cuts, bites, and scratches all over all his body. His arms and legs were covered in bandages and just about all of his body was bruised. Albus could see how someone would suspect he was attacked by a thestral.
âWell, thatâs what the Hufflepuffs are saying,â John told him.
âThe Ravenclaws think it was a Hippogriff,â Amanda chimed in.
Matt sighed and glanced at Amy, who gave him a look. âIt wasnât either,â Matt began, âI got a bit too close to the Whomping Willow.â
âWhat?!â John exclaimed, âReally?
âEr, yeah,â Matt said.
Albus was debating about whether to ask Matt to elaborate or not when he continued.
âI spent the night here when Albus took me that one night. Then I left in the morning and went for a walk on the grounds. I wasnât paying attention to where I was going and the tree gave me quite a beating.â
âWow,â Albus responded, âIâm glad youâre ok.â
âYeah,â John said, âBut when do you get to leave here?â
âIâm not really sure,â Matt told them, âNot for at least another week. Madam Pomfrey wants the cuts healed and the bruises faded before I leave. And I canât really walk that well.â
âA whole week?â Rose exclaimed.
âAt least,â Matt responded, âI hope itâs not more. Iâm getting so bored. Whatâs been going on in the rest of the castle?â
âWell, did you see that article Rita Skeeter wrote last week?â Albus asked.
âYeah, I read it yesterday. But Amy told me there wasnât anything to worry about.â
âSheâs right. But the whole castleâs talking about it. Dad thinks itâll blow over when the next Quidditch match arrives.â
âHeâs probably right,â Rose agreed.
âI hope I get to leave here before the next match. I donât want to miss it,â Matt said.
âI hope so too,â John took a sip of butterbeer, âNothing worse than missing Quidditch.â
âI can think of no less than ten things,â Rose muttered.
âI think we might have a chance of winning the cup,â Albus said excitedly.
âThat would be so cool!â Amanda shouted, âI love Quidditch. I was never into Muggle sports, but Quidditch is awesome.â
âDefinitely,â John agreed, âI never saw the point of Muggle sports, but I guess if you canât play QuidditchâŠâ
They spent the next hour talking about Quidditch and everything else that was going on in the castle. Albus told Matt about how Xavier Goyle had melted his cauldron in potions the other day. The potion had spread across the floor and burned through Scorpius Malfoy and his friend, Jackson Limbertâs, shoes. The Gryffindors had thought this was very funny, especially when they found out that the potion had turned both boys feet pink. Other than that, nothing too exciting had happened in class during Mattâs absence. Washburn had continued being horrible to Albus and the other Gryffindors. In Transfiguration, they had started transfiguring Muggle pencils into quills. Rose, John, and a couple of the Ravenclaws were the only ones who had managed to do it.
After they had exhausted the topic of lessons, the conversation turned back to Quidditch. Professional Quidditch this time. No one seemed to think the Chudley Canons had any hope of ever making it to the Cup. Even Matt seemed to agree. No one had any idea who would be playing in the Cup this year, but it didnât matter much because it had already been decided that the Cup would take place in Russia and none of them would get to go anyway.
Amy spent the entire visit sitting next to Matt, so Albus was unable to share the contents of his newest dream or what had happened in detention the previous Saturday. Albus found out that Amy spent most of her spare time visiting Matt. He had never seen such a devoted sister before. Albus had thought his older cousins were protective, but they were nothing compared to Amy.
Eventually, Madam Pomfrey came back to tell them that they had stayed long enough and it was time for them to leave.
âWell, I hope you can leave soon,â Albus said as he stood up.
ââNight, Matt,â John cleaned up the leftover food and put it back in the bag.
âSee you soon,â Rose told him.
âBye,â Amanda stood up and followed everyone out from behind the curtains.
âBye, guys,â Matt yawned as they left.
âHe doesnât look good,â Albus whispered once they had left the room.
âNo, he doesnât,â Rose agreed, âBut at least heâs awake.â
âGood point, but I can see why Madam Pomfrey wonât let him leave yet. Everyone would bombard him with questions about what happened,â John pointed out.
âI donât think he knows you were in the Hospital Wing that night, Albus,â Amanda said, âHe says he spent the night in the Hospital Wing, but you know he didnât.â
âYeah,â Albus agreed, âAnd they brought him back there so early, there wouldnât have been any time for him to wander the grounds.â
âDonât point it out, though,â Rose warned him.
âI wonât,â Albus assured her, âWe agreed that we wouldnât say anything about what happened now that weâve heard the story.â
âHeâll have to tell us eventually,â John reasoned.
âI know. I hope itâs soon,â Albus said.
âI bet it will be soon,â Rose told them, âHow many stories can he come up with about what happens every full moon?â
âYeah,â Albus said, âI just hope itâs not worse next month.â
No one said anything else the rest of the way to the common room. Albus knew that everyone else was thinking what he was thinking. That it was very much a possibility that next month would be worse.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight, and thanks to my other sister and my brother. Thanks to inkheart for the review.
You may have noticed that I lost practically all my reviews for this story during the site crash. I had around 40 and lost all but 8. So please read and review!
I thought Iâd share that Iâve finished the sequel to this! Albus Potter and the Tracks They Left Behind, which is about Albusâs 2nd year, will be posted as soon as Iâve posted all of this one.
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
As February progressed, the castle grounds were blanketed in even more snow. The students found themselves going outside for snowball fights during much of their free time. These games started out as informal fun, but soon groups of people formed large teams that eventually led to each house having their own team. On occasion, half the school would be outside participating. The games usually resulted in a few students going to the hospital wing. The students also tracked quite a bit of snow and mud into the castle and Filch was not happy about it. He spent his time lurking near the front doors, waiting to yell at anyone who came inside with muddy shoes. Albus and his friends participated in a few snowball fights, but soon found that the older students were able to bewitch snowballs and it was hard for them to keep up. It was fun nonetheless, and even Rose took breaks from studying to join in.
They also made sure to visit Matt every night. They told him the latest news of the castle and helped him with his homework. No one mentioned his injuries beyond a simple âhow are you?â and Albus could tell that Matt wanted to avoid the subject. Eventually, after a full three weeks in the hospital wing, Madam Pomfrey finally let him leave. His bruises had faded, cuts had healed, and was looking almost normal. By now, the entire castle had heard the Whomping Willow story, and Albus hoped that no one would ask any questions about it.
âI am so glad to be out of there,â Matt said as he set his books down on a table in the common room the night he left the hospital wing.
âIâm glad you are, too,â Albus sat down and took out his transfiguration book.
âWe all are,â Rose grinned, but didnât sit down. She walked over to Albus and whispered in his ear, âIâve got to talk to you, alone. James, too. Weâll go up to your dormitory. Bilius and Ethan are down here, so itâll be empty.â
âWeâll be right back,â Albus told Matt, John, and Amanda as he got up. He went up to his dormitory and sat on the bed, waiting for his brother and cousin.
A few minutes later, Rose came into the room followed by a bewildered looking James. âWhat is it?â James asked.
âI think itâs time for our plan, you know, about getting Albus to talk to Dumbledore,â Rose told them.
âNow?â Albus asked in a shocked tone. The more he had thought about that plan, the more nervous he became. It could go wrong in so many ways.
âYes, I think so,â Rose replied adamantly, âIâve given up the library research.â
âReally?!â James laughed, âIâd better call the Prophet!â
âShut it, James,â Rose said. âTomorrow, during Charms, Iâll set off the fireworks and youâll get sent to Kendrickâs office. And then maybe weâll finally get some answers.â
âAll right,â Albus sighed. His curiosity trumped his desire to not cause anymore trouble in Washburnâs class.
âWeâll let you know how it goes, James,â Rose told her cousin.
James grinned, âSomehow, I think Iâm going to hear about it before I see you. This is brilliant, setting off fireworks in Washburnâs classâŠ.â
âIâm not talking about that!â Rose sighed, âIâm talking about the stuff with Dumbledore.â
âI know, but still. Blimey, I wish Iâd be there to see the look on Washburnâs faceâŠ.â
âNo, you donât,â Albus replied, âHeâs going to be livid.â
âYeah, but thatâs what weâre hoping for,â Rose said, âItâs the only way to get into Kendrickâs office.â
âI know, I just wish there was a better way,â Albus sighed.
âMe, too,â Rose said softly.
******
Albus hardly slept at all that night. He tossed and turned while worrying about the next dayâs charms class. He finally gave up sleeping around six in the morning and got up. Once John and Matt were up, the three of them headed down to breakfast.
Albus sat next to Rose, who was already there, and served himself some toast. However, Albus was too nervous to eat it. He just kept glancing up at the staff table, where Washburn was doing his usual morning glare at the students.
âAre you ok, Albus?â Matt asked, âYou donât look too good.â
âIâm just tired, I guess,â Albus said quietly while glancing at Rose. She gave him a sympathetic look, but didnât say anything. Amanda, John, and Matt had no idea what would be happening in Charms, of course, so they just thought Albus was sick.
âMaybe you should go to the Hospital Wing,â Matt suggested while stuffing eggs in his mouth.
âNo, Iâll be fine,â Albus assured him.
Albus couldnât pay attention during DADA. Harry lectured during the whole class, but Albus spent the whole time worrying about Charms. The class seemed to go by twice as fast as normal and before Albus knew it, it was over.
Albus walked to Charms with Rose, who told him that everything was set. The Weasley fireworks were in her bag, and ready to be set off. She didnât tell him when it would be happening, but Albus assumed it would be during the practical part of the class.
Washburn stormed into the room in his usual burst of fury. He went to his desk and took attendance. When he got to Mattâs name, a strange grin appeared on his face.
âNice of you to finally join us in class, Eckerton,â he sneered, âWhatâs it been? Three weeks? I certainly hope youâve been studying Charms while you skipped class.â
Albus glanced over at Matt, who was turning red and slouching down in his seat.
Washburn continued the attendance and when he was done, he started lecturing. Albusâs heart was pounding loudly now and he couldnât make out a word Washburn said. All he noticed was that Washburn was calling on Matt to answer every single question he asked. Matt had no idea what any of the answers were and was looking more miserable each minute. Eventually, Washburn announced that they would be charming paper birds to fly. He said that this charm was much like levitation, and if one was capable of levitating a paper bird, theyâd be capable of making one fly.
Albus groaned as he pulled out his wand. Levitation never ended well in this class, and he knew for a fact it wouldnât end well today. He glanced down at Roseâs bag, which was sitting in between them on the floor. Once Washburn settled down to grade homework at his desk, Albus noticed Rose turn her wand from her paper bird and towards her bag, which had been emptied of everything except the fireworks earlier. She gave Albus a nervous look and muttered an incantation.
A loud explosion erupted from the bag and a large hippogriff made of fire floated towards the ceiling. Everyone stopped what they were doing and stared at it. A few people screamed. Albus put on a mortified face while Rose tried her best to look surprised.
âPotter!â Washburn ran out from behind his desk and was in front of Albus within five seconds. Albus had never heard him scream so loud. âWhat on earth are you doing?! Must you always disrupt my class like this?! Never have I seen such a blatant disruption!â He was shouting so loud now that Albus was sure everyone in the castle had heard him.
âIâll have you expelled from this castle!â Washburn continued, âIâll make sure you-â
âWhat is going on in here?â Professor Patil came charging into the room and interrupted Washburnâs tirade. She saw the firework and pointed her wand at it. It disappeared immediately.
âPotter has disrupted my class yet again! He set off a firework while I was trying to teach!â Washburn informed her, âAnd I will make sure there is some punishment! He has gotten away with far too much.â
âWell, I think this is a matter that is better taken up with the Headmaster,â Professor Patil replied, âCome along, Potter.â
Albus nodded and got up from the table. So far, so good. The plan was going as well as it could be. He was going to make it to the Headmasterâs office. He followed Patil out into the hallway. Washburn glared at him as he left, his mouth opening and closing, but no words were coming out.
Professor Patil did not say a word the whole way to the Headmasterâs office. She led him up a few flights of stairs and stopped in front of a stone gargoyle.
âIâm in the middle of teaching a class, so Iâll leave you here to see the Headmaster,â she informed him. âRubber duck,â she said to the gargoyle.
The gargoyle opened to reveal a circular staircase. Albus stepped inside and climbed up. His heart was pounding as he stepped off the last stair and came into a circular room. It was adorned with the portraits of past headmasters. There were all sorts of silver instruments on every surface, along with bookcases overflowing with books. In the back was a desk with a comfy looking chair behind it. Behind the chair was Professor Dumbledoreâs portrait. Albus glanced around and noticed that he was alone in the room. Luckily, Professor Kendrick was not there. Albus breathed a sigh of relief. That was the one thing that could have gone wrong with the plan. If Kendrick was there, then Albus would not have a chance to talk to Dumbledore.
Albus ran to Dumbledoreâs portrait, eager to get this over with, as Kendrick could return any minute. As he approached Dumbledore, he passed the only other portrait that was currently awake. It was a portrait of a greasy haired, hooked nose man. âGetting into trouble, Potter? Just like your father,â the man said. It was Professor Snape.
Albus chose to ignore him as he reached Dumbledore. âUm, excuse me, Sir,â he started.
âHello, Albus,â Dumbledore smiled, âI wondered when Iâd be seeing you. But I must ask, what kind of trouble did you cause to be sent here?â
âI, um, er, well, it wasnât me, exactly. It was Rose. But we assumed, hoped rather, that Iâd get blamed for it,â Albus stammered.
âAh, youâve been wanting to talk to me?â Dumbledore asked.
âYes, sir,â Albus replied.
âI will be glad to help you, but first I really must know what you and Rose did,â Dumbledore insisted, âI am rather curious.â
âWell, Rose set off a Weasley firework in Professor Washburnâs class,â Albus confessed.
âInteresting. I seem to remember her mother doing the same in my class once, although I never could prove it,â Snape commented.
âThatâs certainly a creative way of getting to talk to me,â Dumbledore replied, âBut I must tell you that a better way would be to send word with another portrait and Iâd be able to meet you in the common room.â
Albus slapped his head, âI canât believe I didnât think of that! Too late now. Anyway, what I want to talk about is private.â
âOh, I understand. Ask away.â
âUm, well, over Christmas, Rose, James, and I, and a few other of our cousins overheard our parents talking,â Albus paused, waiting for the reprimand for listening in on a conversation.
âPerfectly understandable. I do believe that if adults donât want children hearing their conversations, they ought to use the proper charms against eavesdropping.â
Albus grinned, âThatâs what I thought, but Grandma was pretty mad. She took away all of Jamesâs Extendable Ears.â
âWhat a shame. I always thought those were ingenious. I wish they had been invented when I was your age.â
âAnyway, we overheard that they are keeping something from us. A secret, I guess. We always thought they told us everything about Voldemort, the horcruxes, and the Battle at Hogwarts. But now weâre not so sure. They were talking about figuring out when to tell us something. Something they donât want us to spread around,â Albus informed him.
âI see,â Dumbledore replied with a thoughtful look on his face, âGo on.â
âWell, Professor, we think we sort of know what it is. Well, I heard them say one word and the same word was mentioned in these weird dreams Iâve been having. Iâve been having dreams due to someone doing Legilimency on me. Iâm learning Occlumency, though.â
âThatâs good,â Dumbledore said, âI hope itâs going well.â
âMine is, but James isnât doing so well with his.â
âWhoâs teaching you?â Snape interrupted, âItâs not your father, is it?â Snape laughed at the very thought.
âNo,â Albus replied coldly, âBut he could if he wanted to.â
âNo, he couldnât,â Snape replied, âI tried to teach him, and he is incapable of the task.â
âHeâs doing better now,â Albus said defensively.
âWho is teaching you, then?â Snape pressed.
âMy Aunt Hermione.â
âWell, as much of a know it all she was, sheâs probably a competent teacher,â Snape approved.
âThank you, Severus,â Dumbledore said, âNow, continue, Albus.â
âUm, right. Anyway, I guess I was wondering if you could tell me anything about the Hallows,â Albus held his breath, waiting for Dumbledoreâs reaction.
Dumbledore sighed, âI was afraid thatâs what you were going to ask. What do you know about them?â
âNot much. My parents havenât told me anything, but Iâm pretty sure thatâs what theyâre keeping from us. Rose, James, and I have been researching in the library about them, but we havenât found anything. All I know is that they are objects and I learned that from my dreams.â
âBe careful not to believe everything those dreams tell you,â Snape warned, âThat was one of your fatherâs problems.â
âSeverus,â Dumbledore said warningly and turned back to Albus. âYou will not find any information about the Hallows in the history books about Voldemort. And this is because there are few who know about their importance in the final battle. Many of those who do, do not believe it.â
âSo, they do have to do with the battle?â Albus asked.
âYes, they do,â Dumbledore confirmed.
âWill you tell me what they are?â
Dumbledore sighed again, âI am afraid that it is not my place to tell you. That responsibility remains with your father. I will tell you that they played an important role in defeating Voldemort, but beyond that, youâll have to wait until your father is ready to tell you.â
Albus groaned, âBut why? Why wonât he tell me?â
âAdults have a habit of keeping things from children because they think they are protecting them. This is not always the case, as I have learned on many occasion. I made the same mistake numerous times, most of them involving Harry and the information about his past.â
âOh,â Albus responded, âDo you know when heâll tell me?â
âNo, although I do think it will be soon. Perhaps within the next few months,â Dumbledore revealed.
âMonths?!â Albus shouted, âI canât wait that long!â
âPatience is a mighty virtue, Albus,â Dumbledore said, âI know itâs hard to wait that long. Which is why I will give you a little hint.â
âA hint? Like where we can find out about the Hallows without asking my dad?â Albus asked hopefully.
âNot exactly. But before I get to that, I sense there is something else troubling you.â
Albus thought for a moment before responding. âWell, I guess there is one thingâŠâ he paused, wondering if he should tell Dumbledore about Matt.
Dumbledore smiled, but didnât say anything.
Albus sighed. âOk, itâs my friend Matt. He gets sick a lot, once a month to be exact. And I just found out heâs a werewolf. Not that that matters or anything. I still want to be friends with him,â Albus said quickly.
âAh, yes, Matthew Eckerton,â Dumbledore replied.
âYou know him?â
âYes, he voiced a few concerns to me before the school year started. He and his parents had a meeting with Professor Kendrick.â
âThat was quick, Potter. I must say that I am pleasantly surprised that you found out so quickly. Your father never was able to put the clues together to figure out that Lupin was a werewolf. Miss Granger told him,â Snape interjected.
Albus averted his eyes from Snape and mumbled, âEr, Rose is the one who really found out. I just confirmed it when I was in the Hospital Wing the same time as Matt.â
âOf course,â Snape said flatly.
âSeverus,â Dumbledore warned, âContinue, Albus.â
âItâs just, Matt hasnât told us yet. Heâs still trying to hide it from us. I just wish heâd trust me. It just kind of feels like no one trusts me. Matt wonât tell me heâs a werewolf and my dad wonât tell me about the Hallows. Why wonât anyone trust me?â Albus told Dumbledore.
âI understand,â Dumbledore responded, âBut I do think itâs more complicated than you not being trustworthy. You, I believe, are very trustworthy. As far as Matt trusting you, I will tell you that he had a very rough childhood. Heâs been through horrors you canât even imagine. I do think he trusts you, but I donât think he tells many people about his lycanthropy. I know that he is very afraid about what will happen if people find out-â
âBut it doesnât matter to me! Or John or Rose or Amanda!â Albus interrupted.
âI know. But past experiences have caused Matt to be reluctant to tell anyone. Although I do think he will confide in you eventually.â
âSo you agree that I shouldnât tell him that I know?â Albus asked.
âAs long as he doesnât know that you know, I think that would be a wise choice.â
âNo, I donât think he has any idea that I know,â Albus said.
âGood,â Dumbledore continued, âNow, I believe trust is a two-way street. You want Matt to confide in you, but can you think of anything that you are keeping from him, and John, and Amanda as well?â
Albus wracked his brain, âWell, just the Hallows, but I donât even know what they are.â
âThe Hallows, thatâs exactly what I suspected you were keeping secret. But why?â
âUm, I guess Iâm not sure. It just seems like something that I should keep to myself. Since my parents havenât even told anyone,â Albus reasoned.
âAh, but you wish your parents would tell you about them?â
âYes, but-â
âIt might be wise to tell your friends, Albus. Just because your parents havenât told anyone, doesnât mean you have to keep it to yourself.â
âReally?â Albus asked.
âYes, and that is my hint to you. Tell your friends what you know about the Hallows. They just might be able to help you,â Dumbledore told him.
âYou think they would know more than we could get from books?â Albus asked skeptically.
âThereâs only one way to find out,â Dumbledore winked.
âAll right, if youâre sure,â Albus responded.
âGood luck with that, Potter,â Snape smirked.
Albus heard a door open behind him and he jumped. He had momentarily forgotten what he had done to get to Kendrickâs office. As he remembered the chaos in Washburnâs class, dread consumed him once more. What was going to happen? Albus turned around and saw Professor Kendrick standing in the doorway.
âSit down, Albus,â Kendrick said as he walked towards his desk.
Albus sat down in the chair in front of the desk while Kendrick sat down in his chair.
âProfessor Patil told me what happened. Before we start discussing, Iâm going to ask Professor Washburn to come in. Along with your dad. Hopefully weâll be able to get to the bottom of this,â Kendrick got up from the desk and went over to the fireplace. He threw a handful of floo powder in and thrust his head into the emerald flames.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight, as well as my other sister and my brother. Thanks to Moonylupin for the review!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
âNow, donât expect to create much more than a wisp of silvery fog on your first attempt,â Harry told his class of eager seventh years, âPatronuses are difficult for even the best wizards to conjure.â
âBut my mum and dad said you managed it in your third year,â Christina Davies interrupted.
âWell, yes, I did,â Harry told his class, âBut I had wonderful teacher and the motivation I needed to manage it at such a young age. Now, everyone think of a happy memory, just as we discussed-â
âExcuse me, Harry?â The flames in the classroom fireplace turned a bright emerald green and the headmasterâs face appeared in it. The whole class turned to look towards the fireplace and were shocked to see Professor Kendrickâs head.
âYes, Professor?â Harry answered in a confused tone. Fireplaces had been installed in all the classrooms during the rebuilding of Hogwarts after the Battle in order for the teachers to communicate faster in the event of an emergency. Harry had never used his fireplace before and was a bit worried when he saw Kendrick in it.
âYour son caused a disruption in Charms just now-â
âWhat did James do this time?â Harry sighed.
âNo, not James. It was Albus,â Kendrick told Harry.
âWhat?!â Harry was baffled. He never imagined Albus would cause enough trouble to be sent to the Headmasterâs office. Even James had avoided that so far.
âYes, it was Albus. Heâs in my office right now and Iâd like to discuss it with you and Professor Washburn,â Kendrick said
âAll right. Iâll meet you in your office in a few minutes.â
âIâll see you then,â Kendrickâs head disappeared and the flames returned to their usual orange.
The seventh years all turned their heads back to Harry, with looks of shock on their faces.
âWhat did Albus do?â Victoire asked, âI canât imagine him getting in trouble.â
âI really donât know what happened, Victoire,â Harry answered.
âWere his friends in on this, too?â Amy asked anxiously. Harry could tell she was worried about her brother getting in trouble.
âIâm not sure. I just heard about this now,â Harry responded, âIâve got to go. Iâm dismissing class now. I trust youâll all use this time responsibly,â Harry grinned, knowing theyâd all use the time to goof off. âWeâll continue with Patronuses next class.â
Harry left the classroom as his students were packing up. He made it to Kendrickâs office in record time, gave the password, and entered the room. Kendrick was sitting behind his desk, with Albus and Washburn sitting in front of it. There was an empty chair between them. Nobody was saying a word. Both Dumbledore and Snapeâs portraits seemed to be paying close attention. Harry walked over to the empty chair and he noticed that Albus was shaking and he looked extremely scared.
âHi, Al,â Harry whispered and gave his son a quick hug before taking the middle seat. Albus remained quiet and he was staring straight at Dumbledoreâs portrait.
âDaddy wonât be able to save you this time, Potter,â Washburn sneered.
âThatâs enough, Jameson,â Kendrick said calmly, âNow that Harry is here, could you please explain to both of us what happened?â
âI was trying to teach and all of a sudden, there was an explosion and a firework emerged from the table he was sitting at,â Washburn spat, âHe set it off to cause a disruption. Heâs been doing it ever since the beginning of the year.â
âIs this true, Albus?â Kendrick asked. All three adults turned to look at Albus, who was sinking lower in his seat. He did not say a word.
âOf course itâs true!â Washburn growled after a few moments of silence.
A loud banging disrupted their discussion. Harry turned away from Albus and looked at the office door. âDo you want me to get that?â
âYes, I suppose,â Kendrick replied.
Harry got up and went over to the door. He opened it and Rose came bursting in. She was out of breath and looked flushed. âDonât. Expel. Him.â she panted.
âWhat?!â Kendrick said, âI wasnât planning on expelling Albus.â
âYou should!â Washburn stood up and glared at Kendrick.
âSit down,â Kendrick responded, âYou have to respect my decisions. I will not expel Albus, but there will be a punishment.â
âNo!â Rose shouted. She walked towards Kendrickâs desk and stood in front of it. Harry followed and stood behind Albusâs chair. âIt wasnât him!â she announced.
âWhat do you mean?!â Washburn exclaimed, âOf course it was him! I saw him!â
âNo, you didnât. You saw it came from our table, there was no way you could tell who actually did it. John, Matt, and I were also sitting at that table,â Rose explained.
âWhat are you getting at, Rose?â Harry asked. Now he was thoroughly confused about the whole event.
âIt was me,â Rose said simply, âIt was my firework.â
âYou set off a firework during a class?â Harry was mystified. If there was anyone who was less likely than Albus to cause trouble during class, it was Rose. Rose did love causing trouble, but she never did it during classes.
âWell, not really,â Rose glanced shiftily at Washburn and then returned her gaze to Harry. âNot intentionally, that is. It was one of those new fireworks that Uncle George is working on. Theyâre still in the testing stage. The ones that are supposed to actually disappear if you vanish them, but then reappear an hour or so later. Only right now they permanently disappear.â
âThatâs good,â Harry breathed a sigh of relief. There were much worse experimental products that could have accidentally gotten set off.
âAnyway, theyâre very unstable right now and they go off if thereâs a lot of magic around, and we were practicing charming paper birds,â Rose told him.
âWhy did you have it?â Harry asked.
âI, um, took it during Christmas break,â Rose mumbled while looking at her feet.
âWhat?!â Harry exclaimed.
âI found it at the Burrow and didnât realize it was one of the experimental ones. I just realized that the other day.â
âAnd why was it in your bag?â
âI was meaning to give it to you during DADA, but I forgot,â Rose confessed.
Harry sighed, âAll right. I guess that mystery is solved.â
âWhat about punishment! They need to be punished!â Washburn shouted while glaring at Rose.
âRose will get lines, but seeing as Albus wasnât actually involved, I canât punish him,â Kendrick explained.
âBut, but,â Washburn sputtered.
âAnd that is final, Jameson,â Kendrick said firmly, âNow, Albus and Rose, you should get going to your next class. Rose, you can do your lines with Professor Washburn tomorrow night at seven.â
Albus and Rose nodded. Albus got up and gave Harry a hug before he followed Rose out of the room. He still didnât say anything, but he looked a bit less scared than he had earlier and he had stopped shaking.
Kendrick stood up, âIâm glad we got this all straightened out. I shall see both of you later.â
Washburn glared at Harry and stomped out of the room, slamming the door behind him. Harry turned to leave as well, but stopped when he heard a familiar voice. âHarry, I would like to discuss something with you, if you have time.â
Harry turned around and saw the familiar face of Albus Dumbledore looking at him. âYeah, Iâve got time.â
âIâll leave you to your conversation, then,â Kendrick said as he left his office.
Harry walked over to Dumbledoreâs portrait, âWhat is it, Professor?â
âI had an interesting conversation with Albus earlier.â
âReally?â Harry was very curious as to what the two of them would have talked about.
âOh, yes,â Dumbledore continued, âHe has been wondering about the Hallows.â
âThe, the, Hallows?â Harry stammered. He didnât think his kids had ever even heard of the Hallows.
âThe Hallows. He overheard you talking about them over Christmas holiday. He, James, and Rose have been attempting to research them in the library ever since.â
âThey have?â
âThatâs what Albus told me. Naturally, they did not find any answers,â Dumbledore went on, âSo, Albus asked me what I knew about them.â
âAnd did you tell him?â Harry asked anxiously.
âI told him I do know about them, but that I could not give him the answers he wanted. I believe that is your duty, Harry,â Dumbledore responded.
Harry breathed a sigh of relief, âThank you.â
âWhy havenât you told them, Harry?â
Harry stopped to think. Dumbledore gazed at him while waiting patiently. âWell, I guess because I donât want a whole lot of people knowing about them. The last thing we need is to have someone seeking them out.â
âBut you fear that is whatâs happening.â
âYes, I do. Iâm afraid thatâs what the dreams mean,â Harry told him.
âAre you afraid the kids will tell the whole school?â
âI guess I am,â Harry confessed, âEspecially James. Heâs always so eager to tell everyone he meets stories about me.â
âHe is proud of being your son,â Dumbledore said, âAnd I think if you expressed your concern about others knowing about the Hallows, they would keep the secret.â
âYouâre probably right,â Harry sighed, âBut Iâm also afraid about whoeverâs doing the Legilimency finding out about them. If I tell the kids, then whoever wants the Hallows will be able to find out where they are.â
âPerhaps. It is a tough call. But Iâm sure youâll always make the right decision in the end,â Dumbledore replied, âWere you ever planning on telling them?â
âYes, I was.â
âWhen?â
âIâm not sure, I guess,â Harry responded, âWhen they were a bit older, I suppose. But I was waiting for the right moment.â
âAnd that moment might be approaching earlier then you thought,â Dumbledore replied, âAlbus thinks you donât trust him.â
âHe does?â Harry sighed. This was getting more complicated by the moment.
âYes, he told me. He is a bit upset about it. But it is aided by the fact that you arenât the only one keeping a big secret from him.â
Harry paused to think. Who else was keeping secrets from his son? âOh, his friend, Matt, right? He hasnât told Albus yet, has he?â
âNo, he hasnât. But Albus and Rose have figured it out on their own. I donât think he fully understands why Matt hasnât told him. He just sees it as the people he loves arenât trusting him .â
âOh, no, itâs so much more complicated than that,â Harry responded.
âThatâs what I told him. But that is an issue thatâs between him and Matt and there isnât much you can do about it. What you can do is reconsider when you are going to tell your children about the Hallows.â
âYeah, I guess I will. I just donât want to rush into it. Maybe at the end of term would be good. That way they can process the idea over the summer at home where they wonât be tempted to tell others about it.â
âThat would be wise,â Dumbledore smiled.
âThanks for telling me, Professor. I should probably get going,â Harry said.
âI shall see you soon, Harry.â
âBye,â Harry turned around and left the office. He thought about what Dumbledore said on his way to the Great Hall for lunch. What Dumbledore said made sense, but he was still reluctant about telling his kids about the Hallows.
******
âThat was an impressive lie the Weasley girl told,â Snape said curtly to Dumbledore after Harry left.
âYes, it was,â Dumbledore agreed.
âBut you didnât tell Potter about it.â
âNo, I did not feel it was necessary. I donât think anymore punishment would have accomplished anything. I canât imagine Albus or Rose will do anything like that again in the near future,â Dumbledore explained.
âThey did lie, though. They lied to the Headmaster. That deserves punishment,â Snape responded.
âPerhaps, perhaps,â Dumbledore said calmly, âBut, Severus, you did not tell Harry either.â
******
âThat was crazy,â Albus shouted after he left the headmasterâs office with Rose. As soon as the gargoyle closed behind them, James appeared in front of them.
âWell, are you in huge trouble, Albus?â he asked anxiously.
âLuckily, no,â Albus told his brother.
âWhat happened, then?â James pushed, âAre you going to tell us about your talk with Dumbledore?â
âOf course!â Albus said, âJust not here. What if someone heard us?â
âThereâs still an hour until our next class, why donât we go up to the common room? It might be empty now,â Rose suggested.
âGood idea,â Albus agreed. He started walking towards Gryffindor Tower. James and Rose followed, neither of them saying a word.
The common room was empty. Albus, James, and Rose hurried inside and snagged the good armchairs near the fire. James and Rose looked at Albus expectantly, waiting for him to begin.
Albus launched into a lengthy explanation about his conversation with Dumbledore. James and Rose sat quietly and didnât interrupt him. Albus told them every bit of the conversation, except for the parts about Matt. Albus would tell Rose about that later, after James left.
âSo, Dumbledore knows?â James said after Albus finished.
âYes, he does, but he wonât tell me much,â Albus explained, âJust told me to ask my friends.â
âThatâs so strange,â Rose furrowed her brow, âWhy would they know anything about the Hallows if we donât?â
âDunno,â James commented, âHe was a bit mad, though.â
âYeah, but he was brilliant. He hasnât been wrong about much,â Albus reminded them.
âSo, you think we should tell our friends?â Rose asked.
âIâm not really sure,â Albus confided, âIâd be willing to try anything right now to figure out what the Hallows are, but what if Dadâs mad that we told people?â
âHe canât be mad if we donât even know what they are,â James reasoned, âAs far as he knows, weâve never even heard the word âHallowsâ.â
âThatâs true,â Rose said.
âWell, Dumbledore seems to think that Dadâs going to tell us soon, possibly this year,â Albus reminded them.
âMaybe we should give it another month or so?â Rose suggested, âMaybe something will turn up in the library.â
âDumbledore said we wonât find anything in the library. The Hallows do have to do with Voldemortâs downfall. He told me that much. And hardly anyone knows about that part, of course.â
âI guess we could give it a little while longer, to see if he tells us about them,â James sighed.
âOk, then, weâll wait a bit longer,â Albus agreed, âAnyway, if Dad wonât tell us, he certainly wonât want our friends to know.â
âYeah,â James said, âOh, what punishment did you wind up with?â
âI got detention tomorrow night,â Rose told him.
âI got nothing,â Albus grinned.
âWhat?!â James shouted, âNothing?â
âNope, nothing.â
âI convinced them it was me. Well, I convinced them the firework went off accidentally,â Rose explained the story she told about the experimental firework.
âThatâs amazing,â James grinned, âYou must be an excellent liar.â
Rose blushed and suppressed a smile.
âSpeaking of amazing,â Albus started, âHow did you find out where Kendrickâs office is?â
âThat would be all me,â James continued grinning, âAll my brilliance.â
âWhat did you do?â Albus asked suspiciously.
âWell, I expected to find Uncle Harry in his office after class, but he wasnât there. I was so worried youâd get expelled before I was able to explain. So I went to find James so we could figure out what to do-â
âLet me tell him, Rose,â James interrupted, âWe ran back to Dadâs office and thatâs when I thought of how we could find the office. Mind you, I wish Iâd thought of it earlier and then you wouldnât have had to do the whole firework thing.â
âWell, what was it?â Albus asked impatiently.
James reached into his robes and pulled a rather old looking piece of parchment out. âThe Marauderâs Map.â
Albus stared at it and smacked his forehead. âOf course! Why didnât we think of it before?â
âI dunno, but the thought just popped into my head. Iâm so glad Dad told us how it worked. We were able to find Kendrickâs office, but of course the door was closed and we didnât know the password. But then we looked at the map and the little dot labeled âRose Weasleyâ had a speech bubble that said âRubber duckâ. So Rose said that and she was in. Easy as that.â
Albus continued to stare in awe at the map. âSo now youâve got the map? Youâre going to be in huge trouble. What if Dadâs using it?â
âI donât think he is. It wasnât sitting out or anything. We werenât even sure it was there, thought he might have left it at home. I summoned it. It came flying out of the bottom of a trunk that was shoved in the back of the storage cupboard,â James explained.
âAre you going to keep it?â Albus asked.
âFor now,â James told him, âAt least until I hear anything about Dad wondering where it is.â
âI hope you donât get in trouble, James,â Rose warned, âBe careful.â
âI will, donât worry. Iâd just like to get some mischief in,â James grinned.
âBe careful about who sees it, too,â Rose insisted.
âIâm just letting Nathan and Bradley see it. And Cedric and Ben, of course. They know all about it. And they keep asking when Iâd manage to nick it.â
Rose sighed, âFine. Well, weâd best get going to class.â She stood up and walked towards the portrait hole.
Albus got up and followed Rose, âSee ya later, James.â
âBye,â James waved.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight, as well as my other sister and my brother. Thanks also to inkheart, Moonylupin, and Peter for their reviews!
Please read and review!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
As the week progressed, Albus fell back into his usual Hogwarts routine. His homework drove most of the thoughts about the Hallows out of his head. He occasionally thought about telling John, Matt, and Amanda about them, but he decided not to. James, who was even more busy than Albus, did not seem to be lingering on thoughts of the Hallows either. Between homework, Quidditch practice, and Occlumency lessons, he hardly had any leisure time at all. Albus had yet to hear about any amazing pranks that James had been able to pull off with the help of the Marauderâs Map.
Towards the end of the week, Albus and his friends had something else to worry about that succeeded in Albus momentarily forgetting about the Hallows all together. The full moon. It fell on a Monday this month. The Sunday before it, Albus and his friends were enjoying a snowball fight on the grounds.
SMACK! John had sent a snowball at the back of Albusâs head and the force caused him to fall face first into the deep snow. âIâll get you!â Albus shouted as he stood back up and formed a large snowball. He sent it flying across the nearly empty Quidditch Pitch towards John. But John was too quick. He jumped aside and the snowball hit Matt instead.
âHa, ha!â John shouted gleefully. They were having a team snow ball fight. It was John and Rose versus Albus, Matt, and Amanda. John seemed delighted that Albus had hit one of his own teammates instead. John rolled another snow ball and threw it at Amanda. It hit her square in the back. She in turn quickly made a snowball and threw it at Rose. Rose jumped aside and the snowball sailed into the ground behind her. Despite the fact that Albusâs team had three people and John and Rose were only two, John and Rose seemed to be doing much better. John had a good arm and very good aim and was great at dodging snowballs.
Albus quickly made another snowball and was about to throw it, but he noticed that Matt still hadnât gotten up. He dropped his snowball and ran over to Matt and was hit in the head by a snowball sent by John.
âStop the game!â Albus shouted and pointed to Matt. John, Rose, and Amanda glanced over and immediately dropped their snowballs.
âMatt, are you all right?â Albus poked Mattâs arm, but he didnât respond.
âMatt?â John rolled him over onto his back. Matt groaned. John pulled him up into a sitting position. âWe should probably go inside,â John said to Albus.
âYeah,â Albus agreed. He grabbed Mattâs other arm and he and John pulled Matt to his feet. âIâm sorry, I didnât think I threw it that hard.â
âI didnât think you did either,â John agreed. They walked back towards the castle, supporting Matt between them.
âMaybe we should go to the Hospital Wing,â Rose suggested.
âNo, no Hospital Wing,â Matt whispered, âIâm fine. Iâve just got to lie down.â
âAre you sure?â Amanda asked.
âYeah, Iâll be fine. Letâs just go back to Gryffindor,â Matt said.
They walked slowly back to Gryffindor Tower. By the time they were at the common room, Matt was able to walk unsupported, although he still didnât look good. Once they were in the room, Matt made a beeline for the dormitory. Albus and John went with him so they could dump their wet cloaks and scarves.
âAre you going to stay up here?â Albus asked Matt.
âI think so,â Matt said as he climbed into his bed.
âOk, well I hope youâre feeling better,â Albus replied.
âMe, too,â John said. But by the time the two boys left the room, Matt had already fallen asleep.
Albus and John headed back down the circular staircase and back into the common room. The room was packed and very noisy. Rose and Amanda had already settled themselves to doing homework at a small secluded table in a corner of the room. Albus and John sat down across from the girls and took out their books.
âSo,â Albus whispered, âIs the full moon sometime soon?â
âYep,â Rose told him without looking up from her homework, âItâs tomorrow.â
âDâyou think itâll be as bad as last time?â Amanda asked.
âI dunno,â Rose answered, âI really donât know why his transformations are so bad.â
âI think heâs part of that study Uncle Bill was talking about,â Albus told them, âWhen I was in the Hospital Wing last month, the Healer mentioned a study, but Madam Pomfrey shushed him before he elaborated.â
âThen that might explain it. But why would he be in the study if itâs just making things worse?â John asked.
âWho knows what it was like before it, though,â Rose commented.
âGood point,â John responded. The four friends sank into their thoughts and continued working on their homework in silence for a half hour. The noise in the common room made it difficult to carry on a conversation. Albus managed to finish his Charms homework, but it took him longer than usual since he was distracted by worrying about Matt.
Albus closed his Charms book and put it back into his bag. When he looked up, he was surprised to see Matt coming over towards them. Albus sat back up and poked John, who was still working diligently on his Herbology essay that was due the next day. John looked up as Matt sat down next to Rose.
âWhat are you guys talking about?â Matt asked.
âNot much, really, weâre just doing homework,â John told him, âI guess Iâll have to finish this after dinner.â He closed his Herbology book and stuffed it in his bag.
âYou coming to dinner?â Albus asked Matt, âWe werenât sure if youâd be up.â
A look of panic flashed across Mattâs face, âWhy would you think that?â he asked quickly.
Albus glanced shiftily at John, âEr, just because you didnât look too good after getting hit by that snowball.â
Matt visibly relaxed, âOh, um, Iâm feeling better now.â
âThatâs good,â Albus answered. Matt did look a bit better, although he was still much paler than usual. âLetâs go eat, then. Iâm starved.â
Rose and Amanda packed up their work and the group headed down to the Great Hall. Even though Matt went to dinner, Albus noticed that he didnât eat much. After dinner, they headed back up to the common room to finish their homework.
âIâm still three inches short,â John announced after he worked for another twenty minutes on his Herbology essay.
âLet me see it,â Rose reached over and took Johnâs essay. She read it silently for a few minutes. âYou can elaborate on the uses of Devilâs Snare in Potions.â
âDevilâs Snare has uses in Potions?â John asked.
âYes, in more advanced Potions. Itâs in the book,â Rose told him. John flipped through his book and began working on his essay again.
Albus had finished his Herbology essay the previous day and was currently working on a DADA essay that was also due the next day. âHave you guys all finished the DADA essay?â he asked.
âYes,â Rose responded without glancing up from her book.
âYeah,â Amanda answered while working furiously on her star chart.
âHuh?â Matt picked his head up from his book. He had fallen asleep in his DADA book.
âHave you finished the DADA essay?â Albus repeated.
âOh, no, but Iâll get it done,â Matt said tiredly and put his head back down on his book.
Albus glanced at Rose, who gave him a worried look. Albus had a feeling that Matt would not be getting the essay done. They both went back to their work without saying a word. A few minutes later, someone tapped Albus on the shoulder.
âHey,â someone said from behind him.
Albus turned around and saw Victoire standing behind his chair. âOh, hi, Victoire. Whatâs up?â
âNot much,â Victoire sat down in the chair next to Albus. âAmy and I just have to tell you something.â Amy had sat down next to Matt and was trying to wake him up.
âWhat is it?â Albus asked. John, Rose, and Amanda had all looked up from their work and were waiting for Victoire to get on with it.
âQuinton Willinson has finished his detentions,â Victoire told him.
âOh, great,â Albus groaned.
âI just thought you should know,â Victoire said.
âDo you think heâs going to bother me anymore?â Albus asked.
âHe might. Detention certainly deterred him for a month, but who knows what could happen now that heâs done with detention. Iâd just watch out, if I were you. All of you.â
They all nodded, except for Matt, who was sleepily paying attention to something Amy was whispering in his ear.
âWell, Iâve got studying to do,â Victoire stood up, âYou coming, Amy? I still havenât finished that Arithmancy stuff.â
Amy stopped whispering to Matt and looked at Victoire. âUh, yeah, I havenât finished it either.â She said something else to Matt and then stood up and left with Victoire, while glancing once more at her brother.
âWell, this could be bad,â Rose said once they left.
âI know. Heâs going to be livid after having detention for a month,â Albus replied.
âYouâve got to be careful. Heâs going to want revenge again,â John said.
âYeah, he will,â Albus agreed.
âHas Slughorn mentioned anymore parties?â John asked.
âNo, surprisingly not. But Iâm not going to any even if he does.â
âI think thatâs a good idea. I wonât either. We should try and avoid Willinson,â Rose responded.
They worked on their homework for another hour before going to bed. Matt had fallen asleep again shortly after Amy and Victoire left, and Albus had to poke him rather hard to wake him up. Once they got up to the dormitory, Matt collapsed onto his bed and was asleep within minutes.
Albus lay awake for a while before he managed to fall asleep. He was worried about Matt and about what Willinson was going to do now that he was free from detention. Albus tried to clear his mind, but there were so many things worrying him that he found it impossible. His sleep was filled with strange dreams, involving Willinson, along with the usual nightmare about the Hallows.
Albus went down to breakfast the next morning with John and Matt. They were running late because it had taken John and Albus a while to wake Matt up. By the time they made it to the Great Hall, Rose and Amanda had already finished breakfast and were getting ready to go to DADA.
âThere you are!â Rose said when Albus sat down next to her, âYouâd better eat fast. Weâve got to go to class in five minutes.â
âI know, it took us forever to get him up,â Albus gestured to Matt, who was leaning his head on his arm and not eating anything. Rose nodded and glanced at Matt sympathetically.
Albus and John shoved a few slices of toast into their mouths and then the group was off to DADA. They managed to run into the room before the bell rang, but they were the last ones there. There was only one table available, the one in front, which happened to be right in front of the table Scorpius Malfoy and his friends sat at. Albus groaned silently and sat down at the table, hoping Malfoy wouldnât mention Mattâs fatigue.
âIâll collect your essays now,â Harry announced once heâd finished taking attendance. He got up and went around the room to collect the essays.
Albus handed his dad his essay and Harry moved on to Matt. Matt was laying his head on his book and seemed to be asleep. Harry lightly tapped him on the shoulder. âHuh?â Matt glanced up.
Malfoy snorted loudly behind them and Albus turned around and glared at him.
âDo you have the essay done?â Harry asked quietly.
âOh, no. Iâm sorry, Professor,â Matt whispered, âI tried to get it done last night, but I justâŠâ his voice trailed off.
âItâs all right,â Harry replied, âTry to have it done by next week. I know I didnât give you much time, since I just assigned it Friday.â
Matt nodded and put his head back down on the table. Harry went back to his desk and started the dayâs lecture. âToday we are going to continue-â
âSir,â Malfoy interrupted, âSir, why does he get extra time for his essay?â Malfoy pointed at Matt.
Harry sighed, âI do not think that is any of your concern, Mr. Malfoy.â
âBut itâs not very fair, is it? Why canât I have extra time?â
âYou handed in your essay today, didnât you?â Harry asked.
âYes, why?â
âWell, then, you obviously are in no need of extra time. If you ever think you need extra time for an assignment, just tell me why and I may grant it to you.â
âBut-â
âThatâs the end of this discussion, Mr. Malfoy,â Harry cut him off, âNow, back to the lessonâŠ.â
Harry lectured for the entire class. Throughout the first half of class, Malfoy repeatedly poked Matt with his wand to try and wake him up. Albus turned around and glared at him numerous times but Malfoy kept doing it. Eventually, Harry noticed and threatened Malfoy with detention if it continued. Albus was relieved when class was over, but they still had to make it through Charms with the Slytherins. Although Albus knew even Malfoy wouldnât poke anyone with his wand in Washburnâs class.
âSo, first you get special treatment from Madam Pomfrey and now from Professor Potter, too?â Malfoy glared icily at Matt after they left the DADA room.
âJust leave him alone,â Albus growled.
âI will find out why, you can count on it,â Malfoy stared at Matt, who had gone as pale as a ghost when Malfoy said this.
âIs there a problem?â Harry had just left the classroom and was standing behind Malfoy.
Malfoy jumped as he heard Harryâs voice, âNo, Professor.â He gave Matt one more glare before taking off for the Charms classroom.
âIâll see you later, Al,â Harry gave Albus a hug before going back into the classroom.
âBye, Dad,â Albus hugged him back. Albus and Matt started to walk to Charms. John, Rose, and Amanda had gone on ahead, but Albus was staying behind to walk with Matt, who was walking considerably slower.
âLate again, Potter, Eckerton,â Washburn growled as they walked into the room. They headed for their usual back table and passed Malfoy on the way. He was smiling smugly at them, noticeably happy that they were late. The class went by in its usual agony. Washburn seemed to have increased his hatred for Albus since the firework incident, if that was possible. He called on Albus for every question, even though Albus never raised his hand. The only times he didnât do this was when he chose to call on Matt, which was every time he fell asleep.
Much to Albusâs surprise, Matt made it through double Herbology without going to the Hospital Wing. Albus was sure that Neville would have made him go after he tripped over a pot and banged his arm on the bench. But Neville just asked if he was all right and continued teaching.
After dinner, Albus and his friends found themselves taking a much needed break from studying. They had all finished the homework that was due the next day and were relaxing at their usual table. Albus was losing horribly at Wizardâs Chess to Rose, whose knight was currently beating up Albusâs queen. John and Amanda were playing a rather loud game of Exploding Snap.
âYou want to play, Matt?â John asked as he was dealing cards for the next round.
âNo,â Matt groaned. He was curled up in an armchair near the table and was wincing every few minutes.
âAll right,â John gave him a worried look, âDo you want me to go with you to the Hospital Wing?â
âNot right now,â Matt whispered and closed his eyes again.
Albus glanced up and looked at his friends. They all had worried looks on their faces. Albus watched Matt fall back asleep, which only took two minutes.
âQueen to D4,â Rose announced, âAnd checkmate.â Roseâs queen moved to the square, beat up Albusâs remaining bishop, and won the game. âGood game.â
âYeah,â Albus agreed, âHave you ever lost?â
âIâve lost to my dad quite a few times,â Rose said as she put her chessmen away.
Albus put his chessmen back in their case and folded up the board. He looked up once he was done and saw Amy coming over. She walked over to Matt and started gently shaking him awake.
âHi, Amy,â Albus said.
Amy looked over at Albus, âOh, hi, Albus,â she said quietly and went back to waking Matt up. Matt opened his eyes and groaned.
âCâmon, itâs time to go,â Albus heard Amy whisper. Albus looked at Rose, John, and Amanda. They were all watching Amy, too.
âUgh, no,â Matt whispered. But he sat up and winced.
âItâs ok, come on,â Amy grabbed Mattâs arm and pulled him gently out of the chair. Matt got up and let Amy lead him out of the common room.
âHas she ever taken him to the Hospital Wing before?â Albus asked once they left.
âNo, I donât think so,â Rose said.
âShe must think itâs going to be bad this time,â John said glumly.
âGuess so,â Albus responded quietly.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight, my other sister, and my brother. Thanks as well to inkheart and Moonylupin for their reviews!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
The four friends were very subdued the rest of the evening. They all joined in a game of Exploding Snap, but none of them were very into it. Although they didnât talk about Matt the rest of the evening, Albus knew they were all thinking about him. Eventually, they just decided to go to bed.
Albus climbed into his four-poster bed and tried to fall asleep. He tossed and turned for hours, but sleep wouldnât come to him. He was too worried about Matt.
âAre you awake, John?â Albus asked once he was sure Bilius and Ethan were asleep.
Albus heard the bed to his right creak as John turned over. âYeah, canât sleep.â
âMe neither.â
âMaybe this month wonât be as bad,â John suggested.
âHope so,â Albus said, âBut even if it isnât as bad, he wonât be in class tomorrow.â
âWhich means that Malfoyâs going to say something,â John groaned.
âYeah, weâve got to do something about that,â Albus decided.
âWe could hex him,â John suggested.
âThatâd be good, but I donât mean like that. I mean something thatâll throw him off the trail. We canât let him find out,â Albus explained.
âOh, right,â John thought for a moment, âHow about, since Matt wonât lie about where he is, weâll do it for him.â
âThatâs what I was thinking, too,â Albus said, âI know, if someone asks, weâll just tell them Mattâs visiting his sick gran.â
âGood idea,â John agreed.
Albus yawned, âWell, I suppose we should try and get some sleep.â
âProbably. Good night, then.â
ââNight.â After another hour of laying awake, Albus finally fell asleep.
Albus woke up feeling very tired, after only a few hours sleep. He went down to breakfast with John and met Rose and Amanda there, who were looking worried and not eating much.
âHave you heard anything yet?â Rose asked once Albus sat down.
âNo, have you?â
âNo. I havenât seen Amy at all and havenât had time to go to the Hospital Wing.â
âWe could try and go during lunch,â John suggested.
Everyone agreed to that plan and managed to eat a bit of breakfast before heading off to Potions. By the time they got there, Slughorn was ready to start class, which meant Malfoy didnât have any time to ask where Matt was. Since it was just a single period, Slughorn lectured during the entire class and Albus had a hard time staying awake. He managed to take a few notes, but by the time the class was over, he felt in need of a nap.
âHey, there, Potter,â Malfoy ran up beside Albus just outside the door of the Potions classroom.
âMalfoy,â Albus mumbled and kept walking.
âCouldnât help but notice that Eckerton wasnât in class today. You gonna tell me where he is?â
âVisiting his gran. Sheâs not doing too well,â Albus lied.
âReally? Thatâs interesting,â Malfoy raised his eyebrows, âAfter seeing him yesterday, Iâd have guessed he was the one whoâs ill.â
âMaybe heâs just worried about his gran,â John said shortly, before turning down the corridor towards the Transfiguration room, âNow weâve got to go to class.â
âSee you, then,â Albus said to Malfoy as he followed John to Transfiguration. Malfoy turned around and left without saying a word. âI hope that worked.â
âMe, too,â John agreed.
After Transfiguration, Albus and his friends ate a hurried lunch and went to the Hospital Wing. When they got there, Albus noticed that the doors were open. âWell, thatâs a good sign.â
âDefinitely,â Rose agreed and walked inside. Albus, John, and Amanda followed her. The bed at the far end of the ward had the curtains drawn and all the other beds were empty. âHe must be in there,â Rose pointed to the curtained bed.
âWhereâs Madam Pomfrey?â Albus whispered. The nurse didnât appear to be in the room.
John pointed to the curtains, which started to rustle, âShe must be back there.â
A gap appeared in the curtains and Madam Pomfrey came out from behind them. She was carrying an empty glass and a clipboard. When she noticed the group of Gryffindor first years, she came rushing over to them. âI thought Iâd be seeing you lot here.â
âIs Matt all right?â Rose whispered anxiously.
âYes, he should be fine in a couple days,â Madam Pomfrey smiled.
âSo, itâs not nearly as bad as last time?â Albus asked.
âOh, no, heâs much better this month,â Madam Pomfrey set the empty glass down on a table and started writing on the clipboard.
âWell, can we see him?â John asked tentatively.
âSorry, but no. Heâs sleeping right now. And I donât think he wants visitors. He hasnât told you yet, has he?â
âNo,â John answered.
Madam Pomfrey sighed, âOf course. Well, I do hope he tells you soon. I have a feeling this whole thing would be easier on him if he wasnât keeping it to himself.â
âI guess weâll just see him when he leaves, then,â Albus said.
âI think that would be best. He should be ready to leave on Thursday or Friday. Youâd best be off to class,â Madam Pomfrey picked up the empty glass and strode into her office.
As Albus walked to the common room to collect his books, he thought about what Matt was going to do when he found out that they knew about his secret. Matt seemed so keen on keeping it from everyone. He didnât even want his friends to visit him in the Hospital Wing. Yet, he hadnât done a very good job at hiding it. Or had they found out so easily just because Rose knew so much about werewolves? Albus wasnât sure he would have figured it out without her. But even so, if Albus had found out so quickly, how long would it be until Malfoy found out?
******
âHey, Potty,â a cold voice from behind Albus said. It was Friday night and Albus, Rose, John, and Amanda were eating dinner while wondering when Matt would come back. Albus turned around at the voice and choked on his pumpkin juice when he saw who it was.
âWillinson,â Albus coughed.
âWhat do you want?â John said shortly as he slapped Albus on the back.
âOh, not much,â Willinson replied, âHavenât seen you much since our little duel last month, Potty.â
âYeah, I hear youâve been quite occupied with detention,â Albus laughed.
âLaugh now, but the detention is over. Iâll have plenty of time on my hands now.â
âAnd what are you going to do? You couldnât even hex me. Your friends did it.â
âDoesnât matter. Iâm not the one who wound up in the Hospital Wing, am I?â Willinson snorted.
âAnd I suppose youâre proud that a first year could disarm you?â Albus grinned, âBecause if I were you, Iâd be a bit embarrassed.â
âShut it, Potty, I planned that.â
âNo, you didnât. Quite the look of shock on your face after I did it,â Albus responded. Willinson glared at him.
âWhatâs going on here?â someone from behind Albus asked.
âN-nothing, Professor,â Willinson said quickly.
âThen Iâd suggest returning to the Slytherin table, Mr. Willinson,â Neville replied. Willinson turned on the spot and headed to the Slytherin table without saying another word.
âHe wasnât bothering you, was he?â Neville asked once Willinson left.
âNot really,â Albus told Neville.
âGood. If heâs causing trouble, just let me know. I think the detentions may have set him straight, though. Heâs not nearly as smug when heâs in the forest,â Neville responded and left for the staff table.
Albus laughed, âI guess heâs not as brave as we thought he was.â
âCourse heâs not!â John exclaimed, âHeâs a Slytherin, not a Gryffindor.â
âYeah, weâre the brave ones!â Albus agreed.
After dinner, Albus and his friends went to the common room to spend the evening. The room was quite a bit emptier than usual. There was a big dueling club meeting and most of the Gryffindors were attending it. First years were not allowed to join the dueling club, so all of them were in the common room, along with some older students who werenât part of the club. Since it was so empty, Albus and his friends were able to snag a few of the good armchairs in front of the fire. They were all putting off homework, except for Rose who was reading a book, since it was the weekend.
âYou going to join the dueling club next year?â Albus asked, while sorting through his Chocolate Frog cards. âI canât wait to join. James says itâs awesome.â
âOf course!â John shouted, âHey, have you got any Snape cards?â
âYeah, Iâve got quite a few,â Albus shifted his deck of cards and pulled out five Snapes, âWant one?â
âYeah, I still havenât gotten any,â John told him. Albus handed him one of his cards.
âIs it normal to get injured badly in the dueling club?â Amanda asked.
âItâs possible, but it doesnât usually happen,â Albus told her. âThe teachers make sure nothing bad happens.â
âThen I might join. How about you, Rose?â Amanda said.
âSure, probably,â Rose responded absentmindedly.
âAre you ok? Youâre awfully quiet,â Amanda commented.
âIâm all right,â Rose answered, âIâm just thinking about Matt. Madam Pomfrey said he was supposed to be back today.â
âIâve been thinking about that, too,â Albus told her, âI hope heâs ok.â
âWell, even if he doesnât come back until tomorrow, itâs still better than last month,â John whispered, âBut I wonder when heâs going to tell us.â
âWhy donât we go up to the dormitory and talk about it,â Albus suggested, âItâs too quiet in here, someoneâs going to hear us. And Bilius and Ethan are down here anyway.â Albus pointed to a table to their left, where the other two Gryffindor first year boys were sitting playing gobstones.
âGood idea,â Rose agreed and closed her book. The group got up from their chairs and followed Albus to the boysâ dormitory.
When they got up to the dormitory, Albus sat down on his bed. Rose and Amanda looked around a bit before sitting down next to him.
âI canât take it anymore, weâve got to tell him!â John shouted and started pacing around the room, âIâm not sure heâs ever going to tell us!â
âHe will, weâve just got to give him some more time!â Albus insisted.
âIâm not so sure, Albus. He hasnât told us yet, what makes you so sure heâll ever do it?â John questioned.
âI donât know, I just think he will.â
âWell, I donât. And Iâm not so sure I can keep pretending I have no clue why he leaves every month. I mean, how long has it been since weâve known? And weâve known him since September. Isnât that enough time for him to trust us?â John stormed over to his bed and threw himself on it.
âHonestly, John, thatâs really not a long time. September wasnât even six months ago,â Rose reasoned.
âSo youâre on Albusâs side, then? You think we should just pretend weâre clueless about his disappearances?â John asked.
âYes, I do. I think he will tell us, once he realizes he can trust us,â Rose told him.
âWell, what more do we have to do?â John huffed.
âItâs not that simple!â Albus shouted, remembering his conversation with Dumbledore. âDo you know how hard it must be for him? Heâs probably had people abandoning him because of this his whole life!â
âAnd I suppose you know more about it than I do? Last I checked, you werenât a werewolf,â John shouted.
âYeah, I do know more than you!â Albus shouted back, getting up from the bed and walking towards John.
âReally, and how would that be?â John got up and stood in front of Albus, staring at him.
âBecause Teddyâs dad was a werewolf! Iâve told you that! And my dadâs told me all about what he went through! You know he wasnât even going to be allowed to come to Hogwarts, but then Dumbledore became headmaster and let him! And then he couldnât even keep a job because no one wanted to hire a werewolf! So, yeah, I do know a bit more than you do!â
âFine, so you know more about it than me, but how do you know that Matt will tell us?â
âI just do, ok?â Albus insisted, thinking of what Dumbledore had said.
âWell, I think that it might be easier if we just told him we know. Then he could just talk to us about it and we could stop keeping secrets!â John shouted.
âAlbus,â Rose said from behind Albus and started tugging on his robes.
âNot now, Rose,â Albus pushed her hand away, âIt probably would be easier, but itâs his secret, so letâs just let him tell us!â
âBut what if he doesnât!â John threw his hands up in the air. âAre we just going to go our whole seven years at Hogwarts pretending we donât know?â
Rose poked Albus more persistently and Albus pushed her hand away again. âOf course not, because heâll tell us soon!â
âAlbus!â Rose shouted louder and pointed to the doorway.
Albus turned his head away from John and glanced at the doorway. Matt was standing there, looking tired and run down, with a shocked look on his face. He stared at Albus for a few seconds before turning and running back down the stairs.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: I know itâs shorter than usual, but I wanted the cliffhanger. The next chapter will be quite a bit longer, as Iâm planning on combining two chapters again.
Thanks to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight, my other sister, and my brother. Thanks as well to inkheart and Moonylupin for their reviews!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Albus turned back to John and they stared at each other. âHow long had he been standing there?â Albus asked quietly.
Rose sighed, âSince right after you finished talking about Teddyâs dad.â
âSo he definitely knows we know,â Albus responded.
âIâd say so,â Rose agreed.
Albus and John looked at each other again, and with their argument forgotten they both turned and ran out of the dormitory to follow Matt. Albus didnât look back, but the sound of footsteps told him that Rose and Amanda werenât far behind. Albus didnât know what he was going to say to Matt when they found him, he just knew he had to do something. This was not how Albus imagined Matt telling them about his lycanthropy. And he was sure that it was not what Dumbledore had in mind. But whatâs done is done, and Albus could only hope that Matt wasnât too mad at them.
When they reached the common room, it was packed. Albus realized that dueling club practice must have just let out. He glanced quickly around the room, thinking theyâd never find Matt amongst all the other Gryffindors. John elbowed Albus in the side and pointed towards the Fat Ladyâs portrait. It was opening, and then it closed again, but they didnât see anyone enter or leave. Someone short must have left. Albus knew it was Matt. He motioned for his friends to follow. They pushed their way through the throngs of older students and eventually made it to the portrait. The group scrambled through the hole and landed in the seventh floor corridor.
âWhere is he?â Amanda asked.
âI dunno,â Albus said, glancing around. Matt was no where in sight. âI wish we had the Marauderâs Map.â
âThe what?â John asked.
âThe Marauderâs Map. Itâs that map of Hogwarts my grandpa and his friends made. Remember? I told you about it.â
âOh, yeah.â
âWell, we donât have it. But weâd better get going if we have any hopes of finding him,â Rose started running down the corridor.
Albus, John, and Amanda followed Rose down the corridor. After a minute or so, Albus spotted Matt. âThere he is!â he whispered to his friends. They continued running and it didnât take long to catch up to Matt. Since it was right after a full moon, Matt was going slower than usual.
Albus and his friends stopped a few meters in front of him. âMatt?â Albus asked tentatively.
Matt turned around and walked slowly towards his friends, past a tapestry of
Barnabas the Barmy trying to teach trolls to dance ballet, and stopped a few feet in front of Albus. âSo, you know?â he asked in a voice so soft, Albus could hardly hear it. He stared at the ground.
âEr, yeah,â Albus answered in an equally quiet voice.
Matt didnât look up and turned around and paced slowly down the hallway. He seemed to be thinking hard. When he got just past the tapestry, he stopped and walked back towards Albus. Albus knew he was trying to think of something to say. Albus glanced at his friends and all of them looked very uncomfortable. They stood completely still, not saying a word, while Matt continued pacing up and down the hallway.
On his third or fourth time returning to Albus, Albus wasnât sure as he had lost count, Matt finally looked up at him with a scared expression on his face. Matt opened his mouth and was about to say something when he stopped. He turned and looked at the wall facing the tapestry.
Albus turned to see what Matt was staring at. When his gaze reached the wall, his mouth fell open. A door was sitting upon the wall, where there hadnât been a door before. Albus turned around and looked at Rose. Albus had a feeling he knew where the door came from, and Roseâs knowing look of awe confirmed it. John was staring at it as if he had been stupefied. Amanda was blinking and rubbing her eyes, as if the door was just a figment of her imagination.
Matt glanced at Albus and then he walked towards the door. When he reached it, he grasped the handle and opened it. He walked slowly inside, leaving the door open behind him. Once Matt was inside, Albus nodded to his friends and walked inside. John, Rose, and Amanda followed.
When Albus got into the room, he gazed around in awe. The entire room was decorated in Gryffindor scarlet and gold. The high ceiling was painted gold and the walls were covered in scarlet drapery. The floor was covered in scarlet and gold patterned carpet. In the back of the room was a large fireplace complete with a crackling fire. In front of the fire, were three large comfy looking scarlet armchairs and a big gold couch.
âWhat is this place?â Amanda asked as she walked around the room.
âI think itâs the Room of Requirement,â Albus told her, âItâs also called the Come and Go Room. It only appears when youâre in need of it. And it changes according to your needs.â
âDadâs told me about this before, but he wouldnât tell me where it was or how to find it,â John told them.
âSame with me,â Rose said.
âMe, too,â Albus replied.
âItâs incredible!â Amanda grinned, âLooks just like the Gryffindor common room.â
âOnly better,â John responded, âWe can sit near the fire.â
âIt looks like it was made for us,â Albus commented.
âIt does,â Rose agreed, âMatt, did youâŠrequest this?â
âYeah,â Matt sighed.
âSo, you knew about the Room?â John asked.
âYes,â Matt answered, âAmy told me about it before I came to Hogwarts. She thought, it well, might be useful, for me.â He sighed, âSometimes I come here after I get out of the Hospital Wing, if I want to just be alone and sleep.â
âAnd does it look like this then?â Amanda asked.
âNo, usually itâs got a four-poster bed and the fireplace, and thatâs it.â
âSo, itâll give you whatever you ask for?â Amanda responded.
âEr, I think so, within reason,â Matt told her, âLike, if you wanted a room full of Galleons, I donât think it would be able to do it. And it canât give you food. Something about the laws of Transfiguration or something.â
âIs this where youâve been all day?â John asked as he wandered around the room. âBecause we went to see you on Tuesday and Madam Pomfrey said youâd get to leave Thursday or today.â
Matt sighed and slowly walked towards one of the armchairs and sat down in it. Albus followed and sat down on the couch. Rose sat down next to him while John and Amanda took the remaining chairs. âYeah, I was here,â Matt said quietly after a few moments of silence. âI was just so tired and I couldnât face going to Charms and dealing with Washburn and Malfoy.â
Albus could understand that. Looking back on the previous months, he realized that Washburn did tend to call on Matt more right after he got back from the Hospital Wing.
âYou were still tired? Even after spending three days in the Hospital Wing? Why?â John asked while he pulled a Chocolate Frog out of his pocket and opened it. âOh, look, Albus. Now Iâve got Snape!â
âI dunno. Thatâs just how it is,â Matt mumbled.
The group sat in silence for a few moments. John pulled out a few more frogs and offered them around. Albus, Rose, and Amanda each took one and ate them. Albus got Minerva McGonagall, which he gave to Amanda since he already had about seven of her.
âYou guys have to promise me something,â Matt broke the silence, âDonât tell anyone.â
Albus stared at him. âOf course we wonât,â he said solemnly. John, Rose, and Amanda nodded their heads in agreement.
âThanks,â Matt whispered, and got up from his chair.
âWhere are you going?â Albus asked.
âI dunno. I just figured you wouldnât want to hang out with me anymore,â Matt looked nervously at Albus.
âWhat?!â Albus shouted, âOf course we still want to hang out with you!â
âReally?â Matt asked, while a smile slowly crept up on his face.
âDefinitely!â John assured him.
âOf course,â Amanda smiled.
âWe wonât abandon you,â Rose said adamantly.
Matt visibly relaxed and sat back down in his chair. âI guess I just thought that you wouldnât. Since, well, everyone Iâve ever been friends with stopped talking to me once they found out.â
âThat wonât happen with us,â Albus assured him.
âBut doesnât it scare you, just a bit?â Matt asked tentatively.
âNope,â Albus replied, grinning. He glanced at Rose, who grinned back.
âWhatâs so funny?â Matt looked from Albus to Rose.
âDid Professor Kendrick tell you that you arenât the first werewolf to attend Hogwarts?â Albus asked.
âYeahâŠâ Matt responded warily, âHe said there was one other, a couple decades ago.â
âAnd Iâm guessing he never told you who that was?â Rose replied.
âEr, no, he didnât,â Matt answered, âBut Amy told me that Teddyâs dad was a werewolf and he went here, so I assumed it was him.â
âExactly,â Albus grinned, âAnd my dadâs Teddyâs godfather.â
âReally?â Matt asked.
âYup,â Rose said. âIâll let Albus tell you the rest.â
âYou mean, thereâs more?â Matt stared in awe at Albus.
âYup, you want to know why my dadâs Teddyâs godfather, donât you?â
âOf course!â
âWell, here it goes. My grandpa, the one who was killed by Voldemort, went to Hogwarts the same time Remus Lupin did. Along with Sirius Black and Peter Pettigrew. They all became pretty good friends. Remus Lupin tried to keep the fact that he was a werewolf secret, but eventually, my grandpa, Sirius, and Peter found out. And they didnât abandon him. In fact, they all became illegal animagi and spent the full moons with him.â
âReally?â Matt glanced around at his friends.
âReally,â Albus continued, âThey stayed friends right up until Pettigrew betrayed my grandparents. And you know that story. Then, Remus met Nymphadora Tonks, who was somehow related to Sirius, I think she was his cousinâs daughter. Anyway, they got married and had a son, Teddy, right in the height of Voldemortâs reign. They both were killed in the Battle. But Remus had made my dad Teddyâs godfather, so heâs kind of like a brother. So, you can see that no way would I abandon you.â
âWow,â Matt grinned at Albus, âBut what about the rest of you?â
âNope, you donât have to worry about me,â Rose answered, âTeddyâs like my cousin.â
âIâm not related to any werewolves, heck, youâre the first one Iâve met. But donât worry. Youâre my friend and nothing can change that,â John replied.
âHonestly, it scared me a bit when I first found out,â Amanda admitted, âBut Iâm Muggle-born, so the only idea of werewolves Iâd had were in Muggle fairy tales.â
Matt looked at her and the smile on his face disappeared. He glanced nervously at Albus.
âBut Iâm fine with it now. Rose taught me a lot. I know now that real werewolves arenât anything like the ones in fairy tales. And besides, just because you get furry once a month doesnât mean youâre a different person the rest of the month. I was friends with you before I knew and Iâll stay friends with you now,â Amanda assured him.
Matt relaxed, âThanks, guys. Iâve never had better friends. But how long have you known?â
âWell, Rose figured it out in November, but we werenât positive until I wound up in the Hospital Wing at the same time as you last month.â
âWhat?!â Mattâs mouth fell open, âHow did that happen?â
Albus explained the duel with Quinton Willinson and how he had overheard Madam Pomfrey and the Healer talking early the next morning.
âWhy didnât you tell me you knew?â Matt asked quietly.
âI thought it would be better for you to tell us when youâre ready, but I guess that didnât happen,â Albus answered.
âGuess not, but thanks anyway, for the thought,â Matt replied. Everyone sat quietly for a few moments, before Albus broke the silence.
âCould we, er, ask you questions about it?â Albus asked tentatively.
Matt sighed, âSure, I guess.â
âIf you donât want to-â Albus started.
âNo, itâs fine, itâs just Iâve never actually told anyone about it. Itâs always been my parents or Amy. But yeah, ask whatever you want,â Matt told them.
âAll right, if youâre sure,â Albus paused, âWell, when did it happen?â
Matt took a deep breath. âWhen I was five. We were Muggle camping at the time. My mumâs Muggle-born, and she had gone camping when she was a kid, and she wanted me and Amy to get the experience. You guys do know what Muggles do when they camp, right?â
âThatâs when they live in those cramped, tiny tents that are just big enough to sleep in, right? And they donât use electricity or any of that stuff they use instead of magic?â John asked.
Amanda stifled a giggle at his description of camping. âWell, thatâs the general idea, I suppose, but itâs usually a lot funner than you describe it.â
âRight,â Matt said, âWell, thatâs what my mum wanted to do. So Dad agreed because he thought it sounded crazy enough to be fun. And it was, at first. We didnât use any magic. I donât remember a whole lot, but I do remember Dad playing with matches trying to get the campfire lit. It took him a half hour. Amy says that after that first campfire, Mum lit all the rest of them.
âWe were going to camp for three nights, I think. The second night was a full moon. It was a blue moon. You know, when there are two moons in a month, they call the second one a blue moon. They donât happen often. Only every 2 or 3 years. It was the end of December, remember that the seasons are opposite in Australia, so it was warm. We were all in one tent, and in the middle of the night I had to go to the bathroom. There was a long walk to the bathroom, through the woods. I was halfway there when I heard this deep growl. The last thing I remember is a huge animal pouncing on me and a searing pain in my back, and then I blacked out.â
Albus listened but didnât say anything. He heard Amanda gasped. Albus sort of felt sick to his stomach. Ever since he found out that Matt was a werewolf, he knew he must have been bit, but he never really thought about the details. Now, hearing about it, he felt awful that his friend had been through it.
âAnd then what happened?â John whispered.
âWell, my parents told me what happened a while after I woke up. Amy is a really light sleeper and she heard the growls and my screaming. She woke up my parents and my dad went noticed that I was gone and he ran out of the tent with his wand. There were a bunch of Muggles who had woken up and were running around screaming. They told my parents that a kid was being attacked by a wolf. That kid of course, was me. My parents kept running towards the growls until they found me. Dad saw what was happening and started shooting off all sorts of spells that somehow had great effect on the werewolf. Then my mum started trying to stun the werewolf, too. After a few spells, the werewolf was stunned.â
âMuggles saw it?â Rose asked.
âYeah,â Matt continued, âMy mum sent word to the Ministry and they sent Obliviators and representatives from the Werewolf Control Unit. Dad was head of that department at the time. None of the Muggles remember anything from it of course, but it was in the paper, so all the wizards and witches found out about it. But they didnât know it was me who got attacked. The law prevents the names of underage werewolves from being released.â
âWow,â Albus said, âI guess thatâs good that no one knew it was you.â
âIt didnât really help, though,â Matt replied bitterly. âBut thereâs more before I get to that. After the Ministry people showed up, my dad Apparated with me to Eastworth, thatâs one of the hospitals in Australia. I spent nearly a month there. Right up until the next full moon. I woke up two weeks after it happened. Spent the next two weeks waiting for all the injuries to heal, but they didnât heal all the way. That took a couple months. Anyway, the first full moon was awful. I hardly remember any of it. Just the pain and illness in the few days before it and the two weeks it took to heal after it.â
âBut what about the Wolfsbane Potion?â Rose asked tentatively.
Matt sighed, âThe thing is, that doesnât work for me. The Healers havenât been able to figure out why yet. I took it during the first few full moons and it had no effect on me at all, so my parents stopped giving it to me.â
Albus couldnât think of what to say. He now knew the story. Matt had told them the whole thing. It seemed like once he started, he just didnât stop. Maybe it felt good to finally tell someone about it? Albus figured that was it. He couldnât imagine carrying around a secret like that for twelve years. Then Albus remembered something Matt had told him on the train. âUm, Matt? Why did your family move to here?â Albus had the feeling that had something to do with his being a werewolf. Matt hadnât mentioned much about moving to England, and when he talked about it on the train, he changed the subject quickly.
âUm, well, because of me,â Matt replied glumly, âI never told you before, but my parents were really well-known in Australia. Not really famous like your family is, Albus, but just kind of upper class types. Both of them were. My dad comes from a long line of pure bloods. But not the kinds who despise Muggles and Muggle-borns. They were just always involved in the Ministry and had a load of gold, that kind of thing.
âAnd my mum, her family is really rich. They were always involved in all sorts of celebrity type stuff. They knew all sorts of famous people and hosted fancy parties and things like that. Then my mum got her letter telling her she was a witch. My grandparents were horrified and excited at the same time. They obviously couldnât tell any of their friends about it, and they had a hard time keeping it a secret.
âMy parents met in school and got married a few years later. Put together, they were the ideal magical couple. My dad got a job at the Ministry in the Werewolf Control Unit. Eventually, shortly after I was born, he worked his way up to Head. Then, a few months after I was bitten, he became Head of the entire Department for the Control and Regulation of Magical Creatures. Kind of ironic, isnât it?â
âThatâs how he knew how to stun the werewolf,â Rose commented.
âYeah, and itâs a good thing he did,â Matt said, âAnyway, my family was involved in all sorts of fancy events and committees, both magical and Muggle. My parents were living the perfect life. Then, I got bit.â
âAnd it all had to stop, didnât it?â Albus said softly.
âYes, and slowly it did. First, they stopped doing the Muggle things. Muggles donât know werewolves are real, so they couldnât do much Muggle stuff anymore. The Muggles would ask what was wrong with me and my parents couldnât tell them. If they lied and said it was some sort of Muggle disease, it would have been all over their news. So, my parents just told everyone that they were going to relax and raise their family away from all the fame.
âThe magic stuff was a little more complicated. Everyone who worked in my dadâs office knew that I had been bit and they kept it a secret for a long time. For over two years, no one knew it happened. Then, there were more werewolf attacks down there. So people started drafting anti-werewolf legislation. My dad immediately rejected all of it. People got suspicious, and one of his colleagues got pretty fired up about it. He was all for more restriction. So, he leaked that I was a werewolf to other parts of the Ministry. Of course, they couldnât really fire him for me being a werewolf. But right before that happened, the Ministry managed to pass a law requiring all places of transformation to be separate buildings. The department overruled Dadâs veto and the minister signed it into law. Dad refused to comply and got fired for breaking the law.â
John let out a low whistle, âMatt, Iâm so sorry, did you think it was your fault?â
âYeah, I did, actually,â Matt said darkly, âMum and Dad kept telling me it wasnât and not to think that way, but I couldnât help it.
âBut it was just all downhill from there. My parents had already sent a letter to Amyâs school, the Australian School of Sorcery, to see if I could still attend. They wouldnât let me. So they were planning on moving anyway.â
âThey wouldnât?!â John shouted, âBut why?â
âSaid it was too dangerous. I was really depressed after that. The transformations got worse. I always held out hope that Iâd be able to go to school. Amy would come home with stories and I looked forward to when Iâd get to go. So, just to seek out the options, my parents sent letters to a few other schools. The Salem Witch Institute in Massachusetts, Hogwarts, and the Adirondack Academy of Magic in New York State. And a couple others that I donât remember the names. Hogwarts, Salem, and Adirondack both said I could still attend. Adirondack had never had any werewolves attend, but they said they would work it out. Salem turned out to be a really bad idea. My parents and Amy didnât like it.
âBy then, my parents were definitely willing to move so I could go to school. They were debating which school I should go to when they read about a study St. Mungoâs was doing. It would try to figure out why Wolfsbane wouldnât work for some people. That was the deciding factor. They decided on Hogwarts and signed me up for the study. We moved that summer.â
Albus sat and thought. He now knew what Dumbledore had meant by âtrue horrors in his pastâ. It wasnât just being bit by a werewolf and becoming one himself. It was the fact that Mattâs familyâs whole life was drastically changed because of what had happened. They moved halfway across the world because of it. âWhat about Amy? She had already been at school in Australia for a few years,â Albus commented.
âYeah, she had. She was 14 when we moved, going into her fourth year. And she wasnât too happy about it. I know you guys just see her as a protective older sister, but she wasnât always,â Matt paused, âShe was really upset when my parents told her that we had to move. She didnât want to leave her friends. She blamed me.â
âBut sheâs always looking out for you!â Rose replied, âI canât imagine her being mad at you.â
âI know,â Matt said, âBut itâs true. You see, my parents didnât let her be anywhere near me when I transformed. She stayed with my grandparents every full moon that she wasnât in school. She stayed with them for a few days after the full moon, too. By the time she got back, I was mostly better.â
âOh,â Rose said, âBut what happened?â
âWell, once we moved, she couldnât go stay with my grandparents every full moon anymore. We moved in June, right after the full moon. There were two more full moons before she started school. Dad still had connections with the Ministry in Australia, so he managed to set up portkeys for her to take to my grandparentsâ house, even after we moved. She was still mad at me when she left for school and it made me feel horrible. But after a few weeks, she settled into Hogwarts and made new friends, including Victoire.
âThen the summer came and my parents had to face that she would be there during full moons. Something happened and Dad couldnât get portkeys to Australia anymore. By then Iâd been a werewolf for over three years and she still hadnât been there. She was 15, then, so my parents figured she was old enough anyway. Anyway, the night came and I, er, went to the place where I transform when Iâm home. In the morning, my parents always came and got me really early, so they could take me to my bed and give me my potions and stuff. Well, apparently that night Amy hadnât slept at all. She told me later that she couldnât once she heard my screaming and howling. She stayed awake all night, waiting for the moon to set, and once it did, she went and got me even before my parents did.
âWell, once she saw me, she realized what I was going through. That morning, she saw me unconscious, with broken bones, and covered in blood and cuts. It made her realize how bad it really is. She told me later that once she saw me, she started crying and she started trying to heal my cuts. Then my parents came and found her. They started crying with her and let her help them do everything they do after a transformation. When I woke up, we had a long talk, all four of us. Amy completely forgave me for moving here and sheâs been very protective ever since, especially when it comes to someone being rude about my condition.â
âOh, Matt,â Rose whispered, âIâm so glad that Amy isnât mad at you anymore. I just canât believe you have to go through all this.â
âItâs all right, Iâll survive,â Matt assured her.
âI know, it just doesnât seem fair,â Rose said.
âYeah,â Albus agreed, âDo you know what happened to the werewolf that bit you?â
âMy dad told me,â Matt answered, âHe got in a load of trouble, because of what did happen and what could have happened. He could have attacked some of the Muggles that were there, instead of me. It was only by chance that it happened to be me, a wizard, he bit. We were probably the only wizards anywhere near that campsite, but there were loads of Muggles around. Anyway, he got sentenced to ten years in prison.â
âSo heâs still there?â John asked.
âYup,â Matt replied. He paused for a few moments, watching his friends. âSo, now you know the whole story.â
âWere you really planning on keeping it a secret the whole time you were at Hogwarts?â Albus asked.
âEr, Iâm not sure. I guess so. Thatâs what my parents told me to do anyway. They told me not to tell anyone, and I didnât want to tell anyone either. I didnât really think anyone would find out.â
âRose is pretty smart, though,â Albus said, âI wouldnât have figured it out without her, well, until I wound up in the Hospital Wing with you last month.â
âI guess I wouldnât have been able to go all through school without anyone finding out.â
âSo who does know?â Albus asked.
âHardly anyone. The teachers, of course. Most of them have been really nice about it, especially your dad, Albus,â Matt answered.
Albus grinned, âYeah, like that essay that was due the other day.â
âOh, yeah, Iâd forgotten about that,â Matt groaned, âIâll have to do it this weekend. Washburnâs been pretty rude, but heâs rude to every Gryffindor. Amy had warned me about that.â
âWhat about over Christmas holiday, did you really fall out of a tree, or was that just another cover-up story?â Albus asked, suddenly remembering that.
Matt blushed, âEr, yeah, it was. There was a full moon over the holiday. The second one of December to be exact. It was a blue moon. Only the second one since the one when I got bit. The first one was when I was 8 and it was awful. Much worse than the regular full moons. And the one in December was just as awful. Plus, I had to transform at my grandparents house. In their attic, which my dad sound proofed and strengthened the walls with magic. So, yeah, those injuries were from the full moon, not falling out of a tree.â
âI had a feeling about that,â Albus commented, âSo, no other students know?â
âNope,â Matt answered, âYouâre the only ones, besides Amy. Sheâs not allowed to tell her friends. She hasnât even told Victoire.â
âThanks for telling us the whole story,â Rose said.
âYou know, it feels good to finally tell someone. Kind of like I can relax now. I was always afraid youâd find out and tell someone and Iâd have to leave.â
âWeâd never do that,â Albus assured him.
âThanks,â Matt smiled.
Just then the door to the room burst open and Amy came running in, out of breath. âThere you are!â she shouted and ran towards Matt.
âHowâd you get in here?â John asked. âWeâre already using the Room.â
âI made all the requests for it and I always request that Amy be able to find me, but to keep everyone else out,â Matt answered.
âAnd itâs a good thing, too! Itâs half past midnight! I was worried sick! Madam Pomfrey said you left ages ago, but I havenât seen you all day,â Amy gave him a hug.
âOuch!â Matt winced.
âOh, sorry!â Amy released her grip, âHave you been here all day?â
âPretty much.â
âYou skipped class? Are you sure youâre better?â Amy asked in a worried tone.
âIâm just tired and I didnât want to face Washburn today. He always calls on me when Iâm tired, he does it on purpose,â Matt yawned.
âOh, heâs such a git,â Amy replied, âBut are you sure youâre ok? I could take you back to the Hospital Wing.â
âIâm fine, honestly,â Matt said adamantly.
âHow did they know how to get in here?â Amy glanced around at Albus, John, Rose, and Amanda, and then leaned over and whispered something in Mattâs ear.
âItâs all right, Amy,â Matt sighed, âThey know. I told them. I told them everything.â
âWhat?!â Amy opened her eyes wide and stared at Matt. âMum and Dad told you not to!â
âI know, but itâs all right. They figured it out months ago and were just waiting until I was ready to tell them.â
âTheyâd better not tell,â Amy glanced around at Albus and the others.
âDonât worry, they wonât,â Matt assured her, âAlbusâs dad is Teddyâs godfather. So, they definitely wonât tell. Albusâs grandpa was really good friends with Teddyâs dad.â
âI knew that,â Amy said, âGuess I just never really put it together.â
âYup, and you know, Iâm really glad I told them everything. I can relax a little bit.â
âJust be sure no one else finds out,â Amy warned.
âI know, Iâll be careful,â Matt said, âBut you know, you could tell Victoire, if you want. I donât think sheâd tell anyone, do you, Albus?â
âNo, she wouldnât tell anyone,â Albus assured them.
âYeah, I know she wouldnât. Iâve been tempted to tell her ever since she told me that her dad was attacked by Fenrir Greyback,â Amy revealed, âBut Mum and Dad donât want me to tell anyone.â
âI know, they didnât want me to tell anyone either, but that didnât work out,â Matt replied, âI just wanted you to know that I wouldnât mind if you told Victoire.â
âOk, Iâll think about it. But thanks for telling me that. Itâs hard keeping it a secret. Sometimes I just want to talk about it.â
âMe, too. Thatâs why Iâm kinda relieved they know now,â Matt gestured to his friends.
âI guess you should let Mum and Dad know that you told them.â
âI will, Iâll send them a letter this weekend,â Matt yawned.
âYou really ought to go to bed,â Amy suggested.
âThatâd probably be a good idea,â Albus agreed, âQuidditch is tomorrow.â
âOh, yeah, Iâd forgotten!â Matt said excitedly.
âShould be a good game,â John commented.
âRavenclaw will probably win,â Amanda predicted.
Albus and his friends walked back to Gryffindor Tower with Amy, and the common room was practically deserted by the time they got back. Victoire was there, along with Samantha Meyers, and a couple other seventh years who Albus vaguely recognized. Amy bid them goodnight and went to sit with her friends. When Albus, John, and Matt went up to their dormitory, Bilius and Ethan were already asleep. Albus climbed into his bed feeling very content. He was happy that Matt had finally opened up to them, but still felt a bit worried about what Matt was going through. Albus was also quite thrilled with the idea of having the Room of Requirement available to them. He didnât think heâd manage to find that until he was much older, but now he would be able to use it during all his years at Hogwarts. With that and the Marauderâs Map, if James let him borrow it, Albus and his friends would certainly be able to have some fun. If only he had the Invisibility Cloak. And with thoughts of his dad actually giving him the Cloak, Albus fell into a surprisingly restful sleep.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: So, there it is! The chapter youâve been waiting for! I really hope you liked it. I wound up re-writing a bunch of it, since parts had contradicted my other story. It was originally two chapters, but I combined them to make up for the last chapter which was quite short!
Speaking of my other story, I will be posting it very soon! Itâs called In Moonlightâs Shadow and itâs basically the product of me having too much background story about Matt to possibly put into a story that focuses on Albus. The story goes into great detail about why Matt and his family moved to England. Itâs done in first person, from Amyâs point of view. I have thirty chapters written so far. I hope youâll all check it out once I post it!
Thanks as usual to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight, my other sister, and my brother. Thanks as well to inkheart, Moonylupin, and mamaykay for the reviews!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Albus woke up late the next morning, but he was still up before John or Matt were. Bilius and Ethanâs beds were empty, so they were already up. Albus was surprised that John wasnât up yet. He rarely ever missed breakfast, even on the weekends. The Quidditch match wasnât for another two hours, so Albus quietly got dressed and read a bit of his Quidditch in the Twentieth Century book. He had been reading for a half hour when he heard someone come into the room.
âAlbus?â a voice called out, âArenât you up yet?â
Albus looked up from his book, âOh, hi Rose, Amanda. Iâve been up for a while, but those two are still asleep.â He jerked his head towards John and Mattâs beds.
âI donât think Iâve ever seen John miss breakfast before,â Rose commented while looking at his sleeping form.
âMe neither. But we did stay up pretty late last night,â Albus said.
âYeah. Weâve been up for a while, doing homework,â Rose responded.
âStill have loads more to do, though,â Amanda sighed, âI havenât made much progress on my phases of the moon essay for Astronomy.â
âBet Matt could have that done in fifteen minutes,â Albus commented, âHe could probably help you.â
âGood idea, Iâll ask him after the match,â Amanda decided, âWe should probably get them up, though.â
Albus agreed and pulled back the curtains on Mattâs bed while Rose and Amanda prodded John awake. Albus looked down at Matt, who was sleeping soundly. Albus almost felt bad waking him up, but he knew Matt wanted to watch the match and would be mad if no one woke him up in time. Albus pulled back the blankets and gently poked his arm.
âWhaâs going on?â Matt mumbled. He sat up and rubbed his eyes.
âWe almost slept through Quidditch,â John replied sleepily as he got up out of bed and headed to the bathroom.
âOh, right!â Matt yawned and got up immediately.
Fifteen minutes later, Albus headed down to the Great Hall with his friends to have lunch before the match. The usual excitement that accompanied a Quidditch match was in the air when they walked into the room. Harry had been right when he said that Quidditch would take peopleâs minds off Rita Skeeterâs article. Albus hadnât heard anyone mention it in days. It seemed as if everyone had finally forgotten about it.
âWhy canât the conditions be like this when we play?â James groaned as he sat down next to Albus.
The weather was unusually good. It was still bitterly cold, but it was relatively sunny.
âWell, it doesnât matter, because our team can play in any weather!â Samantha Meyers announced. âThe Hufflepuffs on the other handâŠ.â
âTheyâre better than the Slytherins this year,â James commented.
âTrue, but the Slytherins havenât totally lost the Cup yet. Ravenclaw only beat them by 30 points in their match. Now, if they lose to Hufflepuff in the next match, theyâll be out of the running,â Samantha explained.
After lunch, everyone made their way to the Quidditch pitch. Albus and his friends managed to get good seats, but none of them really knew which team to root for. The match lasted almost two hours before the Ravenclaw Seeker finally caught the Snitch. Both Seekers spent most of the match hovering above the other players, neither of them managing to see the Snitch. James was sitting a few seats down from Albus and Albus heard him shouting to the Seekers on numerous occasions because he had seen the Snitch. In the end, the Ravenclaw Seeker saw it hovering near the Hufflepuff goal posts, caught it, and won the game.
Albus and his friends spent the remainder of the day working on their homework. Matt was able to help Amanda finish her essay, and everyone helped him catch up on all the work he had missed the previous week.
******
âFifteen minutes left!â Professor Slughorn announced during double potions one March afternoon, a few weeks later. âBring a sample of your potion up to my desk for grading and clean up, please!â
Albus poured a bit of his boil-cure potion into a vial and took it up to Professor Slughorn while John cleaned out their cauldron.
âAlbus, mâboy!â Slughorn grinned at him and took his potion. He held it up to the light and shook it. âNear perfect, I think! Could have done with a few more porcupine quills, but very good.
âNow, I am planning on having another little meeting this Sunday evening,â Slughorn went on, as he put Albusâs potion on his desk with the others. âI was hoping you and Miss Weasley would be able to attend.â
Albus inwardly groaned. He did not want to go to another Slug Club meeting. The thought of being that close to Quinton Willinson again made him shudder. âEr, well, actually, Iâve got lessons with my Aunt Hermione every Sunday. Rose does, too.â
âOh, what a shame,â Slughorn replied, âMaybe next time, then?â
âEr, maybe,â Albus shifted nervously. He had no intentions of ever going to another Slug Club meeting. At least not while Willinson was still at Hogwarts.
Albus went back to his table, got his bag, and left the room with his friends. As they walked up the stairs to the Entrance Hall, Albus told them about the Slug Club meeting.
âYouâre not going, are you, Albus?â John questioned.
âDefinitely not,â Albus replied adamantly, âPlus, Iâve got Occlumency that night anyway.â
âIâm glad he made the meeting for a Sunday, then,â Rose commented.
âYeah, me too. But he wonât do it again, though. Now that he knows we have lessons that night. I guess next time Iâll just have to say Iâve got too much homework or something,â Albus said.
âOr use a Puking Pastille or Fever Fudge or something,â John suggested.
âThat could work,â Albus replied as they emerged into the Entrance Hall. They started to cross towards the Great Hall when Albus noticed someone walking towards them. He grabbed the backs of Rose and Mattâs robes and stopped them.
âWhat?â Matt turned around and looked quizzically at Albus.
âShush!â Albus whispered, âCome here.â Albus lead them over to a broom cupboard and pulled them inside it.
âWhat are we doing in here?â John asked loudly.
âShush!â Albus said again and opened the door a crack. âLook at that man. Heâs who I saw arguing with Washburn!â
Rose, John, Matt, and Amanda each took a turn peering out the door to look at the wizard. âAre you sure?â Rose asked.
âPositive,â Albus replied.
âWait, you saw him arguing with Washburn?â Matt asked.
âOh, right, you were in the Hospital Wing then,â Albus remembered. He quickly rehashed what he had overheard while doing detention for Washburn.
âSo Washburnâs doing some kind of job for that wizard?â
âYeah,â Albus said, âAnd I think theyâre up to something. I say we follow him.â
âBut itâs time for supper!â John whined.
âExactly. Which means no one will be around to wonder what weâre up to,â Albus reasoned. âPlus, weâll get supper after.â
John sighed, âFine. Where do you think they went?â
âProbably Washburnâs office.â
Rose opened the door. âLetâs go then.â
Albus followed Rose out the door and they crept up the stairs towards Washburnâs office, with John, Matt, and Amanda following. The corridors were empty since everyone was in the Great Hall. They reached the Charms classroom and Albus peeked inside. Washburn and the other wizard were standing near his desk, arguing in hushed voices. Albus motioned for his friends to move closer and the five of them huddled near the open door, being careful not to make too much noise.
âYou havenât done it yet,â the strange man hissed, âWhy havenât you done it?â
âIâm sorry!â Washburn replied, âI havenât been able to yet!â
âWell, why not? It doesnât seem that difficult to me.â
âItâs harder than youâd think! I donât know where they are!â Washburn answered.
âIâve told you how to find out!â
âI know and Iâve been trying. I have, really!â Washburn moaned.
Albus looked quizzically at his friends. He had never seen Washburn like this before. Usually, it was Washburn who was doing the bullying, not the other way around. But this man was obviously angry that Washburn hadnât finished whatever he wanted him to do.
âWell, hurry up then. Try harder!â the strange wizard insisted.
âI will, I will.â
âYou know we cannot proceed without them. Iâm positive I know where one of them is, but it will prove very difficult to get. Once we find out where the others are, weâll do them first. Theyâre the more important ones anyway. So, you must do it soon. Just find out where they are. Iâll retrieve them. Youâve obviously had difficulties with even doing the simple task of finding them, let alone retrieving them,â the wizard growled.
âYes, I know. I will try harder, I will. Itâs justâŠ,â Washburn trailed off.
âWhat?!â the wizard demanded.
Albus leaned his head closer to the doorway, but Washburn remained silent. Then Albus felt a wet object collide with his head. âArgh!â he screamed and turned around.
âIckle firsties!â Peeves was bobbing up and down in the air, cackling madly. âSpying on teachers? Very naughty!
âPeeves!â Rose shouted as the poltergeist heaved a water balloon at her head. Peeves cackled and threw another water balloon at Albus.
âWhat is going on out here?!â Washburn appeared in the doorway, his voice returning to the usual rage that Albus was used to.
âFirsties spying on your meeting, Professor, Sir!â Peeves saluted Washburn and flew down the hallway, laughing hysterically.
âPotter!â Washburn spat, glaring at Albus. Albus stood trembling and soaking wet, waiting for whatever was coming next. At the time, spying on Washburn seemed like a great idea. But now that he thought about it, it was inevitable that they would be caught.
The strange wizard came sauntering out of the room with a smug look on his face. âI think that concludes our discussion. I shall be speaking with you shortly.â He walked down the corridor and disappeared around a corner.
Washburn watched him leave and once he was gone, Washburn turned back to Albus. âJust what, do you lot, think you were doing?â he seethed.
Albus stood still, but said nothing. Rose, John, Matt, and Amanda remained silent as well. Washburn looked at each of them in turn and returned his gaze to Albus. â100 points from Gryffindor. And detention, this Monday at 7 pm, all of you. Iâll have you polishing the trophies,â he spat.
Albus nodded. 100 points, that was the most Washburn had ever taken from them before. The detention was no big deal, but the points would set Gryffindor quite a ways back in the running for the House Cup.
âUm, Professor,â Matt whispered, âIs there any chance we could do it this weekend, maybe, instead of Monday?â
Washburn turned to glare at Matt, looking livid. âNO! Iâve got other detentions scheduled for the weekend! Youâll meet me in the Trophy Room at 7 pm on Monday, or Iâll report you to the headmaster!â He gave Matt one more piercing stare and went back into his room, slamming the door behind him.
Albus turned and looked at his friends. They all had shocked expressions on their faces and Matt looked quite worried. Roseâs hair was dripping with water.
âTold you we should have gone to supper instead,â John commented, as they started walking down the corridor.
âShut it,â Albus replied, âWe may have gotten detention, but we did hear some useful information.â
âHeâs got a point,â Rose said, âWashburnâs definitely up to something. That man wants him to find something out, find out where something is, and then theyâre going to try to steal it.â
âI guess, but we donât even know what theyâre trying to find out. We canât really do anything about it,â John responded.
âAnd Washburnâs even more angry with us,â Matt said dryly.
âYeah, but he already hates me so much that it doesnât matter,â Albus pointed out, âBy the way, why did you want the detention switched? Thatâs not the, you know, is it?â Albus asked, not wanting to say âfull moonâ out loud, in case anyone was lurking around.
âNo,â Matt whispered, âBut itâs two nights after the detention, so Iâll already be feeling miserable.â
âOh,â Albus said, remembering how tired Matt always was in the days preceding the full moon. âMaybe you could talk to my dad or Professor Longbottom? Theyâd make Washburn switch it.â
âI know they would, but then word would get around to Malfoy. The last thing I need is him wondering why I can choose when I have my detentions. You know Washburn would somehow mention it in class.â
âYeah, he would,â Albus said darkly.
âWeâll just polish your trophies for you,â John assured him, âJust make it look like youâre doing something and weâll cover for you.â
Matt smiled weakly, âThanks.â
âSo, we going to go eat supper or not?â John turned towards the stairs.
âYou guys go ahead,â Albus answered, âIâve got to go change out of these wet robes.â He gave Rose a meaningful glance.
âIâve got to change, too,â Rose told them and gestured to her soaking robes.
âAll right,â John said, and started down the stairs with Matt and Amanda.
Albus and Rose set off for Gryffindor Tower. Once they entered the deserted common room, Rose turned to look at Albus. âYou thought of the Hallows when you heard Washburn talking, didnât you?â
âYeah,â Albus said, âDid you?â
Rose nodded, âIt does seem suspicious.â
âItâs got to be him. It fits. Thatâs why he hates me. He thought Iâd know where the Hallows are, but I donât.â
âI dunno. I mean, it does fit, but still, Washburnâs a teacher.â
âSo what? Teachers can be Dark wizards, too.â
âI know, but we donât have any proof! We didnât even hear him say âHallowsâ,â Rose reasoned.
âI know, so I donât think we should tell my dad yet, we canât get him in trouble, but itâs a start. And we learned more about the Hallows,â Albus pointed out, âThey already know where one of them is, but itâs going to be hard to get. Maybe itâs heavily guarded?â
âProbably. Anyway, I think weâll probably have to take Dumbledoreâs advice and talk to John, Matt, and Amanda about it. Weâve got to find out what they are.â
âYeah, we should. Weâll do it soon,â Albus assured her.
âAlbus, do you think that Washburn, or whoever is trying to get the Hallows, will be able to bring back Voldemort?â Rose asked quietly.
âI donât think so. I mean, heâs dead, right? So how could he come back? Plus, in my dream, the wizard said he was going to bring about Voldemortâs âidealsâ.â
âWell, his âidealsâ are pretty scary,â Rose shuddered, âAnd the idea of a second Voldemortâs almost as scary as the first one.â
âYeah,â Albus agreed, âWhich is why weâve got to keep Washburn from getting the Hallows.â
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight, my other sister, and my brother. Also, thanks to Moonylupin, XXEveryinchXX, and TheNobleHouseofPotter for their reviews!
Iâve posted my next story, In Moonlightâs Shadow. Please check it out on my author page!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Word spread like wildfire that a group of first years had lost Gryffindor 100 points in one night. Quite a few older students were very angry about this, especially since the loss of points placed them below both Slytherin and Hufflepuff in the running for the House Cup. After classes the next day, Albus and his friends were bombarded by a couple fifth years, including his cousins Georgia and Gabriella, demanding to know why the points were taking away. Albus quickly explained what had happened with Washburn, and silence fell around the common room. After a few moments, someone started clapping. Soon after, a couple more people joined in and eventually the entire common room was cheering and slapping Albus and his friends on the back. Albus stared quizzically at everyone, wondering why they were all cheering that he had lost them so many points.
âWhyâs everyone clapping?â Albus asked James.
James grinned, âBecause you made Washburn so angry! Everyone hates him! No oneâs had the nerve to spy on him before. Itâs brilliant, really. Iâve heard people have been trying to get him to quit since he first started teaching when Victoire was a first year. Youâve done so much stuff to him this year. First you set him on fire-â
âThat was a complete accident!â
âDoesnât matter, the point is, heâs horrible to everyone, except the Slytherins. And youâre rebelling against him. Honestly, youâve got more nerve than I thought,â James stared in awe at his brother.
âThanks,â Albus smiled at James. Albus had felt horrible about losing so many points, but if the other Gryffindors werenât going to care, than maybe it wasnât so bad after all.
For the next few days, whenever Albus and his friends were in the common room, the other Gryffindors would ask Albus for help in planning pranks to pull on Washburn. Apparently, the other Gryffindors saw Albusâs spying as inspiration to figure out their own ways to drive the Charms professor crazy. Albus, however, wanted nothing to do with it. He was far too worried about the idea of Washburn and that other wizard trying to find the Hallows and use them to complete Voldemortâs plans. He spent the weekend trying to do homework, but always wound up thinking about the Hallows and trying to think of something that was heavily guarded that could be used to gain power.
By the time Monday arrived, Albus had exhausted every possible powerful object and couldnât think of anymore. Monday meant that it was time for their detention with Washburn. After dinner, Albus and his friends walked slowly to the trophy room. Albus was not looking forward to being in close vicinity with the person who was most likely performing Legilimency on him.
âAre you all right, Matt?â Rose asked, jolting Albus out of his thoughts. He turned around to look at Matt, who was lagging behind the rest of them, even though they were all walking slow.
âYeah,â Matt yawned, âJust tired, no big deal.â
âYou should go to Madam Pomfrey. Sheâll make Washburn reschedule the detention,â Rose suggested.
âAnd have Malfoy find out? No. Plus, if I do it another time, Iâll have to do it alone,â Matt shuddered at the thought of being alone with Washburn.
No one said another word the rest of the way to the trophy room. When they got there, Washburn was already there, looking murderous, and standing next to a large bucket of cleaning supplies.
âItâs 7:05. Youâre late,â he growled.
âSorry, sir,â Matt mumbled, âIt was my fault.â
âI donât care whoâs fault it was. It just means youâll be here later,â Washburn barked, âYouâll be staying until every one of these trophies is spotless. No magic, of course.â
Washburn strode over to a large armchair that was sitting near the door, sat down in it, and started his usual glaring. Albus picked up a bottle of polish and a rag and wandered over to a trophy for the Gobstones Club. John and Matt started polishing trophies on either side of Albus, while Rose and Amanda started on the other side of the room. The trophy room was quite large and Albus guessed it would take them at least two hours, perhaps more, to polish all the trophies and cases. They polished in silence for a half hour, moving along the wall of trophies as they went on. Albus was polishing a Wizardâs Chess Championship trophy from 1922 when he felt a sharp poke in his side. He turned to his right and saw John, who had stopped polishing his trophy. âWhat?â Albus whispered.
John silently pointed to Albusâs other side and Albus turned to look. Matt was standing with his head slumped up against the trophy case. He was fast asleep. Albus glanced nervously back at John. Albus didnât want to know what Washburn would do to Matt if he discovered that he wasnât awake.
âMatt,â Albus prodded his friend gently, âWake up.â
Matt groaned a little and lifted his head off the glass. Albus glanced nervously at Washburn. Luckily he was currently pointing out a spot of dirt that Rose had missed on a Quidditch trophy. Albus poked Matt again, a little harder this time.
âOuch!â Matt winced and opened his eyes. He glanced around with a confused look on his face.
âShush!â Albus whispered. âYou fell asleep. Keep polishing.â
âOh, right,â Matt picked up his rag that had fallen on the floor when he drifted off and went back to polishing.
The three boys continued polishing in silence for the next hour. Occasionally, either Albus or John would have to wake Matt up. Matt was not getting a whole lot of polishing done, but since he was working right next to Albus and John, Washburn didnât seem to notice.
âAlbus,â John whispered a while later.
âWhat?â Albus looked over at John. John pointed at the trophy he was polishing. Albus looked at it and saw that it was a plaque of everyone who received an award for special services to the school.
John pointed at two names on it, Harry Potter and Ron Weasley. âWhat did they do?â he whispered.
âSaved my mum from Voldemort and a basilisk in the Chamber of Secrets,â Albus whispered back. âAnd discovered that it was Voldemort attacking students in the first place. He possessed my mum through a diary he wrote when he was 16.â
John stared wide-eyed at Albus. âWhoa. I think I remember my parents telling me about that. They werenât in Hogwarts yet when that happened.â
âQuiet back there,â Washburn growled.
Matt jerked awake at the sound of Washburnâs voice. âWhaâs going on?â he said a little too loudly.
âOh, wake up, Eckerton! Itâs only 9 pm!â Washburn shouted, âThe sooner you finish, the sooner you can go to bed.â
âSorry, sir,â Matt replied and went back to polishing a trophy.
As Albus continued polishing, he thought about the award his dad had gotten all those years ago. He had been a hero every year he had been in school. He still was a hero. âWill I ever do anything like that?â Albus thought. âWill I ever live up to what people think I will do? Everyone thinks Iâll do great things just because my dad did, but what if I canât?â Albus doubted that he would ever get an award for special services to the school.
âEckerton!â Washburn shouted, causing Albus to come out of his thoughts. âWhy canât you stay awake?! Get up!â
Albus looked over at Matt. He was slumped yet again on one of the glass display cases, looking very pale. He opened his eyes and started slowly dragging his rag along the glass with his eyes drooping.
âWhy donât you lay off him already?â John shouted disgustedly. âYou know perfectly well why heâs tired.â
Washburn got up from his chair and started towards John. Albus glanced nervously from one to the other. Rose and Amanda both stopped polishing and were paying close attention. Matt had fallen asleep on the glass again. âWhat did you say?â Washburn spat once he was within two feet of John.
John stared at him, not breaking eye contact. âI said, why donât you leave him alone? You knew heâd be tired today and you still made him do detention! Just let him sleep and weâll finish the cleaning. Weâre almost done anyway.â
Washburnâs face turned a shade of purple that Albus had only seen on his Great-Uncle Vernon. He stepped closer to John, but John didnât look away. â50 more points from Gryffindor for talking back. And another detention, I think. Tomorrow night. Lines. My office. But just you. Sleeping Beauty will be even worse tomorrow and as much as Iâd love to give more detention to Potter, Weasley, and Tagger, they havenât done anything. This was all you. Go on, get out of here!â He shouted stormed out of the room.
Albus stared in shock as he left. He glanced around at John, who was still glaring at the door, his face as red with anger as Roseâs hair. âCâmon, letâs go,â he said quietly as he prodded Matt awake.
âHuh?â Matt mumbled.
âDetentionâs over,â Albus told him as he walked towards the door.
âOh, ok,â Matt yawned and followed the rest of them out of the door.
âHeâs kept us past curfew,â Rose commented as they made their way through the corridors.
âFigures,â John grunted.
âThat was brilliant, by the way,â Albus said.
âWhat was brilliant?â Matt asked.
âJohn flipped out on Washburn while you were asleep,â Albus told him.
âWhat did you do?â Matt asked John in an astonished voice. âWhy do I always miss the good stuff?â
John was still too angry to say much, so Albus explained. âHe told Washburn off for yelling at you. It was after Washburn woke you up that second time. And you had just fallen asleep again. John started yelling at him about how he shouldnât have shouted at you when he knew why you were tired and how he shouldnât have assigned you detention for today.â
âWhat?!â Matt shouted, âAre you mad? What did he do to you?â
âDetention tomorrow night. And fifty points lost,â John replied.
âYou are mad,â Matt said quietly, âYou didnât have to do that. I donât want you getting in trouble for me.â
âYes, I did,â John said, âItâs not fair what he did. He should have made the detention over the weekend, like you suggested. Heâs deliberately trying to run you down. Itâs just not fair.â
âYeah, well, lifeâs not fair. I found that out six years ago,â Matt said bluntly.
âYeah, but it doesnât mean itâs okay for people to treat you like dung,â John replied softly.
******
By the time John trudged back into the common room after his detention the next night, most of the rest of the Gryffindors had gone to bed. There were a few fifth years huddled up at one table, studying for their O.W.L.s, and Victoire and Amy were up talking quietly while studying for their N.E.W.T.s. Albus and his friends had managed to get the good armchairs near the fire once the fourth years occupying them had gone to bed. Rose was reading a book while Albus and Amanda played gobstones. Matt was sound asleep in his chair.
âHowâd it go?â Albus asked as John collapsed in one of the chairs.
âIt was bloody miserable,â John groaned, âHe stared at me the whole time. Had me write âI will respect my elders and not talk backâ about 300 times.â
âYeah, thatâs what he does. Iâve gotten used to it, but it drove me mad during the first few detentions,â Albus told him.
âHeâs an evil git,â John growled.
âI know,â Albus agreed.
âWell, I donât want to talk about him anymore. I just spent two hours with him. Anyway, what have you been up to?â John asked.
âNot much. We finished all our homework a while ago. Weâve just been sitting around waiting for you,â Albus said.
âWhen did he fall asleep?â John jerked his head towards Matt.
âAbout an hour ago,â Amanda answered.
John sighed, âYou know, itâs almost like he expects everyone to be rude to him.â
âIâm pretty sure he does,â Albus whispered.
âWell, itâs probably because most people have,â Rose commented, âI mean, most people arenât exactly nice to, well, people like him.â
âI know, but he shouldnât just accept it. Iâm going to stick up for him,â John said.
âWe will, too,â Rose agreed, âBut heâs just not used to it.â
âI guess, but Iâm not going to let anyone treat him badly. Especially not someone like Washburn,â John replied.
âMe neither,â Albus said.
âDefinitely,â Amanda replied.
âWe should probably go to bed,â Albus said after glancing at his watch, âWeâve got Astronomy tomorrow.â
Amanda groaned, âOh, yeah. Should be a miserable night.â
âYours wonât be as miserable as his will be,â John pointed to Matt.
******
The next day went by fast for Albus. Charms was thoroughly miserable for Albus and all his friends. John had made it onto the list of people Washburn clearly disliked more than the others. Now, the only one of Albusâs friends who wasnât, was Amanda. However, Washburn did dislike her more than the other Gryffindors, just because she was friends with Albus. Washburn spent the whole class lecturing and shouting at Matt whenever he fell asleep. Albus could tell that John was trying hard to behave himself whenever this happened. It didnât help that Malfoy spent the whole class with a smug look on his face, clearly enjoying that Washburn was shouting at Matt every five minutes.
âEvil git. We ought to sneak a few puking pastilles in his pumpkin juice,â John muttered under his breath after Washburn woke Matt up for the fourth time.
âWhat did you say, Brickston?â Washburn shouted.
âNothing, sir,â John answered.
âDidnât sound like nothing,â Washburn growled, âTen points from Gryffindor.â
Matt wound up skipping Potions because he couldnât face a second class with Malfoy that day. Malfoy interrogated Albus again as to where Matt was, and Albus told him that Matt had left after lunch to visit his sick gran.
After dinner, Albus and his friends decided to see if Matt was in the Room of Requirement. He never showed up at dinner. When they arrived in the Room, Amy was already there, trying to wake Matt up.
âHey, Amy,â Albus said quietly.
Amy turned around, âOh, hi, Albus.â
âAre you going to the Hospital Wing now?â Rose asked.
âYeah, Iâll see you guys tomorrow, I guess,â Matt yawned as Amy helped him out of the bed.
âAll right,â Albus replied.
âBye,â John, Rose, and Amanda said quietly.
âBye,â Matt winced as he followed his sister out of the room.
Albus and his friends spent the rest of the evening in the Room, working on their homework. After a few hours, in which Albus managed to get the latest Potions homework done, it was time for Astronomy.
Professor Polo announced that they would be finishing their March star charts that night. Albus, John, Rose, and Amanda set up their telescopes and got to work.
âThis is the first full moon on a Wednesday, isnât it?â Albus whispered to Rose after a few minutes.
âYeah, I think so,â Rose said, âIâm just glad we donât have this with the Slytherins.
âWhereâs your friend, Matt?â Jackie Pierce, the Hufflepuff on Albusâs other side asked.
âHeâs visiting his sick gran,â Albus said automatically.
âOh, I hope sheâs better soon,â Jackie replied.
Albus focused his telescope and marked down a few stars. He moved his telescope and pointed it towards the moon. He sighed as he thought about how something as beautiful as the moon could control someoneâs life as much as it controlled Mattâs.
Albus managed to finish his star chart just as the class was ending. John and Rose were able to finish theirs as well.
âI hope he doesnât take off a whole lot of points for not getting all the stars,â Amanda sighed as they climbed into the portrait hole.
âIf you only forgot a couple, I donât think youâll loose that many points,â Rose assured her.
Albus sat down in one of the armchairs in front of the empty fireplace. âAre any of you tired?â
John sat down next to Albus, âNo, not really.â
Rose and Amanda shook their heads and sat down. âLetâs stay up. We can go see Matt in the morning,â Rose suggested.
âGood idea,â Albus agreed. The friends spent much of the night playing numerous games of chess, Exploding Snap, and Gobstones. Eventually, the sun started to rise and morning came.
âShould we go, then?â John asked once they finished their game of Exploding Snap.
âYeah, itâs probably a good time,â Rose said. âBut maybe you should go get the map, Albus. I donât fancy running into Filch.â
Albus agreed and ran up to Jamesâs dormitory. James and the rest of the second year boys were all sound asleep. Albus ran to Jamesâs trunk and rummaged around in it until he found the Marauderâs Map. He left a quick note to James telling him that he took the map, quickly left the room, and went back to the common room.
Albus spread the map out on the floor and tapped it with his wand, âI solemnly swear that I am up to no good.â
âBlimey, that is brilliant!,â John grinned as the writing appeared on the map. Albus had told his friends about the map before, but he had never showed it to them.
âWow!â Amanda stared in awe at the map. âThat is awesome.â
âLetâs see,â Albus scanned the map, âFilch is still in his office.â
âWhat about Washburn?â John asked.
âHmm,â Albus looked back at the map.
âThere he is!â Rose pointed at the map, âHeâs in his office, too.â
âGood,â John said in a relieved voice, âOh, and thereâs Madam Pomfrey. Sheâs walking through the Entrance Hall.â
âLetâs go, then,â Albus stood up, âMischief Managed.â He stuffed the map into his robe pocket and left the room, with Rose, John, and Amanda following.
When they arrived at the Hospital Wing, it was completely deserted. Albus and his friends settled themselves on the bed next to the one Matt usually stayed in. The door opened a few minutes later, but it wasnât Madam Pomfrey who came through. It was Amy, followed by Victoire.
âWhat are you doing here?â Amy asked when she saw Albus and the others.
âWe had Astronomy last night and werenât tired, so we just stayed up and figured weâd come see Matt,â Albus told her.
âOh, all right,â Amy replied. She walked over to the bed where Albus and his friends were sitting and Victoire followed. âI told her,â Amy said to Albus, âabout Matt.â
âI still canât believe you kept this from me all these years,â Victoire said.
âYouâre not mad, are you?â Amy asked quietly.
âNo, of course not,â Victoire assured her and sat down next to Rose on the bed. âIt just must have been so hard to keep that a secret.â
Amy sat down next to Victoire, âIt was. But I didnât really have a choice. My parents forbid me from telling anyone.â
âWell, Iâm glad you told me now. Your parents arenât going to be mad, are they?â
âNo, I asked them a couple weeks ago and they said it would be all right if I told you,â Amy answered.
âGood,â Victoire said and turned to Albus, âHow long have you guys known?â
âSince January. Well, Rose put the clues together in November, but we didnât know for sure until January. But we didnât talk to Matt about it until last month,â Albus responded.
The group sat in silence for a few moments, before Victoire asked, âWhenâs he coming back?â
âShould be any time,â Amy stood up and glanced at the door. âBut just to let you guys know, heâs not going to be in any shape to talk to you.â
âWe know, we just want to be here for him,â John replied.
âI honestly donât even know if heâs going to want you here. He never likes anyone seeing him right after a transformation.â
âWe donât care what he looks like,â John said adamantly.
âI know you donât, but I think heâs still afraid youâre going to abandon him. Heâs never had such supportive friends before. The few friends he had went running in the other direction once they found out,â Amy explained.
âGits,â John muttered under his breath.
The door to the Hospital Wing opened and Albus looked up. Madam Pomfrey came bustling through while using her wand to float a stretcher through the door. Matt was laying upon it, covered in a thick green blanket. Amy immediately rushed over to them. âHow is he?â she asked anxiously.
âNot that bad, actually,â Madam Pomfrey replied, âA few broken bones and a fair bit of cuts and bruises, but not as bad as past months.â
âOh, good,â Amy replied.
Madam Pomfrey directed the stretcher towards the bed next to the one Albus and his friends were sitting on. âWhat are you lot doing here?â she asked briskly once she noticed them.
âWe, er, just wanted to see if Matt was okay,â Albus answered nervously. He suddenly wasnât sure if they should have gone to the Hospital Wing after all.
âHe knows you know, then?â Madam Pomfrey asked.
âYeah, and he explained everything last month,â Albus told her.
âAnd you know, too?â Madam Pomfrey gestured to Victoire.
âYes, I do,â Victoire answered.
Madam Pomfrey smiled, âGood. Itâs about time he had some loyal friends. Now, Iâve got to heal him up a bit and then if heâs awake, you can see him.â She pulled the curtains closed behind her and Amy. A minute later, she came out, went to her office, and came back with numerous potions and bandages. Albus watched as she went back through the curtains and listened to the various healing spells she was performing.
Victoire, Albus, and his friends all sat on the bed, no one saying a word. Albus was still a bit worried about Mattâs reaction to them being there. He hadnât thought about it before, but now he realized that Amy was right and Matt probably didnât want them to see him like this. He glanced at his friends, who were also looking a bit nervous. They didnât have long to dwell on it, though, because a little while later, Madam Pomfrey and Amy appeared from behind the curtains.
âHeâs awake,â Madam Pomfrey told them, âYou can see him for a few minutes, but not very long. He needs rest.â
Albus glanced at his friends and they stood up. He walked through the curtains, with Rose, John, and Amanda following. Matt was laying on the bed, looking thoroughly miserable. His face was covered in cuts and there was a large bruise on his left cheek. Both of his arms were heavily bandaged and he looked very tired.
âWhat are you guys doing here?â he asked hoarsely when he saw Albus and the others.
âWe wanted to come see you. Are you all right?â Albus asked.
âIâve been better,â Matt answered bluntly.
âI hope you donât mind that we came,â Rose said softly.
âItâs all right,â Matt sighed, âI just thought you wouldnât have wanted to.â
ââCourse we do,â John said, âYouâre our friend.â
Matt grinned tiredly at them. âOh, did you tell Victoire?â he asked Amy, who had just come back through the curtains with Victoire.
âYeah, I told her this morning,â Amy replied.
âAnd it doesnât bother me in the least,â Victoire assured him. Matt yawned and smiled at her.
Madam Pomfrey came back with another steaming potion in a goblet. âTime for you lot to go,â she told them, âHe needs to sleep.â
âOk,â Albus said, âBye, Matt. Hope you feel better.â
âWeâll come see you tonight,â Rose told him.
âOk, have fun in class,â Matt yawned. John and Amanda waved as the group left. Amy and Victoire followed behind them, whispering to each other.
Albus walked to the Great Hall for breakfast with his friends. He was feeling quite tired after staying up the whole night. Albus was glad that Matt didnât seem to mind them coming to see him so soon after the full moon, but he could tell that Matt still wasnât completely comfortable with them knowing his secret. Albus figured that after a couple weeks or so Matt would gradually relax about it. Now, all Albus had to do was decide when to tell his friends about the Hallows. He had been putting it off, but decided to take Dumbledoreâs advice and see if they knew anything about them. It was the only clue he had, and if he was going to stop Washburn from getting the Hallows, he he had to use it.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight, as well as my other sister and my brother. Thanks also to inkheart, Moonylupin, and Mamaykay for their reviews!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter or any of The Tales of Beedle the Bard.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Albus did not have a chance to ask John, Matt, and Amanda about the Hallows until after the Easter holiday. Matt spent the rest of the week in the Hospital Wing, and Albus didnât want to talk about the Hallows there. He preferred to do it in private. The Easter holiday began the day after Matt left the Hospital Wing. Neither Albus nor his friends stayed at the castle over the holiday. Albus quite enjoyed the break and spent much of it playing Quidditch with James. Rose and her family came to stay for a few days, but Albus didnât see the rest of his extended family. Albus, Rose, and James did spend a bit of time sneaking around Grimmauld Place, looking for clues that would lead them to finding out what the Hallows were, but they didnât find anything useful.
By the time Albus was back at Hogwarts, the snow had melted and it was relatively warm. April was upon them, which meant that the end of term exams were only two months away. The teachers made sure to remind them of this during every class. Albus had not thought it possible, but they were being assigned even more homework than before. Of course, no one was feeling the pressure more than the fifth and seventh years, who were preparing for their O.W.L.s and N.E.W.T.s. All of them could be seen studying in the common room and library until late at night. A few of them were already cracking under the pressure. Albus was glad that his O.W.L.s were still four years away, but he was not looking forward to them. Even Victoire was becoming nervous about the exams and had started threatening younger students with detentions if they were too loud in the common room. Usually Victoire was very level headed and not much bothered her, but she was afraid she wouldnât have enough N.E.W.T.s to get her into the Healer program.
âI am not looking forward to my O.W.L.s,â John sighed as he watched as a fifth year nodded off while reading her notes.
âMe neither,â Matt agreed.
âYouâll be fine if you study,â Rose assured them.
âThatâs the part Iâm not looking forward to,â John laughed, âIâm having enough trouble studying for this yearâs exams.â
âHave you finished your Herbology?â Albus asked John.
âIâm working on it now,â John told him.
âI havenât even started it,â Amanda commented. Matt was helping her finish this weekâs Astronomy assignment.
âWell, itâs not due until day after tomorrow,â Albus told them.
âGood thing!â John shouted and threw down his quill, âI need a break from all this!â
âShush!â Victoire came storming over to their table. She looked very tired. âThis is study time!â
âSorry, Victoire,â John said, âIâm just sick of studying.â
âJust wait until seventh yearâŠâ Victoire muttered as she went back to the table she was sharing with Amy.
âWant to go to the Room?â Albus whispered.
âYeah, letâs go,â Matt replied and got up. Albus, Rose, Amanda, and John all picked up their books and followed Matt out of the common room. They walked to the Room and Matt paced three times in front of it. The door appeared and they all walked inside. The Room looked just as it did when Matt told them about the night he was bit.
Albus walked inside and sat down on one of the chairs. His friends followed and they all resumed their studying, except for John, who was wandering around the Room.
âIâve got to tell you guys something,â Albus said quietly after a few minutes. Everyone looked up from their books and John came over to the fire and sat down on the couch next to Matt.
âAre you going to tell us where you disappear to with Rose and your brother?â John asked.
âEr, yeah, you noticed that?â Albus asked nervously.
âYes, we all did,â Amanda told him.
âWell, Iâm going to tell you why,â Albus said. âI guess first Iâve got to tell you that this past summer, I thought my dad had told me everything about the defeat of Voldemort.â
âYou mean, he didnât?â John asked.
âNo, I donât think he did,â Albus replied quietly, âOver Christmas, Rose, James, and I, and a couple of our cousins, overheard mine and Roseâs parents whispering about something in the kitchen. They were talking about whether or not to tell us something, something theyâve been hiding from us. I donât know what it was. I just heard them say one word, âHallowsâ. James, Rose, and I researched in the library to try and find out what âHallowsâ were. But we didnât find anything. The only thing we had to go on was the fact that I heard the word âHallowsâ in those Legilimency dreams I have. Someone wants to find the Hallows and steal them, whatever they are.
âRose came up with the idea that I should talk to Dumbledoreâs portrait about it. We figured that the Hallows had something to do with Voldemortâs downfall because they seem to be something just our parents know about. Since Dumbledore told my dad about the Horcruxes, we figured heâd know something about the Hallows. So, Rose came up with the whole idea to set off a firework in Washburnâs class in order to get me into the Headmasterâs office so I could talk to Dumbledore.â
âWait, you did that on purpose?â John asked in awe.
âYeah, we did,â Rose grinned.
âThatâs, thatâs brilliant, but stupid!â John laughed.
âWe know,â Albus said grimly, âIt could have gone much worse. Anyway, Dumbledore did know about the Hallows, but he wouldnât tell us about them. He said it was something my dad had to tell me. But he did give me a clue. He told me to ask you about them,â Albus said.
âHe thinks weâd know what they are?â Amanda asked.
âWell, yeah, thatâs what he said. He said to specifically ask John and Matt about them,â Albus replied.
âHe got that right, Iâve never heard of Hallows before,â Amanda responded.
âYou havenât heard of them, have you?â Albus turned to John and Matt.
John and Matt looked at each other and then glanced at Albus. âWell, Iâve never heard of them,â John said.
âI have, my dad told me about them once,â Matt commented.
âYou know what they are?â Albus asked in shock. He looked at Rose. She looked as clueless as Albus did.
âYeah, I do,â Matt repeated, âHavenât you two ever heard The Tales of Beedle the Bard?â
âOf course,â Albus nodded.
âThe what?â Amanda looked quizzically at Matt.
âThe Tales of Beedle the Bard,â he repeated, âA book of Wizard fairy tales. The Warlockâs Hairy Heart, Babbity Rabbity and Her Cackling Stump, The Wizard and the Hopping Pot, The Fountain of Fair Fortune-â
âMy parents read me those when I was little. Mumâs actually got the original copy!â Rose interrupted excitedly.
âDoes she really?â Matt stared at her in awe.
âYeah, Dumbledore left it to her in his will,â Rose told him. âBut what do a bunch of fairy tales have to do with âHallowsâ?â
âYou didnât let me finish. Thereâs one more. The Tale of the Three Brothers,â Matt told them. âAnd that has everything to do with the Hallows.â
Albus and Rose glanced at each other. Like Rose, Albus had been read those fairy tales when he was little, and he remembered The Tale of the Three Brothers. He remembered his Aunt Hermione reading it to him from the original copy. He hadnât been able to read a word of it, since it was written in Runes, but he definitely remembered the story.
âBut I donât remember anything about any Hallows in that story,â Rose commented.
âYou wouldnât,â Matt told her, âThe story doesnât mention the word Hallows, but the story itself is about the Hallows.â
âThat doesnât make sense,â John announced.
âCould someone explain this story, please?â Amanda asked with a look of confusion on her face.
âSure,â Matt leaned back on the couch and gazed around the room. âThis would be easier if I had the book. I havenât heard it in ages.â Matt got up from the couch and walked over to a book shelf that was behind Albusâs chair. âPerfect! Hereâs one,â Matt picked a book up off the shelf, walked back over to the couch and sat down.
ââThere were once three brothers who were traveling along a lonely, winding road at twilight,â Matt began. He read the whole story straight through. It was just as Albus remembered, with no mention of the word Hallows.
ââAnd then he greeted Death as an old friend, and went with him gladly, and, as equals, they departed this life.'â Matt looked up at Amanda and closed the book. âThatâs the story.â
Amanda stared at him, âThatâs quite a bit different than Muggle fairy tales. Although Iâm still confused.â
âSo am I. Whatâs that got anything to do with âHallowsâ?â Albus asked.
âEverything,â Matt sighed, âJust let me explain it. The Hallows, or the Deathly Hallows as theyâre really known as, are the Invisibility Cloak, the Resurrection Stone, and the Elder Wand. Some people believe that the story tells of the creation of the Deathly Hallows, but most people think itâs just a story.
âMy dad told me about it ages ago. Heâs one of the few people who think they actually exist. When he was younger, before he got married, he actually tried to find them. Looked in loads of books all over the world, trying to trace where they might be. My Uncle Jack went with them, too. They kept searching even after my parents got married. Mum went with them. He gave up his search after he and Mum wanted to start a family. They never did find out anything about the Hallows that would tell him where they were. Uncle Jack kept looking for years afterwards, but eventually settled in New York. He still thinks theyâre out there, someplace, and hasnât truly given up.â
âYou mean, those three objects actually exist?â Rose asked skeptically.
âI dunno,â Matt replied, âMy dad seems to think so. And heâs met a few other people who think so.â
âBut if they donât exist, why would my dad want to keep me from knowing about them?â Albus asked quietly. Albus was not sure what to think about what Matt had said about the Hallows. It was a far-fetched idea, but there was one thing Albus knew might prove their existence. His fatherâs Invisibility Cloak. Albus had not really connected The Tale of the Three Brothers to his dadâs Cloak, but now that he thought about it, the connection made sense.
âOh, come on, Albus, you canât honestly be thinking that they exist?â Rose said exasperatingly.
âWe already know one of them exists!â Albus told her, âWhat about Dadâs Invisibility Cloak?â
âYour dadâs got an Invisibility Cloak?â Matt asked. âReally?â
âYeah,â Albus told him.
âBut that doesnât mean itâs the one from the story,â John said, âI mean, there are loads of Invisibility Cloaks out there. One of my uncles used to have one. But it wore out and he never got another.â
âExactly!,â Albus said excitedly, âMy dadâs Cloak is different from all other Invisibility Cloaks. It doesnât wear out! I know most Invisibility Cloaks just have a charm or something put on them and it wears off eventually. That must have been the kind your uncle had, John. But my grandpa had that cloak before my dad did, and my dad still has it. It still works as good now as it ever has.â
âWhoa,â Matt stared at Albus with a glint of excitement in his eyes, âThen that could be the Cloak from the story!â
âBut what about the other Hallows?â Rose asked. âI donât think they exist.â
âThey might,â John said, âI know Iâve heard of super wands being passed from wizard to wizard centuries ago.â
âOk,â Rose began, âSay there is a âsuper wandâ out there, and Uncle Harryâs cloak is âThe Invisibility Cloakâ. But how on earth would a âResurrection Stoneâ work?â
Albus couldnât answer that, but he did think that the Deathly Hallows existed. Why else would his dad have kept all this secret? The Deathly Hallows had something to do with Voldemortâs downfall, and Albus was going to find out what. âWell, if these three objects are the âHallowsâ that I heard mentioned in my dream, than someone is trying to find them,â Albus realized.
âThat canât be good,â John said, âWhoeverâs been doing that Legilimency wants to continue what Voldemort was doing, right?â
âRight,â Albus confirmed, âDo you know if anything special happens if youâve got all three Hallows?â
âDad said that if one person unites all three, they will be the Master of Death,â Matt answered.
âMaster of Death?â Albus repeated, âWell, I can imagine that Voldemort would have loved to have them, then. Especially that wand.â
âThatâs a scary thought,â John said, âVoldemort with an unbeatable wand.â
Albus silently agreed. âAnyone evil with that wand would be scary. Remember that time we spied on Washburn?â
Matt shuddered, âHow could I not? That resulted in one of the worst detentions ever.â
âI know, and Iâm sorry about that,â Albus said quietly. He still felt a bit guilty about causing all his friends to end up in detention with Washburn. âBut that strange wizard was yelling at Washburn because he hadnât found out where something was.â
âAnd we didnât even hear what it was he had to find,â Matt interrupted.
âBut I think I know what it is. I think that Washburn is trying to find out where the Hallows are,â Albus told them.
âWhat?!â John shouted, âI know heâs horrible, but you think he is trying to unite the Hallows and continue what Voldemort wanted to do?â
âEr, yeah,â Albus said.
âI told him it was ridiculous,â Rose sighed, âBut he still thinks itâs Washburn.â
âIt makes sense, Rose!â Albus shouted.
âIt does fit, but still, heâs a teacher,â Rose replied.
âSo what? He makes it clear that he hates me and James, and you, and Matt. Heâs been giving Matt a hard time since the beginning of the year! And now he hates John, too.â
âI know, but maybe he just doesnât like Gryffindors. He was a Slytherin, you know,â Rose commented.
âYeah, I know that. But what if he hates us because he was on Voldemortâs side?â Albus suggested.
âBut do you really think heâd do this right under your dadâs nose, Albus? I mean, come on! Your dadâs head Auror!â John argued.
Albus shrugged. He really hadnât thought of that. âDunno. Maybe heâs just stupid? Or maybe that bloke he was arguing with is threatening him or something and he hasnât got a choice?â
âWell, I suppose it could be that, but stillâŠâ John replied.
âOk, so what if it is Washburn?â Matt said, âWhat do we do about it?â
âI dunno. I donât think we have enough proof to tell anyone,â Albus answered. âWeâve just got to hope that he doesnât find out where the Hallows are. I only know where the Invisibility Cloak is, Dadâs got it in his office somewhere, and Washburn probably already knows where that is, if heâs the one doing the Legilimency.â
âAll right,â Matt replied, âBut this is mad, I never thought Iâd actually find out the Hallows existed, let alone know where they are! Do you think you could show me the Cloak sometime?â
âSure,â Albus told him, âBut please donât tell your dad about this. Not yet. I know heâd want to know, but I think you ought to wait until after my dad tells me their significance in the war.â
âAll right,â Matt sighed, âI wonât tell him yet.â
âSwear you wonât?â
âI swear,â Matt said, âIâll keep it secret. Iâve got years of experience keeping things secret. Donât worry.â
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight, and my other sister and my brother. Thanks as well to XXEveryinchXX, Moonylupin, inkheart, and leezdz for their reviews!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
Over the next few weeks, Albus thought a lot about the Hallows. He found it hard to concentrate on his homework, and Rose would often scold him for not spending enough time studying. He continued having his strange dreams almost every night, but he didnât think that Washburn had found out anything new about the Hallows. Washburn continued to yell at Albus during every Charms class and give him at least a detention a week. With detention, homework, and Occlumency lessons, Albus had hardly any time for anything else. Life at Hogwarts was just as chaotic as ever. Albus did manage to find time to tell James about what Matt had told him about the Hallows, but James didnât have any ideas as to where the other Hallows could be either. He did agree with Albus that it was highly possible that Washburn was the one trying to unite them.
Before Albus knew it, exams were upon them. The night before they began was very tense. Almost all the Gryffindors were either in the common room, studying, or in the library doing the same. Albus and his friends were studying at a table next to the one Victoire and Amy were at. Both the seventh year girls were extremely nervous, and Victoire insisted on absolute quiet in the common room. Albus did not mind this, because he needed to study anyway. Their first exam was Charms, and Albus was particularly nervous about this exam.
âIâm not sure Iâve passed,â Albus groaned as he walked out of the room with Rose, John, Matt, and Amanda after the Charms exam.
âIâm sure Iâve failed,â Matt replied, âWashburn was breathing down my neck during half of it.â
âI hate when teachers do that,â John said.
âMe, too,â Amanda agreed.
âWell, I think I passed, but-â Rose started.
âOf course you passed,â John interrupted, âYouâve been preparing for exams since September.â
Albus thought the rest of the exams went fairly well. He thought he at least passed Potions. Herbology and DADA went extremely well, and Albus thought he got decent marks in Astronomy, Transfiguration, and History of Magic. However, even though exams were over, O.W.L.s and N.E.W.T.s were still going on, and Victoire was still mandating a quiet common room in the evening. The night of their last exam, Albus and his friends decided to just go to the Room of Requirement and celebrate.
âWhat a relief!â John shouted as he flopped down onto the couch, âNo more exams until next year!â
âYep, a study free summer!â Matt grinned as he pulled a chocolate frog out of his pocket.
âYouâve got homework, you know,â Rose laughed.
âI know, but Iâll save it for the last minute,â Matt replied, âSo, anyone got plans for the summer?â
âIâm going to Ireland with my family,â Amanda told them, âFor two weeks. I canât wait!â
âAre you going on an airplane?â John asked, excitedly.
Amanda laughed, âYeah.â
âBrilliant!â John shouted, âMaybe I can convince my parents to take us on an airplane.â
âItâs not that great,â Matt commented. âAre you doing anything?â
âErm, not sure. We usually visit all my cousins,â John said.
âWell, youâve all got to come stay at my house,â Albus told them. âRose and I always have a big birthday party at the Burrow.â
âMy birthdayâs at the end of August and Albusâs is the end of this month,â Rose said. âSo we always have a party together. But usually itâs just our family. And our parentsâ friends and their kids.â
ââCourse Iâll come!â John smiled, âI want to see your house and the Burrow.â
âMy parents should let me come. Weâre not going to Ireland until the middle of August,â Amanda answered, âAs long as they meet your parents first.â
âThey can meet at Kingâs Cross,â Rose replied.
âCan you come, Matt?â Albus asked.
âEr, I dunno,â Matt said slowly, âMy parents have never let me stay over at someoneâs house before. Not that anyone would has ever wanted me to stay over at their house before. Do you know when it will be?â
Albus looked at Rose, who shrugged. âIâm not sure. I donât think our parents have planned it yet. But weâll make sure itâs not around the full moon.â
âThen I might be able to go,â Matt smiled.
âGreat!â Albus said, âWeâll have loads of fun! We can play Quidditch.â
âI canât believe this year is almost over,â Rose began.
âYeah, I mean, a year ago, I didnât even know I was a witch,â Amanda laughed, âGoing to be strange to go back home.â
âAnd last year, I never even knew about the Hallows, and now Washburnâs trying to steal them,â Albus said quietly.
âWell, at least over the summer you wonât be anywhere near Washburn,â Rose said, âAnd maybe Uncle Harry will tell us the whole story.â
âAnd then you can tell it to us!â John replied. âAnd to stay on topic, this time last year, I was about the same as I am now.â Everyone laughed.
âWell, this time last year, I didnât have any friends,â Matt said quietly.
âBut you do now,â John pointed out.
Matt grinned, âYeah, I do. Never thought I would, though. Itâs been a great year.â
âI havenât showed you the Marauderâs Map, have I?â Albus asked Matt.
âNo, I donât think so,â Matt answered.
âItâs brilliant,â John grinned, âSaw it a couple months ago.â
âYeah, you were in the Hospital Wing,â Albus remembered, âBut Iâve got it now.â Albus pulled the Map out of his robe pocket.
âYou havenât given it back to James yet?â Rose asked.
âNope,â Albus laughed, âI donât really want to give it back. Maybe weâll just share it.â Albus got up from his chair and set the Map down on the table.
âLooks just like a regular piece of parchment,â Matt commented.
âThatâs whatâs so great about it!â Albus grinned, âAnyway, this is the map that my grandpa, Peter Pettigrew, Sirius Black, and of course, Teddyâs dad made, when they were at Hogwarts.â
âYeah, I remember you telling me that,â Matt replied.
âHere it is,â Albus tapped his wand on the parchment and said, âI solemnly swear that I am up to no good.â
Ink spread across the map while Matt stared in awe at it. âThatâs brilliant!â He stared at the map and all the labeled dots milling around it. His eyes stopped on the Whomping Willow. âThis shows the passageway to the Shrieking Shack?â he asked nervously.
âSure does,â Albus said, âIt shows all the passageways out of the school. But donât worry, hardly anyone knows about the Map. Just us, James, my parents, Roseâs parents, my Uncle George, and probably some of my cousins. But none of them, except my parents and Roseâs parents, know how to get in the tunnel.â
âDo you know how to get into the tunnel?â Matt asked.
âNope,â Albus answered. Harry had told him all about the passageways, but hadnât told him how to get into them. Harry had told Albus that he didnât want to ruin all the fun of discovering things for himself.
âGood,â Matt breathed a sigh of relief and went back to inspecting the map. âMoony, Wormtail, Padfoot, and Prongs,â he murmured. âAre those, their nicknames?â
âYup,â Albus confirmed, âMoony was-â
âTeddyâs dad, I figured that one out,â Matt said, âBut what about the others?â
âWormtail was Pettigrew, he was a rat in more ways than one,â Albus said grimly, âAnd Padfoot was Sirius, because he was a big shaggy dog. And Prongs was my grandpa because he was a stag.â
âWow,â Matt said softly, âThis is amazing.â
âSee?â Albus began, âMoony had awesome friends, well most of them were,â Albus said, thinking of Pettigrew. âAnd they didnât dessert him. We wonât dessert you.â
âYeah, youâre our Moony,â John agreed.
Matt smiled at them, âThanks, guys. I know you wonât, now.â
The group quietly watched the map for a few minutes, noting that all the fifth and seventh years were still cooped up in the library, studying for their exams. âWhoâs that?â Albus pointed to a dot that was lingering near the forest.
Rose leaned in closer and read, âJarett Willinson. Never heard of him.â
âWillinson. Do you think heâs related to Quinton Willinson?â Albus asked.
âProbably,â John said, âBut Quinton doesnât have any siblings at school.â
âWhatâs that bloke doing here, then?â Albus wondered.
âLook!â Matt pointed at a dot that was traveling from the castle towards Jarret Willinson. âItâs Washburn!â
Albus looked at the dot, and sure enough, it was Washburn. He was heading towards Jarett Willinson. âWhat are they doing?â
âI dunno,â Matt answered.
âWhat if theyâre going to try and find the Hallows?â Albus asked. âWe should go see what theyâre up to.â
âWhat?!â Matt shouted, âLast time we went to see what Washburn was up to, we wound up in detention.â
âBut what if he is trying to steal the Hallows? If he is, then we wonât get in trouble from him. Heâll get fired,â Albus pointed out.
Matt sighed, âI guess. Letâs go before they leave.â
âAre you coming, Rose?â Albus asked.
âI suppose,â Rose said. She looked at Amanda and the two of them stood up.
âLetâs go, then!â John grinned. He was clearly excited about spying on Washburn again.
Albus and his friends left the room and set off towards the front doors. They saw hardly anyone on their way down the stairs. Peeves was lurking on the second floor corridor, but luckily he didnât notice the first years sneaking off.
âAre they still there?â Rose whispered as they walked onto the grounds.
Albus checked the map. âYeah, theyâre there. They must be talking or something.â
âYou ought to wipe it clean before we meet up with them,â Rose suggested.
âGood idea,â Albus agreed, âMischief managed.â
Albus walked slowly towards the edge of the forest, where he could just make out two cloaked figures. The sun was setting and it was nearly dark. Once Albus was a couple feet away from the two wizards, he recognized who Jarret Willinson was, and stopped abruptly.
âOuch!â Amanda shouted as she ran into Albus.
âShush!â Albus whispered, and he pulled his friends behind a tree.
âWhat is it?â Rose asked.
âThat wizard! Jarett Willinson! Heâs the bloke that was arguing with Washburn when we spied on him! And the time I had detention and they argued in Washburnâs study. Iâm sure of it.â
âThat means-â Rose replied.
âThat theyâre going after the Hallows. Remember, when we spied on them, that Jarett Willinson told Washburn that he would come and they would steal the Hallows together,â Albus said.
âWeâve got to stop them,â John replied.
âYeah,â Albus agreed, âLetâs go.â Albus walked out from behind the tree, with his friends following. They slowly approached Washburn and Jarett Willinson. They were soon close enough to hear what the two wizards were saying.
âYouâve discovered the location of one of the Hallows?â Jarett asked.
âI believe so. Potter finally cracked. Iâd heard that his Occlumency skills were abysmal, but I didnât think it would take me this long. The two kids donât know a thing about the Hallows,â Washburn stated.
Jarett laughed, âThey will soon. Which one did you discover?â
âThe Resurrection Stone,â Washburn said.
âPerfect. And where is it?â
âIn here,â Washburn pointed to the forest. âBut I donât know where.â
âHow are we supposed to find it?!â Jarett shouted angrily.
âDonât ask me!â Washburn shouted back.
âIt was your job to find out where it is,â Jarett said icily and took a step closer to Washburn. âAnd you havenât found the exact place.â
âSorry, but Potter didnât know either,â Washburn answered nervously. âShouldnât we just start searching?â
âWe will, but Iâve told Quinton he could come with us, and heâs not here yet,â Jarett answered. âAnd weâve got another job to do tonight, anyway.â
âAnd what is that?â Washburn asked.
âKill Potter,â Jarett said.
Albus let out a gasp. They were going to kill his dad? But why? Albus turned around and looked at his friends. They were all standing stock still and wearing looks of utter fear on their faces.
âI donât think weâre alone anymore,â Washburn informed Jarett and a grin appeared across his face.
Albus turned back around to face the two wizards and backed up. Jarett and Washburn turned towards Albus and started walking towards him and his friends.
âI believe you are right,â Jarett responded, âMr. Potter, how nice of you to join us.â
âWhat are we going to do with them?â Washburn asked while glaring at the five fist years.
âOh, I donât know, what do you think?â Jarett replied.
âWell, Potter seems incapable of doing the simplest charms. The Weasley girl is a right know-it-all. Eckerton is asleep half the time, so I doubt heâs capable of doing much magic. Brickston doesnât know when to keep his mouth shut. And the other girl doesnât seem too bright either,â Washburn said, âI say we just let them hang around and if they interfere, Iâll take care of them.â He stared Albus in the eye, with a look of complete loathing.
âVery well,â Jarett agreed, âYou know them better than I do. Now, letâs get back to business.â
âRight. Now, why do we have to kill Potter? Isnât he the one who knows where all the Hallows are?â Washburn asked.
âI know that!â Jarett shouted, âBut heâs the one whoâs got the Elder Wand! And if we want it, weâve got to kill him.â
âOh, right,â Washburn responded.
Albus watched the two wizards and glanced nervously at his friends. He had no idea what he was going to do next. Albus had been right, Washburn and this other wizard were after the Hallows. Albus heard footsteps behind him and turned around, pulling out his wand at the same time.
âQuinton,â Jarett said, âYouâre late.â
âSorry, Father,â Quinton mumbled, âFilch was lurking around. I had to wait for him to leave.â
Jarett Willinson was Quintonâs dad. As Albus watched them, he only hoped that Jarett was as hopeless at dueling as his son was.
âPut your wand away, Potter!â Washburn growled at Albus.
âLeave it out, Al,â a voice said from behind Albus. Albus turned around and saw his dad pulling off the Invisibility Cloak. Albus let out a sigh of relief. His dad was there, everything would be okay.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight! Thanks to my other sister and my brother, too. And thanks to inkheart, TheNobleHouseofPotter, XDNLxtlz99, drownzer, and Moonylupin for their reviews!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
âNice of you to join us, Potter,â Jarett stepped towards Harry. âHow did you find us?â
Harry drew his wand and stared at Jarett. âFollowed your son. Students arenât supposed to be out of their common rooms after hours.â
âI donât think it matters what he does now,â Jarett replied icily. âOnce we have the Hallows, we will have power you know nothing of.â
âSo itâs you,â Harry said, âYouâve been after the Hallows. And youâve been doing the Legilimency, Washburn?â
âYes, I have,â Washburn confirmed. âOnly your sons donât know anything about the Hallows, so it proved pointless. You, however, provided us with a great deal of information.â
âNo, I havenât told them about the Hallows yet. But I suppose Iâll have to after tonight,â Harry said.
âI donât think youâll have the chance, Potter,â Jarett growled.
âYouâve found out where the Hallows are, then?â Harry asked.
Washburn nodded, âThe Resurrection Stone is in the forest. I managed to break through your pathetic Occlumency. The Invisibility Cloak is in your hand. And youâve got the Elder Wand, we already knew that.â
Harry held up his wand, âIâm afraid I donât.â
âWhat?!â Jarett shouted and looked at Harryâs wand, âBut you had it! Thatâs how you defeated Voldemort!â
âMaybe so,â Harry began, âBut I havenât got it now, have I?â
âYouâve got it somewhere!â Jarett growled. âEnough talk! Give me the Cloak!â
âDonât think so,â Harry shoved the Cloak into his pocket and raised his wand higher. âWeâll duel if you want, but if you come with me now, youâll have less time in Azkaban.â
âI donât care about Azkaban!â Jarett shouted. âCrucio!â
âProtego!â Harry shouted at the same time. A shield formed in front of Harry, protecting him, Albus, and Albusâs friends from Jarettâs spell.
Washburn and Quinton ran from behind Jarett, holding their wands out. Harry stepped towards Jarett and Jarett stepped closer to Harry. Albus watched them, his heart beating fast. Jarett sent more spells towards Harry, but Harry blocked each of them. Albus smiled a little as he saw how much better at dueling his dad was than Jarett.
Jets of light flew out of both Harry and Jarettâs wand, lighting up the night around them. Harry sent a spell towards Jarett and he flew back and landed on the ground. Jarett stumbled back to his feet and sent a stunning spell at Harry.
âJust tell me where the wand is!â Jarett shouted as he dodged Harryâs curse.
âNo!â Harry shouted back and leaped out of the way of another stunner. The two wizards continued dueling, each one sending spells and curses towards the other. Albus stared at them. He had never seen dueling like this before. Neither wizard seemed to be slowing down. Harry was noticeably faster and dodged spells more easily than Jarett, but Jarett didnât appear to be giving up anytime soon.
âWhat do we do?â Rose whispered to Albus.
Albus turned away from the duel. âI dunno!â Albus heard footsteps behind him again and turned to see Quinton standing with his wand facing Albus.
âSo, we duel again, Potter,â Quinton smirked. âImpedimenta!â
Albus dodged the spell easily, but didnât know what to do next. He hadnât learned many dueling spells yet. He held his wand up higher and watched Quinton.
âPetrificus Totalus!â Quinton shouted. Albus jumped to the side and dodged the new spell.
âAhh!â someone screamed behind Albus. He turned around and saw John, Rose, and Matt standing around Amanda, who was laying rigid on the ground. The spell meant for Albus had hit Amanda square in the chest.
Quinton laughed. âOne down, four to go!â
âWatch out!â Albus shouted to his friends. They held up their wands and stood next to Albus.
âPetrificus Totalus!â Quinton shouted again. Albus and his friends darted to one side and Quintonâs spell hit a nearby bush.
Albus regained his balance and turned to Quinton. He raised his wand and shouted, âExpelliarmus!â
Quinton dodged the spell and smirked at Albus, âThink thatâll work again? Petrificus Totalus!â
Albus and his friends dodged the spell yet again. âDonât you know any other spells?â John laughed.
âShut it!â Quinton shouted, breathing heavily.
Albus whispered to Rose, âWeâll all disarm him at once. On the count of three. Tell them.â Albus waited until Rose had passed the word on to John and Matt and began to count. âOneâŠâ
âWhat are you doing?â Quinton asked nervously.
âTwoâŠThree!â Albus shouted.
âExpelliarmus!â All four first years screamed the spell before Quinton realized what was going on. He was knocked off his feet and his wand flew out of his hand and sailed through the air, landing near Matt. Matt picked it up and stowed it in his robe.
âUrgh,â Quinton picked his head up off the ground.
âLet me take it from here,â Washburn stormed over to where Quinton was laying. âPatheticâŠâ
Albusâs heart started beating even faster. He had never seen Washburn duel before. It would surely be a whole lot harder to disarm him than it was to disarm Quinton. Albus had no desire whatsoever to start dueling with one of his teachers.
âSo you four, well five, if you count Tagger,â Washburn began, âDecided to find out what I was doing. Thought that it was a good idea to meddle in my business?â
âEr,â Albus mumbled.
âDonât deny it, Potter!â Washburn shouted. âYou came here tonight! You spied on me months ago!â
âIf youâre going to kill my dad, than it is my business!â Albus shouted.
âYou could see it that way, if youâd like. But if itâs your business, and you get in the way, weâll kill you, too,â Washburn growled at Albus.
Albusâs stomach churned with fear and he looked over to where Harry was dueling Jarett. Harry had just sent a spell at Jarett that had completely knocked him off his feet. Harry looked over to Albus while Jarett was trying to get up. âDonât do anything to my son, Washburn!â Harry shouted. âProtego!â He sent a shield charm in between where Albus and Washburn were standing. âYouâll regret it!â
âI donât think I will, Potter!â Washburn shouted back, aimed his wand at Harry, and sent a silent curse towards him. Harry easily dodged it.
âCrucio!â Jarett had regained his balance and was pointing his wand at Harry. Harry turned back and ran out of the way of the unforgivable curse just in time. He returned to his duel with Jarett, sending more jets of light at him.
âAre you Death Eaters?â John asked once Washburn returned his gaze to the group of first years.
Washburn smirked at John. âYou still havenât learned to shut your mouth, have you? No, weâre not Death Eaters. Although Jarettâs father was. Heâs in Azkaban now. Albusâs bloody father captured him!â
âSo, what are you going to do? If you were planning on killing us, you wouldâve done it by now,â John replied.
Washburn stepped closer to John, âMaybe I like to drag it out. But enough of that. Potter!â He looked at Albus and pointed his wand at Albusâs chest. âI donât suppose you know if your father has any spare wands laying around? One that might be the Elder Wand?â
âI dunno,â Albus whispered, âI donât think so.â
ââCourse not,â Washburn growled, âAnd you probably wouldnât tell me if you did.â
âDonât think so,â Albus said.
âNow, I think you four would be a whole lot easier to deal with if you didnât have your wands,â Washburn seethed. âExpelliarmus!â he pointed his wand at Matt. Harryâs shield charm had worn off and disappeared moments before.
Albus looked over to where Matt was. Matt collapsed to the ground when the spell hit his chest,and his wand and Willinsonâs wand flew through the air, landing next to Washburn. Albus darted over to where Matt was laying to see if he was ok.
âExpelliarmus!â Albus shouted at Washburn after he realized that Matt was knocked out cold. âWhat did you do to him?!â
Washburn deflected the spell and picked up the two wands. âI just disarmed him, that usually doesnât knock you out unless there are multiple people casting it. Always knew he was weak,â Washburn sneered.
âShut it!â John shouted as he bent down to try and wake Matt up, âWhy donât you ever leave him alone?!â
âAhh, looks like youâll be next,â Washburn pointed his wand at John, âExpelliarmus!â Johnâs wand sailed out of his hand and Washburn caught it. âNow for the Weasley girl. Expelliarmus!â Roseâs wand left her hand and landed in between Washburn and Albus.
Albus ran forward to pick up Roseâs wand. âI donât think so, Potter,â Washburn reached the wand first and picked it up. âYouâre next. Expelliarmus!â
Albus felt his wand leave his hand and saw Washburn catch it. He glanced nervously at his friends. They werenât doing too well. No wands, and two of them were unconscious. Albus looked at Washburn, who had started pacing in a circle around them.
âDefenseless students,â he smirked, âI think youâll be much more willing to do what I say now. Time to go into the forest, weâre going on a little scavenger hunt.â
âNo,â Albus told him, âWeâre not.â
âYouâre not in a position to negotiate, Potter. Youâll help me find the Resurrection Stone,â Washburn barked, âNow, follow me!â Washburn started to walk towards the forest, but Albus did not follow. âLetâs go, Potter!â
âWeâre not going,â Rose said, crossing her arms across her chest.
âYouâll regret that,â Washburn said icily. He walked back to where Albus, Rose, and John were standing. âCrucio!â he shouted at Rose.
Rose screamed and jumped to the side, just missing the curse. Washburn started sending curses towards all three of them. Albus jumped behind a tree to avoid a jinx that wound up hitting the tree. He looked over to where Harry and Jarett were dueling. As far as Albus could tell, Harry was winning. Jarett appeared to be slowing down, but Albus noticed that his dad was limping a bit as he dodged Jarettâs spells.
âWhat are we going to do?â Rose asked anxiously.
âI donât know!â Albus shouted back. He peeked his head out from behind the tree and saw John running towards them. Washburn pointed his wand at Johnâs back and hit him with a Trip Jinx. John fell forward and he landed on the ground with a sickening crunch. âJohn!â Albus shouted and ran out from behind the tree.
âJust you and the Weasley girl now, Potter,â Washburn growled. âSectumsempra!â he shouted at Rose.
âNo!â Albus shouted as the curse hit one of her arms. She sank down onto the ground, screaming in pain. Albus could see blood seeping out of her robes. âStop it!â Albus shouted again. Albus glanced over to his dad again. Both of the wizards were slowing down. Willinson was definitely the worse off, he was leaning against a tree, trying to hold up his wand with a broken arm. âDad! Help!â
Harry turned away from his duel and came limping over when he heard Albusâs shout. âExpelliarmus!â he shouted at Washburn, and all five wands the Charms teacher was holding sailed out of his hands. Washburn turned away from Rose and looked at Harry. âDonât go near my niece,â Harry growled at Washburn.
âLetâs go,â Washburn lifted Quinton onto his feet, âYou all right?â
âFine,â Quinton grunted. The two of them took one look at Harry and ran off into the night. Albus saw them disapparate just as they left the Hogwarts grounds.
Albus glanced over to where Jarett had been moments before. He was gone. âArenât you going to go after them, Dad?â
âCanât,â Harry lifted his robe and revealed a nasty cut on his leg, âTook all my strength to get over here and save you.â Harry sank down onto the ground, breathing heavily. âAre you all right?â
âYeah, Iâm fine,â Albus sat down next to his dad and leaned up against him. âBut I want to know the whole story about the Hallows.â
âI know, and I will tell you,â Harry sighed, âAfter we get back to the castle.â
âOk,â Albus whispered. He looked over to where Rose had collapsed and saw her getting up. She walked slowly over to Albus and Harry and sank down on Harryâs other side.
âUncle Harry? Can we go back to the castle now?â she asked quietly. Her voice was shaking. She was holding one of her hands down over her arm, stopping the bleeding that Washburnâs curse had caused.
âI think that would be a good idea,â Harry replied.
âHarry?â a new voice said from behind them. âWhat happened?â
Albus, Harry, and Rose turned around. Neville was standing behind them. âBit of a nasty duel,â Harry answered, and went on to explain the entire evening.
Neville shook his head, âBlimey, Washburnâs always been a little cold, but Iâd never have expected that. What was he after?â
âIâll explain that later,â Harry said, while trying to stand up, âBut right now weâve got to get back to the castle.â
âRight,â Neville agreed, âGive me your hand.â Harry extended his arm and Neville helped him up. Albus and Rose got up after him.
Harry leaned on Neville and Neville helped him walk over to where John was laying. Neville conjured a stretcher and with a flick of his wand, John was laying upon it. He did the same with Matt and Amanda. âWhat happened to them?â Harry asked quietly.
âJohn got hit by a trip jinx and hit his head on a rock, Amanda got a full-body-bind curse, and Matt just got hit by Expelliarmus,â Albus explained.
âThatâs nothing Madam Pomfrey canât fix, then,â Harry replied. âLetâs go.â
The group slowly made their way back to the castle. It took them quite a while. Albus was fine, except for a few cuts and being completely worn out. The bleeding on Roseâs arm seemed to have slowed down, but it would need to be magically healed or else it would surely open up again. Harry was walking quite slowly, and Albus could tell by the way he winced every time they went up the stairs, that he was in a great deal of pain. Eventually, they made it up to the Hospital Wing. When they got into the ward, Madam Pomfrey was already bustling around, and when she saw them come in, she immediately descended upon them.
âThere you are, Harry!â the nurse shouted, âIâve been trying to contact you all evening. James got into a nasty duel with a couple Slytherins and heâs been unconscious ever since.â She gestured to one of the beds at the far end of the room and looked back at Harry. She gazed upon the group and her mouth fell open. âWhat in the name of Merlin happened to you lot?â
âQuinton Willinsonâs father, Jarett Willinson, tried to kill me,â Harry said simply. âHad quite the duel with him down near the forest. Him, along with Quinton, plus Professor Washburn.â
Madam Pomfreyâs eyes became large with shock. âProfessor Washburn? And where are they now?â she asked quietly.
âThey took off, disapparated once they left the grounds,â Harry told her, âI couldnât catch them with this nasty cut on my leg.â
âWell, come on, then,â the nurse said, âHarry, you go in bed one, since itâs closest. Albus, bed two, and Rose, bed three.â Madam Pomfrey gestured to the beds and then approached the stretchers that Neville was holding up with his wand. âAnd letâs see, Neville, take them to beds four, five, and seven, since James is in bed six.â
Neville nodded and directed the stretchers to the empty beds. Albus walked over to the second bed and lay down. He stared at the ceiling, thinking about what had happened. Washburn thought Harry had the Elder Wand, but Harry didnât. Where was it? Who had it? And why did Washburn think that Harry had it? At least Harry said that he would tell Albus everything. It was only a matter of time before Albus knew the whole story about the Hallows.
Madam Pomfrey came bustling over to Albusâs bed. âHere, drink this,â she handed him a potion. âDreamless sleep.â Madam Pomfrey turned away from Albus and strode across the room to one of her cabinets. She rummaged around inside. âAll the Potters in the Hospital Wing at once, it was bound to happen sooner or laterâŠâ she muttered.
Albus gratefully took the potion, and a few minutes later, he fell into a restful sleep.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight and my other sister and brother. Thanks as well to XDNLxtlz99, drownzer, inkheart, Moonylupin, and MiZzPrInCeZz for their reviews!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
When Albus awoke the sun was shining into the window next to his bed. He sat up and peered at the clock on the wall. It was two oâclock. Albus looked over at Roseâs bed; she was still asleep.
Madam Pomfrey came out from behind the curtains around one of the beds. She walked over to Albus once she noticed he was awake. âHow are you, dear?â
âIâm fine,â Albus told her, while trying to peek at the other beds, to see how everyone else was.
âAre you sure?â Madam Pomfrey asked, âNothing hurts?â
âNo, Iâm fine,â Albus answered truthfully, âBut what about everyone else? Whereâs my dad?â
âTheyâre all fine, too,â Madam Pomfrey assured him, âTheyâre asleep. And your dad left a few hours ago. He had to take care of some things at the Ministry. He said heâd be back later. Now, do you want something to eat?â
âSure,â Albus said, suddenly realizing how hungry he was. Madam Pomfrey left the room for a few minutes and came back with a tray filled with sandwiches and pumpkin juice. She set it down on Albusâs bedside table and Albus started eating. Rose and James woke up a few minutes later, and they joined Albus in his lunch. James immediately asked them what had happened last night. Albus and Rose explained the whole thing.
âBlimey,â James said quietly, once they had finished, âI always knew Washburn was evil.â
âExplains why he hates us so much,â Albus replied, âWe knew nothing about the Hallows, and he thought heâd be able to find out where they were by reading our minds.â
âGuess so,â James agreed. âSo, Dad said heâd tell us about the Hallows?â
âYeah, he did,â Albus told him, âI guess he will when he gets back from the Ministry.â
John, Matt, and Amanda woke up an hour later, and Albus and Rose told them the rest of what had happened the previous night. They were all happy that Washburn, Jarett, and Quinton hadnât gotten any of the Hallows, but were worried that they had gotten away. They spent much of the afternoon discussing what would happen next.
Albus was sure that, somehow, the rest of the school already knew what had happened the night before. They had no idea what Washburn, Quinton, and Jarett were after, but they knew about the duel that had taken place on the grounds. Madam Pomfrey spent a lot of time keeping curious students out of the Hospital Wing, and eventually she locked the door. Victoire and Amy were the first ones to visit Albus and the others in the Hospital Wing, followed by the rest of Albusâs cousins. They all wanted to know what went on, and Albus told them most of the story. He left out the part about the Hallows, since none of Albusâs cousins knew about them. Amanda, John, and Mattâs parents showed up for a few hours each and were all relieved that their kids were ok.
Once evening arrived, Madam Pomfrey made all of Albusâs cousins and Amy leave, and she gave Albus and the others a large platter of food for their dinner. After they finished eating, Albus heard someone trying to get into the room.
âBloody hell, I think she locked it!â a voice shouted out.
âOh, Ron, honestly. Just knock,â a female voice said. Albus heard a loud knock, and Madam Pomfrey came running out of her office. She flung the door open and Ron and Hermione came running in. âRose!â Hermione shouted and descended upon her daughter. She wrapped Rose in a big hug. âAre you all right?â
âYes, Mum,â Rose hugged Hermione back. Ron sat down on the bed and wrapped his arms around Rose as well.
âWhereâs Harry?â Madam Pomfrey asked, âI thought he was coming with you?â
âHe was behind us,â Ron glanced at the door.
âIâm here,â Harry appeared in the doorway and limped over to Albusâs bed. He sank down on it and gave Albus a hug.
âI told you not to walk on that leg yet,â Madam Pomfrey scolded.
âDidnât have much of a choice. I had to alert the Ministry. Iâve got Aurors looking for Washburn and both Willinsons right now,â Harry explained.
âGood,â Madam Pomfrey handed Harry a goblet of potion, âDrink that.â
Harry took the potion and downed it in one mouthful. âDisgusting.â
âDad?â Albus asked tentatively, âAre you going to tell us about the Hallows now?â
Harry sighed, âI suppose.â
âYouâve got to let John, Matt, and Amanda listen to,â Albus insisted.
âI know, theyâve got to know what happened, too,â Harry agreed, âWe just need some place private.â
âHow about the Room of Requirement?â Albus suggested.
âYouâve found that already?â Harry grinned.
âWell, Matt showed it to us,â Albus explained.
âOh,â Harry replied, âWell, that would be the perfect place.â Harry stood up. âPoppy, Iâve got a bit of explaining to do to the kids.â
âCanât you do it here?â Madam Pomfrey asked, âIt really would be best for them all to stay here a while longer.â
âI promise weâll all come back once Iâm done,â Harry said.
âReally, Harry, they need rest!â Madam Pomfrey insisted.
âI owe them an explanation, Poppy,â Harry said quietly.
âOh, fine!â Madam Pomfrey threw her hands up in disgust, âBut donât have them out too long.â
Harry grinned. Albus got up out of the bed. James, Rose, John, Matt, and Amanda all got up as well. They followed Harry, Ron, and Hermione to the door.
âIâm getting too old for this,â Madam Pomfrey muttered as they left.
âYouâre not leaving, are you?â Matt asked nervously.
Madam Pomfrey smiled, âOf course not, dear. Donât you worry.â
The group made their way slowly to the seventh floor. Once they reached the portrait of Barnabas the Barmy, Harry started pacing. After a few moments, a door appeared where it hadnât been previously. Harry opened it and everyone followed him inside. The room looked a lot like it did when Matt asked for it. The only noticeable difference was that this time there were more armchairs and another couch.
Harry sat down on one of the couches. Albus and James sat on either side of him. Ron, Hermione, and Rose took the other couch, while John, Matt, and Amanda took the chairs.
âDad,â Albus began, âWe already know about the Hallows.â
âYou do?â Harry asked.
âEr, yeah, we know about the connection to the Tale of the Three Brothers, and we know that the Deathly Hallows are the Elder Wand, Resurrection Stone, and the Invisibility Cloak. We just donât know why youâve kept it a secret.â
Harry sighed, âHow long have you known?â
âA few months now. Since April. Matt told us about them.â
âReally?â Harry looked at Matt, âYou knew about them?â
âYeah, my dad told me,â Matt answered, âBut I wasnât sure if I believed they existed or not, until Albus told me about the Cloak.â
âNot many people think theyâre real,â Harry replied, âI first heard the Tale of the Three Brothers when I was 17. It was the year that Ron, Hermione, and I were hunting Horcruxes. When Dumbledore was killed, he left each of us something in his will. You already know that he left Hermione the original copy of The Tales of Beedle the Bard, written completely in ancient runes. Ron got the Deluminator, and I got the first Snitch I ever caught.
âHermione decoded the runes and noticed a symbol in a drawing that went with the Tale of the Three Brothers.â Harry pulled a piece of parchment and a quill out of his pocket. He drew a triangle, with a circle inside it, and a line connecting the top of the triangle to the bottom. âThis was the symbol. We recognized it because at Bill and Fleurâs wedding, Xenophilius Lovegood was wearing it on his robes. Viktor Krum approached him about it because this symbol is also Grindelwaldâs symbol.â
âGrindelwald, that evil wizard Dumbledore defeated?â Matt asked.
âYes,â Harry continued, âBut at one point, Dumbledore and Grindelwald were friends-â
âWhat?!â Matt shouted.
âThey were,â Harry said. Albus already knew this part of the story, but it must have had relevance to the Hallows, if Harry was telling it again. âThey were friends, who were obsessed with uniting the Hallows. That symbol is the symbol of the Hallows. The triangle is the Cloak, the circle, the Stone, and the line, the Elder Wand. Grindelwald and Dumbledoreâs friendship fell apart after Dumbledoreâs sister was killed. Eventually, Dumbledore had to confront Grindelwald and defeat him. Grindelwald had the Elder Wand, and when Dumbledore defeated him, the Wand changed its allegiance, and Dumbledore became the new master.â
âDumbledore had the Elder Wand?â Albus asked.
âYes, he did,â Harry said, âNow, after Hermione decoded the story, we went to see Xenophilius Lovegood, and he explained the Hallows to us. We were skeptical, but we knew that the Cloak existed. You may have already guessed this, but Voldemort found out about the Elder Wand and he wanted to get it, because he believed it would enable him to kill me. That is why he wanted someone to kill Dumbledore. However, before Snape killed Dumbledore, Draco Malfoy disarmed him. The Wand changed allegiance once again. You see, the Elder Wand doesnât change allegiance when a wizard kills the wizard it belongs to. That wizard just needs to be defeated. Defeat doesnât always equal death. Since Snape killed Dumbledore, Voldemort assumed that the wand had shifted its allegiance to Snape, but in actuality, it belonged to Draco.
âWhen we got captured and taken to the Malfoy Manor, I disarmed Draco. I defeated him. Even though he did not have the Elder Wand in his possession at the time, it was still his wand. But when I disarmed him, it became mine. The Elder Wand had been buried with Dumbledore, but Voldemort stole it. Voldemort assumed that the wand had allegiance to Snape, so Voldemort used his snake to kill Snape.
âAfter Snape died, I viewed his memories in the Pensieve, and found out that I was a Horcrux and I would have to die in order for Voldemort to die. As I was walking into the forest, I tried once again to open the Snitch that had failed to open earlier in the year. It opened, and inside was the Resurrection Stone. In the forest, Voldemort tried once again to kill me, but he only succeeded in killing the Horcrux inside me. When I came back, Voldemort and I had one final duel. He had the Elder Wand, but itâs allegiance belonged to me. He tried to kill me with a wand that was mine. A wand will not work properly against its rightful owner. So, when we dueled, Voldemortâs killing curse bounced off my disarming spell, and hit him.â
Albus stared at his dad, âBut what about the fact that Voldemort used your blood to come back to life? Isnât that why you survived?â
âThatâs part of it, Al,â Harry told him.
Albus didnât know what to say. He finally had the answers he had been looking for. This was why no one else knew about them. The Hallows did have to do with Voldemortâs downfall, a big part.
âWhereâs the Elder Wand now?â James asked, âDo you have it?â
âNo,â Harry answered, âThat wand is too much trouble. Itâs back with Dumbledore. And if I die a natural death, it will have no allegiance.â
âOh,â James replied, âWouldâve been cool, though, having an unbeatable wand.â
âAnd the Stone?â Albus asked, âIs it really somewhere in the forest?â
âYes,â Harry answered, âAnd I have no idea where. The only Hallow Iâve got is the Invisibility Cloak.â
âBut you did unite them, the Hallows?â Albus asked.
âFor a little while, yes,â Harry said. âI was the Master of Death.â
âThatâs what Washburn and the Willinsons wanted to do, right?â
âYes, that was their plan,â Harry answered. âBut they did not succeed.â
âDo you think theyâll try again?â Albus asked quietly.
âYes, Albus, they probably will,â Harry replied, âBut Iâm hoping that they will be in Azkaban soon. There are Aurors looking for them right now.â
âI hope theyâre caught,â Albus said.
âMe, too,â Harry agreed, âIâll do everything I can to make sure that they are.â
Albus sat quietly, thinking about everything his dad had said. Harry had united the Hallows, he had been the âMaster of Deathâ. Albus was relieved that he finally knew the whole story, but he still had more questions. Had his dad ever used the Resurrection Stone? How did it wind up in the forest? But Albus decided to ask the question that had been pulling at him since he first heard âHallowsâ mentioned months ago. âDad, why didnât you tell us?â
Harry sighed, âIt was a mistake not telling you sooner. I want you to know that. I should have told you last summer, when I told you everything else. But at the same time, I didnât want you to tell anyone about it. I wanted to wait until you were older and more mature.â
âSo you didnât trust me?â Albus asked. He hated it when people told him he wasnât old enough to do something, or know about something.
âNot exactly. I didnât want you to be tempted to tell people about the Hallows. If word got out that there is an unbeatable wand out there, especially one that is on the Hogwarts grounds, the result could be bad. Look at what Washburn and the two Willinsons did. And they are just three people. Imagine if half the school was going after that wand? Iâm not saying everyone would want to use the wand for evil, but if a lot of people were going after it we could have a disaster on our hands. The idea of power, whether one is going to use it for good or evil, does crazy things to people. And that is why I didnât tell you. I didnât want a lot of people to know about it. But that didnât work at all. Now, more people than just you and James and Rose know about it.
âWhich brings me to my next point,â Harry said in a more serious tone, âNone of you can tell anyone anything I have told you tonight. You canât tell anyone that the Hallows exist, and that they are all currently residing somewhere in or around Hogwarts. A lot of people know about my Cloak, but without knowledge of the Resurrection Stone or the Elder Wand, they wonât think anything of it.â
âI canât even tell our cousins?â James asked.
âNo, Iâm sorry, but you canât,â Harry replied
âI wonât tell,â Albus assured Harry. Rose, John, and Amanda all nodded.
âWish I could tell my dad,â Matt said, âHeâd love to hear about it.â
âIs he interested in the Hallows?â Harry asked.
âYeah, he was. He went all over the world researching them when he was younger. Never found out where they were. Gave up after he and my mum decided to start a family, though. He still believes they exist,â Matt replied.
âMaybe Iâll tell him, someday,â Harry answered, âBut for now, please donât tell him.â
âAll right,â Matt agreed.
âWell, then, I think we ought to get back to the Hospital Wing,â Harry stood up, âMadam Pomfrey will have my head if I keep you up much later.â
******
Madam Pomfrey let Albus and the others leave the Hospital Wing two days later. Albus was quite happy about this, as he was getting bored with the Hospital Wing. Albus and his friends spent much of the days following talking or playing games in the common room or on the grounds. Shortly after they were released, O.W.L.s and N.E.W.T.s finished, and the common room returned to its usual noisy state. A few students asked Albus and his friends about what had happened with Washburn and the Willinsons, but Albus didnât tell them anything. The studentsâ attention was soon turned towards the Quidditch final. Just as Albus and Harry had predicted a few months prior, it would be Gryffindor vs. Ravenclaw.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight, and my other sister and my brother. Thanks as well to inkheart, smirkyhaha, and harshabc for their reviews!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
âYouâre going to be fine, James,â Albus assured his brother at breakfast a few mornings later. James was sitting across from him, but wasnât eating anything. With the exception of James, everyone else at the Gryffindor table was in high spirits. Exams were over, and it was the last Quidditch match of the year. The only one besides James who wasnât eating anything was Matt, and considering that the full moon was that night, it wasnât surprising.
âJames, youâve got to eat something,â Samantha Meyers had appeared behind James and was pouring him a glass of pumpkin juice, âAt least drink this.â James nodded and took the goblet, but he only drank a few sips. He glanced nervously at Albus, and then looked up at the staff table.
Albus turned and looked as well. Harry wasnât there. The past few days, Harry had been away from Hogwarts more than he had been there. He had been spending a lot of time at the Ministry, organizing the search for Washburn and both Willinsons. âHeâll be there, James. He said he would. You know he wouldnât miss the match for the world.â
âOk, team, letâs go!â Samantha stood up and beckoned her team to follow her. James followed the rest of the team, with one last glance at the staff table. As they left, the entire Gryffindor table stood up and cheered.
A few minutes later, Albus and his friends walked down to the pitch. âLast Quidditch match of the year,â Albus sighed.
âYeah, just hope we win!â John shouted.
âHope so, too. But Ravenclaw will be hard to beat. Theyâve got a good team,â Albus replied.
âAt least the weatherâs good,â John pointed out, âI donât think weâve played in better conditions than this the whole year.â John was right about that. It was warm, hardly windy at all, and there was just enough cloud cover to mask the glare from the sun.
âI hope itâs a quick match,â Matt yawned as they climbed into the stands.
âIt probably wonât be,â Albus said, âWeâre pretty evenly matched with Ravenclaw.â
Matt groaned, âMaybe James will spot the Snitch early.â
âWouldnât count on it,â Albus responded, âJames told me that in order to win the Cup, weâve got to be at least 40 points up before he catches the Snitch. Otherwise, weâll win the match, but Ravenclaw will get the Cup. And Samantha has made it clear she wants the Cup. Itâs her only chance. Sheâs only been captain for this year. Before her, it was Teddy.â
âMaybe you shouldâve stayed in the castle,â Rose said sympathetically.
âAnd miss Quidditch?â Matt stared at her like she had three heads.
Rose sighed. âI donât know whatâs with you guys and Quidditch,â she muttered.
âItâs a good game!â Amanda grinned, âWay better than football.â
âDoesnât take much for something to be more interesting than football,â John laughed, âI mean, honestly, what were the Muggles thinking? How can a game be exciting with one ball?â
Albus laughed. He had to agree. He had been to one football match before. It was a community league, and Harry had taken him and James to see if they had been interesting in playing it. Throughout the whole match, both Albus and James had commented on how much better Quidditch was.
Albus watched the stands fill up, hoping to catch a glimpse of his dad. He looked at the part of the stands where the staff sat, but the seat next to Neville that Harry usually occupied during Quidditch matches remained empty. Where was he? The match was about to start. He promised James that he would be there.
âWelcome, Hogwarts students and staff to the Quidditch Final!â Todd Smithâs voice boomed over the crowd. âTodayâs match is between Gryffindor and Ravenclaw! And here come the teams!
âFirst is Ravenclaw. Captain Tyler Pike, followed by Dan Burke, Natalie Cable, Allie Davies, Damien Waverly, Kate Waverly, and Zack Valentino!â Seven players in blue robes walked out onto the field, with their brooms over their shoulders.
âNext we have Gryffindor! Captain Samantha Meyers, followed by Ryan OâMalley, James Potter, Bradley Weasley, Fred Weasley, Georgia Weasley, and Heather Weasley!â The Gryffindor team marched onto the field and stopped in front of the Ravneclaws.
âProfessor Oteski steps onto the field. Captains Meyers and Pike shake hands, and the teams are off!â
Albus watched as both teams soared into the air. Heather immediately took control of the Quaffle, passing it back and forth between Fred and Samantha. They flew down the pitch, dodging Bludgers sent by Valentino and Davies.
âGryffindor scores the first goal of the game!â Todd shouted out, once Heather managed to get the Quaffle past Kate Waverly. âRavenclaw in possession now. Waverly passes to Burke, and then back to Waverly.â
âHi, Al.â
Albus turned around at the sound of his name. Harry had appeared behind him and was climbing over the seats in order to sit down. Albus moved over so Harry could sit in between him and Matt. âDad, you made it!â
ââCourse I did! I said I would,â Harry replied as he sat down, âDid I miss anything?â
âHeather just scored the first goal of the game,â Albus grinned.
âAwesome! Sheâs got some arm, let me tell you. Even as a baby. I remember once, she threw one of her toys at me. Gave me a black eye,â Harry laughed.
âWhy are you sitting here?â Albus asked, âYou usually sit with the rest of the staff.â
âTo be honest, itâs more fun sitting here,â Harry grinned, âI donât have to control my excitement when Gryffindor scores.â
At that moment, Samantha scored a goal, and all the Gryffindors jumped up, screaming and hollering with joy. Harry screamed the loudest of them all.
âSee what I mean?â Harry grinned, âThe staff always has to contain their excitement, in order not to play favorites.â
For the next hour, the game continued with both Gryffindor and Ravenclaw scoring goal after goal. After the first initial goals, Ravenclaw caught up quickly and tied the match. Both teams showed exceptional skill, and there had still not been any glimpse of the Snitch.
âNow, this is Quidditch,â Harry grinned and looked at Albus. âThis could be another for the record books.â
Albus agreed, âYeah, weâve just got to hope that we can somehow get 40 points ahead.â
âThat could take a while,â Harry said.
âCable of Ravenclaw has scored!â Todd shouted, â110-100 Ravenclaw!â
âMerlin!â Albus shouted. Albus looked out over the pitch. Heather was in possession of the Quaffle again. Valentino was flying directly behind her and hit a Bludger towards her head. Luckily, she ducked at that very moment and the Bludger wound up hitting Damien Waverly instead. Waverly slipped off his broom, but managed to hold on with one hand. He got back on the broom and sent a nasty look towards Valentino. In the meantime, Heather managed to score another goal.
It became clear within the next half hour of the game, that the Damien Waverly had been injured by the Bludger. His coordination was all off, and he was having problems catching the Quaffle. This, of course, worked to Gryffindorâs advantage, and soon enough the score was 120-150 Gryffindor.
âJust one more goal,â Albus said, âOne more and James can catch the Snitch.â
âItâll be hard to keep up that 40 point lead, though,â Harry pointed out. âHeâll have to find the Snitch soon after the goal is scored.â
âI hope he does,â Rose said, âI donât think Matt can take much more of this.â
Albus looked over at his friend and felt bad that he had become so absorbed in the game, that he hadnât noticed how bad Matt looked. Matt appeared to have fallen asleep and was leaning his head on Harryâs shoulder. He was wincing every once and a while, much like he had been during the Gryffindor vs. Slytherin game. Why did they always schedule Quidditch matches around the full moon?
Harry nudged Matt gently until he woke up, âWhaâs going on?â Matt asked sleepily.
âYou fell asleep,â Harry said gently, âYouâre welcome to lean on me, but I wasnât sure if you wanted to miss the match.â
âI donât, thanks,â Matt replied, blushing a little, âItâs bad enough having Malfoy see me fall asleep in class, but during QuidditchâŠ.â
âI donât think he can see you here,â Albus said quietly, âHeâs on the other side of the stands.â
âGood,â Matt responded. âBut I still donât want to miss the match.â
Albus turned his attention back to the match. It seemed to be getting harder and harder for Ravenclaw to to score goals with only two chasers. Damien Waverly was flying more erratically by the minute and his teammates had long since stopped trying to throw him the Quaffle. However, despite the difficulties, Ravenclaw was putting up a good fight. Their other two chasers were superb.
âBurke scores!â Todd shouted out over the crowd, âMaking the score 130-150 Gryffindor! Câmon, you can do it, Gryffindor! Just two more goals and catch the Snitch!â
âDarn,â Albus sighed, âSo much for one more goal.â
âItâs all right, Al, two goals wonât be hard,â Harry shifted awkwardly to turn towards his son. Matt had fallen asleep on his shoulder again. âMadam Pomfrey didnât even want him to go to the match,â Harry gestured to Matt. âBut I convinced her to let him.â
âThanks,â Albus smiled, âHe didnât want to miss it, even if he is asleep during half of it.â
âWell, Madam Pomfrey worries a lot,â Harry told him, âFrankly, she wasnât too keen on James playing, either. Said heâd just recovered from his duel with those Slytherins and he ought to be resting. But I insisted that he could play.â
âHe seems to be doing fine,â Albus said as he glanced out over the pitch. James was currently circling above the rest of the players. The Ravenclaw Seeker, Tyler Pike, was doing the same.
âHe is,â Harry agreed, âStaying out of the way, thatâs the best strategy for a Seeker.â
âGryffindor scores!â Todd exclaimed, âCaptain Meyers has scored!â
âSee, Al, now itâs just one more goal, again,â Harry said.
The game was now entering itâs third hour. There was still no sign of the Snitch, which was good for Gryffindor, since they still needed to score one more goal before James could catch it. About ten minutes after Samantha scored, Heather managed to score as well.
âYes!â Albus jumped up in his seat and shouted out in excitement. Now, James could catch the Snitch.
âAs long as Gryffindor can keep their forty point lead, and catch the Snitch, they will win the Cup!â Todd shouted.
Albus watched as James started picking up speed and fly around the pitch, looking for the Snitch. But in the meantime, Dan Burke was once again storming up the pitch with the Quaffle. He flew straight towards the Gryffindor goals and managed to score another goal.
âDamn!â Todd shouted.
âLanguage, Smith!â Patil shouted next to him.
âSorry, Professor,â Todd said, âNow, Gryffindor must score another goal in order to gain back the forty point lead. And they might be doing that now! Fred Weasley has gained possession of the Quaffle. He passes to Meyers and then Meyers passes it back. Fred aims the Quaffle, and score! Gryffindor has the forty point lead again!â
The Gryffindors were all on their feet now, shouting in excitement and chanting âGo, James, go! All of them except Matt and Harry. Somehow, Matt was managing to sleep through everything, and Harry continued to let him lean on his shoulder. Luckily, no one seemed to notice, besides Albus, John, Rose, and Amanda. They kept glancing worried looks at Matt, but eventually, they got sucked up into the emotion of the game and watched Jamesâs search for the Snitch.
âAnd I think heâs seen it!â Todd screamed, âYes, Potter has seen the Snitch! Heâs flying directly towards the ground. Pike has noticed it as well, but he is all the way at the other end of the pitch. I donât think heâll get there in time. No, he definitely wonât!â
Albus watched as James flew closer and closer to the ground. Albus was sure he would crash into it, and watched nervously as James finally pulled out of the dive, just in time. He flew back up a few feet, holding the struggling Snitch in his hand. Albus turned to his dad. âWeâve won! Weâve got the Cup!â
âGryffindor wins! With 320 points, Gryffindor has not only won the match, but theyâve won the Cup as well! Congratulations, Gryffindor!â Toddâs voice rang out over the crowd.
âMatt, wake up!â John nudged his friend awake, âWeâve won, wake up!â
âWhaâ?â Matt slowly lifted his head off Harryâs shoulder and looked at all the excitement around him. âOh, right. Awesome!â
Harry stood up, grinning, âIâm going to go congratulate James. Iâll see you later. Iâll probably stop by the common room, for the party.â
Albus gave his dad a hug before he left, âAll right. See you later.â
âLetâs get back to the common room,â Rose suggested as she watched Matt rub his head, âWeâll see James there.â
âOk,â Albus agreed. He knew Matt had no desire to join the mob of Gryffindors currently storming the pitch.
Despite their slow walk back to the castle and up to the seventh floor, Albus and his friends made it back to the common room before most of the other Gryffindors. In fact, the only other people there were a few older students Albus didnât know, Amy, Victoire, and someone Albus definitely didnât expect to see.
âTeddy!â Albus shouted as he spotted Teddy sitting next to Victoire on one of the couches. âWhat are you doing here?â
âCame to see the match. James did brilliantly! They couldnât have found a better Seeker to replace me,â he grinned, âAnd came to see Vickyâs graduation, of course.â He smiled at Victoire and giggled.
âOh, right,â Albus grinned, âGlad you came!â
âYeah, itâs great to be back here,â Teddy grinned, âWell, I think I might go to Hogsmeade and pick up some supplies for the party.â
âGreat!â Albus said, âSee you in a bit.â
âYou, too,â Teddy stood up. He gave Victoire a quick kiss and exited the common room. It was really starting to fill up now, although the team had yet to arrive.
âAre you going to stay for the party?â Albus quietly asked Matt.
âI donât think so,â Matt yawned, âThink I might take a nap.â
âOk,â Albus responded. Matt left the group and made his way through the crowd to the dormitories.
âItâs so unfair,â Rose said softly as he left. Albus, John, and Amanda nodded in agreement, but no one said anything else on the subject.
The group found seats at their usual table and shortly after they sat down, James and the rest of the team came into the room.
âWeâve got it!â Samantha Meyers was the first to burst into the room, holding the Quidditch Cup above her head. âWe did it!â She was positively beaming. The rest of the team climbed in behind her, all of them grinning from ear to ear. The entire common room burst into applause as soon as they were all inside.
âThank you, everyone!â Samantha shouted over the crowd, âI just want to say a few words.â She waited until everyone was silent. âFirst, I just want to thank the whole team. We couldnât have done this without any of you. Weâve got a fantastic team here, and Iâm definitely going to miss all of you next year. I especially want to congratulate James,â she turned to James, who was clearly basking in the glory, âYou have done an outstanding job this whole year. Coming in as Seeker, right after Teddy Lupin, who was one of the best Seekers this house has ever had. That, and being expected to live up to your dadâs reputation. Well, all I can say is you have lived up to that expectation. And I think you are definitely going to rival Teddy as far as seeking skill goes-â
âAh, Samantha!â Teddy came bursting back into the common room, âAm I missing you rambling on about my brilliance on the Quidditch pitch?â
âActually, no, Teddy,â Samantha laughed, âI was just saying how James could give you a run for your money when it comes to seeking.â
âWell, thatâs no surprise, since it was Yours Truly who trained him,â Teddy joked.
âOh, shut it, Teddy!â Samantha replied.
âAnd I get no credit at all?â Harry had come into the common room and was standing behind Teddy.
âHarry!â Teddy turned around, grinning, âGlad you could come to the party! Iâve just gotten back from getting supplies.â
âGood,â Samantha grinned, grabbing one of the bags and pulling out Butterbeers, âThen letâs get this party started!â
The party proceeded much like the one following the Gryffindor vs. Slytherin match had, only even more boisterous. Teddy had not only bought stuff from Honeydukes, but from Weasleyâs Wizard Wheezes as well. Teddy treated everyone to a display of Everlasting Fireworks, which took the shape of Gryffindor lions, Snitches, and broomsticks. Albus and his friends quite enjoyed it, and they also played round after round of Exploding Snap. Just like the previous party, no one left for dinner. Teddy had bought enough food that no one needed to. Even Harry stayed well into the evening.
âYou know, Rose,â John said after what must have been their tenth game of Exploding Snap, âI donât think Iâve ever seen you without a book before.â
Albus looked over at Rose, who was indeed without any sort of book. âWell, exams are over now,â Rose laughed, âI do take a break from studying every once and a while.â
âItâs just sort of shocking,â John grinned, âRose without a book.â
âDonât worry,â Albus laughed, âI guarantee you sheâll be back to studying within two weeks of going back home.â
âOh, shut it, Albus,â Rose grinned.
âHey, guys,â James was standing next to their table, his grin still as big as when he first came into the room.
âOh, hi, James!â Albus replied, âCongratulations on the match! You did brilliantly.â
âYeah, it was awesome!â John agreed.
âGreat job!â Amanda said.
âIt was great!,â Rose said.
âThanks,â James replied, âYouâre trying out next year, right Albus?â
âYeah, definitely,â Albus answered, âBut I donât know if Iâll make it. I mean, the only position open will be Samanthaâs.â
âIâm sure youâll make it,â James assured him, âYouâre a great Chaser.â
âThanks,â Albus said quietly, his cheeks turning a bit crimson.
âGreat party, huh?â James said, âBut whereâs Matt?â
âHe, er, doesnât feel good. Heâs in the dormitory, sleeping,â Albus answered.
âOh, I hope he feels better soon. He didnât look too good this morning,â James responded, âWell, Iâd better get back to the team. See you later.â
Albus waved as James left and was absorbed back into the huge crowd in the room. It seemed as if every Gryffindor was in the common room. With Harry and Teddy there as well, there was hardly room to move. Albus kind of liked it though. He wasnât a huge fan of large crowds of people, but as long as everyone wasnât focusing on him, he was ok with it. And now, the attention was definitely on James and the rest of the Quidditch team. Albus glanced around the room and saw that the entire team was right at the center of things, along with Teddy and Harry.
âOh, hi, Matt,â Rose said quietly. Albus turned his head away from the Quidditch team and saw that Matt had come down from the dormitory. He was leaning on the table and looking very tired.
âHi,â he mumbled quietly, âIâve got to go now. Iâll see you tomorrow, probably.â
âYeah, tomorrow,â Albus agreed. During the past few months, Albus and the others had started visiting Matt the day after every full moon. Ever since the first time they had done that, Matt had started getting more and more comfortable with the idea of his friends seeing him so soon after a transformation. But Albus and the others had not visited him so early in the morning since. They now visited in the late afternoon, after classes were done for the day.
âWant me to go with you?â John asked.
âNo, itâs ok, Amyâs going to,â Matt replied
âReady?â Amy appeared next to Matt.
âYeah, I guess, letâs go,â Matt turned and started to walk towards the portrait hole. Amy followed closely behind.
âLast one here, until September,â Rose commented after theyâd left.
âWonder what itâs like at home?â John mused.
âDunno, but I donât think we should ask,â Albus said quietly.
âNo, probably not,â John agreed.
Albus and his friends stayed up late into the night, playing games of chess and Exploding Snap. Harry spent most of the evening in the common room, but he left around 9 pm. However, the party continued well into the wee hours of the morning. It probably would have lasted much longer, but Neville came in around 1 am, and told them they had to go to bed. Apparently, the noise had carried into other parts of the castle and some of the other professors wanted to get some sleep. After Neville left, Albus dragged himself up to his dormitory. He was completely exhausted from staying up so late and fell asleep the moment his head hit the pillow.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight, as well as my other sister and my brother. Thanks also to BKL8008, inkheart, Moonylupin, and XDNLxtlz99 for their reviews! There are only a few chapters left in this story, just to let everyone know.
Chapter 38: Graduation
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
âMay I have your attention, please,â Professor Kendrick stood up and announced at the End of Year Feast the a couple days later. Albus stopped talking to John and turned to face the Headmaster.
âThank you,â Kendrick continued once the Great Hall was quiet, âWhat a year, what a year. It is hard to believe that it is now June. The year has ended with quite a shock. I know that you all know by now what transpired on the grounds this past week.â
Albus glanced around at his fellow students and saw that they were all turning to stare at him. He sunk down in his seat a little bit and tried to avoid their gaze.
âI want to assure you all that the Aurors are looking for both Professor Washburn and Jarett Willinson, as well as Quinton Willinson. Whether this was an isolated attack, I am not sure. But whether there are more attacks to come or not, I am sure we will all stand strong, and stand as one. Whatever is coming, we will deal with it. We have dealt with evil in the past and chances are we will deal with it in the future.â Professor Kendrick paused and looked out at his students. Everyone had returned their gaze to him, and were no longer staring at Albus and his friends.
âNow, onto lighter matters. I have a few announcements, then the House Cup needs awarding. First, O.W.L. and N.E.W.T. results will be mailed partway through the summer, as usual. Second, the graduation ceremony will take place tomorrow, at ten oâclock. And lastly, as usual, I must remind you of the fact that using magic is prohibited while you are not in school over the summer.
âAnd now, the House Cup. In last place, Hufflepuff with 376 points.â Kendrick announced. Albus clapped politely along with everyone else in the Hall. âNext, Gryffindor with 413 points.â Albus groaned, as did everyone else sitting at the Gryffindor table. No doubt that the many points Washburn took from all of them helped assure that they did not get the House Cup. âIn second place, with 452 points, Slytherin.â There was a bit more polite applause, but none of it from the Gryffindor table. âAnd in first place, Ravenclaw with 563 points! Congratulations, Ravenclaw!â Kendrick waved his wand and the decorations transformed from their usual Hogwarts colors into the Ravenclaw blue.
Albus clapped his hands, while looking glumly at his plate. Oh, well, there was always next year. At least theyâd gotten the Quidditch Cup.
âI think that is all that needs to be announced,â Kendrick said once the applause died down, âAnd with that, enjoy the feast!â Kendrick waved his wand once again and food appeared on all the plates.
âWeâll win it next year,â John announced as he heaped his plate high with chicken, âBut you know what, Iâm going to miss this food over the summerâŠ.â
ââCourse weâll win it next year,â Albus agreed, âWashburn wonât be here anymore to take off unfair points.â
âYou donât know who Kendrickâll get to replace him, though,â Rose warned.
âGood point,â Matt said as he buttered a piece of bread. He was still recovering from the full moon and wasnât that hungry. Normally, he wouldnât even be out of the Hospital Wing yet, but he had convinced Madam Pomfrey to let him attend the feast. âDo you know if your dad will be teaching DADA again next year?â
âDunno,â Albus shrugged. He hadnât really thought about it before, but Harry had come to teach DADA at a momentâs notice, and maybe Kendrick really didnât have time to get anyone else. But now heâd have the whole summer.
âHope he does,â Matt replied, âOtherwise, weâll be getting two new teachers, and what are the chances that both of them will be nice?â
âNot high,â Rose said. âI like having Uncle Harry teach here. I hope he comes back.â
âMe, too,â Albus agreed. John and Amanda nodded.
âJust hope our next Charms teacher is nicer,â Amanda said, âOf course, it wonât take much, will it?â
âNope,â Rose replied, âWonât take much at all.â
******
Albus awoke the next morning with just enough time to catch a quick breakfast in the Great Hall before making his way to the grounds for the graduation.
âWeâll see you after, when weâre getting on the train,â Rose said to John and Amanda as she got up from the table.
âBye,â John mumbled, his mouth full of toast.
âHave fun,â Amanda waved.
Albus and Matt waved as they followed Rose out of the room. âGood thing itâs sunny today,â Albus commented, âRemember Teddyâs? Last year?â
Rose laughed, âOh, yeah, how could I forget that?â
âWhat happened?â Matt asked.
âWorst thunderstorm of the whole year,â Albus grinned, âItâs funny looking back on it, but it wasnât then. We got soaked, despite the tents Kendrick put up. Not to mention the wind, thunder, and lightning. Scared Lily out of her mind. Mum had to take her into the castle partway through.â
âGlad itâs not like that this year,â Matt agreed. The three of them walked onto the grounds and over towards the chairs that had been set up by the lake. People were already milling about and finding seats. Albus spotted his parents, grandparents, aunts, uncles, and cousins, all taking up practically half the seats.
âThereâs my mum and dad,â Matt pointed to two people sitting down near where Albusâs Aunt Fleur and Uncle Bill were, âWant to meet them?â
âSure,â Albus said and Rose nodded.
Matt started walking towards them, but once they noticed him, they came running towards the three of them and met them halfway. âOh, Matthew! How are you? Are you feeling ok?â A tall blond woman with an Australian accent enveloped Matt in a tight hug.
âMum!â Matt said, his cheeks turning red, âIâm fine! Really, I am.â
âAre you sure? You look a bit pale. Did you sleep well last night?â the blond woman asked anxiously, with her arms still wrapped around her son.
âIâm sure! I slept fine, really,â Matt assured her.
âJulie, I think heâs fine.â The man, who Albus guessed was Mattâs dad, pulled the woman off of Matt. He also had an Australian accent and was tall, with graying hair.
âOh, all right,â the woman sighed, âI just worry.â
âI know, so do I,â the man said quietly, then turned to Matt, âHow was the end of term?â
âGreat, really. Well, with the exception of what happened with Washburn,â Matt told them.
âAnd you wonder why I worry so much,â the woman said to the man, âIâm glad everything else was fine.â
âOh, these are my friends,â Matt gestured to Albus and Rose, âWell, two of them anyway. Albus Potter and Rose Weasley. Theyâre both Victoireâs cousins, like I told you in my letters. Albus, Rose, this is my mum and dad.â
âPleased to meet you,â Rose smiled and shook their hands.
âHi,â Albus shook their hands after Rose.
âHello, dears,â the woman gave them a warm smile.
âSo youâre the ones who set off fireworks in Professor Washburnâs class?â Mr. Eckerton asked.
âEr, yeah,â Albus answered nervously.
Mattâs dad just laughed, âThat sounds like something Iâd have done in school. Of course, I did plenty of other stuffâŠ.â Mrs. Eckerton gave him a stern look. âNot that Iâm saying you should pull pranks like that, of course. You should behave yourself in school, son,â Mr. Eckerton said quickly to Matt.
Albus stifled a laugh and noticed his own parents, followed by his Uncle Ron and Aunt Hermione walking over towards him. âHi, Mum and Dad!â
Rose grinned and greeted her parents as well, âHello, Mum, Dad.â
âAlbus!â Ginny let go of Lilyâs hand and wrapped her son in a big hug.
âHi, Mum,â Albus replied and rolled his eyes and Ginny finally let him go. He looked over and saw that Roseâs parents were doing the same thing with her.
Albus gestured to Matt and his parents, âThis is our friend, Matt. Well, you already know him, Dad,â Albus laughed, âBut anyway, these are his parents. And Matt, Mr. Eckerton, Mrs. Eckerton, those are my parents, and my Uncle Ron and Aunt Hermione, who are Roseâs parents. And my little sister Lily and Roseâs little brother, Hugo.â
âNice to meet you,â Mattâs dad stuck out his hand. âWalter Eckerton. And my wife, Julie.â The adults spent a few minutes exchanging hand shakes and pleasantries, while Albus and Rose introduced Matt to Lily and Hugo.
âHowâd you get those cuts?â Hugo asked Matt loudly, gesturing to the partially healed cuts on Mattâs arm. Since the full moon was only a couple days ago, they still hadnât completely healed. âDidja get âem from that duel with Professor Washburn?â Hugo said excitedly, ââCause that was awesome. Wish Iâd been there. I woulda blasted him all the way from here to Hagridâs Hut!â
âEr, yeah, theyâre from the duel,â Matt replied quickly.
âWicked!â Hugo grinned. âCanât wait until I can come here.â
âJust another year, Hugo,â Albus smiled at his cousin. âBut donât count on getting to duel with evil teachers. Iâd rather not have had to do that.â
âMe and Lily acted out the duel, didnât we, Lily?â Hugo told them. Lily nodded her head. Hugo continued, âI got to be Washburn, only I won. Lily ran away.â
âDid not!â Lily shouted.
âDid too!â Hugo shouted back.
âKids, calm down,â Ginny said sternly.
âMum, can Matt come stay with us over the summer? John, too, but heâs in the castle. They can come for mine and Roseâs birthday party,â Albus asked.
âI donât see why not,â Ginny smiled, âAs long as itâs ok with his parents.â
âCan I go stay with Albus?â Matt asked his parents, âPlease?â
âI donât knowâŠâ Mrs. Eckerton looked worriedly at her husband.
Mr. Eckerton glanced at his wife and replied, âWeâll have to think about it.â
âOh, come on! Please?â Matt pleaded, âIâll be fine. Albus even said theyâd have the party at, a, good time.â
Harry seemed to catch onto what the Eckertons were worried about and gave them a meaningful gaze, âI understand your worry, but Iâm sure Matt will be fine if he stays with us for a few days. And we will schedule the party at a good time.â
The Eckertons still didnât look convinced, but Mattâs dad said, âHe probably will, but Iâd still like to talk it over with Julie. Weâll get back to you, all right?â
âThatâs fine,â Harry replied.
Matt groaned, âYou worry too much.â
âSometimes we have to worry,â Mattâs mum told him, âYou know that.â
âI know,â Matt sighed.
âI think the ceremonyâs starting now,â Harry announced. âWeâll be in touch with the details of the party.â
âSounds good,â Mrs. Eckerton replied.
âSee you after, Matt,â Albus waved. He and Rose followed their families to the chairs that were set up on the lawn. Albus sat down in between Rose and Harry and waited for the ceremony to begin.
There was a large stage set up in front of the chairs, with a tall podium embossed with the Hogwarts crest. Next to the podium was a table piled with Hogwarts diplomas. All the seventh years sat in the first few rows of chairs, dressed in their black Hogwarts robes and a wizardâs hat.
After a few minutes, in which everyone who had been milling around and talking came and sat down, Professor Kendrick strode up to the podium and began to speak. âWelcome, friends and family, to the graduation ceremony of the Hogwarts Class of 2017. I remember the first time these students stepped foot into Hogwarts. Many were excited and just as many were scared and nervous. Some thought they knew all of Hogwartsâs secrets, and others hardly knew anything about the Wizarding World at all. But that did not matter. Because now, they all stand as one, equally prepared to take on the world around them. I believe that great things will happen to the people in this class and that they will do great things.
âThis class is a special one to me. Every class at Hogwarts is special, but the year I became Headmaster was the year this class came to Hogwarts. I think that I was just as nervous as they were, if not more so.â Kendrick paused as the audience laughed. âAnd I remember each one of their sortings. I remember Tyler Pike tripping over his own feet as he made his way to the stool. Heâs certainly come a long way from that, becoming captain of the Ravenclaw Quidditch team. I also remember Olivia Kadenâs smile as she was sorted into Hufflepuff and ran to join her sister at that table. And who could forget the loud shout of glee from Teddy Lupin as Victoire Weasley was sorted into Gryffindor.â
Professor Kendrick continued his speech for another ten minutes. After he was done, each of the Heads of House went up to the podium and gave a speech as well. Albus liked Nevilleâs speech the best. He talked about how proud he was of each and every Gryffindor that was graduating that day, and what made them special. Albus found it a bit difficult to pay attention to Professor Patilâs speech about the Ravenclaws because she used such big words that Albus hardly knew what she was saying. He assumed it all meant that Professor Patil knew that all the Ravenclaws would wind up making great contributions to the Wizarding World in the discoveries of various things. Professor Polo gave a good speech about the Hufflepuffs, and then Slughorn gave one, but it didnât focus much on the Slytherins. His speech mainly consisted of listing who he had taught at Hogwarts, and how famous they are now. He spent a good portion of it talking about how he had taught Harry. Albus saw his dad grimace as Slughorn mentioned what a marvelous potions brewer he had been. Albus had to stifle a laugh at that, because he knew the story of Snapeâs potions book and how Harry had wound up with it in his sixth year.
Professor Kendrick took the podium once Slughorn had finished, âThank you, Professors Longbottom, Patil, Polo, and Slughorn. Now, two outstanding students shall speak on behalf of their class. First, Head Boy Tyler Pike. And then, Head Girl Victoire Weasley.â
Tyler Pike took the podium and began his speech. It was a long-winded speech full of more words Albus didnât understand, much like Professor Patilâs had been. Must be a Ravenclaw thing, he thought. Albus glanced at Rose and noticed she was paying rapt attention. Maybe she should have been in Ravenclaw.
Once Tyler concluded his speech, Victoire stepped up to the podium. She waited for the crowd to stop their applause for Tylerâs speech and then she began. âWow, what a crazy seven years itâs been!â she paused and smiled at the audience. âI remember our first day here. I was scared, we were all scared. Short first years, lost in a sea of older students, and now weâre at the top. Over the past seven years we have not only gotten an education that will serve us throughout our entire lives, but we have forged friendships and memories that will last a lifetime. Memories. In the end, thatâs all weâve got. I know I speak for us all in saying that the memories weâve made here at Hogwarts are some of the best we have. It hasnât always been easy and not all the memories are good ones. Weâve all lost the House Cup at least once in the past seven years, weâve lost Quidditch matches, failed tests, and had fights with friends. But now isnât the time to dwell on those memories. Right now we should remember the good times. The times we did win the House Cup, the spectacular wins in Quidditch, the tests weâve aced, and the fact that our friendships are strong enough to withstand a few rows.
âIâm sure we all have mixed feelings about leaving Hogwarts. I know I do. This castle has been our home away from home for the past seven years. A good portion of our lives have been spent here. It will be sad to leave Hogwarts behind, but this moment is what weâve been working towards ever since we stepped off the train when we were 11. Hogwarts has prepared us, not only academically, but socially, for the world before us. We are ready, we can go into the world and make something of ourselves. When you look out at the class behind me, donât just look at us as the Hogwarts Class of 2017. Look at us as the future Healers, Aurors, researchers, and who knows, maybe even the future Minister of Magic. So, in conclusion, we are ready to face the world. Whatever it has in store for us, we will be able to take it on. Using our different talents, we as a group will be able to take whatever the world has to throw at us.â
The audience broke out into loud applause. Albus clapped along with them. He thought Victoireâs speech had been much better than Tylerâs and judging by the applause, everyone else thought so, too. The applause died down as Victoire went back to her seat and Kendrick took up the podium once again.
âThank you, Tyler and Victoire,â he nodded his head in their direction, âNow it is time to present the diplomas.â Kendrick waved his wand and the podium moved to the side, while the table with the diplomas moved to the center of the stage. The four heads of houses got up and stood next to the table. Kendrick stood on the other side and picked up the first diploma. âKatelyn Isabelle Asterly,â he called out.
A tall, red haired Hufflepuff stood up and walked over to the headmaster. She took her diploma and shook Kendrickâs hand. Then she shook all the heads of housesâ hands and walked off the stage. She walked the short distance to the lake. Albus watched her and noticed that Hagrid was standing there. The boats they had crossed the lake on earlier in the year were sitting on the calm water.
The headmaster continued to call off names. Albus recognized a few of them, but most of them were people he had just seen occasionally.
âAmy Marie Eckerton,â Kendrick called out a short while later. Albus and Rose clapped loudly as Mattâs sister accepted her diploma and walked over to the growing group of seventh years near the lake.
Albus watched as Kendrick called out more names. He recognized the two Slytherins that had hexed him earlier in the year. Neither he or Rose clapped for them. They politely clapped for everyone else. Albus also recognized the Quidditch captain, Samantha Meyers and clapped a bit louder for her.
The crowd of seventh years on the stage diminished until there were only two left. âVictoire Fleur Weasley,â Kendrick announced. Albus and Rose clapped louder than they had for anyone else as their cousin shook Kendrickâs hand. Albus heard Teddy whistle and give a loud shout of âGo Victoire!â as she shook Nevilleâs hand. Professor Patil shot him a stern look and he quieted down. Albus had to stifle a laugh. Even after you graduate, you still have to listen to the professors, he thought.
âCameron Alexander Zabino,â Kendrick called once Victoire had crossed the stage. A burly looking Slytherin accepted his diploma and joined his class by the lake.
Kendrick waved his wand and the table disappeared. The podium moved back to the center of the stage and Kendrick stood behind it. âIn the past seven years, the students in this class have learned a great deal about magic and life in general. These skills will help them as they pursue the careers and dreams of their choosing. It is time for them to journey from Hogwarts, on the same boats they arrived her on seven years ago. The first time they crossed this lake, they were both excited and scared about what Hogwarts had in store for them. As they cross the lake once more, they are more confident, but still excited and a bit scared about what the world has in store for them. I know I speak for us all when I say Iâm sure they will do great things.â
Kendrick nodded his head towards the group of seventh years. The students climbed into the boats and Hagrid got into the one in front. He brandished his pink umbrella and bellowed, âForward!â The boats all started moving, taking the seventh years away from Hogwarts and towards the new adventures that awaited them as adults.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Thanks to my sister and beta, Dancer_of_Starlight, my other sister, and my brother. Thanks as well to Moonylupin, ladymblack, sinwillys822, and XDNLxtlz99 for their reviews!
Also, if anyone picked up on the fact that this took place in 2016/2017, whereas the Harry Potter Lexicon indicates that Albusâs first year would have been 2017/2018, I figured out the dates differently than the Lexicon did. I used Victoireâs birthday (May 2, 1999) and figured out that her 7th year would hvae been 2016/2017. I know the Lexicon figured it out differently, but Iâm sticking with my own calculations.
Thereâs only one chapter left! Iâll post it next week and then look for the sequel, which Iâll post sometime after Christmas!
Disclaimer- I donât own Harry Potter.
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
The audience stood up and applauded as the boats left. A few people cheered and whistled. Albus could hear Teddyâs cheering over everyone elseâs. After a few minutes, people started to leave.
Albus and Rose said a quick goodbye to their families before heading off to the horseless carriages that would take them to Hogsmeade Station. They got into a carriage with Matt and the carriage lurched forwards to take them to the train.
âJohn and Amanda must already be on,â Albus said as they walked down the corridor in the train.
âProbably, weâre some of the last ones on,â Rose pointed out. They continued to look into the compartments before they found the one that their friends were in.
âHow was the graduation?â John asked once the compartment door was shut once again.
âReally good,â Rose said.
âYeah, Teddy kept shouting and whistling and Professor Patil was glaring at him,â Albus laughed.
âAnd Victoireâs speech was really good,â Matt told them, âMuch better than Tyler Pikeâs speech.â
âI could hardly understand a word of it,â Albus commented.
âI thought it was a good speech,â Rose responded, âIt was all about how the class needs to use their talents and skills to further advance the Wizarding World.â
âWell, he could have just said that,â Albus huffed, âHe didnât have to make it so bloody confusing.â
âI got told off by him once, I couldnât understand anything he was telling me,â John laughed.
âHeâs just got a big vocabulary,â Rose insisted, âAnyway, the graduation was really good.â
âYeah, but itâll be weird next year when Victoireâs gone. Sheâs starting training to be a Healer next year,â Albus told them and turned to Matt, âWhatâs Amy doing?â
âSheâs going to be a Healer, too,â Matt told them, âSheâs going to work with Healer Sterling this summer, actually. She, er, wants to get involved with the study Iâm in and stuff.â
âOh, is that the Healer whoâs in charge of it? Heâs the one who Albus saw in the Hospital Wing a couple months ago?â John asked.
âYeah,â Matt told them, âAmyâs wanted to be a Healer and work on the Wolfsbane Potion ever since she saw me after the full moon for the first time,â he said quietly.
âThatâs good,â Amanda said, âMaybe sheâll actually find a cure.â
âMaybe, but probably not,â Matt replied sullenly.
âSo, what are you doing in Ireland, Amanda?â Rose asked after a moment of awkward silence.
âMainly just sight seeing and stuff,â Amanda answered, âItâs going to be really fun. Iâve always wanted to go there.â
âThereâs all kinds of history there,â Rose told her, âThereâs a bunch of wizarding villages there, too. Iâd love to go and visit them.â
âThat would be fun,â Amanda agreed, âBut I think weâre sticking with the Muggle stuff.â
âOh, right,â Rose said, âWell, if I ever go to Ireland, you can come with me and weâll look around all the wizarding villages.â
âI wish I was going to Ireland over the summer,â John announced, âWeâre not doing anything. Just staying home.â
âUs, too,â Albus said, âLast year we went to France.â
âThat was loads of fun!â Rose grinned, âI want to go back.â
âThe funniest part was watching James try and speak French to all the French people,â Albus laughed. âBut this year weâre just staying home.â
âWe never go anywhere,â Matt told them. âWell, we did go see my uncle in America a couple years ago. I was eight. But we havenât been back since. Itâs really expensive to ride on Muggle airplanes, and we always go to Australia every Christmas,â he sighed. âIâd rather just visit my uncle than my grandparents.â
âIâve never been to America,â John told him, âWhatâs it like?â
âDifferent. The Muggles drive on the wrong side of the road,â Matt said, âBut it was loads of fun when we went. I think we might be going next year.â
âWell, you can all come visit me and Rose for a little while,â Albus told them, âWe usually have our birthday party at the Burrow, but you can come stay at my house before it.â
âThat would be awesome!â John grinned, âIâll just Floo to your place.â
âYeah, that would work,â Albus agreed, âAnd hopefully your parents will let you come, Matt.â
âI think they will,â Matt responded, âBut weâre not connected to the Floo Network.â
âYouâre not?â Albus asked, âWhy?â
âBasically, because of what happened in Australia with the Ministry and everyone finding out about me. My parents just want to lay low here, and if weâre not on the Network, thatâs one less way of the Ministry tracking us down. Of course, my dad works for the Ministry, so Iâm not exactly sure what my parentsâ logic is.â
âOh,â Albus said, âDo you just Apparate everywhere?â
âPretty much. Well, I Side-Along Apparate, of course. But that works to get where weâre going. My parents will just Apparate me to your house,â Matt told them.
âThatâll work.â
âAnd you can come stay at my house,â Rose told Amanda.
âOk, but I canât do any kind of Apparition or Floo,â Amanda said.
âItâs all right, my parents can drive. Weâll come get you,â Rose assured her.
âGreat. I canât wait to see your house. I bet itâs a lot different from mine. Iâve never been in a wizard house before,â Amanda said.
âSo, is your whole family going to be at the Burrow?â John asked.
âPretty much. We usually have a few parties there during the summer. A few of our cousins have summer birthdays, too, so there are a few other birthday parties. Rose and me always have a shared one, though, since weâre the same age. Samantha and Lindyâs birthday is in the beginning of July, so they get a party. Fred, Bradley, and Gabriella are all born in August, like Rose, so they all have parties, too. But theirs are usually at their own houses. Then thereâs the end of summer party, thatâs always at the end of August,â Albus told him.
âExcellent. Thereâll be some awesome Quidditch matches, then!â John grinned.
âOh, yeah, Quidditch can get pretty exciting during the summer,â Albus responded, âThereâs usually so many people that we can get a real tournament going.â
âThatâll be loads of fun, then. And my dad said heâd get me a broom this year,â John told them.
âGreat! You can bring it with you. Iâm asking for one for my birthday,â Albus said.
âIâve got a broom at home,â Matt said, âIâll bring it, too.â
âI obviously donât have one,â Amanda sighed, âMaybe I can convince my parents to get me one, but I doubt it. As much as theyâve grown accustomed to magic, the idea of flying still freaks them out.â
âItâs all right,â Rose said, âThere are plenty of brooms in our family, someone will let you borrow theirs.â
âSpeaking of Quidditch, I think the Chudley Cannons are going to make a real come-back next season,â Matt grinned.
âUgh!â Albus groaned, âYouâre kidding, right? Thereâs no way they could ever make a come back!â
âYeah they can!â Matt insisted, âAnd someday, theyâll make it to the League Cup and Iâll go and support them!â
âThe day the Chudley Cannons make it to the League Cup is the day Gryffindors and Slytherins get along,â John laughed.
âYouâll see, theyâll get to the League Cup. And then theyâll win it!â Matt said excitedly, âI want to go to the next one, even if the Cannons arenât in it, though.â
âMe, too,â Albus agreed.
âIâve been to the World Cup once,â Matt went on, âWhen I was four. I can hardly remember it, but Amy says we had really good seats. It was in Australia, I think itâs one of the only times itâs been there. It was the New Zealand Kiwis versus France. France won.â
âThat must have been awesome,â John grinned.
âYeah, Iâve been to regular matches, but not the World Cup,â Albus said.
âWell, I hardly remember any of it. I mostly remember Franceâs celebrating afterwards,â Matt said, âJust like Iâll be celebrating when the Cannons win.â
Everyone else groaned. The group kept talking about Quidditch for a while, and they all agreed that they wanted to go to the next Cup. No one knew where it would be, but they wanted to go even if it was far away.
Once theyâd exhausted the topic of Quidditch, they played a couple rounds of Wizardâs Chess and Exploding Snap. Rose won all the games of chess and while they each won at least one round of Exploding Snap, Rose won most of them as well. When the trolley came around, they bought a bit of everything and had fun eating Bertie Botts Beans and trading Chocolate Frog cards. Albus had most of the cards by now, but he was still didnât have McGonagall.
Towards the end of the trip, everyone quieted down a bit. Rose dug out a book and started reading, Amanda doodled on a piece of parchment, John and Albus started up the Quidditch discussion again, and Matt fell asleep. Albus and John were just beginning to discuss the chances of Puddlemere United making it into the next League Cup when the compartment door opened. Victoire and Amy walked into the compartment, both sporting huge grins.
âSo, howâs it feel to have graduated?â Rose asked, putting down here book.
âBrilliant!â Victoire said, âWeâve been celebrating with everyone else, but thought weâd come see you. What have you been up to?â
âNot much, just talking about Quidditch,â Albus said.
Victoire sat down next to Rose and Amy sat down next to her sleeping brother. âOf course. Thatâs one thing Iâll definitely miss next year,â Victoire sighed, âIâve never been very good at Quidditch, but I love watching it.â
âYou can come back to watch,â Albus told her, âYouâve got to. Iâm going to try out for Chaser next year and if I make it, I want you to come to the matches.â
âI will, at least some of them,â Victoire assured him, âBut Iâll be pretty busy next year. Healer training is pretty intense.â
âYouâll be good at it, though,â Rose said, âBoth of you will be.â
âI hope so,â Amy said quietly as she looked at Matt, âItâd be great to discover a better version of that potionâŠ.â
âIf anyone can do it, you can,â Victoire told her, âYouâve always been the best at Potions in our year. Iâve just barely squeaked by. I really hope I got at least an E on my N.E.W.T. If not, I canât become a Healer.â
Amy blushed, âWell, Iâm not that great at it. Iâm sure you got an E on your N.E.W.T.â
âWhere do you train to be a Healer?â Amanda asked, âIs there a university or something?â
âThere are some classes, of course, but itâs not like a Muggle university. And thereâs less schooling than Muggle doctors need. We do a couple years of classes and interning at St. Mungoâs,â Amy told her.
âYeah, weâre going to get a flat in London sometime this summer and split the rent during the training,â Victoire added.
âCan I go visit you? I want to see your flat,â Albus asked.
Victoire laughed, âOf course you can.â
Amy stretched her arms and got up, âWell, weâre almost there, so I think Iâll go get my stuff ready. You coming, Victoire?â
âSure, we could probably get in a bit more celebrating before weâre in London,â Victoire grinned. âSee you guys in a little while.â
Albus waved as his cousin and Amy left the compartment. The remainder of the journey was uneventful. Albus played another round of Exploding Snap with John and Amanda and then he dozed off for a bit. The next thing he knew, John was shaking him awake when they were in London. Albus yawned and started putting all his things back in his bag. He joined the crowd of students heading out of the train and walked onto the platform with his friends.
âThereâs my parents,â Matt pointed to the left and Albus saw the Eckertons talking to his Uncle Bill and Aunt Fleur, âI guess Iâll probably see you guys this summer, if my parents let me come.â
âThey will,â Albus said adamantly.
âTheyâd better,â John laughed.
âI hope so,â Matt responded quietly, âWell, Iâll let you know if I can, Albus. See you soon, I hope.â
âDefinitely, this summer will be awesome!â Albus grinned, âBye, Matt!â John, Rose, and Amanda all said goodbye as well.
âBye, guys!â Matt waved and walked over to his parents. Albus watched as Mrs. Eckerton pulled him into a tight hug. She reminded Albus a lot of his grandmother.
âYou should find your parents so they can meet ours,â Albus told John and Amanda.
âGood idea,â John looked out among the crowd, âOh, theyâre over there. Hey, Mum! Dad!â he shouted.
A man and woman walked over to John, the woman shaking her head and the man laughing. Three little girls followed them. âMust you be so loud, dear?â the woman asked.
âMum, what a way to greet me after you havenât seen me in months,â John grinned.
âOh, come here, Johnny,â the woman smiled and wrapped John in a hug.
âMum!â Johnâs cheeks reddened and he pulled away. âHi, Dad.â
âHello, John, how was the rest of term?â
âGreat!â
âAlbus! Rose!â Harry said from behind Albus.
Albus turned around, âHey, Dad! Hi, Mum, Lily, Hugo, Aunt Hermione, Uncle Ron.â Albus and Rose exchanged greetings with their parents and siblings while John continued to tell his parents about school. Lily and Hugo seemed to hit it off with one of Johnâs sisters and they were running around the platform, trying to get each other to eat the disgusting flavors of Bertie Bottâs.
Amanda had meanwhile found her parents and brought them over to the group. They both looked a bit uncomfortable among all the witches and wizards, but seemed to want to meet Albus and the others.
Rose seemed to take charge of all the introductions. âOk, Mum, Dad. These are mine and Albusâs friends, John and Amanda.â The next few minutes were spent with all the adults shaking hands and introducing themselves. Rose and Albus told John and Amandaâs parents about their birthday party and it seemed like both John and Amanda would be able to go. After a few minutes of discussing details, John, Amanda, and their families said goodbye to the Potters and the Weasleys and headed back into London.
âReady to go, James?â Harry shouted to his oldest son who was standing a few meters away, talking to Nathan.
âYeah, Dad, just a second,â James shouted back. He said something else to Nathan and then walked over to his family.
Albus and the rest of the Potters walked back out of the station with Rose and her family. Albus was tired from the journey home and did not say much. He was thinking about the past year. It had been great. Sure, the whole altercation with Washburn had been scary, but that was over now, and his dad was taking care of that at the Ministry. He was happy he had made a few good friends and was very glad that Matt trusted them with his secret. Albus was looking forward to the summer and having John and Matt visit him at Grimmauld Place, but in all honesty, he was looking forward about going back in September. He had only been at Hogwarts for a year, but it already felt like a second home to Albus.
~Fin~
âââââââââââââââââââââââââââ
A/N: Well, there it is, the last chapter! Itâs a bittersweet moment to finish posting this here. Iâve been working on this story for over a year, and even though I finished it last April, Iâve been editing it as Iâve posted it here.
Thanks go out to my wonderful beta and youngest sister, Dancer_of_Starlight. Sheâs been reading this and betaing it ever since I started writing it in September of 2007. Iâve bounced ideas off of her and she tells me whether theyâre good or theyâre awful. My other sister and my brother have also been extremely helpful. Thanks to them as well!
Thanks as well to all my faithful reviewers. XDNLxtlz99, sinwillys822, Moonylupin, and ginnyweasleypotter87, you guys are awesome!
Albusâs story is far from over, though! Be on the lookout for the sequel, Albus Potter and the Tracks They Left Behind, sometime shortly after Christmas! It chronicles Albusâs second year at Hogwarts and is filled with new characters and plots! It is completely finished, so updates will be on a regular basis. Iâm currently working on the nameless story of Albusâs third year.
Iâll leave you with that rather long bit of authorâs notes. I hope everyone has a Happy Hanukkah, Merry Christmas, and Happy Other Holidays!